]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
Use gdb_sysroot for main executable on attach
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 2 goodbye
2795 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2796 * 1 hello
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @quotation
2848 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2849 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2850 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2851 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2852 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2853 like this:
2854
2855 @smallexample
2856 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2857 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2858 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2859 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2860 @end smallexample
2861 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2862 @c doesn't support threads"?
2863 @end quotation
2864
2865 @cindex focus of debugging
2866 @cindex current thread
2867 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2868 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2869 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2870 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2871 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2872
2873 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2874 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2875 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2876 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2877 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2878 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2879 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2880 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2881 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2882 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2883
2884 @smallexample
2885 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2890 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2891 further qualifier.
2892
2893 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2894 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2895 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2896 @c program?
2897 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2898 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2899 @c threads ab initio?
2900
2901 @cindex thread number
2902 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2903 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2904 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2905
2906 @table @code
2907 @kindex info threads
2908 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2909 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2910 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2911 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2912 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2913
2914 @enumerate
2915 @item
2916 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2917
2918 @item
2919 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2920
2921 @item
2922 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2923 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2924 program itself.
2925
2926 @item
2927 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2928 @end enumerate
2929
2930 @noindent
2931 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2932 indicates the current thread.
2933
2934 For example,
2935 @end table
2936 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2937
2938 @smallexample
2939 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2940 Id Target Id Frame
2941 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2942 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2943 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2944 at threadtest.c:68
2945 @end smallexample
2946
2947 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2948 Solaris-specific command:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item maint info sol-threads
2952 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2953 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2954 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2959 @item thread @var{threadno}
2960 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2961 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2962 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2963 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2964 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2968 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2969 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2970 8 printf ("hello\n");
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @noindent
2974 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2975 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2976 threads.
2977
2978 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2979 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2980 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2981 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2982 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2983 information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 @kindex thread apply
2986 @cindex apply command to several threads
2987 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2988 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2989 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2990 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2991 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2992 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2993 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2994 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2995 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2996 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2997
2998
2999 @kindex thread name
3000 @cindex name a thread
3001 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3002 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3003 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3004 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3005
3006 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3007 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3008 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3009 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3010 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3011
3012 @kindex thread find
3013 @cindex search for a thread
3014 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3015 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3016 matches the supplied regular expression.
3017
3018 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3019 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3020 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3021 is the LWP id.
3022
3023 @smallexample
3024 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3025 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3026 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3027 Id Target Id Frame
3028 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 @kindex set print thread-events
3032 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3033 @item set print thread-events
3034 @itemx set print thread-events on
3035 @itemx set print thread-events off
3036 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3037 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3038 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3039 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3040 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3041
3042 @kindex show print thread-events
3043 @item show print thread-events
3044 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3045 have started and exited.
3046 @end table
3047
3048 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3049 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3050 programs with multiple threads.
3051
3052 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3053 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3054
3055 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3056 @table @code
3057 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3058 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3059 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3061 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3062 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3063 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3064 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3065 macro.
3066
3067 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3068 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3069 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3070 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3071 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3072 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3073
3074 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3075 refers to the default system directories that are
3076 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3077 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3078 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3079
3080 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3081 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3082 was loaded in the inferior process.
3083
3084 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3085 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3086 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3087 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3088 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3089 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3090 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3091
3092 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3093 only on some platforms.
3094
3095 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3096 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3097 Display current libthread_db search path.
3098
3099 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3100 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3101 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3102 @item set debug libthread-db
3103 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3104 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3105 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3106 @end table
3107
3108 @node Forks
3109 @section Debugging Forks
3110
3111 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3112 @cindex multiple processes
3113 @cindex processes, multiple
3114 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3115 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3116 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3117 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3118 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3119 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3120 will cause it to terminate.
3121
3122 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3123 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3124 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3125 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3126 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3127 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3128 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3129 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3130 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3131 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3132
3133 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3134 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3135 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3136 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3137
3138 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3139 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3140
3141 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3142 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3146 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3147 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3148 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3149 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @item parent
3153 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3154 unimpeded. This is the default.
3155
3156 @item child
3157 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3158 unimpeded.
3159
3160 @end table
3161
3162 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3163 @item show follow-fork-mode
3164 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3165 @end table
3166
3167 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3168 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3169 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3170
3171 @table @code
3172 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3173 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3174 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3175 retain debugger control over them both.
3176
3177 @table @code
3178 @item on
3179 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3180 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3181 independently. This is the default.
3182
3183 @item off
3184 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3185 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3186 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3187 is held suspended.
3188
3189 @end table
3190
3191 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3192 @item show detach-on-fork
3193 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3194 @end table
3195
3196 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3197 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3198 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3199 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3200 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3201 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3202
3203 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3204 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3205 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3206 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3207 and Programs}.
3208
3209 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3210 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3211 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3212 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3213 the child process's @code{main}.
3214
3215 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3216 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3217
3218 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3219 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3220 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3221 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3222 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3223 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3224 command.
3225
3226 @table @code
3227 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3228 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3229
3230 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3231 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3232
3233 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3234
3235 @table @code
3236 @item new
3237 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3238 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3239 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3240 original inferior.
3241
3242 For example:
3243
3244 @smallexample
3245 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3246 (gdb) info inferior
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog1
3249 (@value{GDBP}) run
3250 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3251 Program exited normally.
3252 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3253 Id Description Executable
3254 * 2 <null> prog2
3255 1 <null> prog1
3256 @end smallexample
3257
3258 @item same
3259 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3260 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3261 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3262 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3263 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3264
3265 For example:
3266
3267 @smallexample
3268 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3269 Id Description Executable
3270 * 1 <null> prog1
3271 (@value{GDBP}) run
3272 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3273 Program exited normally.
3274 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3275 Id Description Executable
3276 * 1 <null> prog2
3277 @end smallexample
3278
3279 @end table
3280 @end table
3281
3282 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3283 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3284 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3285
3286 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3287 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3288
3289 @cindex checkpoint
3290 @cindex restart
3291 @cindex bookmark
3292 @cindex snapshot of a process
3293 @cindex rewind program state
3294
3295 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3296 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3297 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3298 later.
3299
3300 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3301 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3302 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3303 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3304 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3305
3306 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3307 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3308 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3309 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3310 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3311 start again from there.
3312
3313 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3314 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3315
3316 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3317
3318 @table @code
3319 @kindex checkpoint
3320 @item checkpoint
3321 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3322 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3323 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3324
3325 @kindex info checkpoints
3326 @item info checkpoints
3327 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3328 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3329 listed:
3330
3331 @table @code
3332 @item Checkpoint ID
3333 @item Process ID
3334 @item Code Address
3335 @item Source line, or label
3336 @end table
3337
3338 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3339 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3340 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3341 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3342 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3343 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3344 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3345
3346 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3347 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3348 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3349 the debugger.
3350
3351 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3352 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3353 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3354
3355 @end table
3356
3357 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3358 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3359 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3360 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3361 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3362 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3363 previously read data can be read again.
3364
3365 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3366 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3367 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3368 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3369 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3370 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3371
3372 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3373 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3374 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3375 different execution path this time.
3376
3377 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3378 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3379 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3380 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3381 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3382 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3383 potentially pose a problem.
3384
3385 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3386
3387 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3388 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3389 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3390 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3391 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3392 next.
3393
3394 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3395 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3396 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3397 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3398 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3399
3400 @node Stopping
3401 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3402
3403 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3404 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3405 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3406
3407 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3408 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3409 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3410 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3411 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3412 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3413 explicitly request this information at any time.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex info program
3417 @item info program
3418 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3419 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3420 @end table
3421
3422 @menu
3423 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3424 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3425 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3426 Skipping over functions and files
3427 * Signals:: Signals
3428 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3429 @end menu
3430
3431 @node Breakpoints
3432 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3433
3434 @cindex breakpoints
3435 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3436 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3437 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3438 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3439 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3440 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3441 program.
3442
3443 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3444 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3445 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3446 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3447 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3448 call).
3449
3450 @cindex watchpoints
3451 @cindex data breakpoints
3452 @cindex memory tracing
3453 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3454 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3455 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3456 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3457 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3458 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3459 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3460 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3461 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3462 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3463 same commands.
3464
3465 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3466 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3467 Automatic Display}.
3468
3469 @cindex catchpoints
3470 @cindex breakpoint on events
3471 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3472 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3473 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3474 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3475 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3476 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3477 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3478
3479 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3480 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3481 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3482 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3483 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3484 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3485 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3486 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3487 enable it again.
3488
3489 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3490 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3491 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3492 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3493 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3494 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3495 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3496
3497 @menu
3498 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3499 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3500 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3501 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3502 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3503 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3504 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3505 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3506 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3507 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3508 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3509 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3510 @end menu
3511
3512 @node Set Breaks
3513 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3514
3515 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3516 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3517 @c
3518 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3519
3520 @kindex break
3521 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3522 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3523 @cindex latest breakpoint
3524 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3525 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3526 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3527 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3528 convenience variables.
3529
3530 @table @code
3531 @item break @var{location}
3532 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3533 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3534 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3535 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3536 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3537
3538 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3539 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3540 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3541 that situation.
3542
3543 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3544 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3545 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3546
3547 @item break
3548 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3549 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3550 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3551 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3552 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3553 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3554 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3555 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3556 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3557 inside loops.
3558
3559 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3560 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3561 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3562 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3563 existed when your program stopped.
3564
3565 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3566 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3567 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3568 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3569 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3570 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3571 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3572
3573 @kindex tbreak
3574 @item tbreak @var{args}
3575 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3576 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3577 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3578 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3579
3580 @kindex hbreak
3581 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3582 @item hbreak @var{args}
3583 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3584 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3585 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3586 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3587 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3588 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3589 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3590 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3591 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3592 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3593 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3594 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3595 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3596 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3597 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3598 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3599 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3600 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3601
3602 @kindex thbreak
3603 @item thbreak @var{args}
3604 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3605 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3606 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3607 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3608 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3609 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3610 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3611 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3612
3613 @kindex rbreak
3614 @cindex regular expression
3615 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3616 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3617 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3618 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3619 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3620 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3621 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3622 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3623 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3624
3625 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3626 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3627 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3628 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3629 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3630 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3631
3632 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3633 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3634 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3635 classes.
3636
3637 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3638 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3639 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3640
3641 @smallexample
3642 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3643 @end smallexample
3644
3645 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3646 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3647 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3648 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3649 every function in a given file:
3650
3651 @smallexample
3652 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3653 @end smallexample
3654
3655 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3656 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3657
3658 @kindex info breakpoints
3659 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3660 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3661 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3662 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3663 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3664 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3665 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3666
3667 @table @emph
3668 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3669 @item Type
3670 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3671 @item Disposition
3672 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3673 @item Enabled or Disabled
3674 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3675 that are not enabled.
3676 @item Address
3677 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3678 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3679 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3680 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3681 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3682 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3683 @item What
3684 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3685 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3686 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3687 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3688 @end table
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3692 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3693 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3694 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3695 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3696 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3697
3698 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3699 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3700 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3701 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3702
3703 @noindent
3704 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3705 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3706 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3707 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3708 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3709
3710 @noindent
3711 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3712 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3713 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3714 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3715 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3716 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3717
3718 @noindent
3719 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3720 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3721
3722 @end table
3723
3724 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3725 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3726 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3727 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3728
3729 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3730 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3731 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3732 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3733
3734 @itemize @bullet
3735 @item
3736 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3737
3738 @item
3739 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3740 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3741
3742 @item
3743 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3744 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3745
3746 @item
3747 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3748 several places where that function is inlined.
3749 @end itemize
3750
3751 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3752 the relevant locations.
3753
3754 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3755 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3756 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3757 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3758 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3759 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3760 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3761
3762 For example:
3763
3764 @smallexample
3765 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3766 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3767 stop only if i==1
3768 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3769 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3770 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3771 @end smallexample
3772
3773 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3774 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3775 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3776 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3777 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3778 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3779 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3780 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3781 that belong to that breakpoint.
3782
3783 @cindex pending breakpoints
3784 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3785 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3786 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3787 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3788 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3789 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3790 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3791 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3792 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3793 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3794 is not yet resolved.
3795
3796 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3797 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3798 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3799 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3800 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3801 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3802
3803 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3804 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3805 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3806 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3807
3808 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3809 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3810 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3811
3812 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3813 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3814 address specification to an address:
3815
3816 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3817 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3818 @table @code
3819 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3820 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3821 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3822
3823 @item set breakpoint pending on
3824 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3825 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3826
3827 @item set breakpoint pending off
3828 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3829 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3830 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3831
3832 @item show breakpoint pending
3833 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3834 @end table
3835
3836 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3837 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3838 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3839
3840 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3841 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3842 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3843 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3844 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3845 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3846 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3847 breakpoints.
3848
3849 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3850
3851 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3852 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3853 @table @code
3854 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3855 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3856 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3857 breakpoint must be used.
3858
3859 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3860 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3861 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3862 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3863 @end table
3864
3865 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3866 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3867 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3868 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3869 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3870 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3871 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3872 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3873 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3874
3875 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3876 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3877 @table @code
3878 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3879 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3880 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3881 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3882
3883 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3884 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3885 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3886 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3887 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3888 @end table
3889
3890 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3891 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3892 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3893
3894 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3895 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3896
3897 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3898
3899 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3900 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3901 @table @code
3902 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3903 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3904 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3905 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3906 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3907
3908 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3909 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3910 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3911 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3912 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3913 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3914 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3915 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3916 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3917 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3918 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3919 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3920 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3921
3922 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3923 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3924 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3925 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3926 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3927 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3928 @end table
3929
3930
3931 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3932 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3933 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3934 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3935 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3936 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3937 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3938 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3939
3940
3941 @node Set Watchpoints
3942 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3943
3944 @cindex setting watchpoints
3945 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3946 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3947 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3948 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3949 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3950
3951 @itemize @bullet
3952 @item
3953 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3954
3955 @item
3956 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3957 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3958 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3959
3960 @item
3961 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3962 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3963 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3964 @end itemize
3965
3966 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3967 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3968 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3969 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3970 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3971 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3972 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3973 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3974 the expression changes.
3975
3976 @cindex software watchpoints
3977 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3978 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3979 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3980 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3981 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3982 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3983 culprit.)
3984
3985 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3986 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3987 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3988
3989 @table @code
3990 @kindex watch
3991 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3992 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3993 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3994 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3995 to watch the value of a single variable:
3996
3997 @smallexample
3998 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3999 @end smallexample
4000
4001 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4002 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4003 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4004 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4005 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4006 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4007
4008 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4009 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4010 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4011 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4012 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4013 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4014 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4015 error.
4016
4017 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4018 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4019 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4020 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4021 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4022 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4023 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4024 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4025 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4026 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4027 Examples:
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4031 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 @kindex rwatch
4035 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4036 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4037 by the program.
4038
4039 @kindex awatch
4040 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4041 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4042 or written into by the program.
4043
4044 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4045 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4046 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4047 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4048 @end table
4049
4050 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4051 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4052 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4053 a never-changing value:
4054
4055 @smallexample
4056 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4057 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4058 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4059 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4060 @end smallexample
4061
4062 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4063 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4064 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4065 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4066 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4067 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4068
4069 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4070 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4071 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4072 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4073 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4074 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4075 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4076 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4077
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4080 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4081 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4082
4083 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4084 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4085 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4086 @end table
4087
4088 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4089 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4090 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4091
4092 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4093
4094 @smallexample
4095 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4096 @end smallexample
4097
4098 @noindent
4099 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4100
4101 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4102 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4103 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4104 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4105 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4106 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4107 will print a message like this:
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4114 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4115 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4116 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4117 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4118 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4119 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4120 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4121
4122 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4123 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4124 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4125 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4126 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4127 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4128
4129 @smallexample
4130 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4131 @end smallexample
4132
4133 @noindent
4134 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4135
4136 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4137 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4138 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4139 expression with separately allocated resources.
4140
4141 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4142 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4143 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4144
4145 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4146 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4147 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4148 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4149 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4150 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4151 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4152 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4153 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4154
4155 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4156 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4157 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4158 watched expression from every thread.
4159
4160 @quotation
4161 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4162 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4163 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4164 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4165 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4166 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4167 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4168 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4169 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4170 @end quotation
4171
4172 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4173
4174 @node Set Catchpoints
4175 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4176 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4177 @cindex exception handlers
4178 @cindex event handling
4179
4180 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4181 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4182 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4183
4184 @table @code
4185 @kindex catch
4186 @item catch @var{event}
4187 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4188
4189 @table @code
4190 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4191 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4192 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4193 @kindex catch throw
4194 @kindex catch rethrow
4195 @kindex catch catch
4196 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4197 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4198
4199 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4200 regular expression will be caught.
4201
4202 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4203 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4204 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4205 exception being thrown.
4206
4207 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4208 @value{GDBN}:
4209
4210 @itemize @bullet
4211 @item
4212 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4213 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4214 supported.
4215
4216 @item
4217 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4218 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4219 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4220 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4221 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4222 built.
4223
4224 @item
4225 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4226 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4227
4228 @item
4229 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4230 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4231 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4232 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4233
4234 @item
4235 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4236 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4237 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4238 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4239 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4240 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4241 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4242 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4243 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4244
4245 @item
4246 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4247
4248 @item
4249 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4250 @end itemize
4251
4252 @item exception
4253 @kindex catch exception
4254 @cindex Ada exception catching
4255 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4256 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4257 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4258 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4259 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4260
4261 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4262 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4263 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4264 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4265 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4266 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4267 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4268 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4269
4270 @item exception unhandled
4271 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4272 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4273
4274 @item assert
4275 @kindex catch assert
4276 A failed Ada assertion.
4277
4278 @item exec
4279 @kindex catch exec
4280 @cindex break on fork/exec
4281 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4282 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4283
4284 @item syscall
4285 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4286 @kindex catch syscall
4287 @cindex break on a system call.
4288 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4289 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4290 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4291 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4292 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4293 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4294 will be caught.
4295
4296 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4297 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4298 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4299 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4300
4301 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4302 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4303 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4304 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4305
4306 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4307 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4308 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4309 available choices.
4310
4311 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4312 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4313 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4314 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4315 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4316 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4317 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4318 behind the OS upgrades).
4319
4320 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4321 arguments to it:
4322
4323 @smallexample
4324 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4325 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4326 (@value{GDBP}) r
4327 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4328
4329 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4330 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4331 (@value{GDBP}) c
4332 Continuing.
4333
4334 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4335 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4336 (@value{GDBP})
4337 @end smallexample
4338
4339 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4343 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4344 (@value{GDBP}) r
4345 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4346
4347 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4348 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4349 (@value{GDBP}) c
4350 Continuing.
4351
4352 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4353 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4354 (@value{GDBP})
4355 @end smallexample
4356
4357 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4358 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4359 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4360
4361 @smallexample
4362 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4363 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4364 (@value{GDBP}) r
4365 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4366
4367 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4368 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4369 (@value{GDBP}) c
4370 Continuing.
4371
4372 Program exited normally.
4373 (@value{GDBP})
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4377 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4378 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4379 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4380
4381 @smallexample
4382 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4383 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4384 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4385 (@value{GDBP})
4386 @end smallexample
4387
4388 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4389 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4390 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4391 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4392 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4393 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4394
4395 @smallexample
4396 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4397 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4398 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4399 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4400 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4401 (@value{GDBP})
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4405
4406 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4407 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4408
4409 @smallexample
4410 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4411 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4412 @end smallexample
4413
4414 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4415
4416 @item fork
4417 @kindex catch fork
4418 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4419 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4420
4421 @item vfork
4422 @kindex catch vfork
4423 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4424 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4425
4426 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4427 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4428 @kindex catch load
4429 @kindex catch unload
4430 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4431 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4432 matches one of the affected libraries.
4433
4434 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4435 @kindex catch signal
4436 The delivery of a signal.
4437
4438 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4439 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4440 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4441
4442 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4443 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4444 signal names.
4445
4446 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4447 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4448 will be caught.
4449
4450 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4451 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4452 catchpoint.
4453
4454 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4455 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4456 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4457 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4458 commands.
4459
4460 @end table
4461
4462 @item tcatch @var{event}
4463 @kindex tcatch
4464 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4465 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4466
4467 @end table
4468
4469 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4470
4471
4472 @node Delete Breaks
4473 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4474
4475 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4476 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4477 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4478 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4479 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4480 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4481
4482 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4483 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4484 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4485 their breakpoint numbers.
4486
4487 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4488 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4489 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4490
4491 @table @code
4492 @kindex clear
4493 @item clear
4494 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4495 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4496 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4497 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4498
4499 @item clear @var{location}
4500 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4501 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4502 most useful ones are listed below:
4503
4504 @table @code
4505 @item clear @var{function}
4506 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4507 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4508
4509 @item clear @var{linenum}
4510 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4511 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4512 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4513 @end table
4514
4515 @cindex delete breakpoints
4516 @kindex delete
4517 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4518 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4519 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4520 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4521 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4522 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4523 @end table
4524
4525 @node Disabling
4526 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4527
4528 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4529 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4530 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4531 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4532 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4533
4534 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4535 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4536 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4537 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4538 do not know which numbers to use.
4539
4540 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4541 affects all of its locations.
4542
4543 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4544 different states of enablement:
4545
4546 @itemize @bullet
4547 @item
4548 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4549 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4550 @item
4551 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4552 @item
4553 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4554 disabled.
4555 @item
4556 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4557 N times, then becomes disabled.
4558 @item
4559 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4560 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4561 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4562 @end itemize
4563
4564 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4565 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4566
4567 @table @code
4568 @kindex disable
4569 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4570 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4571 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4572 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4573 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4574 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4575 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4576
4577 @kindex enable
4578 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4579 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4580 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4581
4582 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4583 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4584 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4585
4586 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4587 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4588 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4589 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4590 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4591 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4592 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4593
4594 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4595 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4596 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4597 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4598 @end table
4599
4600 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4601 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4602 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4603 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4604 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4605 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4606 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4607 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4608 Stepping}.)
4609
4610 @node Conditions
4611 @subsection Break Conditions
4612 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4613 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4614
4615 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4616 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4617 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4618 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4619 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4620 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4621 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4622 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4623
4624 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4625 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4626 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4627 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4628 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4629
4630 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4631 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4632 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4633 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4634 one.
4635
4636 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4637 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4638 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4639 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4640 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4641 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4642 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4643 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4644 conditions for the
4645 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4646 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4647
4648 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4649 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4650 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4651 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4652 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4653 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4654
4655 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4656 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4657 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4658 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4659 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4660
4661 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4662 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4663 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4664 with the @code{condition} command.
4665
4666 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4667 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4668 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4669 catchpoint.
4670
4671 @table @code
4672 @kindex condition
4673 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4674 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4675 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4676 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4677 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4678 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4679 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4680 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4681 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4682 prints an error message:
4683
4684 @smallexample
4685 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4686 @end smallexample
4687
4688 @noindent
4689 @value{GDBN} does
4690 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4691 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4692 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4693
4694 @item condition @var{bnum}
4695 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4696 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4697 @end table
4698
4699 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4700 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4701 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4702 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4703 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4704 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4705 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4706 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4707 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4708 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4709 your program reaches it.
4710
4711 @table @code
4712 @kindex ignore
4713 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4714 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4715 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4716 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4717 takes no action.
4718
4719 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4720 a count of zero.
4721
4722 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4723 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4724 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4725 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4726
4727 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4728 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4729 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4730
4731 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4732 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4733 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4734 Variables}.
4735 @end table
4736
4737 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4738
4739
4740 @node Break Commands
4741 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4742
4743 @cindex breakpoint commands
4744 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4745 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4746 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4747 enable other breakpoints.
4748
4749 @table @code
4750 @kindex commands
4751 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4752 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4753 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4754 @itemx end
4755 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4756 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4757 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4758
4759 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4760 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4761
4762 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4763 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4764 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4765 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4766 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4767 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4768 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4769 Expressions}).
4770 @end table
4771
4772 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4773 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4774
4775 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4776 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4777 that resumes execution.
4778
4779 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4780 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4781 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4782 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4783 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4784
4785 @kindex silent
4786 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4787 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4788 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4789 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4790 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4791 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4792
4793 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4794 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4795 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4796
4797 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4798 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4799
4800 @smallexample
4801 break foo if x>0
4802 commands
4803 silent
4804 printf "x is %d\n",x
4805 cont
4806 end
4807 @end smallexample
4808
4809 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4810 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4811 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4812 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4813 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4814 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4815 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4816
4817 @smallexample
4818 break 403
4819 commands
4820 silent
4821 set x = y + 4
4822 cont
4823 end
4824 @end smallexample
4825
4826 @node Dynamic Printf
4827 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4828
4829 @cindex dynamic printf
4830 @cindex dprintf
4831 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4832 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4833 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4834 having to recompile it.
4835
4836 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4837 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4838 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4839 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4840 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4841 redirects to files and so forth.
4842
4843 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4844 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4845 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4846 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4847 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4848 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4849 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4850
4851 @table @code
4852 @kindex dprintf
4853 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4854 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4855 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4856 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4857
4858 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4859 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4860 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4861 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4862 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4863 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4864
4865 @item gdb
4866 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4867 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4868
4869 @item call
4870 @kindex dprintf-style call
4871 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4872 @code{printf}).
4873
4874 @item agent
4875 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4876 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4877 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4878 support running commands on the target.
4879
4880 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4881 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4882 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4883 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4884 command.
4885
4886 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4887 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4888 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4889 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4890 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4891 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4892
4893 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4894 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4895 you could do the following:
4896
4897 @example
4898 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4899 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4900 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4901 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4902 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4903 (gdb) info break
4904 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4905 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4906 continue
4907 (gdb)
4908 @end example
4909
4910 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4911 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4912 the variable settings.
4913
4914 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4915 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4916 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4917 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4918 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4919 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4920
4921 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4922 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4923 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4924
4925 @end table
4926
4927 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4928 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4929 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4930 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4931 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4932 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4933
4934 @node Save Breakpoints
4935 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4936
4937 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4938 breakpoints}} command.
4939
4940 @table @code
4941 @kindex save breakpoints
4942 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4943 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4944 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4945 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4946 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4947 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4948 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4949 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4950 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4951 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4952 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4953 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4954 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4955 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4956 that can no longer be recreated.
4957 @end table
4958
4959 @node Static Probe Points
4960 @subsection Static Probe Points
4961
4962 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4963 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4964 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4965 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4966 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4967
4968 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4969 ELF-compatible systems:
4970
4971 @itemize @bullet
4972
4973 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4974 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4975 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4976 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4977 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4978 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4979 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4980 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4981
4982 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4983 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4984 C@t{++} languages.
4985 @end itemize
4986
4987 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4988 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4989 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4990 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4991 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4992 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4993 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4994 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4995 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4996
4997 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4998 probes}, with optional arguments:
4999
5000 @table @code
5001 @kindex info probes
5002 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5003 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5004 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5005 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5006
5007 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5008 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5009 probes from all providers are listed.
5010
5011 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5012 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5013 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5014
5015 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5016 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5017 given, all object files are considered.
5018
5019 @item info probes all
5020 List the available static probes, from all types.
5021 @end table
5022
5023 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5024 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5025 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5026 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5027 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5028
5029 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5030 commands, with optional arguments:
5031
5032 @table @code
5033 @kindex enable probes
5034 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5035 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5036 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5037 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5038
5039 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5040 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5041 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5042
5043 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5044 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5045 given, all object files are considered.
5046
5047 @kindex disable probes
5048 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5049 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5050 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5051 @end table
5052
5053 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5054 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5055 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5056 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5057 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5058 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5059 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5060 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5061 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5062 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5063 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5064 at the current probe point.
5065
5066 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5067 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5068 an error message.
5069
5070
5071 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5072 @node Error in Breakpoints
5073 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5074
5075 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5076 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5077
5078 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5079 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5080 @smallexample
5081 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5082 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5083 @end smallexample
5084
5085 @noindent
5086 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5087 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5088 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5089
5090 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5091 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5092
5093 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5094 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5095 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5096
5097 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5098 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5099 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5100 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5101
5102 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5103 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5104 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5105 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5106 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5107 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5108 first in the bundle.
5109
5110 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5111 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5112 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5113 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5114 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5115 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5116 is hit.
5117
5118 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5119 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5123 @end smallexample
5124
5125 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5126 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5127 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5128 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5129 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5130 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5131 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5132 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5133
5134 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5135 adjusted breakpoints:
5136
5137 @smallexample
5138 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5139 to 0x00010410.
5140 @end smallexample
5141
5142 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5143 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5144 frequently than expected.
5145
5146 @node Continuing and Stepping
5147 @section Continuing and Stepping
5148
5149 @cindex stepping
5150 @cindex continuing
5151 @cindex resuming execution
5152 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5153 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5154 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5155 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5156 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5157 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5158 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5159 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5160 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5161 handlers}).)
5162
5163 @table @code
5164 @kindex continue
5165 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5166 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5167 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5168 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5169 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5170 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5171 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5172 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5173 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5174 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5175
5176 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5177 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5178 @code{continue} is ignored.
5179
5180 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5181 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5182 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5183 @code{continue}.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5187 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5188 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5189 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5190
5191 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5192 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5193 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5194 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5195 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5196 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5197
5198 @table @code
5199 @kindex step
5200 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5201 @item step
5202 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5203 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5204 abbreviated @code{s}.
5205
5206 @quotation
5207 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5208 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5209 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5210 @c distinction here.
5211 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5212 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5213 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5214 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5215 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5216 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5217 below.
5218 @end quotation
5219
5220 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5221 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5222 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5223 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5224 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5225 called within the line.
5226
5227 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5228 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5229 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5230 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5231 was any debugging information about the routine.
5232
5233 @item step @var{count}
5234 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5235 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5236 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5237
5238 @kindex next
5239 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5240 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5241 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5242 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5243 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5244 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5245 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5246 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5247
5248 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5249
5250
5251 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5252 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5253 @c
5254 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5255 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5256 @c function are executed without stopping.
5257
5258 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5259 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5260 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5261
5262 @kindex set step-mode
5263 @item set step-mode
5264 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5265 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5266 @itemx set step-mode on
5267 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5268 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5269 information rather than stepping over it.
5270
5271 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5272 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5273 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5274
5275 @item set step-mode off
5276 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5277 debug information. This is the default.
5278
5279 @item show step-mode
5280 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5281 source line debug information.
5282
5283 @kindex finish
5284 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5285 @item finish
5286 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5287 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5288 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5289
5290 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5291 ,Returning from a Function}).
5292
5293 @kindex until
5294 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5295 @cindex run until specified location
5296 @item until
5297 @itemx u
5298 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5299 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5300 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5301 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5302 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5303 than the address of the jump.
5304
5305 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5306 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5307 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5308 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5309 through the next iteration.
5310
5311 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5312 stack frame.
5313
5314 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5315 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5316 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5317 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5318 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5319
5320 @smallexample
5321 (@value{GDBP}) f
5322 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5323 206 expand_input();
5324 (@value{GDBP}) until
5325 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5326 @end smallexample
5327
5328 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5329 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5330 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5331 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5332 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5333 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5334 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5335
5336 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5337 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5338 argument.
5339
5340 @item until @var{location}
5341 @itemx u @var{location}
5342 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5343 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5344 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5345 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5346 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5347 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5348 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5349 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5350 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5351 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5352 invocations have returned.
5353
5354 @smallexample
5355 94 int factorial (int value)
5356 95 @{
5357 96 if (value > 1) @{
5358 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5359 98 @}
5360 99 return (value);
5361 100 @}
5362 @end smallexample
5363
5364
5365 @kindex advance @var{location}
5366 @item advance @var{location}
5367 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5368 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5369 @ref{Specify Location}.
5370 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5371 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5372 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5373 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5374
5375
5376 @kindex stepi
5377 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5378 @item stepi
5379 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5380 @itemx si
5381 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5382
5383 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5384 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5385 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5386 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5387
5388 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5389
5390 @need 750
5391 @kindex nexti
5392 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5393 @item nexti
5394 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5395 @itemx ni
5396 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5397 proceed until the function returns.
5398
5399 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5400
5401 @end table
5402
5403 @anchor{range stepping}
5404 @cindex range stepping
5405 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5406 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5407 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5408 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5409 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5410 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5411 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5412 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5413 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5414 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5415 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5416 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5417 if necessary:
5418
5419 @table @code
5420 @kindex set range-stepping
5421 @kindex show range-stepping
5422 @item set range-stepping
5423 @itemx show range-stepping
5424 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5425
5426 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5427 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5428 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5429 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5430 default is @code{on}.
5431
5432 @end table
5433
5434 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5435 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5436 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5437
5438 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5439 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5440 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5441
5442 For example, consider the following C function:
5443
5444 @smallexample
5445 101 int func()
5446 102 @{
5447 103 foo(boring());
5448 104 bar(boring());
5449 105 @}
5450 @end smallexample
5451
5452 @noindent
5453 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5454 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5455 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5456 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5457
5458 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5459 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5460 is called from many places.
5461
5462 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5463 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5464 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5465 @code{foo}.
5466
5467 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5468 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5469
5470 @table @code
5471 @kindex skip function
5472 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5473 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5474 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5475 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5476 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5477
5478 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5479 will be skipped.
5480
5481 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5482 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5483
5484 @kindex skip file
5485 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5486 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5487 will be skipped over when stepping.
5488
5489 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5490 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5491 @end table
5492
5493 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5494 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex info skip
5498 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5499 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5500 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5501 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5502
5503 @table @emph
5504 @item Identifier
5505 A number identifying this skip.
5506 @item Type
5507 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5508 @item Enabled or Disabled
5509 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5510 @item Address
5511 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5512 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5513 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5514 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5515 address here.
5516 @item What
5517 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5518 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5519 where it is defined.
5520 @end table
5521
5522 @kindex skip delete
5523 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5524 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5525 skips.
5526
5527 @kindex skip enable
5528 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5529 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5530 skips.
5531
5532 @kindex skip disable
5533 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5534 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5535 skips.
5536
5537 @end table
5538
5539 @node Signals
5540 @section Signals
5541 @cindex signals
5542
5543 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5544 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5545 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5546 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5547 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5548 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5549 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5550 requested an alarm).
5551
5552 @cindex fatal signals
5553 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5554 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5555 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5556 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5557 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5558 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5559
5560 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5561 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5562 signal.
5563
5564 @cindex handling signals
5565 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5566 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5567 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5568 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5569 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5570
5571 @table @code
5572 @kindex info signals
5573 @kindex info handle
5574 @item info signals
5575 @itemx info handle
5576 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5577 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5578 the defined types of signals.
5579
5580 @item info signals @var{sig}
5581 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5582
5583 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5584
5585 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5586 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5587 for details about this command.
5588
5589 @kindex handle
5590 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5591 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5592 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5593 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5594 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5595 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5596 say what change to make.
5597 @end table
5598
5599 @c @group
5600 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5601 Their full names are:
5602
5603 @table @code
5604 @item nostop
5605 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5606 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5607
5608 @item stop
5609 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5610 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5611
5612 @item print
5613 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5614
5615 @item noprint
5616 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5617 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5618
5619 @item pass
5620 @itemx noignore
5621 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5622 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5623 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5624
5625 @item nopass
5626 @itemx ignore
5627 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5628 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5629 @end table
5630 @c @end group
5631
5632 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5633 program until you
5634 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5635 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5636 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5637 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5638 program sees that signal when you continue.
5639
5640 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5641 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5642 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5643 erroneous signals.
5644
5645 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5646 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5647 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5648 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5649 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5650 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5651 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5652 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5653 Program a Signal}.
5654
5655 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5656 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5657
5658 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5659 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5660 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5661 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5662 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5663 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5664 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5665 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5666 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5667 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5668 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5669 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5670 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5671
5672 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5673
5674 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5675 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5676 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5677 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5678
5679 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5680 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5681 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5682 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5683
5684 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5685 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5686
5687 @smallexample
5688 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5689 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5690 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5691 (@value{GDBP}) c
5692 Continuing.
5693
5694 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5695 main () sigusr1.c:28
5696 28 p = 0;
5697 (@value{GDBP}) si
5698 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5699 9 @{
5700 @end smallexample
5701
5702 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5703 program to receive the signal first:
5704
5705 @smallexample
5706 (@value{GDBP}) n
5707 28 p = 0;
5708 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5709 (@value{GDBP}) si
5710 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5711 9 @{
5712 (@value{GDBP})
5713 @end smallexample
5714
5715 @cindex extra signal information
5716 @anchor{extra signal information}
5717
5718 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5719 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5720 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5721 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5722 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5723 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5724 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5725 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5726 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5727 system header.
5728
5729 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5730 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5731
5732 @smallexample
5733 @group
5734 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5735 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5736 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5737 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5738 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5739 type = struct @{
5740 int si_signo;
5741 int si_errno;
5742 int si_code;
5743 union @{
5744 int _pad[28];
5745 struct @{...@} _kill;
5746 struct @{...@} _timer;
5747 struct @{...@} _rt;
5748 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5749 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5750 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5751 @} _sifields;
5752 @}
5753 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5754 type = struct @{
5755 void *si_addr;
5756 @}
5757 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5758 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5759 @end group
5760 @end smallexample
5761
5762 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5763
5764 @node Thread Stops
5765 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5766
5767 @cindex stopped threads
5768 @cindex threads, stopped
5769
5770 @cindex continuing threads
5771 @cindex threads, continuing
5772
5773 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5774 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5775 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5776 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5777 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5778 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5779 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5780 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5781 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5782
5783 @menu
5784 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5785 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5786 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5787 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5788 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5789 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5790 @end menu
5791
5792 @node All-Stop Mode
5793 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5794
5795 @cindex all-stop mode
5796
5797 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5798 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5799 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5800 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5801 underfoot.
5802
5803 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5804 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5805 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5806
5807 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5808 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5809 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5810 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5811 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5812 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5813 stops.
5814
5815 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5816 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5817 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5818 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5819
5820 @cindex automatic thread selection
5821 @cindex switching threads automatically
5822 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5823 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5824 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5825 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5826 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5827 thread.
5828
5829 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5830 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5831
5832 @table @code
5833 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5834 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5835 @cindex lock scheduler
5836 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5837 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5838 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5839 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5840 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5841 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5842 Other threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5843 completely free to run when you use commands
5844 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5845 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5846 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5847
5848 @item show scheduler-locking
5849 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5850 @end table
5851
5852 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5853 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5854 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5855 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5856 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5857 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5858 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5859 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5860 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5861 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5862 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5863 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5864 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5865 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5866
5867 @table @code
5868 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5869 @item set schedule-multiple
5870 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5871 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5872 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5873 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5874 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5875 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5876
5877 @item show schedule-multiple
5878 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5879 multiple processes.
5880 @end table
5881
5882 @node Non-Stop Mode
5883 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5884
5885 @cindex non-stop mode
5886
5887 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5888 @c with more details.
5889
5890 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5891 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5892 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5893 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5894 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5895 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5896
5897 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5898 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5899 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5900 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5901 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5902 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5903 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5904 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5905 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5906 independently and simultaneously.
5907
5908 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5909 or attach to your program:
5910
5911 @smallexample
5912 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5913 set pagination off
5914
5915 # Finally, turn it on!
5916 set non-stop on
5917 @end smallexample
5918
5919 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5920
5921 @table @code
5922 @kindex set non-stop
5923 @item set non-stop on
5924 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5925 @item set non-stop off
5926 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5927 @kindex show non-stop
5928 @item show non-stop
5929 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5930 @end table
5931
5932 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5933 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5934 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5935 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5936 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5937 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5938 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5939 default.
5940
5941 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5942 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5943 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5944
5945 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5946 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5947 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5948 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5949 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5950
5951 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5952 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5953 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5954 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5955 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5956
5957 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5958
5959 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5960 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5961 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5962 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5963 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5964 previously current thread.
5965
5966 @node Background Execution
5967 @subsection Background Execution
5968
5969 @cindex foreground execution
5970 @cindex background execution
5971 @cindex asynchronous execution
5972 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5973
5974 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5975 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5976 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5977 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5978 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5979 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5980
5981 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5982 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5983
5984 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5985 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5986 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5987 are:
5988
5989 @table @code
5990 @kindex run&
5991 @item run
5992 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5993
5994 @item attach
5995 @kindex attach&
5996 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5997
5998 @item step
5999 @kindex step&
6000 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6001
6002 @item stepi
6003 @kindex stepi&
6004 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6005
6006 @item next
6007 @kindex next&
6008 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6009
6010 @item nexti
6011 @kindex nexti&
6012 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6013
6014 @item continue
6015 @kindex continue&
6016 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6017
6018 @item finish
6019 @kindex finish&
6020 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6021
6022 @item until
6023 @kindex until&
6024 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6025
6026 @end table
6027
6028 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6029 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6030 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6031 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6032 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6033 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6034
6035 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6036 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6037
6038 @table @code
6039 @kindex interrupt
6040 @item interrupt
6041 @itemx interrupt -a
6042
6043 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6044 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6045 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6046 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6047 @end table
6048
6049 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6050 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6051
6052 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6053 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6054 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6055
6056 @table @code
6057 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6058 @cindex thread breakpoints
6059 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6060 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
6061 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6062 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6063 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6064 specify some source line.
6065
6066 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6067 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6068 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6069 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6070 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6071
6072 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6073 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6074 program.
6075
6076 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6077 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6078 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 @end table
6085
6086 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6087 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6088 thread list. For example:
6089
6090 @smallexample
6091 (@value{GDBP}) c
6092 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6096 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6097 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6098 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6099 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6100 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6101 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6102 command.
6103
6104 @node Interrupted System Calls
6105 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6106
6107 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6108 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6109 @cindex premature return from system calls
6110 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6111 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6112 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6113 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6114 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6115 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6116 stop execution.
6117
6118 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6119 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6120 style anyways.
6121
6122 For example, do not write code like this:
6123
6124 @smallexample
6125 sleep (10);
6126 @end smallexample
6127
6128 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6129 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6130
6131 Instead, write this:
6132
6133 @smallexample
6134 int unslept = 10;
6135 while (unslept > 0)
6136 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6137 @end smallexample
6138
6139 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6140 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6141 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6142 @value{GDBN}.
6143
6144 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6145 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6146 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6147 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6148
6149 @node Observer Mode
6150 @subsection Observer Mode
6151
6152 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6153 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6154 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6155 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6156 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6157
6158 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6159 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6160 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6161 mode.
6162
6163 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6164 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6165 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6166 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6167 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6168
6169 @table @code
6170
6171 @kindex observer
6172 @item set observer on
6173 @itemx set observer off
6174 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6175 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6176 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6177 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6178
6179 @item show observer
6180 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6181
6182 @kindex may-write-registers
6183 @item set may-write-registers on
6184 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6185 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6186 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6187 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6188
6189 @item show may-write-registers
6190 Show the current permission to write registers.
6191
6192 @kindex may-write-memory
6193 @item set may-write-memory on
6194 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6195 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6196 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6197 defaults to @code{on}.
6198
6199 @item show may-write-memory
6200 Show the current permission to write memory.
6201
6202 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6203 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6204 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6205 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6206 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6207 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6208
6209 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6210 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6211
6212 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6213 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6214 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6215 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6216 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6217 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6218 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6219
6220 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6221 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6222
6223 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6224 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6225 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6226 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6227 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6228 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6229 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6230
6231 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6232 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6233
6234 @kindex may-interrupt
6235 @item set may-interrupt on
6236 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6237 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6238 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6239 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6240 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6241
6242 @item show may-interrupt
6243 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6244
6245 @end table
6246
6247 @node Reverse Execution
6248 @chapter Running programs backward
6249 @cindex reverse execution
6250 @cindex running programs backward
6251
6252 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6253 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6254 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6255 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6256
6257 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6258 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6259 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6260 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6261 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6262 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6263
6264 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6265 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6266 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6267 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6268 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6269 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6270 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6271 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6272 prior values@footnote{
6273 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6274 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6275 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6276
6277 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6278 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6279 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6280 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6281 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6282 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6283 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6284 }.
6285
6286 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6287 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @kindex reverse-continue
6291 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6292 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6293 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6294 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6295 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6296 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6297 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6298
6299 @kindex reverse-step
6300 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6301 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6302 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6303 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6304
6305 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6306 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6307 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6308 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6309 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6310 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6311
6312 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6313 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6314
6315 @kindex reverse-stepi
6316 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6317 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6318 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6319 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6320 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6321 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6322 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6323
6324 @kindex reverse-next
6325 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6326 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6327 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6328 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6329 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6330 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6331 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6332 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6333 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6334 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6335
6336 @kindex reverse-nexti
6337 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6338 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6339 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6340 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6341 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6342 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6343 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6344 frame) is reached.
6345
6346 @kindex reverse-finish
6347 @item reverse-finish
6348 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6349 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6350 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6351 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6352
6353 @kindex set exec-direction
6354 @item set exec-direction
6355 Set the direction of target execution.
6356 @item set exec-direction reverse
6357 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6358 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6359 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6360 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6361 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6362 @item set exec-direction forward
6363 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6364 This is the default.
6365 @end table
6366
6367
6368 @node Process Record and Replay
6369 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6370 @cindex process record and replay
6371 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6372
6373 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6374 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6375 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6376
6377 @cindex replay mode
6378 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6379 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6380 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6381 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6382 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6383 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6384 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6385 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6386 execution log.
6387
6388 @cindex record mode
6389 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6390 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6391 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6392 for future replay.
6393
6394 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6395 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6396 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6397 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6398 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6399 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6400
6401 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6402 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6403 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6404 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6405
6406 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6407 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6408
6409 @table @code
6410 @kindex target record
6411 @kindex target record-full
6412 @kindex target record-btrace
6413 @kindex record
6414 @kindex record full
6415 @kindex record btrace
6416 @kindex record btrace bts
6417 @kindex record bts
6418 @kindex rec
6419 @kindex rec full
6420 @kindex rec btrace
6421 @kindex rec btrace bts
6422 @kindex rec bts
6423 @item record @var{method}
6424 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6425 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6426 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6427 recording methods are available:
6428
6429 @table @code
6430 @item full
6431 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6432 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6433 execution.
6434
6435 @item btrace @var{format}
6436 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6437 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6438 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6439 reverse execution.
6440
6441 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6442 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6443 formats are available:
6444
6445 @table @code
6446 @item bts
6447 @cindex branch trace store
6448 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6449 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6450 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6451 @end table
6452
6453 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6454 @end table
6455
6456 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6457 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6458 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6459 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6460
6461 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6462 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6463
6464 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6465 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6466 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6467 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6468 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6469
6470 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6471 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6472 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6473 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6474 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6475 does not support these two modes.
6476
6477 @kindex record stop
6478 @kindex rec s
6479 @item record stop
6480 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6481 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6482 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6483
6484 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6485 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6486 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6487 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6488 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6489
6490 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6491 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6492 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6493 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6494 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6495
6496 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6497 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6498
6499 @kindex record goto
6500 @item record goto
6501 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6502 ways to specify the location to go to:
6503
6504 @table @code
6505 @item record goto begin
6506 @itemx record goto start
6507 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6508
6509 @item record goto end
6510 Go to the end of the execution log.
6511
6512 @item record goto @var{n}
6513 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6514 @end table
6515
6516 @kindex record save
6517 @item record save @var{filename}
6518 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6519 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6520 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6521
6522 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6523
6524 @kindex record restore
6525 @item record restore @var{filename}
6526 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6527 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6528
6529 @kindex set record full
6530 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6531 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6532 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6533 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6534
6535 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6536 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6537 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6538 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6539 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6540 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6541 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6542 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6543
6544 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6545 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6546 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6547
6548 @kindex show record full
6549 @item show record full insn-number-max
6550 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6551 recording method.
6552
6553 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6554 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6555 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6556 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6557 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6558 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6559 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6560 oldest one to be deleted.
6561
6562 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6563 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6564
6565 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6566 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6567
6568 @item set record full memory-query
6569 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6570 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6571 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6572 case.
6573
6574 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6575 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6576 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6577 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6578 results.
6579
6580 @item show record full memory-query
6581 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6582
6583 @kindex set record btrace
6584 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6585 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6586 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6587 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6588 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6589 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6590 You can use the following command for that:
6591
6592 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6593 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6594 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6595 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6596 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6597 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6598 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6599 position.
6600
6601 @kindex show record btrace
6602 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6603 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6604
6605 @kindex set record btrace bts
6606 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6607 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6608 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6609 format. Default is 64KB.
6610
6611 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6612 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6613 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6614 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6615 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6616 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6617 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6618
6619 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6620 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6621
6622 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6623 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6624
6625 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6626 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6627 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6628
6629 @kindex info record
6630 @item info record
6631 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6632 method:
6633
6634 @table @code
6635 @item full
6636 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6637 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6638
6639 @itemize @bullet
6640 @item
6641 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6642 @item
6643 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6644 @item
6645 Highest recorded instruction number.
6646 @item
6647 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6648 @item
6649 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6650 @item
6651 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6652 @end itemize
6653
6654 @item btrace
6655 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6656
6657 @itemize @bullet
6658 @item
6659 Recording format.
6660 @item
6661 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6662 @item
6663 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6664 instructions.
6665 @item
6666 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6667 @end itemize
6668
6669 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6670 @itemize @bullet
6671 @item
6672 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6673 @end itemize
6674 @end table
6675
6676 @kindex record delete
6677 @kindex rec del
6678 @item record delete
6679 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6680 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6681 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6682 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6683
6684 @kindex record instruction-history
6685 @kindex rec instruction-history
6686 @item record instruction-history
6687 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6688 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6689 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6690 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6691 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6692
6693 @table @code
6694 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6695 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6696 @var{insn}.
6697
6698 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6699 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6700 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6701 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6702 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6703 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6704
6705 @item record instruction-history
6706 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6707
6708 @item record instruction-history -
6709 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6710
6711 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6712 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6713 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6714 number @var{end} is included.
6715 @end table
6716
6717 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6718
6719 @kindex set record
6720 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6721 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6722 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6723 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6724 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6725
6726 @kindex show record
6727 @item show record instruction-history-size
6728 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6729 instruction-history} command.
6730
6731 @kindex record function-call-history
6732 @kindex rec function-call-history
6733 @item record function-call-history
6734 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6735 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6736 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6737 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6738 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6739 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6740 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6741 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6742 given together.
6743
6744 @smallexample
6745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6746 1 void foo (void)
6747 2 @{
6748 3 @}
6749 4
6750 5 void bar (void)
6751 6 @{
6752 7 ...
6753 8 foo ();
6754 9 ...
6755 10 @}
6756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6757 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6758 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6759 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6760 @end smallexample
6761
6762 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6763 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6764 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6765 to print:
6766
6767 @table @code
6768 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6769 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6770
6771 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6772 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6773 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6774 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6775 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6776
6777 @item record function-call-history
6778 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6779
6780 @item record function-call-history -
6781 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6782
6783 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6784 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6785 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6786 @end table
6787
6788 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6789
6790 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6791 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6792 Define how many lines to print in the
6793 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6794 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6795
6796 @item show record function-call-history-size
6797 Show how many lines to print in the
6798 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6799 @end table
6800
6801
6802 @node Stack
6803 @chapter Examining the Stack
6804
6805 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6806 stopped and how it got there.
6807
6808 @cindex call stack
6809 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6810 is generated.
6811 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6812 the arguments of the call,
6813 and the local variables of the function being called.
6814 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6815 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6816 stack}.
6817
6818 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6819 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6820
6821 @cindex selected frame
6822 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6823 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6824 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6825 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6826 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6827 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6828
6829 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6830 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6831 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6832
6833 @menu
6834 * Frames:: Stack frames
6835 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6836 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6837 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6838 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6839
6840 @end menu
6841
6842 @node Frames
6843 @section Stack Frames
6844
6845 @cindex frame, definition
6846 @cindex stack frame
6847 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6848 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6849 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6850 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6851 which the function is executing.
6852
6853 @cindex initial frame
6854 @cindex outermost frame
6855 @cindex innermost frame
6856 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6857 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6858 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6859 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6860 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6861 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6862 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6863 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6864
6865 @cindex frame pointer
6866 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6867 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6868 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6869 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6870 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6871 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6872
6873 @cindex frame number
6874 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6875 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6876 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6877 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6878 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6879
6880 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6881 @c underflow problems.
6882 @cindex frameless execution
6883 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6884 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6885 @smallexample
6886 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6887 @end smallexample
6888 generates functions without a frame.)
6889 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6890 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6891 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6892 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6893 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6894 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6895 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6896
6897 @table @code
6898 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6899 @cindex current stack frame
6900 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6901 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6902 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6903 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6904 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6905
6906 @kindex select-frame
6907 @cindex selecting frame silently
6908 @item select-frame
6909 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6910 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6911 @code{frame}.
6912 @end table
6913
6914 @node Backtrace
6915 @section Backtraces
6916
6917 @cindex traceback
6918 @cindex call stack traces
6919 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6920 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6921 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6922 stack.
6923
6924 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6925 @table @code
6926 @kindex backtrace
6927 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6928 @item backtrace
6929 @itemx bt
6930 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6931 frames in the stack.
6932
6933 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6934 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6935
6936 @item backtrace @var{n}
6937 @itemx bt @var{n}
6938 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6939
6940 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6941 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6942 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6943
6944 @item backtrace full
6945 @itemx bt full
6946 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6947 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6948 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6949 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6950
6951 @item backtrace no-filters
6952 @itemx bt no-filters
6953 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6954 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6955 @itemx bt no-filters full
6956 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6957 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6958 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6959 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6960 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6961 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6962 support.
6963 @end table
6964
6965 @kindex where
6966 @kindex info stack
6967 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6968 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6969
6970 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6971 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6972 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6973 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6974 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6975 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6976 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6977 multi-threaded program.
6978
6979 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6980 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6981 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6982 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6983 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6984 line number.
6985
6986 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6987 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6988
6989 @smallexample
6990 @group
6991 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6992 at builtin.c:993
6993 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6994 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6995 at macro.c:71
6996 (More stack frames follow...)
6997 @end group
6998 @end smallexample
6999
7000 @noindent
7001 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7002 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7003 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7004
7005 @noindent
7006 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7007 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7008 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7009 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7010 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7011
7012 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7013 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7014 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7015 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7016 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7017 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7018 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7019 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7020 such a backtrace might look like:
7021
7022 @smallexample
7023 @group
7024 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7025 at builtin.c:993
7026 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7027 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7028 at macro.c:71
7029 (More stack frames follow...)
7030 @end group
7031 @end smallexample
7032
7033 @noindent
7034 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7035 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7036
7037 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7038 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7039 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7040
7041 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7042 @cindex program entry point
7043 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7044 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7045 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7046 @code{main}@footnote{
7047 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7048 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7049 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7050 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7051 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7052 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7053
7054 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7055 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7056
7057 @table @code
7058 @item set backtrace past-main
7059 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7060 @kindex set backtrace
7061 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7062
7063 @item set backtrace past-main off
7064 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7065 default.
7066
7067 @item show backtrace past-main
7068 @kindex show backtrace
7069 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7070
7071 @item set backtrace past-entry
7072 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7073 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7074 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7075 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7076
7077 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7078 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7079 application. This is the default.
7080
7081 @item show backtrace past-entry
7082 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7083
7084 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7085 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7086 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7087 @cindex backtrace limit
7088 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7089 or zero means unlimited levels.
7090
7091 @item show backtrace limit
7092 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7093 @end table
7094
7095 You can control how file names are displayed.
7096
7097 @table @code
7098 @item set filename-display
7099 @itemx set filename-display relative
7100 @cindex filename-display
7101 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7102
7103 @item set filename-display basename
7104 Display only basename of a filename.
7105
7106 @item set filename-display absolute
7107 Display an absolute filename.
7108
7109 @item show filename-display
7110 Show the current way to display filenames.
7111 @end table
7112
7113 @node Frame Filter Management
7114 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7115 @cindex managing frame filters
7116
7117 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7118 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7119
7120 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7121 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7122
7123 @table @code
7124 @kindex info frame-filter
7125 @item info frame-filter
7126 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7127 their name, priority and enabled status.
7128
7129 @kindex disable frame-filter
7130 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7131 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7132 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7133 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7134 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7135 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7136 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7137 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7138 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7139 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7140 may be enabled again later.
7141
7142 @kindex enable frame-filter
7143 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7144 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7145 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7146 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7147 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7148 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7149 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7150 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7151 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7152
7153 Example:
7154
7155 @smallexample
7156 (gdb) info frame-filter
7157
7158 global frame-filters:
7159 Priority Enabled Name
7160 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7161 100 Yes Reverse
7162
7163 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7164 Priority Enabled Name
7165 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7166
7167 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7168 Priority Enabled Name
7169 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7170
7171 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7172 (gdb) info frame-filter
7173
7174 global frame-filters:
7175 Priority Enabled Name
7176 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7177 100 Yes Reverse
7178
7179 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7180 Priority Enabled Name
7181 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7182
7183 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7184 Priority Enabled Name
7185 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7186
7187 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7188 (gdb) info frame-filter
7189
7190 global frame-filters:
7191 Priority Enabled Name
7192 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7193 100 Yes Reverse
7194
7195 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7196 Priority Enabled Name
7197 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7198
7199 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7200 Priority Enabled Name
7201 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7202 @end smallexample
7203
7204 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7205 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7206 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7207 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7208 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7209 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7210 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7211
7212 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7213 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7214 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7215 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7216 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7217 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7218 dictionary resides.
7219
7220 Example:
7221
7222 @smallexample
7223 (gdb) info frame-filter
7224
7225 global frame-filters:
7226 Priority Enabled Name
7227 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7228 100 Yes Reverse
7229
7230 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7231 Priority Enabled Name
7232 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7233
7234 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7235 Priority Enabled Name
7236 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7237
7238 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7239 (gdb) info frame-filter
7240
7241 global frame-filters:
7242 Priority Enabled Name
7243 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7244 50 Yes Reverse
7245
7246 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7247 Priority Enabled Name
7248 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7249
7250 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7251 Priority Enabled Name
7252 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7253 @end smallexample
7254 @end table
7255
7256 @node Selection
7257 @section Selecting a Frame
7258
7259 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7260 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7261 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7262 of the stack frame just selected.
7263
7264 @table @code
7265 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7266 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7267 @item frame @var{n}
7268 @itemx f @var{n}
7269 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7270 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7271 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7272 @code{main}.
7273
7274 @item frame @var{addr}
7275 @itemx f @var{addr}
7276 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7277 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7278 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7279 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7280 switches between them.
7281
7282 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7283 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7284
7285 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7286 pointer and a program counter.
7287
7288 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7289 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7290
7291 @kindex up
7292 @item up @var{n}
7293 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7294 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7295 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7296
7297 @kindex down
7298 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7299 @item down @var{n}
7300 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7301 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7302 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7303 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7304 @end table
7305
7306 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7307 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7308 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7309 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7310
7311 @need 1000
7312 For example:
7313
7314 @smallexample
7315 @group
7316 (@value{GDBP}) up
7317 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7318 at env.c:10
7319 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7320 @end group
7321 @end smallexample
7322
7323 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7324 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7325 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7326 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7327 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7328 for details.
7329
7330 @table @code
7331 @kindex down-silently
7332 @kindex up-silently
7333 @item up-silently @var{n}
7334 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7335 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7336 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7337 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7338 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7339 distracting.
7340 @end table
7341
7342 @node Frame Info
7343 @section Information About a Frame
7344
7345 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7346 stack frame.
7347
7348 @table @code
7349 @item frame
7350 @itemx f
7351 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7352 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7353 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7354 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7355 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7356
7357 @kindex info frame
7358 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7359 @item info frame
7360 @itemx info f
7361 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7362 including:
7363
7364 @itemize @bullet
7365 @item
7366 the address of the frame
7367 @item
7368 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7369 @item
7370 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7371 @item
7372 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7373 @item
7374 the address of the frame's arguments
7375 @item
7376 the address of the frame's local variables
7377 @item
7378 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7379 @item
7380 which registers were saved in the frame
7381 @end itemize
7382
7383 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7384 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7385 the usual conventions.
7386
7387 @item info frame @var{addr}
7388 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7389 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7390 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7391 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7392 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7393 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7394
7395 @kindex info args
7396 @item info args
7397 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7398
7399 @item info locals
7400 @kindex info locals
7401 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7402 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7403 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7404
7405 @end table
7406
7407
7408 @node Source
7409 @chapter Examining Source Files
7410
7411 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7412 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7413 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7414 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7415 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7416 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7417 source files by explicit command.
7418
7419 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7420 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7421 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7422
7423 @menu
7424 * List:: Printing source lines
7425 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7426 * Edit:: Editing source files
7427 * Search:: Searching source files
7428 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7429 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7430 @end menu
7431
7432 @node List
7433 @section Printing Source Lines
7434
7435 @kindex list
7436 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7437 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7438 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7439 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7440 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7441
7442 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7443
7444 @table @code
7445 @item list @var{linenum}
7446 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7447 current source file.
7448
7449 @item list @var{function}
7450 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7451 @var{function}.
7452
7453 @item list
7454 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7455 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7456 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7457 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7458 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7459
7460 @item list -
7461 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7462 @end table
7463
7464 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7465 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7466 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7467
7468 @table @code
7469 @kindex set listsize
7470 @item set listsize @var{count}
7471 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7472 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7473 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7474 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7475
7476 @kindex show listsize
7477 @item show listsize
7478 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7479 @end table
7480
7481 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7482 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7483 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7484 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7485 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7486
7487 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7488 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7489 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7490 to specify some source line.
7491
7492 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7493
7494 @table @code
7495 @item list @var{linespec}
7496 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7497
7498 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7499 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7500 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7501 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7502 the same source file as the first linespec.
7503
7504 @item list ,@var{last}
7505 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7506
7507 @item list @var{first},
7508 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7509
7510 @item list +
7511 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7512
7513 @item list -
7514 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7515
7516 @item list
7517 As described in the preceding table.
7518 @end table
7519
7520 @node Specify Location
7521 @section Specifying a Location
7522 @cindex specifying location
7523 @cindex linespec
7524
7525 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7526 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7527 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7528 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7529
7530 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7531 @value{GDBN} understands:
7532
7533 @table @code
7534 @item @var{linenum}
7535 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7536
7537 @item -@var{offset}
7538 @itemx +@var{offset}
7539 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7540 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7541 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7542 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7543 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7544 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7545 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7546 linespec.
7547
7548 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7549 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7550 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7551 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7552 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7553 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7554 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7555
7556 @item @var{function}
7557 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7558 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7559
7560 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7561 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7562
7563 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7564 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7565 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7566 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7567 functions in different source files.
7568
7569 @item @var{label}
7570 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7571 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7572 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7573 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7574 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7575
7576 @item *@var{address}
7577 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7578 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7579 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7580 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7581 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7582 source files.
7583
7584 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7585 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7586 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7587 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7588 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7589 of @var{address}:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item @var{expression}
7593 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7594
7595 @item @var{funcaddr}
7596 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7597 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7598 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7599 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7600 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7601 (although the Pascal form also works).
7602
7603 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7604 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7605
7606 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7607 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7608 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7609 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7610 functions with identical names in different source files.
7611 @end table
7612
7613 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7614 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7615 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7616 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7617 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7618 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7619
7620 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7621 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7622 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7623 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7624 each one of those probes.
7625
7626 @end table
7627
7628
7629 @node Edit
7630 @section Editing Source Files
7631 @cindex editing source files
7632
7633 @kindex edit
7634 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7635 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7636 The editing program of your choice
7637 is invoked with the current line set to
7638 the active line in the program.
7639 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7640 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7641
7642 @table @code
7643 @item edit @var{location}
7644 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7645 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7646 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7647 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7648 command most commonly used:
7649
7650 @table @code
7651 @item edit @var{number}
7652 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7653
7654 @item edit @var{function}
7655 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7656 @end table
7657
7658 @end table
7659
7660 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7661 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7662 @footnote{
7663 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7664 following command-line syntax:
7665 @smallexample
7666 ex +@var{number} file
7667 @end smallexample
7668 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7669 the file where to start editing.}.
7670 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7671 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7672 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7673 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7674 @smallexample
7675 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7676 export EDITOR
7677 gdb @dots{}
7678 @end smallexample
7679 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7680 @smallexample
7681 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7682 gdb @dots{}
7683 @end smallexample
7684
7685 @node Search
7686 @section Searching Source Files
7687 @cindex searching source files
7688
7689 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7690 regular expression.
7691
7692 @table @code
7693 @kindex search
7694 @kindex forward-search
7695 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7696 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7697 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7698 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7699 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7700 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7701 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7702 @code{fo}.
7703
7704 @kindex reverse-search
7705 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7706 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7707 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7708 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7709 this command as @code{rev}.
7710 @end table
7711
7712 @node Source Path
7713 @section Specifying Source Directories
7714
7715 @cindex source path
7716 @cindex directories for source files
7717 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7718 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7719 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7720 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7721 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7722 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7723 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7724
7725 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7726 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7727 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7728 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7729 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7730 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7731 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7732 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7733 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7734 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7735 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7736
7737 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7738 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7739 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7740 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7741 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7742 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7743
7744 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7745 source files.
7746
7747 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7748 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7749 each line is in the file.
7750
7751 @kindex directory
7752 @kindex dir
7753 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7754 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7755 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7756
7757 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7758 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7759
7760 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7761 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7762 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7763 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7764 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7765 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7766 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7767 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7768 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7769 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7770 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7771 name to look up the sources.
7772
7773 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7774 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7775 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7776 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7777 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7778 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7779 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7780 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7781
7782 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7783 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7784 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7785 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7786 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7787 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7788 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7789
7790 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7791 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7792 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7793 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7794 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7795 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7796 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7797 command.
7798
7799 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7800 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7801 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7802 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7803 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7804 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7805 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7806
7807 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7808 @cindex default source path substitution
7809 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7810 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7811 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7812 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7813 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7814 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7815 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7816 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7817 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7818 together.
7819
7820 @table @code
7821 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7822 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7823 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7824 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7825 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7826 part of absolute file names) or
7827 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7828 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7829
7830 @kindex cdir
7831 @kindex cwd
7832 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7833 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7834 @cindex compilation directory
7835 @cindex current directory
7836 @cindex working directory
7837 @cindex directory, current
7838 @cindex directory, compilation
7839 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7840 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7841 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7842 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7843 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7844 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7845
7846 @item directory
7847 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7848
7849 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7850 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7851
7852 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7853 @kindex set directories
7854 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7855 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7856
7857 @item show directories
7858 @kindex show directories
7859 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7860
7861 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7862 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7863 @kindex set substitute-path
7864 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7865 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7866 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7867
7868 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7869 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7870
7871 @smallexample
7872 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7873 @end smallexample
7874
7875 @noindent
7876 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7877 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7878 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7879
7880 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7881 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7882 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7883 the substitution.
7884
7885 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7886
7887 @smallexample
7888 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7889 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7890 @end smallexample
7891
7892 @noindent
7893 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7894 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7895 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7896 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7897
7898
7899 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7900 @kindex unset substitute-path
7901 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7902 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7903 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7904
7905 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7906
7907 @item show substitute-path [path]
7908 @kindex show substitute-path
7909 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7910 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7911
7912 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7913 rules.
7914
7915 @end table
7916
7917 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7918 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7919 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7920
7921 @enumerate
7922 @item
7923 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7924
7925 @item
7926 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7927 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7928 directories in one command.
7929 @end enumerate
7930
7931 @node Machine Code
7932 @section Source and Machine Code
7933 @cindex source line and its code address
7934
7935 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7936 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7937 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7938 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7939 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7940 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7941 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7942 well as hex.
7943
7944 @table @code
7945 @kindex info line
7946 @item info line @var{linespec}
7947 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7948 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7949 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7950 @end table
7951
7952 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7953 the object code for the first line of function
7954 @code{m4_changequote}:
7955
7956 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7957 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7958 @smallexample
7959 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7960 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7961 @end smallexample
7962
7963 @noindent
7964 @cindex code address and its source line
7965 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7966 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7967 @smallexample
7968 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7969 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7973 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7974 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7975 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7976 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7977 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7978 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7979 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7980 Variables}).
7981
7982 @table @code
7983 @kindex disassemble
7984 @cindex assembly instructions
7985 @cindex instructions, assembly
7986 @cindex machine instructions
7987 @cindex listing machine instructions
7988 @item disassemble
7989 @itemx disassemble /m
7990 @itemx disassemble /r
7991 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7992 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7993 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7994 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7995 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7996 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7997 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7998 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7999 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8000 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8001
8002 @table @code
8003 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8004 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8005 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8006 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8007 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8008 @end table
8009
8010 @noindent
8011 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8012 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8013
8014 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8015 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8016
8017 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8018 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8019 @end table
8020
8021 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8022 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8023
8024 @smallexample
8025 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8026 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8027 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8028 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8029 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8030 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8031 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8032 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8033 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8034 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8035 End of assembler dump.
8036 @end smallexample
8037
8038 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
8039 program is stopped just after function prologue:
8040
8041 @smallexample
8042 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8043 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8044 5 @{
8045 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8046 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8047 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8048 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8049 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8050
8051 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8052 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8053 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8054
8055 7 return 0;
8056 8 @}
8057 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8058 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8059 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8060
8061 End of assembler dump.
8062 @end smallexample
8063
8064 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8065
8066 @smallexample
8067 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8068 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8069 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8070 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8071 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8072 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8073 End of assembler dump.
8074 @end smallexample
8075
8076 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8077 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8078 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8079 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8080
8081 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8082 mnemonics or other syntax.
8083
8084 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8085 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8086 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8087 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8088 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8089
8090 @table @code
8091 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8092 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8093 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8094 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8095 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8096 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8097
8098 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8099 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8100 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8101 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8102
8103 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8104 @item show disassembly-flavor
8105 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8106 @end table
8107
8108 @table @code
8109 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8110 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8111 @item set disassemble-next-line
8112 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8113 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8114 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8115 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8116 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8117 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8118 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8119 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8120 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8121 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8122 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8123 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8124 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8125 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8126 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8127 instruction.
8128 @end table
8129
8130
8131 @node Data
8132 @chapter Examining Data
8133
8134 @cindex printing data
8135 @cindex examining data
8136 @kindex print
8137 @kindex inspect
8138 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8139 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8140 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8141 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8142 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8143 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8144
8145 @table @code
8146 @item print @var{expr}
8147 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8148 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8149 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8150 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8151 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8152 Formats}.
8153
8154 @item print
8155 @itemx print /@var{f}
8156 @cindex reprint the last value
8157 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8158 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8159 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8160 @end table
8161
8162 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8163 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8164 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8165
8166 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8167 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8168 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8169 Table}.
8170
8171 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8172 @kindex explore
8173 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8174 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8175 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8176 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8177 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8178 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8179 embedded in the higher level data types.
8180
8181 @table @code
8182 @item explore @var{arg}
8183 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8184 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8185 @end table
8186
8187 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8188 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8189 C program as
8190
8191 @smallexample
8192 struct SimpleStruct
8193 @{
8194 int i;
8195 double d;
8196 @};
8197
8198 struct ComplexStruct
8199 @{
8200 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8201 int arr[10];
8202 @};
8203 @end smallexample
8204
8205 @noindent
8206 followed by variable declarations as
8207
8208 @smallexample
8209 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8210 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8211 @end smallexample
8212
8213 @noindent
8214 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8215 @code{explore} command as follows.
8216
8217 @smallexample
8218 (gdb) explore cs
8219 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8220 the following fields:
8221
8222 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8223 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8224
8225 Enter the field number of choice:
8226 @end smallexample
8227
8228 @noindent
8229 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8230 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8231 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8232 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8233 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8234 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8235 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8236 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8237
8238 @smallexample
8239 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8240 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8241 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8242 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8243
8244 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8245 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8246
8247 Press enter to return to parent value:
8248 @end smallexample
8249
8250 @noindent
8251 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8252 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8253 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8254 to explore.
8255
8256 @smallexample
8257 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8258 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8259
8260 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8261
8262 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8263
8264 Press enter to return to parent value:
8265 @end smallexample
8266
8267 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8268 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8269 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8270 level data structure).
8271
8272 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8273 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8274 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8275 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8276 same example as above, your can explore the type
8277 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8278 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8279
8280 @smallexample
8281 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8282 @end smallexample
8283
8284 @noindent
8285 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8286 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8287 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8288 example.
8289
8290 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8291 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8292 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8293 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8294 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8295
8296 @table @code
8297 @item explore value @var{expr}
8298 @cindex explore value
8299 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8300 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8301 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8302 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8303 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8304
8305 @item explore type @var{arg}
8306 @cindex explore type
8307 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8308 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8309 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8310 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8311 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8312 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8313 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8314 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8315 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8316 @end table
8317
8318 @menu
8319 * Expressions:: Expressions
8320 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8321 * Variables:: Program variables
8322 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8323 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8324 * Memory:: Examining memory
8325 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8326 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8327 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8328 * Value History:: Value history
8329 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8330 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8331 * Registers:: Registers
8332 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8333 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8334 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8335 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8336 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8337 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8338 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8339 character set than GDB does
8340 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8341 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8342 @end menu
8343
8344 @node Expressions
8345 @section Expressions
8346
8347 @cindex expressions
8348 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8349 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8350 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8351 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8352 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8353 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8354 @ref{Compilation}.
8355
8356 @cindex arrays in expressions
8357 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8358 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8359 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8360 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8361 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8362 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8363
8364 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8365 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8366 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8367 languages.
8368
8369 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8370 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8371
8372 @cindex casts, in expressions
8373 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8374 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8375 at that address in memory.
8376 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8377
8378 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8379 to programming languages:
8380
8381 @table @code
8382 @item @@
8383 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8384 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8385
8386 @item ::
8387 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8388 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8389
8390 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8391 @cindex type casting memory
8392 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8393 @cindex casts, to view memory
8394 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8395 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8396 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8397 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8398 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8399 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8400 @end table
8401
8402 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8403 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8404 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8405
8406 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8407 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8408 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8409 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8410 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8411 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8412 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8413
8414 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8415 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8416 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8417 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8418 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8419 as well.
8420
8421 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8422 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8423 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8424 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8425 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8426 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8427 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8428 choices.
8429
8430 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8431 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8432 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8433
8434 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8435 @smallexample
8436 @group
8437 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8438 [0] cancel
8439 [1] all
8440 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8441 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8442 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8443 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8444 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8445 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8446 > 2 4 6
8447 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8448 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8449 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8450 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8451 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8452 breakpoints.
8453 (@value{GDBP})
8454 @end group
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 @table @code
8458 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8459 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8460 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8461
8462 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8463 is ambiguous.
8464
8465 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8466 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8467 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8468 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8469 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8470 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8471 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8472 in the use of the menu.
8473
8474 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8475 when an ambiguity is detected.
8476
8477 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8478 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8479
8480 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8481 @item show multiple-symbols
8482 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8483 @end table
8484
8485 @node Variables
8486 @section Program Variables
8487
8488 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8489 in your program.
8490
8491 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8492 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8493
8494 @itemize @bullet
8495 @item
8496 global (or file-static)
8497 @end itemize
8498
8499 @noindent or
8500
8501 @itemize @bullet
8502 @item
8503 visible according to the scope rules of the
8504 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8505 @end itemize
8506
8507 @noindent This means that in the function
8508
8509 @smallexample
8510 foo (a)
8511 int a;
8512 @{
8513 bar (a);
8514 @{
8515 int b = test ();
8516 bar (b);
8517 @}
8518 @}
8519 @end smallexample
8520
8521 @noindent
8522 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8523 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8524 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8525 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8526
8527 @cindex variable name conflict
8528 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8529 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8530 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8531 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8532 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8533 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8534 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8535
8536 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8537 @ifnotinfo
8538 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8539 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8540 @end ifnotinfo
8541 @smallexample
8542 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8543 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8544 @end smallexample
8545
8546 @noindent
8547 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8548 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8549 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8550 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8551
8552 @smallexample
8553 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8554 @end smallexample
8555
8556 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8557 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8558 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8559 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8560 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8561
8562 @smallexample
8563 void
8564 foo (int a)
8565 @{
8566 if (a < 10)
8567 bar (a);
8568 else
8569 process (a); /* Stop here */
8570 @}
8571
8572 int
8573 bar (int a)
8574 @{
8575 foo (a + 5);
8576 @}
8577 @end smallexample
8578
8579 @noindent
8580 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8581 here is what you might see
8582 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8583
8584 @smallexample
8585 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8586 $1 = 10
8587 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8588 $2 = 5
8589 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8590 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8591 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8592 $3 = 5
8593 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8594 $4 = 0
8595 @end smallexample
8596
8597 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8598 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8599 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8600 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8601 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8602
8603 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8604 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8605 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8606 @code{some_global}.
8607
8608 @smallexample
8609 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8610 $1 = 23
8611 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8612 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8613 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8614 $2 = 27
8615 @end smallexample
8616
8617 @cindex wrong values
8618 @cindex variable values, wrong
8619 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8620 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8621 @quotation
8622 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8623 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8624 scope, and just before exit.
8625 @end quotation
8626 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8627 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8628 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8629 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8630 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8631 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8632 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8633 variable definitions may be gone.
8634
8635 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8636 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8637 when compiling.
8638
8639 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8640 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8641 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8642 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8643 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8644 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8645 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8646
8647 @smallexample
8648 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8649 @end smallexample
8650
8651 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8652 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8653 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8654 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8655 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8656
8657 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8658 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8659 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8660 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8661
8662 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8663 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8664 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8665 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8666 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8667
8668 @smallexample
8669 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8670 29 i++;
8671 (gdb) next
8672 30 e (i);
8673 (gdb) print i
8674 $1 = 31
8675 (gdb) print i@@entry
8676 $2 = 30
8677 @end smallexample
8678
8679 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8680 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8681 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8682 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8683 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8684 For program code
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 char var0[] = "A";
8688 signed char var1[] = "A";
8689 @end smallexample
8690
8691 You get during debugging
8692 @smallexample
8693 (gdb) print var0
8694 $1 = "A"
8695 (gdb) print var1
8696 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8697 @end smallexample
8698
8699 @node Arrays
8700 @section Artificial Arrays
8701
8702 @cindex artificial array
8703 @cindex arrays
8704 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8705 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8706 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8707 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8708 program.
8709
8710 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8711 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8712 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8713 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8714 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8715 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8716 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8717 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8718 example. If a program says
8719
8720 @smallexample
8721 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8722 @end smallexample
8723
8724 @noindent
8725 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8726
8727 @smallexample
8728 p *array@@len
8729 @end smallexample
8730
8731 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8732 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8733 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8734 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8735 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8736
8737 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8738 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8739 The value need not be in memory:
8740 @smallexample
8741 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8742 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8743 @end smallexample
8744
8745 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8746 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8747 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8748 @smallexample
8749 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8750 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8751 @end smallexample
8752
8753 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8754 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8755 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8756 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8757 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8758 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8759 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8760 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8761 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8762 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8763
8764 @smallexample
8765 set $i = 0
8766 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8767 @key{RET}
8768 @key{RET}
8769 @dots{}
8770 @end smallexample
8771
8772 @node Output Formats
8773 @section Output Formats
8774
8775 @cindex formatted output
8776 @cindex output formats
8777 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8778 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8779 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8780 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8781 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8782
8783 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8784 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8785 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8786 letters supported are:
8787
8788 @table @code
8789 @item x
8790 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8791 hexadecimal.
8792
8793 @item d
8794 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8795
8796 @item u
8797 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8798
8799 @item o
8800 Print as integer in octal.
8801
8802 @item t
8803 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8804 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8805 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8806 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8807
8808 @item a
8809 @cindex unknown address, locating
8810 @cindex locate address
8811 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8812 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8813 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8814
8815 @smallexample
8816 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8817 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8818 @end smallexample
8819
8820 @noindent
8821 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8822 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8823
8824 @item c
8825 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8826 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8827 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8828 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8829
8830 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8831 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8832 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8833 data.
8834
8835 @item f
8836 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8837 using typical floating point syntax.
8838
8839 @item s
8840 @cindex printing strings
8841 @cindex printing byte arrays
8842 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8843 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8844 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8845 natural types.
8846
8847 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8848 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8849 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8850 array.
8851
8852 @item z
8853 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8854 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8855 to the size of the integer type.
8856
8857 @item r
8858 @cindex raw printing
8859 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8860 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8861 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8862 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8863 pretty-printer which might exist.
8864 @end table
8865
8866 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8867
8868 @smallexample
8869 p/x $pc
8870 @end smallexample
8871
8872 @noindent
8873 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8874 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8875
8876 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8877 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8878 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8879
8880 @node Memory
8881 @section Examining Memory
8882
8883 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8884 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8885
8886 @cindex examining memory
8887 @table @code
8888 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8889 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8890 @itemx x @var{addr}
8891 @itemx x
8892 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8893 @end table
8894
8895 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8896 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8897 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8898 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8899 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8900
8901 @table @r
8902 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8903 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8904 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8905 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8906 @c 4.1.2.
8907
8908 @item @var{f}, the display format
8909 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8910 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8911 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8912 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8913 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8914
8915 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8916 The unit size is any of
8917
8918 @table @code
8919 @item b
8920 Bytes.
8921 @item h
8922 Halfwords (two bytes).
8923 @item w
8924 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8925 @item g
8926 Giant words (eight bytes).
8927 @end table
8928
8929 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8930 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8931 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8932 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8933 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8934 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8935 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8936 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8937 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8938 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8939 be altered.
8940
8941 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8942 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8943 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8944 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8945 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8946 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8947 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8948 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8949 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8950 a value from memory).
8951 @end table
8952
8953 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8954 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8955 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8956 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8957 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8958
8959 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8960 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8961 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8962 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8963 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8964
8965 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8966 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8967 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8968 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8969 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8970 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8971 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8972 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8973 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8974
8975 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8976 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8977 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8978 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8979 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8980 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8981 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8982
8983 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8984 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8985
8986 @smallexample
8987 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8988 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8989 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8990 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8991 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8992 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8993 @end smallexample
8994
8995 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8996 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8997 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8998 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8999 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9000 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9001 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9002 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9003 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9004
9005 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9006 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9007 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9008
9009 @cindex remote memory comparison
9010 @cindex target memory comparison
9011 @cindex verify remote memory image
9012 @cindex verify target memory image
9013 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9014 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9015 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9016 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9017 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9018 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9019
9020 @table @code
9021 @kindex compare-sections
9022 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9023 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9024 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9025 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9026 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9027 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9028
9029 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9030 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9031 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9032 @end table
9033
9034 @node Auto Display
9035 @section Automatic Display
9036 @cindex automatic display
9037 @cindex display of expressions
9038
9039 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9040 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9041 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9042 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9043 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9044 The automatic display looks like this:
9045
9046 @smallexample
9047 2: foo = 38
9048 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9049 @end smallexample
9050
9051 @noindent
9052 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9053 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9054 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9055 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9056 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9057 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9058
9059 @table @code
9060 @kindex display
9061 @item display @var{expr}
9062 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9063 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9064
9065 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9066
9067 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9068 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9069 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9070 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9071 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9072
9073 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9074 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9075 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9076 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9077 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9078 @end table
9079
9080 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9081 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9082 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9083
9084 @table @code
9085 @kindex delete display
9086 @kindex undisplay
9087 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9088 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9089 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9090 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9091 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9092 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9093 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9094
9095 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9096 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9097
9098 @kindex disable display
9099 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9100 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9101 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9102 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9103 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9104 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9105 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9106 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9107
9108 @kindex enable display
9109 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9110 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9111 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9112 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9113 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9114 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9115 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9116
9117 @item display
9118 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9119 done when your program stops.
9120
9121 @kindex info display
9122 @item info display
9123 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9124 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9125 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9126 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9127 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9128 @end table
9129
9130 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9131 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9132 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9133 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9134 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9135 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9136 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9137 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9138 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9139 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9140 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9141
9142 @node Print Settings
9143 @section Print Settings
9144
9145 @cindex format options
9146 @cindex print settings
9147 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9148 and symbols are printed.
9149
9150 @noindent
9151 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9152
9153 @table @code
9154 @kindex set print
9155 @item set print address
9156 @itemx set print address on
9157 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9158 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9159 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9160 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9161 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9162 @code{set print address on}:
9163
9164 @smallexample
9165 @group
9166 (@value{GDBP}) f
9167 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9168 at input.c:530
9169 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9170 @end group
9171 @end smallexample
9172
9173 @item set print address off
9174 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9175 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9176
9177 @smallexample
9178 @group
9179 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9180 (@value{GDBP}) f
9181 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9182 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9183 @end group
9184 @end smallexample
9185
9186 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9187 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9188 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9189 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9190
9191 @kindex show print
9192 @item show print address
9193 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9194 @end table
9195
9196 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9197 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9198 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9199 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9200 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9201 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9202 it prints a symbolic address:
9203
9204 @table @code
9205 @item set print symbol-filename on
9206 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9207 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9208 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9209 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9210
9211 @item set print symbol-filename off
9212 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9213 default.
9214
9215 @item show print symbol-filename
9216 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9217 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9218 @end table
9219
9220 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9221 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9222 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9223
9224 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9225 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9226
9227 @table @code
9228 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9229 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9230 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9231 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9232 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9233 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9234 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9235 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9236
9237 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9238 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9239 symbolic address.
9240 @end table
9241
9242 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9243 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9244 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9245 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9246 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9247 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9248 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9249 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9250
9251 @smallexample
9252 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9253 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9254 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9255 @end smallexample
9256
9257 @quotation
9258 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9259 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9260 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9261 @end quotation
9262
9263 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9264 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9265
9266 @table @code
9267 @item set print symbol on
9268 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9269 one exists.
9270
9271 @item set print symbol off
9272 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9273 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9274 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9275
9276 @item show print symbol
9277 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9278 address.
9279 @end table
9280
9281 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9282
9283 @table @code
9284 @item set print array
9285 @itemx set print array on
9286 @cindex pretty print arrays
9287 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9288 but uses more space. The default is off.
9289
9290 @item set print array off
9291 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9292
9293 @item show print array
9294 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9295 arrays.
9296
9297 @cindex print array indexes
9298 @item set print array-indexes
9299 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9300 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9301 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9302 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9303
9304 @item set print array-indexes off
9305 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9306
9307 @item show print array-indexes
9308 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9309 arrays.
9310
9311 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9312 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9313 @cindex number of array elements to print
9314 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9315 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9316 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9317 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9318 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9319 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9320 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9321 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9322
9323 @item show print elements
9324 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9325 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9326
9327 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9328 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9329 @cindex printing frame argument values
9330 @cindex print all frame argument values
9331 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9332 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9333 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9334 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9335 values are:
9336
9337 @table @code
9338 @item all
9339 The values of all arguments are printed.
9340
9341 @item scalars
9342 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9343 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9344 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9345 only scalar arguments are shown:
9346
9347 @smallexample
9348 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9349 at frame-args.c:23
9350 @end smallexample
9351
9352 @item none
9353 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9354 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9355
9356 @smallexample
9357 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9358 at frame-args.c:23
9359 @end smallexample
9360 @end table
9361
9362 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9363 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9364 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9365 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9366 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9367 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9368 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9369 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9370 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9371 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9372
9373 @item show print frame-arguments
9374 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9375
9376 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9377 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9378
9379 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9380 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9381 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9382 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9383 This is the default.
9384
9385 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9386 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9387
9388 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9389 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9390 @kindex set print entry-values
9391 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9392 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9393 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9394 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9395 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9396
9397 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9398 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9399 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9400 @code{no} setting.
9401
9402 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9403 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9404 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9405 this information.
9406
9407 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9408
9409 @table @code
9410 @item no
9411 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9412 point.
9413 @smallexample
9414 #0 equal (val=5)
9415 #0 different (val=6)
9416 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9417 #0 born (val=10)
9418 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9419 @end smallexample
9420
9421 @item only
9422 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9423 values are never printed.
9424 @smallexample
9425 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9426 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9427 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9428 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9429 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9430 @end smallexample
9431
9432 @item preferred
9433 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9434 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9435 value for such parameter.
9436 @smallexample
9437 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9438 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9439 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9440 #0 born (val=10)
9441 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9442 @end smallexample
9443
9444 @item if-needed
9445 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9446 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9447 parameter.
9448 @smallexample
9449 #0 equal (val=5)
9450 #0 different (val=6)
9451 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9452 #0 born (val=10)
9453 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9454 @end smallexample
9455
9456 @item both
9457 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9458 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9459 optimizations.
9460 @smallexample
9461 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9462 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9463 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9464 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9465 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9466 @end smallexample
9467
9468 @item compact
9469 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9470 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9471 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9472 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9473 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9474 @smallexample
9475 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9476 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9477 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9478 #0 born (val=10)
9479 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @item default
9483 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9484 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9485 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9486 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9487 @smallexample
9488 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9489 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9490 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9491 #0 born (val=10)
9492 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9493 @end smallexample
9494 @end table
9495
9496 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9497 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9498
9499 @item show print entry-values
9500 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9501 entry.
9502
9503 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9504 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9505 @cindex repeated array elements
9506 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9507 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9508 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9509 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9510 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9511 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9512 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9513 is 10.
9514
9515 @item show print repeats
9516 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9517 elements.
9518
9519 @item set print null-stop
9520 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9521 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9522 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9523 contain only short strings.
9524 The default is off.
9525
9526 @item show print null-stop
9527 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9528 @sc{null} character.
9529
9530 @item set print pretty on
9531 @cindex print structures in indented form
9532 @cindex indentation in structure display
9533 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9534 per line, like this:
9535
9536 @smallexample
9537 @group
9538 $1 = @{
9539 next = 0x0,
9540 flags = @{
9541 sweet = 1,
9542 sour = 1
9543 @},
9544 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9545 @}
9546 @end group
9547 @end smallexample
9548
9549 @item set print pretty off
9550 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9551
9552 @smallexample
9553 @group
9554 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9555 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9556 @end group
9557 @end smallexample
9558
9559 @noindent
9560 This is the default format.
9561
9562 @item show print pretty
9563 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9564
9565 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9566 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9567 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9568 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9569 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9570 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9571 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9572 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9573
9574 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9575 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9576 international character sets, and is the default.
9577
9578 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9579 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9580
9581 @item set print union on
9582 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9583 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9584 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9585
9586 @item set print union off
9587 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9588 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9589 instead.
9590
9591 @item show print union
9592 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9593 structures and other unions.
9594
9595 For example, given the declarations
9596
9597 @smallexample
9598 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9599 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9600 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9601 Bug_forms;
9602
9603 struct thing @{
9604 Species it;
9605 union @{
9606 Tree_forms tree;
9607 Bug_forms bug;
9608 @} form;
9609 @};
9610
9611 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9612 @end smallexample
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9616
9617 @smallexample
9618 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @noindent
9622 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9623
9624 @smallexample
9625 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9626 @end smallexample
9627
9628 @noindent
9629 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9630 and in Pascal.
9631 @end table
9632
9633 @need 1000
9634 @noindent
9635 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9636
9637 @table @code
9638 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9639 @item set print demangle
9640 @itemx set print demangle on
9641 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9642 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9643 linkage. The default is on.
9644
9645 @item show print demangle
9646 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9647
9648 @item set print asm-demangle
9649 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9650 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9651 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9652 The default is off.
9653
9654 @item show print asm-demangle
9655 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9656 or demangled form.
9657
9658 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9659 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9660 @kindex set demangle-style
9661 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9662 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9663 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9664
9665 @table @code
9666 @item auto
9667 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9668 This is the default.
9669
9670 @item gnu
9671 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9672
9673 @item hp
9674 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9675
9676 @item lucid
9677 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9678
9679 @item arm
9680 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9681 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9682 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9683 require further enhancement to permit that.
9684
9685 @end table
9686 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9687
9688 @item show demangle-style
9689 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9690
9691 @item set print object
9692 @itemx set print object on
9693 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9694 @cindex display derived types
9695 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9696 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9697 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9698 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9699 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9700 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9701 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9702
9703 @item set print object off
9704 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9705 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9706
9707 @item show print object
9708 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9709
9710 @item set print static-members
9711 @itemx set print static-members on
9712 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9713 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9714
9715 @item set print static-members off
9716 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9717
9718 @item show print static-members
9719 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9720
9721 @item set print pascal_static-members
9722 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9723 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9724 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9725 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9726
9727 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9728 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9729
9730 @item show print pascal_static-members
9731 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9732
9733 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9734 @item set print vtbl
9735 @itemx set print vtbl on
9736 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9737 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9738 @cindex VTBL display
9739 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9740 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9741 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9742
9743 @item set print vtbl off
9744 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9745
9746 @item show print vtbl
9747 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9748 @end table
9749
9750 @node Pretty Printing
9751 @section Pretty Printing
9752
9753 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9754 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9755 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9756
9757 @menu
9758 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9759 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9760 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9761 @end menu
9762
9763 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9764 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9765
9766 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9767 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9768 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9769
9770 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9771 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9772 pretty-printers with their names.
9773 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9774 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9775 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9776 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9777
9778 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9779 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9780 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9781 do anything special.
9782
9783 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9784
9785 @itemize @bullet
9786 @item
9787 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9788 all inferiors.
9789
9790 @item
9791 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9792 when debugging that program.
9793 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9794
9795 @item
9796 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9797 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9798 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9799 @end itemize
9800
9801 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9802 pretty-printers are selected,
9803
9804 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9805 for new types.
9806
9807 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9808 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9809
9810 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9811
9812 @smallexample
9813 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9814 $1 = @{
9815 static npos = 4294967295,
9816 _M_dataplus = @{
9817 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9818 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9819 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9820 @},
9821 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9822 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9823 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9824 @}
9825 @}
9826 @end smallexample
9827
9828 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9829
9830 @smallexample
9831 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9832 $2 = "abcd"
9833 @end smallexample
9834
9835 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9836 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9837 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9838
9839 @table @code
9840 @kindex info pretty-printer
9841 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9842 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9843 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9844
9845 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9846 whose pretty-printers to list.
9847 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9848 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9849 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9850 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9851 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9852
9853 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9854 to list.
9855
9856 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9857 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9858 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9859 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9860
9861 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9862 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9863 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9864 @end table
9865
9866 Example:
9867
9868 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9869 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9870 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9871 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9872
9873 @smallexample
9874 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9875 library1.so:
9876 foo
9877 library2.so:
9878 bar
9879 bar1
9880 bar2
9881 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9882 library2.so:
9883 bar
9884 bar1
9885 bar2
9886 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9887 1 printer disabled
9888 2 of 3 printers enabled
9889 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9890 library1.so:
9891 foo [disabled]
9892 library2.so:
9893 bar
9894 bar1
9895 bar2
9896 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9897 1 printer disabled
9898 1 of 3 printers enabled
9899 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9900 library1.so:
9901 foo [disabled]
9902 library2.so:
9903 bar
9904 bar1 [disabled]
9905 bar2
9906 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9907 1 printer disabled
9908 0 of 3 printers enabled
9909 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9910 library1.so:
9911 foo [disabled]
9912 library2.so:
9913 bar [disabled]
9914 bar1 [disabled]
9915 bar2
9916 @end smallexample
9917
9918 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9919 as can each individual subprinter.
9920
9921 @node Value History
9922 @section Value History
9923
9924 @cindex value history
9925 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9926 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9927 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9928 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9929 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9930 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9931 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9932 symbol table.
9933
9934 @cindex @code{$}
9935 @cindex @code{$$}
9936 @cindex history number
9937 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9938 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9939 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9940 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9941 history number.
9942
9943 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9944 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9945 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9946 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9947 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9948 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9949 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9950
9951 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9952 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9953
9954 @smallexample
9955 p *$
9956 @end smallexample
9957
9958 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9959 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9960
9961 @smallexample
9962 p *$.next
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9967 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9968
9969 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9970 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9971
9972 @smallexample
9973 print x
9974 set x=5
9975 @end smallexample
9976
9977 @noindent
9978 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9979 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9980
9981 @table @code
9982 @kindex show values
9983 @item show values
9984 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9985 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9986 values} does not change the history.
9987
9988 @item show values @var{n}
9989 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9990
9991 @item show values +
9992 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9993 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9994 @end table
9995
9996 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9997 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9998
9999 @node Convenience Vars
10000 @section Convenience Variables
10001
10002 @cindex convenience variables
10003 @cindex user-defined variables
10004 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10005 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10006 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10007 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10008 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10009
10010 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10011 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10012 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10013 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10014 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10015
10016 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10017 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10018 For example:
10019
10020 @smallexample
10021 set $foo = *object_ptr
10022 @end smallexample
10023
10024 @noindent
10025 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10026 @code{object_ptr}.
10027
10028 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10029 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10030 value with another assignment at any time.
10031
10032 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10033 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10034 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10035 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10036
10037 @table @code
10038 @kindex show convenience
10039 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10040 @item show convenience
10041 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10042 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10043 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10044
10045 @kindex init-if-undefined
10046 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10047 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10048 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10049 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10050 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10051 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10052 override default values used in a command script.
10053
10054 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10055 any side-effects do not occur.
10056 @end table
10057
10058 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10059 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10060 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10061
10062 @smallexample
10063 set $i = 0
10064 print bar[$i++]->contents
10065 @end smallexample
10066
10067 @noindent
10068 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10069
10070 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10071 values likely to be useful.
10072
10073 @table @code
10074 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10075 @item $_
10076 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10077 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10078 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10079 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10080 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10081 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10082 to the type of @code{$__}.
10083
10084 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10085 @item $__
10086 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10087 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10088 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10089
10090 @item $_exitcode
10091 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10092 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10093 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10094 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10095
10096 @item $_exitsignal
10097 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10098 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10099 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10100 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10101
10102 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10103 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10104 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10105 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10106 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10107
10108 @smallexample
10109 #include <signal.h>
10110
10111 int
10112 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10113 @{
10114 raise (SIGALRM);
10115 return 0;
10116 @}
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10120 or signalled would be:
10121
10122 @smallexample
10123 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10124 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10125 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10126 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10127 >echo The program has exited\n
10128 >else
10129 >echo The program has signalled\n
10130 >end
10131 >end
10132 (@value{GDBP}) run
10133 Starting program:
10134
10135 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10136 The program no longer exists.
10137 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10138 The program has signalled
10139 @end smallexample
10140
10141 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10142 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10143 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10144 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10145
10146 @smallexample
10147 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10148 The program has exited
10149 @end smallexample
10150
10151 @item $_exception
10152 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10153 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10154
10155 @item $_probe_argc
10156 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10157 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10158
10159 @item $_sdata
10160 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10161 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10162 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10163 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10164 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10165
10166 @item $_siginfo
10167 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10168 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10169 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10170 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10171 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10172
10173 @item $_tlb
10174 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10175 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10176 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10177 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10178 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10179 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10180
10181 @end table
10182
10183 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10184 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10185 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10186
10187 @node Convenience Funs
10188 @section Convenience Functions
10189
10190 @cindex convenience functions
10191 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10192 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10193 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10194 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10195 @value{GDBN}.
10196
10197 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10198 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10199
10200 @table @code
10201
10202 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10203 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10204 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10205 returns zero.
10206
10207 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10208 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10209 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10210 it is @code{void}:
10211
10212 @smallexample
10213 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10214 $1 = void
10215 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10216 $2 = 1
10217 (@value{GDBP}) run
10218 Starting program: ./a.out
10219 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10220 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10221 $3 = 0
10222 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10223 $4 = 0
10224 @end smallexample
10225
10226 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10227 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10228 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10229 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10230 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10231 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10232 anymore.
10233
10234 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10235 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10236
10237 @smallexample
10238 void
10239 foo (void)
10240 @{
10241 @}
10242 @end smallexample
10243
10244 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10245
10246 @smallexample
10247 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10248 $1 = void
10249 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10250 $2 = 1
10251 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10252 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10253 $3 = void
10254 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10255 $4 = 1
10256 @end smallexample
10257
10258 @end table
10259
10260 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10261 @code{Python} support.
10262
10263 @table @code
10264
10265 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10266 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10267 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10268 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10269 Otherwise it returns zero.
10270
10271 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10272 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10273 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10274 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10275 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10276 regular expression support.
10277
10278 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10279 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10280 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10281 Otherwise it returns zero.
10282
10283 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10284 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10285 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10286
10287 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10288 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10289 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10290 Otherwise it returns zero.
10291
10292 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10293 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10294 The default is 1.
10295
10296 Example:
10297
10298 @smallexample
10299 (gdb) backtrace
10300 #0 bottom_func ()
10301 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10302 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10303 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10304 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10305 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10306 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10307 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10308 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10309 $1 = 1
10310 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10311 $1 = 1
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10315 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10316 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10317 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10318
10319 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10320 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10321 The default is 1.
10322
10323 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10324 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10325 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10326 Otherwise it returns zero.
10327
10328 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10329 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10330 The default is 1.
10331
10332 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10333 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10334 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10335 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10336
10337 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10338 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10339 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10340 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10341
10342 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10343 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10344 The default is 1.
10345
10346 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10347 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10348 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10349 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10350
10351 @end table
10352
10353 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10354 convenience functions.
10355
10356 @table @code
10357 @item help function
10358 @kindex help function
10359 @cindex show all convenience functions
10360 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10361 @end table
10362
10363 @node Registers
10364 @section Registers
10365
10366 @cindex registers
10367 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10368 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10369 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10370 your machine.
10371
10372 @table @code
10373 @kindex info registers
10374 @item info registers
10375 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10376 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10377
10378 @kindex info all-registers
10379 @cindex floating point registers
10380 @item info all-registers
10381 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10382 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10383
10384 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10385 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10386 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10387 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10388 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10389 @end table
10390
10391 @anchor{standard registers}
10392 @cindex stack pointer register
10393 @cindex program counter register
10394 @cindex process status register
10395 @cindex frame pointer register
10396 @cindex standard registers
10397 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10398 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10399 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10400 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10401 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10402 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10403 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10404 you could print the program counter in hex with
10405
10406 @smallexample
10407 p/x $pc
10408 @end smallexample
10409
10410 @noindent
10411 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10412
10413 @smallexample
10414 x/i $pc
10415 @end smallexample
10416
10417 @noindent
10418 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10419 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10420 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10421 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10422 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10423 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10424 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10425
10426 @smallexample
10427 set $sp += 4
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10431 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10432 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10433 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10434 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10435 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10436 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10437
10438 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10439 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10440 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10441 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10442 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10443 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10444 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10445
10446 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10447 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10448 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10449 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10450 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10451 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10452 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10453 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10454 prints the data in both formats.
10455
10456 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10457 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10458 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10459 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10460 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10461 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10462 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10463
10464 @smallexample
10465 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10466 $1 = @{
10467 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10468 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10469 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10470 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10471 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10472 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10473 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10474 @}
10475 @end smallexample
10476
10477 @noindent
10478 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10479 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10480 value to a @code{struct} member:
10481
10482 @smallexample
10483 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10484 @end smallexample
10485
10486 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10487 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10488 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10489 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10490 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10491 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10492
10493 @cindex caller-saved registers
10494 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10495 @cindex volatile registers
10496 @cindex <not saved> values
10497 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10498 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10499 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10500 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10501 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10502 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10503 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10504 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10505 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10506 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10507 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10508 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10509 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10510 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10511 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10512 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10513 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10514 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10515 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10516 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10517 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10518 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10519 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10520
10521 @node Floating Point Hardware
10522 @section Floating Point Hardware
10523 @cindex floating point
10524
10525 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10526 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10527
10528 @table @code
10529 @kindex info float
10530 @item info float
10531 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10532 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10533 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10534 the ARM and x86 machines.
10535 @end table
10536
10537 @node Vector Unit
10538 @section Vector Unit
10539 @cindex vector unit
10540
10541 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10542 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10543
10544 @table @code
10545 @kindex info vector
10546 @item info vector
10547 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10548 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10549 @end table
10550
10551 @node OS Information
10552 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10553 @cindex OS information
10554
10555 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10556 you debug your program.
10557
10558 @cindex auxiliary vector
10559 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10560 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10561 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10562 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10563 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10564 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10565 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10566 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10567 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10568 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10569 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10570 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10571
10572 @table @code
10573 @kindex info auxv
10574 @item info auxv
10575 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10576 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10577 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10578 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10579 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10580 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10581 an unrecognized tag.
10582 @end table
10583
10584 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10585 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10586 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10587 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10588 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10589 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10590 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10591
10592 @table @code
10593 @kindex info os
10594 @item info os @var{infotype}
10595
10596 Display OS information of the requested type.
10597
10598 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10599
10600 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10601 @table @code
10602 @kindex info os cpus
10603 @item cpus
10604 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10605 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10606 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10607 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10608 kernel initialization.
10609
10610 @kindex info os files
10611 @item files
10612 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10613 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10614 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10615 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10616
10617 @kindex info os modules
10618 @item modules
10619 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10620 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10621 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10622 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10623 in memory.
10624
10625 @kindex info os msg
10626 @item msg
10627 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10628 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10629 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10630 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10631 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10632 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10633 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10634 the message queue was last changed.
10635
10636 @kindex info os processes
10637 @item processes
10638 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10639 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10640 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10641 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10642 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10643 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10644
10645 @kindex info os procgroups
10646 @item procgroups
10647 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10648 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10649 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10650 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10651 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10652 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10653 and the process group leader is listed first.
10654
10655 @kindex info os semaphores
10656 @item semaphores
10657 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10658 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10659 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10660 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10661 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10662
10663 @kindex info os shm
10664 @item shm
10665 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10666 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10667 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10668 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10669 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10670 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10671 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10672
10673 @kindex info os sockets
10674 @item sockets
10675 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10676 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10677 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10678 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10679 connection.
10680
10681 @kindex info os threads
10682 @item threads
10683 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10684 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10685 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10686 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10687 process is not listed.
10688 @end table
10689
10690 @item info os
10691 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10692 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10693 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10694 types, this command will report an error.
10695 @end table
10696
10697 @node Memory Region Attributes
10698 @section Memory Region Attributes
10699 @cindex memory region attributes
10700
10701 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10702 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10703 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10704 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10705 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10706 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10707 user can override the fetched regions.
10708
10709 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10710 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10711 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10712 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10713 all memory.
10714
10715 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10716 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10717
10718 @table @code
10719 @kindex mem
10720 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10721 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10722 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10723 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10724 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10725 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10726
10727 @item mem auto
10728 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10729 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10730
10731 @kindex delete mem
10732 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10733 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10734 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10735
10736 @kindex disable mem
10737 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10738 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10739 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10740 It may be enabled again later.
10741
10742 @kindex enable mem
10743 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10744 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10745
10746 @kindex info mem
10747 @item info mem
10748 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10749 for each region:
10750
10751 @table @emph
10752 @item Memory Region Number
10753 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10754 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10755 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10756
10757 @item Lo Address
10758 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10759
10760 @item Hi Address
10761 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10762
10763 @item Attributes
10764 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10765 @end table
10766 @end table
10767
10768
10769 @subsection Attributes
10770
10771 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10772 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10773 write accesses to a memory region.
10774
10775 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10776 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10777 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10778
10779 @table @code
10780 @item ro
10781 Memory is read only.
10782 @item wo
10783 Memory is write only.
10784 @item rw
10785 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10786 @end table
10787
10788 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10789 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10790 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10791 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10792 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10793
10794 @table @code
10795 @item 8
10796 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10797 @item 16
10798 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10799 @item 32
10800 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10801 @item 64
10802 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10803 @end table
10804
10805 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10806 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10807 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10808 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10809 @c
10810 @c @table @code
10811 @c @item hwbreak
10812 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10813 @c @item swbreak (default)
10814 @c @end table
10815
10816 @subsubsection Data Cache
10817 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10818 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10819 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10820 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10821 registers.
10822
10823 @table @code
10824 @item cache
10825 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10826 @item nocache
10827 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10828 @end table
10829
10830 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10831 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10832 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10833 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10834 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10835
10836 @table @code
10837 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10838 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10839 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10840 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10841 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10842 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10843 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10844 The default value is @code{on}.
10845 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10846 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10847 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10848 @end table
10849
10850
10851 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10852 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10853 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10854 @c
10855 @c @table @code
10856 @c @item verify
10857 @c @item noverify (default)
10858 @c @end table
10859
10860 @node Dump/Restore Files
10861 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10862 @cindex dump/restore files
10863 @cindex append data to a file
10864 @cindex dump data to a file
10865 @cindex restore data from a file
10866
10867 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10868 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10869 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10870 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10871 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10872 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10873 files.
10874
10875 @table @code
10876
10877 @kindex dump
10878 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10879 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10880 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10881 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10882
10883 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10884 @table @code
10885 @item binary
10886 Raw binary form.
10887 @item ihex
10888 Intel hex format.
10889 @item srec
10890 Motorola S-record format.
10891 @item tekhex
10892 Tektronix Hex format.
10893 @end table
10894
10895 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10896 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10897 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10898 form.
10899
10900 @kindex append
10901 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10902 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10903 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10904 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10905 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10906
10907 @kindex restore
10908 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10909 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10910 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10911 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10912 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10913
10914 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10915 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10916 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10917 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10918 from that location.
10919
10920 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10921 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10922 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10923 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10924
10925 @end table
10926
10927 @node Core File Generation
10928 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10929 @cindex dump core from inferior
10930
10931 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10932 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10933 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10934 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10935 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10936 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10937 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10938
10939 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10940 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10941 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10942
10943 @table @code
10944 @kindex gcore
10945 @kindex generate-core-file
10946 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10947 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10948 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10949 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10950 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10951 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10952
10953 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10954 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10955
10956 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
10957 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
10958 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
10959
10960 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
10961 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
10962 @item set use-coredump-filter on
10963 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
10964 Enable or disable the use of the file
10965 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
10966 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
10967 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
10968 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
10969
10970 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
10971 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
10972 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
10973 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
10974 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
10975 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
10976 about the bits that can be set in the
10977 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
10978 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
10979
10980 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
10981 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
10982 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
10983 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
10984 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
10985 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
10986 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
10987 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
10988 @end table
10989
10990 @node Character Sets
10991 @section Character Sets
10992 @cindex character sets
10993 @cindex charset
10994 @cindex translating between character sets
10995 @cindex host character set
10996 @cindex target character set
10997
10998 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10999 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11000 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11001 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11002 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11003 @dfn{target character set}.
11004
11005 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11006 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11007 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11008 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11009 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11010 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11011 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11012 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11013 character and string literals in expressions.
11014
11015 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11016 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11017 target-charset} command, described below.
11018
11019 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11020 support:
11021
11022 @table @code
11023 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11024 @kindex set target-charset
11025 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11026 list of supported target character sets, type
11027 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11028
11029 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11030 @kindex set host-charset
11031 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11032
11033 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11034 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11035 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11036 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11037 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11038
11039 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11040 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11041 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11042
11043 @item set charset @var{charset}
11044 @kindex set charset
11045 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11046 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11047 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11048 for both host and target.
11049
11050 @item show charset
11051 @kindex show charset
11052 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11053
11054 @item show host-charset
11055 @kindex show host-charset
11056 Show the name of the current host character set.
11057
11058 @item show target-charset
11059 @kindex show target-charset
11060 Show the name of the current target character set.
11061
11062 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11063 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11064 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11065 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11066 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11067 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11068
11069 @item show target-wide-charset
11070 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11071 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11072 @end table
11073
11074 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11075 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11076 @file{charset-test.c}:
11077
11078 @smallexample
11079 #include <stdio.h>
11080
11081 char ascii_hello[]
11082 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11083 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11084 char ibm1047_hello[]
11085 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11086 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11087
11088 main ()
11089 @{
11090 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11091 @}
11092 @end smallexample
11093
11094 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11095 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11096 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11097
11098 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11099
11100 @smallexample
11101 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11102 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11103 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11104 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11105 @dots{}
11106 (@value{GDBP})
11107 @end smallexample
11108
11109 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11110 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11111 strings:
11112
11113 @smallexample
11114 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11115 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11116 (@value{GDBP})
11117 @end smallexample
11118
11119 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11120 initial character set:
11121 @smallexample
11122 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11123 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11124 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11125 (@value{GDBP})
11126 @end smallexample
11127
11128 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11129 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11130 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11131 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11132 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11133
11134 @smallexample
11135 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11136 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11137 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11138 $2 = 72 'H'
11139 (@value{GDBP})
11140 @end smallexample
11141
11142 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11143 literals you use in expressions:
11144
11145 @smallexample
11146 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11147 $3 = 43 '+'
11148 (@value{GDBP})
11149 @end smallexample
11150
11151 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11152 character.
11153
11154 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11155 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11156 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11157
11158 @smallexample
11159 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11160 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11161 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11162 $5 = 200 '\310'
11163 (@value{GDBP})
11164 @end smallexample
11165
11166 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11167 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11168
11169 @smallexample
11170 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11171 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11172 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11176 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11177 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11178 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11179 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11180
11181 @smallexample
11182 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11183 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11184 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11185 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11186 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11187 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11188 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11189 $7 = 72 '\110'
11190 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11191 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11192 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11193 $9 = 200 'H'
11194 (@value{GDBP})
11195 @end smallexample
11196
11197 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11198 string literals you use in expressions:
11199
11200 @smallexample
11201 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11202 $10 = 78 '+'
11203 (@value{GDBP})
11204 @end smallexample
11205
11206 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11207 character.
11208
11209 @node Caching Target Data
11210 @section Caching Data of Targets
11211 @cindex caching data of targets
11212
11213 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11214 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11215 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11216 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11217 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11218 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11219 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11220 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11221 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11222 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11223 is executing.
11224 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11225 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11226 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11227 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11228 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11229 in the code segment.
11230 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11231 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11232
11233 @table @code
11234 @kindex set remotecache
11235 @item set remotecache on
11236 @itemx set remotecache off
11237 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11238 with old scripts.
11239
11240 @kindex show remotecache
11241 @item show remotecache
11242 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11243
11244 @kindex set stack-cache
11245 @item set stack-cache on
11246 @itemx set stack-cache off
11247 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11248 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11249
11250 @kindex show stack-cache
11251 @item show stack-cache
11252 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11253
11254 @kindex set code-cache
11255 @item set code-cache on
11256 @itemx set code-cache off
11257 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11258 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11259 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11260
11261 @kindex show code-cache
11262 @item show code-cache
11263 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11264 accesses.
11265
11266 @kindex info dcache
11267 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11268 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11269 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11270 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11271 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11272 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11273
11274 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11275 printed in hex.
11276
11277 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11278 @cindex dcache size
11279 @kindex set dcache size
11280 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11281
11282 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11283 @cindex dcache line-size
11284 @kindex set dcache line-size
11285 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11286 Must be a power of 2.
11287
11288 @item show dcache size
11289 @kindex show dcache size
11290 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11291
11292 @item show dcache line-size
11293 @kindex show dcache line-size
11294 Show default size of dcache lines.
11295
11296 @end table
11297
11298 @node Searching Memory
11299 @section Search Memory
11300 @cindex searching memory
11301
11302 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11303 @code{find} command.
11304
11305 @table @code
11306 @kindex find
11307 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11308 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11309 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11310 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11311 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11312 @end table
11313
11314 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11315 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11316
11317 @table @r
11318 @item @var{s}, search query size
11319 The size of each search query value.
11320
11321 @table @code
11322 @item b
11323 bytes
11324 @item h
11325 halfwords (two bytes)
11326 @item w
11327 words (four bytes)
11328 @item g
11329 giant words (eight bytes)
11330 @end table
11331
11332 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11333 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11334 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11335
11336 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11337 value's type in the current language.
11338 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11339 pattern as a mixture of types.
11340 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11341 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11342 which is typically four bytes.
11343
11344 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11345 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11346 @end table
11347
11348 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11349 (@code{"}).
11350 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11351 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11352
11353 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11354 number of matches found.
11355
11356 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11357 @samp{$_}.
11358 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11359
11360 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11361
11362 @smallexample
11363 void
11364 hello ()
11365 @{
11366 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11367 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11368 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11369 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11370 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11371 @}
11372 @end smallexample
11373
11374 @noindent
11375 you get during debugging:
11376
11377 @smallexample
11378 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11379 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11380 1 pattern found
11381 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11382 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11383 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11384 2 patterns found
11385 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11386 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11387 1 pattern found
11388 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11389 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11390 1 pattern found
11391 (gdb) print $numfound
11392 $1 = 1
11393 (gdb) print $_
11394 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11395 @end smallexample
11396
11397 @node Optimized Code
11398 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11399 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11400 @cindex debugging optimized code
11401
11402 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11403 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11404 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11405 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11406 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11407 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11408 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11409
11410 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11411 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11412 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11413 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11414
11415 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11416 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11417 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11418 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11419 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11420 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11421
11422 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11423 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11424 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11425 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11426 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11427
11428 @menu
11429 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11430 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11431 @end menu
11432
11433 @node Inline Functions
11434 @section Inline Functions
11435 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11436
11437 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11438 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11439 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11440 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11441 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11442 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11443 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11444 @code{info frame} command.
11445
11446 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11447 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11448 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11449 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11450 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11451 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11452 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11453 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11454 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11455 local variables in the caller.
11456
11457 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11458 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11459 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11460 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11461 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11462 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11463 instructions are executed.
11464
11465 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11466 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11467 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11468 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11469
11470 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11471 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11472
11473 @itemize @bullet
11474 @item
11475 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11476 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11477 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11478 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11479 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11480 or inside the inlined function instead.
11481
11482 @item
11483 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11484 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11485 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11486 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11487
11488 @end itemize
11489
11490 @node Tail Call Frames
11491 @section Tail Call Frames
11492 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11493
11494 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11495 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11496 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11497 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11498 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11499
11500 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11501 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11502 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11503 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11504 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11505 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11506 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11507
11508 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11509 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11510 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11511 this information.
11512
11513 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11514 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11515
11516 @smallexample
11517 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11518 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11519 (gdb) info frame
11520 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11521 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11522 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11523 source language c++.
11524 Arglist at unknown address.
11525 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11526 @end smallexample
11527
11528 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11529 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11530 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11531 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11532 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11533 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11534
11535 @table @code
11536 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11537 @item set debug entry-values
11538 @kindex set debug entry-values
11539 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11540 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11541 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11542 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11543 result.
11544
11545 @item show debug entry-values
11546 @kindex show debug entry-values
11547 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11548 values at function entry and tail calls.
11549 @end table
11550
11551 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11552 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11553 reference by variable @code{x}):
11554
11555 @smallexample
11556 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11557 void (*x) (void) = c;
11558 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11559 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11560 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11561
11562 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11563 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11564 a () at t.c:3
11565 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11566 (gdb) bt
11567 #0 a () at t.c:3
11568 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11569 @end smallexample
11570
11571 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11572
11573 @smallexample
11574 int i;
11575 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11576 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11577 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11578 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11579 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11580 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11581 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11582 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11583
11584 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11585 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11586 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11587 (gdb) bt
11588 #0 f () at t.c:2
11589 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11590 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11591 @end smallexample
11592
11593 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11594 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11595
11596 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11597 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11598 @set ARROW @click{}
11599 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11600 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11601 @end ifset
11602 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11603 @set ARROW ->
11604 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11605 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11606 @end ifclear
11607
11608 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11609 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11610 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11611
11612 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11613 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11614 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11615 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11616 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11617 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11618
11619 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11620 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11621 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11622 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11623 omitted.
11624
11625 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11626 entry may fail:
11627
11628 @smallexample
11629 int v;
11630 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11631 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11632 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11633 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11634 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11635 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11636
11637 (gdb) bt
11638 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11639 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11640 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11641 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11642 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11643 @end smallexample
11644
11645 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11646 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11647 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11648 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11649 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11650
11651 @node Macros
11652 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11653
11654 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11655 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11656 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11657 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11658 where it was defined.
11659
11660 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11661 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11662 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11663 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11664
11665 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11666 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11667 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11668 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11669 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11670 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11671 see @ref{List}.
11672
11673 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11674 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11675 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11676
11677 @table @code
11678
11679 @kindex macro expand
11680 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11681 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11682 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11683 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11684 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11685 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11686 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11687 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11688 it can be any string of tokens.
11689
11690 @kindex macro exp1
11691 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11692 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11693 @cindex expand macro once
11694 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11695 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11696 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11697 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11698 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11699 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11700 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11701 can be any string of tokens.
11702
11703 @kindex info macro
11704 @cindex macro definition, showing
11705 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11706 @cindex macros, from debug info
11707 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11708 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11709 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11710 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11711 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11712 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11713
11714 @kindex info macros
11715 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11716 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11717 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11718 command-line where those definitions were established.
11719
11720 @kindex macro define
11721 @cindex user-defined macros
11722 @cindex defining macros interactively
11723 @cindex macros, user-defined
11724 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11725 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11726 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11727 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11728 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11729 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11730 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11731 @var{arglist}.
11732
11733 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11734 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11735 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11736 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11737 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11738
11739 @kindex macro undef
11740 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11741 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11742 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11743 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11744 in the program being debugged.
11745
11746 @kindex macro list
11747 @item macro list
11748 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11749 @end table
11750
11751 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11752 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11753 show our source files:
11754
11755 @smallexample
11756 $ cat sample.c
11757 #include <stdio.h>
11758 #include "sample.h"
11759
11760 #define M 42
11761 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11762
11763 main ()
11764 @{
11765 #define N 28
11766 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11767 #undef N
11768 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11769 #define N 1729
11770 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11771 @}
11772 $ cat sample.h
11773 #define Q <
11774 $
11775 @end smallexample
11776
11777 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11778 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11779 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11780 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11781 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11782 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11783 information.
11784
11785 @smallexample
11786 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11787 $
11788 @end smallexample
11789
11790 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11791
11792 @smallexample
11793 $ gdb -nw sample
11794 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11795 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11796 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11797 (@value{GDBP})
11798 @end smallexample
11799
11800 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11801 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11802 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11803
11804 @smallexample
11805 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11806 3
11807 4 #define M 42
11808 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11809 6
11810 7 main ()
11811 8 @{
11812 9 #define N 28
11813 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11814 11 #undef N
11815 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11816 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11817 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11818 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11819 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11820 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11821 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11822 #define Q <
11823 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11824 expands to: (42 + 1)
11825 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11826 expands to: once (M + 1)
11827 (@value{GDBP})
11828 @end smallexample
11829
11830 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11831 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11832 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11833 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11834
11835 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11836 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11837
11838 @smallexample
11839 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11840 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11841 (@value{GDBP}) run
11842 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11843
11844 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11845 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11846 (@value{GDBP})
11847 @end smallexample
11848
11849 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11850
11851 @smallexample
11852 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11853 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11854 #define N 28
11855 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11856 expands to: 28 < 42
11857 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11858 $1 = 1
11859 (@value{GDBP})
11860 @end smallexample
11861
11862 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11863 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11864 thereof) in force at each point:
11865
11866 @smallexample
11867 (@value{GDBP}) next
11868 Hello, world!
11869 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11870 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11871 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11872 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11873 (@value{GDBP}) next
11874 We're so creative.
11875 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11876 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11877 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11878 #define N 1729
11879 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11880 expands to: 1729 < 42
11881 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11882 $2 = 0
11883 (@value{GDBP})
11884 @end smallexample
11885
11886 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11887 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11888 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11889 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11890
11891 @smallexample
11892 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11893 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11894 -D__STDC__=1
11895 (@value{GDBP})
11896 @end smallexample
11897
11898
11899 @node Tracepoints
11900 @chapter Tracepoints
11901 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11902 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11903
11904 @cindex tracepoints
11905 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11906 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11907 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11908 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11909 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11910 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11911 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11912
11913 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11914 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11915 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11916 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11917 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11918 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11919 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11920 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11921 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11922 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11923 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11924
11925 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11926 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11927 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11928 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11929 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11930 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11931 Packets}.
11932
11933 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11934 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11935 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11936
11937 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11938
11939 @menu
11940 * Set Tracepoints::
11941 * Analyze Collected Data::
11942 * Tracepoint Variables::
11943 * Trace Files::
11944 @end menu
11945
11946 @node Set Tracepoints
11947 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11948
11949 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11950 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11951 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11952 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11953 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11954 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11955 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11956
11957 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11958 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11959 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11960 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11961 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11962 tracepoint was hit.
11963
11964 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11965 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11966 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11967 either.
11968
11969 @cindex fast tracepoints
11970 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11971 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11972 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11973
11974 @cindex static tracepoints
11975 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11976 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11977 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11978 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11979 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11980 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11981 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11982 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11983 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11984 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11985 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11986 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11987 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11988 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11989 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11990 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11991 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11992 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11993 static tracepoint marker.
11994
11995 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11996 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11997
11998 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11999 conditions and actions.
12000
12001 @menu
12002 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12003 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12004 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12005 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12006 * Trace State Variables::
12007 * Tracepoint Actions::
12008 * Listing Tracepoints::
12009 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12010 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12011 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12012 @end menu
12013
12014 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12015 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12016
12017 @table @code
12018 @cindex set tracepoint
12019 @kindex trace
12020 @item trace @var{location}
12021 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12022 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
12023 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
12024 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
12025 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
12026 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
12027 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12028 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12029 in tracing}).
12030 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12031 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12032 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12033 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12034 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12035 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12036 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12037 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12038 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12039 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12040 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12041 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12042
12043 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12044
12045 @smallexample
12046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12047
12048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12049
12050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12051
12052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12053
12054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12055 @end smallexample
12056
12057 @noindent
12058 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12059
12060 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12061 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12062 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12063 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12064 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12065 information on tracepoint conditions.
12066
12067 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12068 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12069 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12070 @kindex ftrace
12071 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12072 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12073 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12074 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12075 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12076 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12077 message.
12078
12079 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12080 @code{trace}.
12081
12082 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12083 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12084 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12085 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12086 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12087 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12088 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12089 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12090
12091 @example
12092 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12093 @end example
12094
12095 @noindent
12096 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12097 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12098
12099 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12100 @cindex set static tracepoint
12101 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12102 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12103 @kindex strace
12104 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12105 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12106 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12107 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12108 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12109
12110 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12111 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12112 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12113 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12114 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12115 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12116 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12117 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12118 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12119 tracing engine:
12120
12121 @smallexample
12122 main ()
12123 @{
12124 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12125 @}
12126 @end smallexample
12127
12128 @noindent
12129 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12130 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12131
12132 @smallexample
12133 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12134 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12135 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12136 Data: "str %s"
12137 [etc...]
12138 @end smallexample
12139
12140 @noindent
12141 so you may probe the marker above with:
12142
12143 @smallexample
12144 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12145 @end smallexample
12146
12147 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12148 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12149 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12150 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12151 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12152 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12153 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12154 the @samp{Data:} field.
12155
12156 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12157 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12158 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12159
12160 @vindex $tpnum
12161 @cindex last tracepoint number
12162 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12163 @cindex tracepoint number
12164 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12165 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12166
12167 @kindex delete tracepoint
12168 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12169 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12170 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12171 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12172 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12173
12174 Examples:
12175
12176 @smallexample
12177 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12178
12179 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12180 @end smallexample
12181
12182 @noindent
12183 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12184 @end table
12185
12186 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12187 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12188
12189 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12190
12191 @table @code
12192 @kindex disable tracepoint
12193 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12194 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12195 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12196 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12197 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12198 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12199 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12200 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12201 next trace experiment.
12202
12203 @kindex enable tracepoint
12204 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12205 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12206 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12207 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12208 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12209 next time a trace experiment is run.
12210 @end table
12211
12212 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12213 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12214
12215 @table @code
12216 @kindex passcount
12217 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12218 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12219 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12220 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12221 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12222 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12223 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12224 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12225 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12226 user.
12227
12228 Examples:
12229
12230 @smallexample
12231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12232 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12233
12234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12235 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12236 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12240 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12241 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12242 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12243 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12244 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12245 @end smallexample
12246 @end table
12247
12248 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12249 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12250 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12251 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12252
12253 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12254 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12255 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12256 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12257 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12258 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12259 is true.
12260
12261 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12262 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12263 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12264 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12265 just as with breakpoints.
12266
12267 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12268 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12269 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12270 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12271 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12272 accesses, and so forth.
12273
12274 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12275 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12276 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12277 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12278 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12279 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12280 search through.
12281
12282 @smallexample
12283 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12284 @end smallexample
12285
12286 @node Trace State Variables
12287 @subsection Trace State Variables
12288 @cindex trace state variables
12289
12290 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12291 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12292 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12293 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12294 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12295 integers.
12296
12297 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12298 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12299 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12300 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12301
12302 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12303 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12304 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12305 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12306 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12307 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12308 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12309 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12310 variable with the same name.
12311
12312 @table @code
12313
12314 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12315 @kindex tvariable
12316 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12317 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12318 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12319 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12320 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12321 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12322 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12323 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12324 value. The default initial value is 0.
12325
12326 @item info tvariables
12327 @kindex info tvariables
12328 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12329 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12330 currently running.
12331
12332 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12333 @kindex delete tvariable
12334 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12335 are specified.
12336
12337 @end table
12338
12339 @node Tracepoint Actions
12340 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12341
12342 @table @code
12343 @kindex actions
12344 @cindex tracepoint actions
12345 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12346 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12347 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12348 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12349 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12350 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12351 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12352 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12353 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12354 @code{while-stepping}.
12355
12356 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12357 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12358 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12359
12360 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12361 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12362 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12363
12364 @smallexample
12365 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12366
12367 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12368
12369 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12370 @end smallexample
12371
12372 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12373 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12374 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12375 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12376 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12377 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12378 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12379 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12380
12381 @smallexample
12382 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12383 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12384 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12385 > collect bar,baz
12386 > collect $regs
12387 > while-stepping 12
12388 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12389 > end
12390 end
12391 @end smallexample
12392
12393 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12394 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12395 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12396 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12397 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12398 special arguments are supported:
12399
12400 @table @code
12401 @item $regs
12402 Collect all registers.
12403
12404 @item $args
12405 Collect all function arguments.
12406
12407 @item $locals
12408 Collect all local variables.
12409
12410 @item $_ret
12411 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12412 of a backtrace.
12413
12414 @item $_probe_argc
12415 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12416 tracepoint is located.
12417 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12418
12419 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12420 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12421 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12422 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12423
12424 @item $_sdata
12425 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12426 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12427 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12428 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12429 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12430 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12431 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12432 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12433 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12434
12435 @smallexample
12436 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12437 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12438 @end smallexample
12439
12440 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12441 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12442 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12443 @value{GDBN}.
12444 @end table
12445
12446 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12447 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12448 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12449
12450 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12451 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12452 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12453 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12454 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12455 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12456 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12457 @samp{mystr}.
12458
12459 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12460 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12461
12462 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12463 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12464 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12465 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12466 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12467 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12468 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12469 action were used.
12470
12471 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12472 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12473 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12474 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12475 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12476 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12477
12478 @smallexample
12479 > while-stepping 12
12480 > collect $regs, myglobal
12481 > end
12482 >
12483 @end smallexample
12484
12485 @noindent
12486 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12487 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12488 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12489 @code{stepping}.
12490
12491 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12492 @kindex set default-collect
12493 @cindex default collection action
12494 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12495 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12496 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12497 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12498 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12499 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12500
12501 @item show default-collect
12502 @kindex show default-collect
12503 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12504 tracepoint hit.
12505
12506 @end table
12507
12508 @node Listing Tracepoints
12509 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12510
12511 @table @code
12512 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12513 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12514 @cindex information about tracepoints
12515 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12516 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12517 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12518 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12519 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12520 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12521
12522 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12523 tracing:
12524
12525 @itemize @bullet
12526 @item
12527 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12528
12529 @item
12530 the state about installed on target of each location
12531 @end itemize
12532
12533 @smallexample
12534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12535 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12536 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12537 while-stepping 20
12538 collect globfoo, $regs
12539 end
12540 collect globfoo2
12541 end
12542 pass count 1200
12543 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12544 collect $eip
12545 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12546 installed on target
12547 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12548 installed on target
12549 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12550 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12551 not installed on target
12552 (@value{GDBP})
12553 @end smallexample
12554
12555 @noindent
12556 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12557 @end table
12558
12559 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12560 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12561
12562 @table @code
12563 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12564 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12565 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12566 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12567 program.
12568
12569 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12570
12571 @table @emph
12572 @item Count
12573 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12574 stable identifier.
12575 @item ID
12576 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12577 @item Enabled or Disabled
12578 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12579 that are not enabled.
12580 @item Address
12581 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12582 @item What
12583 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12584 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12585 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12586 will be left blank.
12587 @end table
12588
12589 @noindent
12590 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12591
12592 @table @emph
12593 @item Data
12594 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12595 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12596 marker call.
12597 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12598 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12599 @end table
12600
12601 @smallexample
12602 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12603 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12604 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12605 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12606 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12607 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12608 Data: str %s
12609 (@value{GDBP})
12610 @end smallexample
12611 @end table
12612
12613 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12614 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12615
12616 @table @code
12617 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12618 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12619 @cindex collected data discarded
12620 @item tstart
12621 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12622 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12623 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12624 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12625 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12626 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12627 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12628 information, and so forth.
12629
12630 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12631 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12632 @item tstop
12633 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12634 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12635 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12636 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12637 needs to be stopped quickly.
12638
12639 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12640 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12641 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12642
12643 @kindex tstatus
12644 @cindex status of trace data collection
12645 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12646 @item tstatus
12647 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12648 collection.
12649 @end table
12650
12651 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12652
12653 @smallexample
12654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12655 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12656 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12657 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12658 > while-stepping 11
12659 > collect $regs
12660 > end
12661 > end
12662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12663 [time passes @dots{}]
12664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12665 @end smallexample
12666
12667 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12668 @cindex disconnected tracing
12669 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12670 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12671 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12672 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12673 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12674 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12675 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12676 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12677
12678 @table @code
12679 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12680 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12681 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12682 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12683 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12684 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12685 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12686 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12687
12688 @item show disconnected-tracing
12689 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12690 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12691
12692 @end table
12693
12694 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12695 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12696 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12697 it will continue after reconnection.
12698
12699 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12700 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12701 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12702 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12703 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12704 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12705 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12706 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12707 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12708 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12709
12710 @cindex circular trace buffer
12711 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12712 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12713 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12714 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12715 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12716 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12717 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12718 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12719 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12720 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12721 the next run.
12722
12723 @table @code
12724 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12725 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12726 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12727 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12728 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12729 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12730 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12731
12732 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12733 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12734 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12735 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12736 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12737 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12738
12739 @end table
12740
12741 @table @code
12742 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12743 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12744 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12745 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12746 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12747 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12748 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12749 likes. This is also the default.
12750
12751 @item show trace-buffer-size
12752 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12753 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12754 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12755 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12756 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12757 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12758 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12759 @end table
12760
12761 @table @code
12762 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12763 @kindex set trace-user
12764
12765 @item show trace-user
12766 @kindex show trace-user
12767
12768 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12769 @kindex set trace-notes
12770 Set the trace run's notes.
12771
12772 @item show trace-notes
12773 @kindex show trace-notes
12774 Show the trace run's notes.
12775
12776 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12777 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12778 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12779 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12780 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12781
12782 @item show trace-stop-notes
12783 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12784 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12785
12786 @end table
12787
12788 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12789 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12790
12791 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12792 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12793 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12794 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12795 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12796 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12797 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12798 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12799 mentioned here.
12800
12801 @itemize @bullet
12802
12803 @item
12804 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12805 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12806 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12807 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12808 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12809 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12810 cannot be collected either.
12811
12812 @item
12813 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12814 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12815 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12816 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12817 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12818 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12819 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12820 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12821 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12822 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12823
12824 @item
12825 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12826 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12827 in a misleading way.
12828
12829 @item
12830 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12831 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12832 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12833 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12834 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12835 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12836 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12837 by @code{ptr}.
12838
12839 @item
12840 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12841 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12842 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12843 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12844 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12845 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12846 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12847 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12848 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12849 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12850 invalid address.
12851
12852 @item
12853 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12854 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12855 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12856 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12857 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12858 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12859 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12860 it to zero.
12861
12862 @end itemize
12863
12864 @node Analyze Collected Data
12865 @section Using the Collected Data
12866
12867 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12868 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12869 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12870 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12871 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12872 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12873 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12874 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12875 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12876 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12877 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12878 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12879 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12880 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12881 the buffer will fail.
12882
12883 @menu
12884 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12885 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12886 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12887 @end menu
12888
12889 @node tfind
12890 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12891
12892 @kindex tfind
12893 @cindex select trace snapshot
12894 @cindex find trace snapshot
12895 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12896 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12897 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12898 snapshot is selected.
12899
12900 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12901
12902 @table @code
12903 @item tfind start
12904 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12905 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12906
12907 @item tfind none
12908 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12909
12910 @item tfind end
12911 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12912
12913 @item tfind
12914 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12915
12916 @item tfind -
12917 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12918 retracing earlier steps.
12919
12920 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12921 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12922 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12923 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12924 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12925
12926 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12927 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12928 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12929 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12930 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12931
12932 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12933 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12934 addresses (exclusive).
12935
12936 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12937 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12938 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12939
12940 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12941 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12942 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12943 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12944 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12945 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12946 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12947 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12948 @end table
12949
12950 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12951 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12952 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12953 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12954 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12955 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12956 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12957 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12958 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12959 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12960 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12961 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12962 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12963 tracepoint as the current one.
12964
12965 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12966 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12967 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12968 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12969 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12970
12971 @smallexample
12972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12973 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12974 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12975 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12976 > tfind
12977 > end
12978
12979 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12980 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12981 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12982 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12983 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12984 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12985 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12986 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12987 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12988 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12989 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12990 @end smallexample
12991
12992 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12993 the buffer:
12994
12995 @smallexample
12996 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12997 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12998 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12999 > tfind line
13000 > end
13001
13002 Frame 0, X = 1
13003 Frame 7, X = 2
13004 Frame 13, X = 255
13005 @end smallexample
13006
13007 @node tdump
13008 @subsection @code{tdump}
13009 @kindex tdump
13010 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13011 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13012
13013 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13014 the current trace snapshot.
13015
13016 @smallexample
13017 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13018 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13019 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13020 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13021 > end
13022
13023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13024
13025 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13026 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13027 at gdb_test.c:444
13028 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13029
13030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13031 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13032 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13033 d1 0x18 24
13034 d2 0x80 128
13035 d3 0x33 51
13036 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13037 d5 0x22 34
13038 d6 0xe0 224
13039 d7 0x380035 3670069
13040 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13041 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13042 a2 0x100 256
13043 a3 0x322000 3284992
13044 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13045 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13046 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13047 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13048 ps 0x0 0
13049 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13050 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13051 fpstatus 0x0 0
13052 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13053 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13054 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13055 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13056 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13057 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13058 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13059 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13060 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13061
13062 (@value{GDBP})
13063 @end smallexample
13064
13065 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13066 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13067 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13068 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13069
13070 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13071 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13072 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13073 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13074 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13075 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13076 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13077 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13078 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13079 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13080
13081 @node save tracepoints
13082 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13083 @kindex save tracepoints
13084 @kindex save-tracepoints
13085 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13086
13087 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13088 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13089 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13090 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13091 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13092 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13093
13094 @node Tracepoint Variables
13095 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13096 @cindex tracepoint variables
13097 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13098
13099 @table @code
13100 @vindex $trace_frame
13101 @item (int) $trace_frame
13102 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13103 snapshot is selected.
13104
13105 @vindex $tracepoint
13106 @item (int) $tracepoint
13107 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13108
13109 @vindex $trace_line
13110 @item (int) $trace_line
13111 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13112
13113 @vindex $trace_file
13114 @item (char []) $trace_file
13115 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13116
13117 @vindex $trace_func
13118 @item (char []) $trace_func
13119 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13120 @end table
13121
13122 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13123 use @code{output} instead.
13124
13125 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13126 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13127 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13128 which are managed by the target.
13129
13130 @smallexample
13131 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13132
13133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13134 > output $trace_file
13135 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13136 > tfind
13137 > end
13138 @end smallexample
13139
13140 @node Trace Files
13141 @section Using Trace Files
13142 @cindex trace files
13143
13144 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13145 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13146 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13147 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13148 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13149
13150 @table @code
13151
13152 @kindex tsave
13153 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13154 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13155 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13156 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13157 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13158 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13159 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13160 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13161 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13162 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13163 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13164 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13165 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13166 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13167 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13168
13169 @kindex target tfile
13170 @kindex tfile
13171 @kindex target ctf
13172 @kindex ctf
13173 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13174 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13175 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13176 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13177 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13178 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13179 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13180 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13181 the host.
13182
13183 @smallexample
13184 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13185 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13186 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13187 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13188 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13189 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13190 i = 0
13191 a = 0
13192 b = 1 '\001'
13193 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13194 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13195 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13196 $1 = 1
13197 @end smallexample
13198
13199 @end table
13200
13201 @node Overlays
13202 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13203 @cindex overlays
13204
13205 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13206 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13207 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13208 use overlays.
13209
13210 @menu
13211 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13212 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13213 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13214 mapped by asking the inferior.
13215 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13216 @end menu
13217
13218 @node How Overlays Work
13219 @section How Overlays Work
13220 @cindex mapped overlays
13221 @cindex unmapped overlays
13222 @cindex load address, overlay's
13223 @cindex mapped address
13224 @cindex overlay area
13225
13226 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13227 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13228 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13229 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13230 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13231
13232 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13233 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13234 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13235 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13236 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13237 largest overlay as well.
13238
13239 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13240 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13241 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13242 there.
13243
13244 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13245 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13246 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13247
13248 @smallexample
13249 @group
13250 Data Instruction Larger
13251 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13252 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13253 | | | | | |
13254 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13255 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13256 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13257 | and heap | | | | | |
13258 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13259 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13260 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13261 | | | | | |
13262 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13263 address | | | | | |
13264 | overlay | <-' | | |
13265 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13266 | | <---. | | load address
13267 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13268 | | | |
13269 +-----------+ | |
13270 +-----------+
13271 | |
13272 +-----------+
13273
13274 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13275 @end group
13276 @end smallexample
13277
13278 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13279 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13280 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13281 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13282 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13283 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13284 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13285 program and the overlay area.
13286
13287 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13288 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13289 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13290 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13291 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13292 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13293 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13294
13295 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13296 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13297 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13298
13299 @itemize @bullet
13300
13301 @item
13302 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13303 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13304 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13305 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13306
13307 @item
13308 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13309 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13310 your program's performance.
13311
13312 @item
13313 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13314 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13315 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13316 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13317 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13318 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13319 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13320
13321 @item
13322 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13323 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13324 instruction and data spaces.
13325
13326 @end itemize
13327
13328 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13329 improved in many ways:
13330
13331 @itemize @bullet
13332
13333 @item
13334 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13335 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13336 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13337 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13338 area in the usual way.
13339
13340 @item
13341 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13342 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13343
13344 @item
13345 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13346 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13347 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13348 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13349 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13350 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13351 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13352
13353 @end itemize
13354
13355
13356 @node Overlay Commands
13357 @section Overlay Commands
13358
13359 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13360 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13361 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13362 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13363 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13364 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13365
13366 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13367 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13368
13369 @table @code
13370 @item overlay off
13371 @kindex overlay
13372 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13373 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13374 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13375 overlay support is disabled.
13376
13377 @item overlay manual
13378 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13379 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13380 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13381 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13382 commands described below.
13383
13384 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13385 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13386 @cindex map an overlay
13387 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13388 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13389 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13390 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13391 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13392 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13393
13394 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13395 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13396 @cindex unmap an overlay
13397 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13398 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13399 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13400 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13401
13402 @item overlay auto
13403 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13404 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13405 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13406 Overlay Debugging}.
13407
13408 @item overlay load-target
13409 @itemx overlay load
13410 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13411 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13412 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13413 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13414 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13415 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13416
13417 @item overlay list-overlays
13418 @itemx overlay list
13419 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13420 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13421 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13422
13423 @end table
13424
13425 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13426 of the function the address falls in:
13427
13428 @smallexample
13429 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13430 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13431 @end smallexample
13432 @noindent
13433 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13434 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13435 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13436 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13437
13438 @smallexample
13439 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13440 No sections are mapped.
13441 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13442 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13443 @end smallexample
13444 @noindent
13445 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13446 name normally:
13447
13448 @smallexample
13449 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13450 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13451 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13452 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13453 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13454 @end smallexample
13455
13456 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13457 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13458 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13459 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13460 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13461
13462 @itemize @bullet
13463 @item
13464 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13465 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13466 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13467 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13468 @item
13469 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13470 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13471 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13472 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13473 breakpoints properly.
13474 @end itemize
13475
13476
13477 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13478 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13479 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13480
13481 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13482 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13483 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13484 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13485 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13486 current state of the overlays.
13487
13488 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13489 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13490
13491 @table @asis
13492
13493 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13494 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13495
13496 @smallexample
13497 struct
13498 @{
13499 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13500 unsigned long vma;
13501
13502 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13503 unsigned long size;
13504
13505 /* The overlay's load address. */
13506 unsigned long lma;
13507
13508 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13509 zero otherwise. */
13510 unsigned long mapped;
13511 @}
13512 @end smallexample
13513
13514 @item @code{_novlys}:
13515 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13516 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13517
13518 @end table
13519
13520 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13521 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13522 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13523 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13524 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13525 currently mapped.
13526
13527 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13528 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13529 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13530 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13531 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13532 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13533 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13534 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13535 are not being executed.
13536
13537 @node Overlay Sample Program
13538 @section Overlay Sample Program
13539 @cindex overlay example program
13540
13541 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13542 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13543 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13544 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13545 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13546 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13547 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13548
13549 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13550 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13551 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13552 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13553
13554 @table @file
13555 @item overlays.c
13556 The main program file.
13557 @item ovlymgr.c
13558 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13559 @item foo.c
13560 @itemx bar.c
13561 @itemx baz.c
13562 @itemx grbx.c
13563 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13564 @item d10v.ld
13565 @itemx m32r.ld
13566 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13567 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13568 @end table
13569
13570 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13571 cross-compiler like this:
13572
13573 @smallexample
13574 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13575 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13577 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13578 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13579 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13580 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13581 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13582 @end smallexample
13583
13584 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13585 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13586 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13587
13588
13589 @node Languages
13590 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13591 @cindex languages
13592
13593 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13594 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13595 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13596 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13597 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13598 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13599
13600 @cindex working language
13601 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13602 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13603 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13604 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13605 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13606 language}.
13607
13608 @menu
13609 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13610 * Show:: Displaying the language
13611 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13612 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13613 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13614 @end menu
13615
13616 @node Setting
13617 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13618
13619 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13620 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13621 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13622 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13623 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13624 are printed, etc.
13625
13626 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13627 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13628 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13629 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13630 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13631 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13632 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13633 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13634 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13635 Displaying the Language}.
13636
13637 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13638 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13639 another language. In that case, make the
13640 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13641 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13642 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13643
13644 @menu
13645 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13646 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13647 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13648 @end menu
13649
13650 @node Filenames
13651 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13652
13653 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13654 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13655
13656 @table @file
13657 @item .ada
13658 @itemx .ads
13659 @itemx .adb
13660 @itemx .a
13661 Ada source file.
13662
13663 @item .c
13664 C source file
13665
13666 @item .C
13667 @itemx .cc
13668 @itemx .cp
13669 @itemx .cpp
13670 @itemx .cxx
13671 @itemx .c++
13672 C@t{++} source file
13673
13674 @item .d
13675 D source file
13676
13677 @item .m
13678 Objective-C source file
13679
13680 @item .f
13681 @itemx .F
13682 Fortran source file
13683
13684 @item .mod
13685 Modula-2 source file
13686
13687 @item .s
13688 @itemx .S
13689 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13690 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13691 @end table
13692
13693 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13694 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13695
13696 @node Manually
13697 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13698
13699 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13700 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13701 your program.
13702
13703 @kindex set language
13704 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13705 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13706 a language, such as
13707 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13708 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13709
13710 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13711 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13712 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13713 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13714 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13715 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13716 command such as:
13717
13718 @smallexample
13719 print a = b + c
13720 @end smallexample
13721
13722 @noindent
13723 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13724 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13725 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13726 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13727
13728 @node Automatically
13729 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13730
13731 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13732 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13733 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13734 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13735 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13736 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13737 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13738 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13739 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13740
13741 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13742 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13743 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13744 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13745 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13746
13747 @node Show
13748 @section Displaying the Language
13749
13750 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13751 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13752
13753 @table @code
13754 @item show language
13755 @anchor{show language}
13756 @kindex show language
13757 Display the current working language. This is the
13758 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13759 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13760
13761 @item info frame
13762 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13763 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13764 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13765 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13766 information listed here.
13767
13768 @item info source
13769 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13770 Display the source language of this source file.
13771 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13772 information listed here.
13773 @end table
13774
13775 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13776 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13777 with a language explicitly:
13778
13779 @table @code
13780 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13781 @kindex set extension-language
13782 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13783 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13784
13785 @item info extensions
13786 @kindex info extensions
13787 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13788 @end table
13789
13790 @node Checks
13791 @section Type and Range Checking
13792
13793 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13794 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13795 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13796 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13797 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13798 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13799 errors when your program is running.
13800
13801 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13802 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13803 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13804 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13805
13806 @menu
13807 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13808 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13809 @end menu
13810
13811 @cindex type checking
13812 @cindex checks, type
13813 @node Type Checking
13814 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13815
13816 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13817 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13818 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13819 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13820
13821 @smallexample
13822 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13823
13824 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13825 $1 = 2
13826 @exdent but
13827 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13828 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13829 @end smallexample
13830
13831 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13832 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13833
13834 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13835 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13836 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13837 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13838 expressions like the second example above.
13839
13840 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13841 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13842 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13843 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13844 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13845 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13846
13847 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13848
13849 @kindex set check type
13850 @kindex show check type
13851 @table @code
13852 @item set check type on
13853 @itemx set check type off
13854 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13855 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13856 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13857
13858 @item show check type
13859 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13860 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13861 @end table
13862
13863 @cindex range checking
13864 @cindex checks, range
13865 @node Range Checking
13866 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13867
13868 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13869 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13870 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13871 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13872 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13873
13874 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13875 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13876 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13877 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13878
13879 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13880 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13881 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13882 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13883 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13884 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13885
13886 @smallexample
13887 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13888 @end smallexample
13889
13890 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13891 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13892 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13893
13894 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13895
13896 @kindex set check range
13897 @kindex show check range
13898 @table @code
13899 @item set check range auto
13900 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13901 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13902 each language.
13903
13904 @item set check range on
13905 @itemx set check range off
13906 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13907 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13908 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13909 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13910
13911 @item set check range warn
13912 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13913 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13914 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13915 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13916 systems).
13917
13918 @item show range
13919 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13920 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13921 @end table
13922
13923 @node Supported Languages
13924 @section Supported Languages
13925
13926 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13927 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13928 @c This is false ...
13929 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13930 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13931 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13932 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13933 language.
13934
13935 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13936 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13937 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13938 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13939 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13940 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13941 language reference or tutorial.
13942
13943 @menu
13944 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13945 * D:: D
13946 * Go:: Go
13947 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13948 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13949 * Fortran:: Fortran
13950 * Pascal:: Pascal
13951 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13952 * Ada:: Ada
13953 @end menu
13954
13955 @node C
13956 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13957
13958 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13959 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13960
13961 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13962 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13963 together.
13964
13965 @cindex C@t{++}
13966 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13967 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13968 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13969 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13970 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13971 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13972 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13973
13974 @menu
13975 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13976 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13977 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13978 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13979 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13980 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13981 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13982 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13983 @end menu
13984
13985 @node C Operators
13986 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13987
13988 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13989
13990 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13991 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13992 often defined on groups of types.
13993
13994 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13995
13996 @itemize @bullet
13997
13998 @item
13999 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14000 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14001
14002 @item
14003 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14004 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14005
14006 @item
14007 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14008
14009 @item
14010 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14011
14012 @end itemize
14013
14014 @noindent
14015 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14016 in order of increasing precedence:
14017
14018 @table @code
14019 @item ,
14020 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14021 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14022 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14023
14024 @item =
14025 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14026 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14027
14028 @item @var{op}=
14029 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14030 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14031 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14032 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14033 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14034
14035 @item ?:
14036 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14037 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14038 should be of an integral type.
14039
14040 @item ||
14041 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14042
14043 @item &&
14044 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14045
14046 @item |
14047 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14048
14049 @item ^
14050 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14051
14052 @item &
14053 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14054
14055 @item ==@r{, }!=
14056 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14057 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14058
14059 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14060 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14061 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14062 and non-zero for true.
14063
14064 @item <<@r{, }>>
14065 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14066
14067 @item @@
14068 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14069
14070 @item +@r{, }-
14071 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14072 pointer types.
14073
14074 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14075 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14076 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14077 integral types.
14078
14079 @item ++@r{, }--
14080 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14081 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14082 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14083 operation takes place.
14084
14085 @item *
14086 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14087 @code{++}.
14088
14089 @item &
14090 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14091
14092 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14093 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14094 to examine the address
14095 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14096 stored.
14097
14098 @item -
14099 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14100 precedence as @code{++}.
14101
14102 @item !
14103 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14104 @code{++}.
14105
14106 @item ~
14107 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14108 @code{++}.
14109
14110
14111 @item .@r{, }->
14112 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14113 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14114 pointer based on the stored type information.
14115 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14116
14117 @item .*@r{, }->*
14118 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14119
14120 @item []
14121 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14122 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14123
14124 @item ()
14125 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14126
14127 @item ::
14128 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14129 and @code{class} types.
14130
14131 @item ::
14132 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14133 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14134 above.
14135 @end table
14136
14137 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14138 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14139 predefined meaning.
14140
14141 @node C Constants
14142 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14143
14144 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14145
14146 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14147 following ways:
14148
14149 @itemize @bullet
14150 @item
14151 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14152 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14153 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14154 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14155 @code{long} value.
14156
14157 @item
14158 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14159 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14160 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14161 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14162 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14163 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14164 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14165 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14166 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14167 constant.
14168
14169 @item
14170 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14171 integral equivalents.
14172
14173 @item
14174 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14175 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14176 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14177 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14178 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14179 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14180 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14181 @samp{\n} for newline.
14182
14183 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14184 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14185 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14186 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14187
14188 @item
14189 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14190 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14191 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14192 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14193 characters.
14194
14195 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14196 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14197 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14198
14199 @item
14200 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14201 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14202
14203 @item
14204 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14205 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14206 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14207 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14208 @end itemize
14209
14210 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14211 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14212
14213 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14214 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14215
14216 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14217 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14218 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14219 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14220 @quotation
14221 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14222 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14223 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14224 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14225 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14226 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14227 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14228 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14229 @end quotation
14230
14231 @enumerate
14232
14233 @cindex member functions
14234 @item
14235 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14236
14237 @smallexample
14238 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14239 @end smallexample
14240
14241 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14242 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14243 @item
14244 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14245 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14246 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14247 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14248 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14249
14250 @cindex call overloaded functions
14251 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14252 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14253 @item
14254 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14255 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14256 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14257 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14258 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14259 default arguments.
14260
14261 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14262 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14263 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14264 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14265 number of function arguments.
14266
14267 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14268 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14269 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14270
14271 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14272 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14273 @smallexample
14274 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14275 @end smallexample
14276
14277 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14278 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14279
14280 @cindex reference declarations
14281 @item
14282 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14283 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14284 dereferenced.
14285
14286 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14287 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14288 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14289 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14290 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14291
14292 @item
14293 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14294 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14295 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14296 necessary, for example in an expression like
14297 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14298 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14299 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14300
14301 @item
14302 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14303 specification.
14304 @end enumerate
14305
14306 @node C Defaults
14307 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14308
14309 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14310
14311 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14312 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14313 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14314 selects the working language.
14315
14316 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14317 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14318 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14319 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14320 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14321 for further details.
14322
14323 @node C Checks
14324 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14325
14326 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14327
14328 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14329 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14330 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14331 constants to pointers.
14332
14333 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14334 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14335 that is not itself an array.
14336
14337 @node Debugging C
14338 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14339
14340 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14341 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14342 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14343 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14344
14345 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14346 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14347 ,Expressions}.
14348
14349 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14350 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14351
14352 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14353
14354 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14355 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14356
14357 @table @code
14358 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14359 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14360 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14361 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14362 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14363 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14364
14365 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14366 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14367 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14368 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14369 classes.
14370 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14371
14372 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14373 @item catch throw
14374 @itemx catch rethrow
14375 @itemx catch catch
14376 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14377 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14378
14379 @cindex inheritance
14380 @item ptype @var{typename}
14381 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14382 @var{typename}.
14383 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14384
14385 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14386 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14387 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14388 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14389 multiple inheritance is in use.
14390
14391 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14392 @item demangle @var{name}
14393 Demangle @var{name}.
14394 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14395
14396 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14397 @item set print demangle
14398 @itemx show print demangle
14399 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14400 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14401 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14402 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14403 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14404
14405 @item set print object
14406 @itemx show print object
14407 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14408 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14409
14410 @item set print vtbl
14411 @itemx show print vtbl
14412 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14413 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14414 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14415 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14416
14417 @kindex set overload-resolution
14418 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14419 @item set overload-resolution on
14420 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14421 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14422 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14423 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14424 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14425 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14426
14427 @item set overload-resolution off
14428 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14429 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14430 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14431 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14432 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14433 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14434 argument types.
14435
14436 @kindex show overload-resolution
14437 @item show overload-resolution
14438 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14439
14440 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14441 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14442 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14443 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14444 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14445 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14446 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14447 @end table
14448
14449 @node Decimal Floating Point
14450 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14451 @cindex decimal floating point format
14452
14453 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14454 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14455 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14456 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14457
14458 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14459 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14460 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14461 configured target.
14462
14463 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14464 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14465 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14466
14467 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14468 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14469 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14470
14471 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14472 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14473 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14474
14475 @node D
14476 @subsection D
14477
14478 @cindex D
14479 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14480 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14481 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14482
14483 @node Go
14484 @subsection Go
14485
14486 @cindex Go (programming language)
14487 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14488 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14489
14490 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14491
14492 @table @code
14493 @cindex current Go package
14494 @item The current Go package
14495 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14496 specifying global variables and functions.
14497
14498 For example, given the program:
14499
14500 @example
14501 package main
14502 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14503 func main () @{
14504 // ...
14505 @}
14506 @end example
14507
14508 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14509
14510 @example
14511 (gdb) p myglob
14512 (gdb) p main.myglob
14513 @end example
14514
14515 @cindex builtin Go types
14516 @item Builtin Go types
14517 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14518 as a string.
14519
14520 @cindex builtin Go functions
14521 @item Builtin Go functions
14522 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14523 function and handles it internally.
14524
14525 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14526 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14527 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14528 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14529 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14530 @end table
14531
14532 @node Objective-C
14533 @subsection Objective-C
14534
14535 @cindex Objective-C
14536 This section provides information about some commands and command
14537 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14538 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14539 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14540
14541 @menu
14542 * Method Names in Commands::
14543 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14544 @end menu
14545
14546 @node Method Names in Commands
14547 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14548
14549 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14550 names as line specifications:
14551
14552 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14553 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14554 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14555 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14556 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14557 @itemize
14558 @item @code{clear}
14559 @item @code{break}
14560 @item @code{info line}
14561 @item @code{jump}
14562 @item @code{list}
14563 @end itemize
14564
14565 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14566
14567 @smallexample
14568 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14572 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14573 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14574 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14575 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14576 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14577 debugged, enter:
14578
14579 @smallexample
14580 break -[Fruit create]
14581 @end smallexample
14582
14583 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14584 enter:
14585
14586 @smallexample
14587 list +[NSText initialize]
14588 @end smallexample
14589
14590 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14591 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14592 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14593 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14594
14595 @smallexample
14596 break create
14597 @end smallexample
14598
14599 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14600 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14601 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14602 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14603 none apply.
14604
14605 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14606 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14607
14608 @smallexample
14609 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14610 @end smallexample
14611
14612 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14613 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14614 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14615 @kindex print-object
14616 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14617
14618 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14619
14620 @smallexample
14621 print -[@var{object} hash]
14622 @end smallexample
14623
14624 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14625 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14626 @noindent
14627 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14628 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14629 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14630 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14631 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14632 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14633
14634 @node OpenCL C
14635 @subsection OpenCL C
14636
14637 @cindex OpenCL C
14638 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14639
14640 @menu
14641 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14642 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14643 * OpenCL C Operators::
14644 @end menu
14645
14646 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14647 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14648
14649 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14650 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14651 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14652 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14653 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14654
14655 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14656 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14657
14658 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14659 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14660 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14661 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14662
14663 @node OpenCL C Operators
14664 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14665
14666 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14667 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14668 vector data types.
14669
14670 @node Fortran
14671 @subsection Fortran
14672 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14673
14674 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14675 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14676
14677 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14678 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14679 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14680 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14681 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14682 underscore.
14683
14684 @menu
14685 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14686 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14687 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14688 @end menu
14689
14690 @node Fortran Operators
14691 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14692
14693 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14694
14695 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14696 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14697 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14698
14699 @table @code
14700 @item **
14701 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14702 of the second one.
14703
14704 @item :
14705 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14706 represent a section of array.
14707
14708 @item %
14709 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14710 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14711 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14712 union type.
14713 @end table
14714
14715 @node Fortran Defaults
14716 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14717
14718 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14719
14720 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14721 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14722 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14723 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14724
14725 @node Special Fortran Commands
14726 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14727
14728 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14729
14730 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14731 such as displaying common blocks.
14732
14733 @table @code
14734 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14735 @kindex info common
14736 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14737 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14738 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14739 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14740 printed.
14741 @end table
14742
14743 @node Pascal
14744 @subsection Pascal
14745
14746 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14747 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14748 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14749 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14750 syntax.
14751
14752 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14753 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14754 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14755
14756 @node Modula-2
14757 @subsection Modula-2
14758
14759 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14760
14761 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14762 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14763 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14764 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14765 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14766 table.
14767
14768 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14769 @menu
14770 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14771 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14772 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14773 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14774 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14775 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14776 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14777 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14778 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14779 @end menu
14780
14781 @node M2 Operators
14782 @subsubsection Operators
14783 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14784
14785 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14786 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14787 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14788 following definitions hold:
14789
14790 @itemize @bullet
14791
14792 @item
14793 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14794 their subranges.
14795
14796 @item
14797 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14798
14799 @item
14800 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14801
14802 @item
14803 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14804 @var{type}}.
14805
14806 @item
14807 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14808
14809 @item
14810 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14811
14812 @item
14813 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14814 @end itemize
14815
14816 @noindent
14817 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14818 increasing precedence:
14819
14820 @table @code
14821 @item ,
14822 Function argument or array index separator.
14823
14824 @item :=
14825 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14826 @var{value}.
14827
14828 @item <@r{, }>
14829 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14830 types.
14831
14832 @item <=@r{, }>=
14833 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14834 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14835 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14836
14837 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14838 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14839 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14840 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14841 comment character.
14842
14843 @item IN
14844 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14845 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14846
14847 @item OR
14848 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14849
14850 @item AND@r{, }&
14851 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14852
14853 @item @@
14854 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14855
14856 @item +@r{, }-
14857 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14858 and difference on set types.
14859
14860 @item *
14861 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14862 on set types.
14863
14864 @item /
14865 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14866 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14867
14868 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14869 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14870 precedence as @code{*}.
14871
14872 @item -
14873 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14874
14875 @item ^
14876 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14877
14878 @item NOT
14879 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14880 @code{^}.
14881
14882 @item .
14883 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14884 precedence as @code{^}.
14885
14886 @item []
14887 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14888
14889 @item ()
14890 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14891 as @code{^}.
14892
14893 @item ::@r{, }.
14894 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14895 @end table
14896
14897 @quotation
14898 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14899 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14900 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14901 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14902 @end quotation
14903
14904
14905 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14906 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14907 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14908
14909 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14910 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14911
14912 @table @var
14913
14914 @item a
14915 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14916
14917 @item c
14918 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14919
14920 @item i
14921 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14922
14923 @item m
14924 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14925 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14926 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14927
14928 @item n
14929 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14930
14931 @item r
14932 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14933
14934 @item t
14935 represents a type.
14936
14937 @item v
14938 represents a variable.
14939
14940 @item x
14941 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14942 explanation of the function for details.
14943 @end table
14944
14945 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14946
14947 @table @code
14948 @item ABS(@var{n})
14949 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14950
14951 @item CAP(@var{c})
14952 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14953 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14954
14955 @item CHR(@var{i})
14956 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14957
14958 @item DEC(@var{v})
14959 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14960
14961 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14962 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14963 new value.
14964
14965 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14966 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14967 set.
14968
14969 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14970 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14971
14972 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14973 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14974
14975 @item INC(@var{v})
14976 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14977
14978 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14979 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14980 new value.
14981
14982 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14983 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14984 there. Returns the new set.
14985
14986 @item MAX(@var{t})
14987 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14988
14989 @item MIN(@var{t})
14990 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14991
14992 @item ODD(@var{i})
14993 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14994
14995 @item ORD(@var{x})
14996 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14997 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14998 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14999 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15000
15001 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15002 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15003 variable or a type.
15004
15005 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15006 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15007
15008 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15009 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15010 variable or a type.
15011
15012 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15013 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15014 @end table
15015
15016 @quotation
15017 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15018 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15019 an error.
15020 @end quotation
15021
15022 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15023 @node M2 Constants
15024 @subsubsection Constants
15025
15026 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15027 ways:
15028
15029 @itemize @bullet
15030
15031 @item
15032 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15033 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15034 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15035 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15036
15037 @item
15038 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15039 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15040 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15041 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15042 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15043 digits.
15044
15045 @item
15046 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15047 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15048 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15049 followed by a @samp{C}.
15050
15051 @item
15052 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15053 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15054 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15055 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15056 sequences.
15057
15058 @item
15059 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15060
15061 @item
15062 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15063 @code{FALSE}.
15064
15065 @item
15066 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15067
15068 @item
15069 Set constants are not yet supported.
15070 @end itemize
15071
15072 @node M2 Types
15073 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15074 @cindex Modula-2 types
15075
15076 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15077 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15078 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15079 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15080 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15081 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15082
15083 The first example contains the following section of code:
15084
15085 @smallexample
15086 VAR
15087 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15088 r: [20..40] ;
15089 @end smallexample
15090
15091 @noindent
15092 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15093 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15094
15095 @smallexample
15096 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15097 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15098 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15099 SET OF CHAR
15100 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15101 21
15102 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15103 [20..40]
15104 @end smallexample
15105
15106 @noindent
15107 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15108
15109 @smallexample
15110 VAR
15111 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15112 @end smallexample
15113
15114 @noindent
15115 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15116
15117 @smallexample
15118 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15119 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15120 @end smallexample
15121
15122 @noindent
15123 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15124 expressions using the debugger.
15125
15126 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15127 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15128
15129 @smallexample
15130 VAR
15131 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15132 @end smallexample
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15136 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15137 @end smallexample
15138
15139 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15140 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15141 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15142 above.
15143
15144 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15145
15146 @smallexample
15147 TYPE
15148 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15149 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15150 VAR
15151 s: t ;
15152 BEGIN
15153 s := blue ;
15154 @end smallexample
15155
15156 @noindent
15157 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15158 and value of a variable.
15159
15160 @smallexample
15161 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15162 $1 = blue
15163 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15164 type = [blue..yellow]
15165 @end smallexample
15166
15167 @noindent
15168 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15169 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15170 their @code{C} counterparts.
15171
15172 @smallexample
15173 VAR
15174 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15175 BEGIN
15176 s[1] := 1 ;
15177 @end smallexample
15178
15179 @smallexample
15180 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15181 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15182 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15183 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15184 @end smallexample
15185
15186 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15187 pointer types as shown in this example:
15188
15189 @smallexample
15190 VAR
15191 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15192 BEGIN
15193 NEW(s) ;
15194 s^[1] := 1 ;
15195 @end smallexample
15196
15197 @noindent
15198 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15199
15200 @smallexample
15201 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15202 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15203 @end smallexample
15204
15205 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15206 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15207 types:
15208
15209 @smallexample
15210 TYPE
15211 foo = RECORD
15212 f1: CARDINAL ;
15213 f2: CHAR ;
15214 f3: myarray ;
15215 END ;
15216
15217 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15218 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15219 VAR
15220 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15221 @end smallexample
15222
15223 @noindent
15224 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15225 below.
15226
15227 @smallexample
15228 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15229 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15230 f1 : CARDINAL;
15231 f2 : CHAR;
15232 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15233 END
15234 @end smallexample
15235
15236 @node M2 Defaults
15237 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15238 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15239
15240 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15241 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15242 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15243 selected the working language.
15244
15245 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15246 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15247 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15248 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15249
15250 @node Deviations
15251 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15252 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15253
15254 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15255 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15256
15257 @itemize @bullet
15258 @item
15259 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15260 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15261 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15262 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15263 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15264 returned a pointer.)
15265
15266 @item
15267 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15268 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15269 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15270 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15271
15272 @item
15273 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15274 argument.
15275
15276 @item
15277 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15278 @end itemize
15279
15280 @node M2 Checks
15281 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15282 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15283
15284 @quotation
15285 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15286 range checking.
15287 @end quotation
15288 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15289
15290 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15291
15292 @itemize @bullet
15293 @item
15294 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15295 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15296
15297 @item
15298 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15299 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15300 @end itemize
15301
15302 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15303 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15304
15305 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15306 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15307
15308 @node M2 Scope
15309 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15310 @cindex scope
15311 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15312 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15313 @ifinfo
15314 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15315 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15316 @end ifinfo
15317 @ifnotinfo
15318 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15319 @end ifnotinfo
15320
15321 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15322 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15323 similar syntax:
15324
15325 @smallexample
15326
15327 @var{module} . @var{id}
15328 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15329 @end smallexample
15330
15331 @noindent
15332 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15333 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15334 identifier within your program, except another module.
15335
15336 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15337 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15338 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15339 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15340
15341 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15342 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15343 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15344 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15345 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15346 @var{module}.
15347
15348 @node GDB/M2
15349 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15350
15351 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15352 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15353 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15354 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15355 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15356 analogue in Modula-2.
15357
15358 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15359 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15360 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15361 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15362 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15363 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15364
15365 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15366 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15367 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15368
15369 @node Ada
15370 @subsection Ada
15371 @cindex Ada
15372
15373 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15374 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15375 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15376 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15377 to be difficult.
15378
15379
15380 @cindex expressions in Ada
15381 @menu
15382 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15383 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15384 in @value{GDBN}.
15385 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15386 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15387 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15388 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15389 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15390 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15391 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15392 Profile
15393 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15394 @end menu
15395
15396 @node Ada Mode Intro
15397 @subsubsection Introduction
15398 @cindex Ada mode, general
15399
15400 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15401 syntax, with some extensions.
15402 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15403
15404 @itemize @bullet
15405 @item
15406 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15407 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15408 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15409 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15410
15411 @item
15412 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15413 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15414
15415 @item
15416 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15417 @end itemize
15418
15419 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15420 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15421 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15422 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15423 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15424
15425 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15426 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15427 was translated from an Ada source file.
15428
15429 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15430 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15431 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15432 middle (to allow based literals).
15433
15434 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15435 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15436 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15437 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15438 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15439 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15440
15441 @node Omissions from Ada
15442 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15443 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15444
15445 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15446
15447 @itemize @bullet
15448 @item
15449 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15450
15451 @itemize @minus
15452 @item
15453 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15454 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15455
15456 @item
15457 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15458
15459 @item
15460 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15461
15462 @item
15463 @t{'Tag}.
15464
15465 @item
15466 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15467 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15468
15469 @item
15470 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15471 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15472
15473 @item
15474 @t{'Address}.
15475 @end itemize
15476
15477 @item
15478 The names in
15479 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15480 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15481 not currently available.
15482
15483 @item
15484 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15485 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15486 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15487 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15488 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15489 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15490 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15491 indeterminate values.
15492
15493 @item
15494 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15495 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15496 are not implemented.
15497
15498 @item
15499 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15500 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15501 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15502 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15503 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15504
15505 @smallexample
15506 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15507 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15508 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15509 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15510 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15511 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15512 @end smallexample
15513
15514 Changing a
15515 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15516 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15517 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15518 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15519 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15520 declared to have a type such as:
15521
15522 @smallexample
15523 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15524 Id : Integer;
15525 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15526 end record;
15527 @end smallexample
15528
15529 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15530 assignments:
15531
15532 @smallexample
15533 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15534 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15535 @end smallexample
15536
15537 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15538 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15539 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15540 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15541 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15542 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15543 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15544 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15545
15546 @item
15547 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15548
15549 @item
15550 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15551 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15552 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15553 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15554 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15555 the proper resolution.
15556
15557 @item
15558 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15559
15560 @item
15561 Entry calls are not implemented.
15562
15563 @item
15564 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15565 formats are not supported.
15566
15567 @item
15568 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15569
15570 @item
15571 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15572 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15573 context.
15574 Should your program
15575 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15576 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15577 @end itemize
15578
15579 @node Additions to Ada
15580 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15581 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15582
15583 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15584 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15585
15586 @itemize @bullet
15587 @item
15588 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15589 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15590 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15591 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15592 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15593 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15594 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15595 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15596
15597 @item
15598 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15599 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15600 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15601
15602 @item
15603 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15604 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15605
15606 @item
15607 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15608 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15609 @end itemize
15610
15611 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15612 additions specific to Ada:
15613
15614 @itemize @bullet
15615 @item
15616 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15617 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15618
15619 @smallexample
15620 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15621 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15622 @end smallexample
15623
15624 @item
15625 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15626 the value of its right-hand operand.
15627 This allows, for example,
15628 complex conditional breaks:
15629
15630 @smallexample
15631 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15632 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15633 @end smallexample
15634
15635 @item
15636 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15637 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15638 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15639 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15640 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15641 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15642 in strings. For example,
15643 @smallexample
15644 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15645 @end smallexample
15646 @noindent
15647 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15648 after each period.
15649
15650 @item
15651 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15652 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15653 to write
15654
15655 @smallexample
15656 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15657 @end smallexample
15658
15659 @item
15660 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15661 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15662 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15663 of 3 might print as
15664
15665 @smallexample
15666 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15667 @end smallexample
15668
15669 @noindent
15670 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15671 clause.
15672
15673 @item
15674 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15675 multi-character subsequence of
15676 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15677 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15678 in place of @t{a'length}.
15679
15680 @item
15681 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15682 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15683 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15684 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15685 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15686 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15687 For example,
15688 @smallexample
15689 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15690 @end smallexample
15691
15692 @item
15693 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15694 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15695 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15696 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15697 object.
15698
15699 @end itemize
15700
15701 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15702 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15703
15704 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15705 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15706 before reaching the main procedure.
15707 As defined in the Ada Reference
15708 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15709 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15710 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15711 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15712
15713 @node Ada Exceptions
15714 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15715
15716 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15717
15718 @table @code
15719 @kindex info exceptions
15720 @item info exceptions
15721 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15722 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15723 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15724 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15725 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15726 @end table
15727
15728 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15729 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15730 argument.
15731
15732 @smallexample
15733 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15734 All defined Ada exceptions:
15735 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15736 program_error: 0x613d20
15737 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15738 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15739 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15740 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15741 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15742 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15743 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15744 @end smallexample
15745
15746 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15747 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15748
15749 @node Ada Tasks
15750 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15751 @cindex Ada, tasking
15752
15753 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15754 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15755
15756 @table @code
15757 @kindex info tasks
15758 @item info tasks
15759 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15760
15761
15762 @smallexample
15763 @iftex
15764 @leftskip=0.5cm
15765 @end iftex
15766 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15767 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15768 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15769 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15770 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15771 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15772
15773 @end smallexample
15774
15775 @noindent
15776 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15777 task currently being inspected.
15778
15779 @table @asis
15780 @item ID
15781 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15782
15783 @item TID
15784 The Ada task ID.
15785
15786 @item P-ID
15787 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15788
15789 @item Pri
15790 The base priority of the task.
15791
15792 @item State
15793 Current state of the task.
15794
15795 @table @code
15796 @item Unactivated
15797 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15798 executing.
15799
15800 @item Runnable
15801 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15802 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15803
15804 @item Terminated
15805 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15806 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15807 terminated themselves.
15808
15809 @item Child Activation Wait
15810 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15811
15812 @item Accept Statement
15813 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15814
15815 @item Waiting on entry call
15816 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15817
15818 @item Async Select Wait
15819 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15820 select statement.
15821
15822 @item Delay Sleep
15823 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15824 alternative open.
15825
15826 @item Child Termination Wait
15827 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15828 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15829 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15830
15831 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15832 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15833 finish terminating.
15834
15835 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15836 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15837 @end table
15838
15839 @item Name
15840 Name of the task in the program.
15841
15842 @end table
15843
15844 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15845 @item info task @var{taskno}
15846 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15847 the following example:
15848 @smallexample
15849 @iftex
15850 @leftskip=0.5cm
15851 @end iftex
15852 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15853 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15854 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15855 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15856 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15857 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15858 Name: task_1
15859 Thread: 0x807f378
15860 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15861 Base Priority: 15
15862 State: Runnable
15863 @end smallexample
15864
15865 @item task
15866 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15867 @cindex current Ada task ID
15868 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15869
15870 @smallexample
15871 @iftex
15872 @leftskip=0.5cm
15873 @end iftex
15874 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15875 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15876 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15877 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15878 (@value{GDBP}) task
15879 [Current task is 2]
15880 @end smallexample
15881
15882 @item task @var{taskno}
15883 @cindex Ada task switching
15884 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15885 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15886 from the current task to the given task.
15887
15888 @smallexample
15889 @iftex
15890 @leftskip=0.5cm
15891 @end iftex
15892 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15893 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15894 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15895 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15896 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15897 [Switching to task 1]
15898 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15899 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15900 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15901 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15902 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15903 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15904 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15905 @end smallexample
15906
15907 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15908 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15909 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15910 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15911 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15912 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15913 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15914 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15915 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15916
15917 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15918 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15919 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15920 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15921 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15922
15923 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15924 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15925 program.
15926
15927 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15928 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15929 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15930
15931 For example,
15932
15933 @smallexample
15934 @iftex
15935 @leftskip=0.5cm
15936 @end iftex
15937 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15938 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15939 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15940 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15941 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15942 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15943 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15944 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15945 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15946 Continuing.
15947 task # 1 running
15948 task # 2 running
15949
15950 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15951 15 flush;
15952 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15953 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15954 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15955 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15956 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15957 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15958 @end smallexample
15959 @end table
15960
15961 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15962 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15963 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15964
15965 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15966 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15967 the platform being used.
15968 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15969 switching is not supported.
15970
15971 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
15972 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15973 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15974 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15975 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15976 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15977
15978 @node Ravenscar Profile
15979 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15980 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15981
15982 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15983 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15984 requirements.
15985
15986 @table @code
15987 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15988 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15989 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15990 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15991 Profile. This is the default.
15992
15993 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15994 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15995 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15996 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15997 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15998 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15999 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16000
16001 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16002 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16003 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16004 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16005
16006 @end table
16007
16008 @node Ada Glitches
16009 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16010 @cindex Ada, problems
16011
16012 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16013 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16014 @value{GDBN},
16015 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16016 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16017
16018 @itemize @bullet
16019 @item
16020 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16021 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16022
16023 @item
16024 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16025 argument lists are treated as positional).
16026
16027 @item
16028 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16029
16030 @item
16031 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16032 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16033 the host machine.
16034
16035 @item
16036 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16037 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16038 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16039 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16040 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16041 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16042 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16043 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16044 you can usually resolve the confusion
16045 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16046 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16047 @end itemize
16048
16049 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16050 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16051 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16052 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16053 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16054 enabled.
16055
16056 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16057 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16058 @table @code
16059
16060 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16061 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16062 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16063 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16064 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16065 This is the default.
16066
16067 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16068 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16069 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16070 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16071 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16072 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16073 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16074
16075 @end table
16076
16077 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16078 @cindex GNAT encoding
16079 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16080 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16081 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16082 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16083 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16084 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16085
16086 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16087 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16088 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16089 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16090 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16091 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16092 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16093 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16094
16095 @table @code
16096
16097 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16098 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16099 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16100 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16101
16102 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16103 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16104 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16105
16106 @end table
16107
16108 @node Unsupported Languages
16109 @section Unsupported Languages
16110
16111 @cindex unsupported languages
16112 @cindex minimal language
16113 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16114 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16115 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16116 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16117 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16118 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16119
16120 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16121 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16122 language.
16123
16124 @node Symbols
16125 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16126
16127 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16128 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16129 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16130 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16131 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16132 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16133 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16134
16135 @cindex symbol names
16136 @cindex names of symbols
16137 @cindex quoting names
16138 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16139 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16140 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16141 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16142 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16143 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16144 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16145 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16146
16147 @smallexample
16148 p 'foo.c'::x
16149 @end smallexample
16150
16151 @noindent
16152 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16153
16154 @table @code
16155 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16156 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16157 @kindex set case-sensitive
16158 @item set case-sensitive on
16159 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16160 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16161 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16162 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16163 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16164 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16165 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16166 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16167 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16168 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16169 case-insensitive matches.
16170
16171 @kindex show case-sensitive
16172 @item show case-sensitive
16173 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16174 lookups.
16175
16176 @kindex set print type methods
16177 @item set print type methods
16178 @itemx set print type methods on
16179 @itemx set print type methods off
16180 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16181 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16182 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16183 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16184 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16185 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16186
16187 @kindex show print type methods
16188 @item show print type methods
16189 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16190 classes.
16191
16192 @kindex set print type typedefs
16193 @item set print type typedefs
16194 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16195 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16196
16197 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16198 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16199 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16200 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16201 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16202 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16203 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16204 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16205 types.
16206
16207 @kindex show print type typedefs
16208 @item show print type typedefs
16209 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16210 printing classes.
16211
16212 @kindex info address
16213 @cindex address of a symbol
16214 @item info address @var{symbol}
16215 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16216 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16217 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16218 is always stored.
16219
16220 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16221 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16222 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16223
16224 @kindex info symbol
16225 @cindex symbol from address
16226 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16227 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16228 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16229 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16230 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16231
16232 @smallexample
16233 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16234 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16235 @end smallexample
16236
16237 @noindent
16238 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16239 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16240
16241 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16242 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16243
16244 @smallexample
16245 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16246 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16247 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16248 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16249 @end smallexample
16250
16251 @kindex demangle
16252 @cindex demangle
16253 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16254 Demangle @var{name}.
16255 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16256 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16257
16258 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16259 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16260
16261 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16262 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16263
16264 @kindex whatis
16265 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16266 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16267 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16268 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16269
16270 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16271 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16272 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16273
16274 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16275 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16276 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16277 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16278 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16279 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16280 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16281 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16282 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16283
16284 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16285 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16286 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16287 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16288 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16289 unroll it.
16290
16291 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16292 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16293 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16294
16295 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16296 Available flags are:
16297
16298 @table @code
16299 @item r
16300 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16301 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16302 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16303
16304 @item m
16305 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16306
16307 @item M
16308 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16309 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16310
16311 @item t
16312 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16313 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16314 names are substituted when printing other types.
16315
16316 @item T
16317 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16318 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16319 @end table
16320
16321 @kindex ptype
16322 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16323 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16324 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16325 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16326
16327 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16328 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16329 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16330 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16331 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16332 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16333 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16334 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16335
16336 For example, for this variable declaration:
16337
16338 @smallexample
16339 typedef double real_t;
16340 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16341 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16342 complex_t var;
16343 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16344 @end smallexample
16345
16346 @noindent
16347 the two commands give this output:
16348
16349 @smallexample
16350 @group
16351 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16352 type = complex_t
16353 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16354 type = struct complex @{
16355 real_t real;
16356 double imag;
16357 @}
16358 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16359 type = struct complex
16360 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16361 type = struct complex
16362 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16363 type = struct complex @{
16364 real_t real;
16365 double imag;
16366 @}
16367 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16368 type = real_t *
16369 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16370 type = double *
16371 @end group
16372 @end smallexample
16373
16374 @noindent
16375 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16376 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16377
16378 @cindex incomplete type
16379 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16380 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16381 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16382 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16383 given these declarations:
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 struct foo;
16387 struct foo *fooptr;
16388 @end smallexample
16389
16390 @noindent
16391 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16392
16393 @smallexample
16394 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16395 $1 = <incomplete type>
16396 @end smallexample
16397
16398 @noindent
16399 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16400 completely specified.
16401
16402 @kindex info types
16403 @item info types @var{regexp}
16404 @itemx info types
16405 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16406 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16407 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16408 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16409 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16410 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16411 name is @code{value}.
16412
16413 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16414 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16415 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16416
16417 @kindex info type-printers
16418 @item info type-printers
16419 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16420 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16421 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16422 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16423 type printers.
16424
16425 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16426
16427 @kindex enable type-printer
16428 @kindex disable type-printer
16429 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16430 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16431 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16432
16433 @kindex info scope
16434 @cindex local variables
16435 @item info scope @var{location}
16436 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16437 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16438 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16439 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16440 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16441
16442 @smallexample
16443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16444 Scope for command_line_handler:
16445 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16446 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16447 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16448 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16449 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16450 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16451 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16452 @end smallexample
16453
16454 @noindent
16455 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16456 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16457 collect}.
16458
16459 @kindex info source
16460 @item info source
16461 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16462 the function containing the current point of execution:
16463 @itemize @bullet
16464 @item
16465 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16466 @item
16467 the directory it was compiled in,
16468 @item
16469 its length, in lines,
16470 @item
16471 which programming language it is written in,
16472 @item
16473 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16474 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16475 @item
16476 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16477 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16478 @item
16479 whether the debugging information includes information about
16480 preprocessor macros.
16481 @end itemize
16482
16483
16484 @kindex info sources
16485 @item info sources
16486 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16487 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16488 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16489
16490 @kindex info functions
16491 @item info functions
16492 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16493
16494 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16495 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16496 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16497 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16498 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16499 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16500 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16501 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16502
16503 @kindex info variables
16504 @item info variables
16505 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16506 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16507
16508 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16509 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16510 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16511 @var{regexp}.
16512
16513 @kindex info classes
16514 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16515 @item info classes
16516 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16517 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16518 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16519 expression.
16520
16521 @kindex info selectors
16522 @item info selectors
16523 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16524 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16525 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16526 expression.
16527
16528 @ignore
16529 This was never implemented.
16530 @kindex info methods
16531 @item info methods
16532 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16533 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16534 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16535 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16536 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16537 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16538 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16539 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16540 @end ignore
16541
16542 @cindex opaque data types
16543 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16544 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16545 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16546 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16547 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16548 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16549 another source file. The default is on.
16550
16551 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16552 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16553
16554 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16555 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16556 is printed as follows:
16557 @smallexample
16558 @{<no data fields>@}
16559 @end smallexample
16560
16561 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16562 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16563 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16564
16565 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16566 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16567 @item set print symbol-loading
16568 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16569 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16570 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16571 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16572 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16573 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16574 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16575 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16576 can be annoying.
16577 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16578 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16579 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16580 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16581
16582 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16583 @item show print symbol-loading
16584 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16585 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16586
16587 @kindex maint print symbols
16588 @cindex symbol dump
16589 @kindex maint print psymbols
16590 @cindex partial symbol dump
16591 @kindex maint print msymbols
16592 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16593 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16594 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16595 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16596 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16597 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16598 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16599 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16600 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16601 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16602 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16603 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16604 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16605 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16606 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16607 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16608 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16609 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16610
16611 @kindex maint info symtabs
16612 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16613 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16614 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16615 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16616 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16617 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16618 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16619
16620 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16621 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16622 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16623 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16624 structure in more detail. For example:
16625
16626 @smallexample
16627 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16628 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16629 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16630 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16631 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16632 readin no
16633 fullname (null)
16634 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16635 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16636 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16637 dependencies (none)
16638 @}
16639 @}
16640 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16641 (@value{GDBP})
16642 @end smallexample
16643 @noindent
16644 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16645 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16646 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16647 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16648 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16649
16650 @smallexample
16651 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16652 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16653 line 1574.
16654 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16655 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16656 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16657 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16658 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16659 dirname (null)
16660 fullname (null)
16661 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16662 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16663 debugformat DWARF 2
16664 @}
16665 @}
16666 (@value{GDBP})
16667 @end smallexample
16668
16669 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16670 @cindex symbol cache size
16671 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16672 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16673 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16674 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16675 with different sizes.
16676
16677 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16678 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16679 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16680
16681 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16682 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16683 @item maint print symbol-cache
16684 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16685 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16686
16687 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16688 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16689 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16690 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16691 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16692
16693 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16694 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16695 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16696 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16697 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16698 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16699
16700 @end table
16701
16702 @node Altering
16703 @chapter Altering Execution
16704
16705 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16706 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16707 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16708 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16709 program.
16710
16711 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16712 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16713 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16714
16715 @menu
16716 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16717 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16718 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16719 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16720 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16721 * Patching:: Patching your program
16722 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16723 @end menu
16724
16725 @node Assignment
16726 @section Assignment to Variables
16727
16728 @cindex assignment
16729 @cindex setting variables
16730 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16731 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16732
16733 @smallexample
16734 print x=4
16735 @end smallexample
16736
16737 @noindent
16738 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16739 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16740 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16741 information on operators in supported languages.
16742
16743 @kindex set variable
16744 @cindex variables, setting
16745 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16746 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16747 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16748 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16749 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16750
16751 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16752 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16753 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16754 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16755 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16756 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16757 command @code{set width}:
16758
16759 @smallexample
16760 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16761 type = double
16762 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16763 $4 = 13
16764 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16765 Invalid syntax in expression.
16766 @end smallexample
16767
16768 @noindent
16769 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16770 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16771
16772 @smallexample
16773 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16774 @end smallexample
16775
16776 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16777 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16778 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16779 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16780 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16781 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16782
16783 @smallexample
16784 @group
16785 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16786 type = double
16787 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16788 $1 = 1
16789 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16790 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16791 $2 = 1
16792 (@value{GDBP}) r
16793 The program being debugged has been started already.
16794 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16795 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16796 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16797 Invalid bfd target.
16798 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16799 The current BFD target is "=4".
16800 @end group
16801 @end smallexample
16802
16803 @noindent
16804 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16805 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16806 @code{g}, use
16807
16808 @smallexample
16809 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16810 @end smallexample
16811
16812 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16813 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16814 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16815 same length or shorter.
16816 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16817 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16818
16819 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16820 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16821 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16822 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16823 and representation in memory), and
16824
16825 @smallexample
16826 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16827 @end smallexample
16828
16829 @noindent
16830 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16831
16832 @node Jumping
16833 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16834
16835 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16836 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16837 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16838
16839 @table @code
16840 @kindex jump
16841 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16842 @item jump @var{linespec}
16843 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16844 @itemx jump @var{location}
16845 @itemx j @var{location}
16846 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16847 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16848 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16849 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16850 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16851 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16852
16853 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16854 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16855 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16856 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16857 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16858 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16859 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16860 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16861 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16862 @end table
16863
16864 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16865 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16866 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16867 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16868 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16869 example,
16870
16871 @smallexample
16872 set $pc = 0x485
16873 @end smallexample
16874
16875 @noindent
16876 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16877 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16878 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16879
16880 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16881 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16882 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16883 detail.
16884
16885 @c @group
16886 @node Signaling
16887 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16888 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16889
16890 @table @code
16891 @kindex signal
16892 @item signal @var{signal}
16893 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16894 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16895 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16896 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16897
16898 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16899 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16900 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16901 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16902 signal.
16903
16904 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16905 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16906 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16907 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16908 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16909 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16910 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16911 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16912
16913 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16914 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16915 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16916 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16917 passes the signal directly to your program.
16918
16919 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16920 after executing the command.
16921
16922 @kindex queue-signal
16923 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16924 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16925 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16926 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16927 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16928 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16929 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16930 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16931 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16932
16933 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16934 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16935 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16936 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16937 @code{continue} command.
16938
16939 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16940 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16941 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16942 (@pxref{Signals}).
16943 @end table
16944 @c @end group
16945
16946 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
16947 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
16948
16949 @node Returning
16950 @section Returning from a Function
16951
16952 @table @code
16953 @cindex returning from a function
16954 @kindex return
16955 @item return
16956 @itemx return @var{expression}
16957 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16958 command. If you give an
16959 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16960 value.
16961 @end table
16962
16963 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16964 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16965 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16966 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16967
16968 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16969 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16970 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16971 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16972 of functions.
16973
16974 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16975 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16976 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16977 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16978 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16979
16980 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16981 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16982 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16983 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16984 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16985 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16986 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16987 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16988 assignment into the right register(s).
16989
16990 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16991 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16992 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16993 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16994 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16995 into a @code{long long int}:
16996
16997 @smallexample
16998 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16999 29 return 31;
17000 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17001 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17002 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17003 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17004 (@value{GDBP})
17005 @end smallexample
17006
17007 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17008 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17009 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17010 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17011 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17012 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17013 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17014 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17015
17016 @smallexample
17017 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17018 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17019 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17020 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17021 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17022 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17023 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17024 (@value{GDBP})
17025 @end smallexample
17026
17027 @node Calling
17028 @section Calling Program Functions
17029
17030 @table @code
17031 @cindex calling functions
17032 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17033 @item print @var{expr}
17034 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17035 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17036 debugged.
17037
17038 @kindex call
17039 @item call @var{expr}
17040 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17041 returned values.
17042
17043 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17044 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17045 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17046 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17047 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17048 value history.
17049 @end table
17050
17051 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17052 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17053 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17054 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17055
17056 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17057 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17058 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17059 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17060 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17061 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17062 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17063 in that case is controlled by the
17064 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17065
17066 @table @code
17067 @item set unwindonsignal
17068 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17069 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17070 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17071 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17072 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17073 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17074 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17075 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17076 received.
17077
17078 @item show unwindonsignal
17079 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17080 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17081 @value{GDBN}.
17082
17083 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17084 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17085 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17086 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17087 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17088 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17089 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17090 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17091 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17092 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17093
17094 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17095 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17096 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17097 @value{GDBN}.
17098
17099 @end table
17100
17101 @cindex weak alias functions
17102 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17103 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17104 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17105 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17106 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17107 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17108 function instead.
17109
17110 @node Patching
17111 @section Patching Programs
17112
17113 @cindex patching binaries
17114 @cindex writing into executables
17115 @cindex writing into corefiles
17116
17117 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17118 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17119 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17120 patching your program's binary.
17121
17122 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17123 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17124 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17125 repairs.
17126
17127 @table @code
17128 @kindex set write
17129 @item set write on
17130 @itemx set write off
17131 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17132 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17133 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17134
17135 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17136 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17137 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17138
17139 @item show write
17140 @kindex show write
17141 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17142 as well as reading.
17143 @end table
17144
17145 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17146 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17147 @cindex injecting code
17148 @cindex writing into executables
17149 @cindex compiling code
17150
17151 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17152 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17153 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17154 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17155
17156 @table @code
17157 @kindex compile code
17158 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17159 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17160 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17161 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17162 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17163 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17164 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17165 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17166 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17167 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17168 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17169 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17170
17171 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17172 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17173 E.g.:
17174
17175 @smallexample
17176 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17177 @end smallexample
17178
17179 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17180 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17181 from actual source code. E.g.:
17182
17183 @smallexample
17184 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17185 @end smallexample
17186
17187 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17188 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17189 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17190 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17191 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17192 editor.
17193
17194 @smallexample
17195 compile code
17196 >printf ("hello\n");
17197 >printf ("world\n");
17198 >end
17199 @end smallexample
17200
17201 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17202 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17203 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17204 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17205 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17206 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17207 inferior symbols otherwise.
17208
17209 @kindex compile file
17210 @item compile file @var{filename}
17211 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17212 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17213
17214 @smallexample
17215 compile file /home/user/example.c
17216 @end smallexample
17217 @end table
17218
17219 @noindent
17220 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17221
17222 @table @code
17223 @anchor{set debug compile}
17224 @item set debug compile
17225 @cindex compile command debugging info
17226 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17227 injecting the code. The default is off.
17228
17229 @item show debug compile
17230 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17231 compiling and injecting the code.
17232 @end table
17233
17234 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17235
17236 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17237 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17238 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17239 injecting process.
17240
17241 @noindent
17242 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17243
17244 @table @asis
17245 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17246 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17247 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17248 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17249
17250 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17251 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17252 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17253 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17254 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17255 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17256 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17257 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17258
17259 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17260 @end table
17261
17262 @noindent
17263 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17264
17265 @table @code
17266 @item set compile-args
17267 @cindex compile command options override
17268 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17269 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17270 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17271 compilation.
17272
17273 @item show compile-args
17274 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17275 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17276 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17277 @end table
17278
17279 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17280
17281 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17282 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17283 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17284
17285 @table @asis
17286 @item C code examples and caveats
17287 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17288 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17289 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17290 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17291 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17292
17293 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17294 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17295 much like any other normal debugging session.
17296
17297 @smallexample
17298 void function1 (void)
17299 @{
17300 int i = 42;
17301 printf ("function 1\n");
17302 @}
17303
17304 void function2 (void)
17305 @{
17306 int j = 12;
17307 function1 ();
17308 @}
17309
17310 int main(void)
17311 @{
17312 int k = 6;
17313 int *p;
17314 function2 ();
17315 return 0;
17316 @}
17317 @end smallexample
17318
17319 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17320 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17321 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17322
17323 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17324 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17325 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17326 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17327 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17328
17329 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17330 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17331 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17332 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17333 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17334 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17335 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17336 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17337 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17338 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17339
17340 @smallexample
17341 compile code k = 3;
17342 @end smallexample
17343
17344 @noindent
17345 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17346 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17347 @code{compile} command changes it.
17348
17349 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17350 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17351 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17352 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17353 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17354
17355 @smallexample
17356 compile code j = 3;
17357 @end smallexample
17358
17359 @noindent
17360 will result in a compilation error message.
17361
17362 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17363 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17364 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17365
17366 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17367 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17368 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17369 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17370
17371 @smallexample
17372 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17373 @end smallexample
17374
17375 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17376 command has completed:
17377
17378 @smallexample
17379 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17380 @end smallexample
17381
17382 @noindent
17383 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17384 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17385 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17386 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17387 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17388
17389 @smallexample
17390 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17391 @end smallexample
17392
17393 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17394 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17395 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17396 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17397 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17398 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17399 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17400 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17401
17402 @smallexample
17403 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17404 @end smallexample
17405
17406 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17407 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17408 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17409 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17410 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17411 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17412 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17413
17414 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17415 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17416 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17417 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17418 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17419 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17420
17421 @smallexample
17422 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17423 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17424 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17425 Compilation failed.
17426 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17427 42
17428 @end smallexample
17429
17430 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17431 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17432 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17433 will print to the console.
17434 @end table
17435
17436 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17437
17438 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17439 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17440 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17441 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17442 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17443 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17444 target architecture and operating system.
17445
17446 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17447 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17448 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17449 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17450 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17451 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17452 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17453
17454 @node GDB Files
17455 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17456
17457 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17458 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17459 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17460 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17461
17462 @menu
17463 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17464 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17465 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17466 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17467 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17468 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17469 @end menu
17470
17471 @node Files
17472 @section Commands to Specify Files
17473
17474 @cindex symbol table
17475 @cindex core dump file
17476
17477 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17478 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17479 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17480 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17481
17482 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17483 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17484 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17485 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17486 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17487 new files are useful.
17488
17489 @table @code
17490 @cindex executable file
17491 @kindex file
17492 @item file @var{filename}
17493 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17494 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17495 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17496 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17497 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17498 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17499 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17500 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17501
17502 @cindex unlinked object files
17503 @cindex patching object files
17504 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17505 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17506 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17507 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17508 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17509 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17510 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17511 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17512
17513 @item file
17514 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17515 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17516
17517 @kindex exec-file
17518 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17519 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17520 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17521 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17522 discard information on the executable file.
17523
17524 @kindex symbol-file
17525 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17526 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17527 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17528 table and program to run from the same file.
17529
17530 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17531 program's symbol table.
17532
17533 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17534 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17535 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17536 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17537 @value{GDBN}.
17538
17539 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17540 executing it once.
17541
17542 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17543 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17544 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17545 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17546 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17547 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17548 optimized code.
17549
17550 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17551 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17552 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17553 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17554 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17555
17556 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17557 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17558 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17559 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17560 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17561 Warnings and Messages}.)
17562
17563 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17564 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17565 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17566 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17567 in stabs format.
17568
17569 @kindex readnow
17570 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17571 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17572 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17573 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17574 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17575 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17576 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17577 entire symbol table available.
17578
17579 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17580 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17581 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17582 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17583 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17584 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17585 @c files.
17586
17587 @kindex core-file
17588 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17589 @itemx core
17590 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17591 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17592 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17593 executable file itself for other parts.
17594
17595 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17596 to be used.
17597
17598 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17599 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17600 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17601 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17602 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17603
17604 @kindex add-symbol-file
17605 @cindex dynamic linking
17606 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17607 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17608 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17609 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17610 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17611 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17612 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17613 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17614 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17615 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17616 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17617 @var{address} as an expression.
17618
17619 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17620 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17621 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17622 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17623
17624 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17625
17626 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17627 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17628 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17629 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17630 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17631 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17632 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17633 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17634 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17635
17636 @itemize @bullet
17637 @item
17638 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17639 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17640 @item
17641 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17642 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17643 @item
17644 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17645 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17646 @end itemize
17647
17648 @noindent
17649 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17650 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17651 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17652 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17653 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17654 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17655 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17656 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17657 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17658 way.
17659
17660 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17661
17662 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17663 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17664 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17665 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17666 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17667 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17668
17669 @smallexample
17670 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17671 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17672 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17673 (y or n) y
17674 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17675 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17676 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17677 (gdb)
17678 @end smallexample
17679
17680
17681 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17682
17683 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17684 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17685 @cindex load symbols from memory
17686 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17687 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17688 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17689 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17690 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17691 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17692 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17693 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17694 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17695
17696 @kindex section
17697 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17698 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17699 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17700 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17701 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17702 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17703 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17704 their addresses.
17705
17706 @kindex info files
17707 @kindex info target
17708 @item info files
17709 @itemx info target
17710 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17711 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17712 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17713 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17714 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17715 current ones.
17716
17717 @kindex maint info sections
17718 @item maint info sections
17719 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17720 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17721 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17722 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17723 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17724 may be arbitrarily combined):
17725
17726 @table @code
17727 @item ALLOBJ
17728 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17729 @item @var{sections}
17730 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17731 @item @var{section-flags}
17732 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17733 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17734 @table @code
17735 @item ALLOC
17736 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17737 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17738 @item LOAD
17739 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17740 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17741 @item RELOC
17742 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17743 @item READONLY
17744 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17745 @item CODE
17746 Section contains executable code only.
17747 @item DATA
17748 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17749 @item ROM
17750 Section will reside in ROM.
17751 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17752 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17753 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17754 Section is not empty.
17755 @item NEVER_LOAD
17756 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17757 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17758 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17759 COFF shared library information.
17760 @item IS_COMMON
17761 Section contains common symbols.
17762 @end table
17763 @end table
17764 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17765 @cindex read-only sections
17766 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17767 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17768 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17769 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17770 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17771 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17772 enhancement to debugging performance.
17773
17774 The default is off.
17775
17776 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17777 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17778 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17779 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17780
17781 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17782 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17783 @end table
17784
17785 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17786 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17787 name and remembers it that way.
17788
17789 @cindex shared libraries
17790 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17791 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17792 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17793
17794 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17795 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17796
17797 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17798 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17799 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17800 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17801 debugging a core file).
17802
17803 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17804 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17805
17806 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17807 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17808 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17809
17810 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17811 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17812 particularly large or there are many of them.
17813
17814 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17815 commands:
17816
17817 @table @code
17818 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17819 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17820 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17821 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17822 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17823 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17824 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17825 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17826
17827 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17828 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17829 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17830 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17831 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17832 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17833 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17834 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17835 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17836
17837 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17838 @item show auto-solib-add
17839 Display the current autoloading mode.
17840 @end table
17841
17842 @cindex load shared library
17843 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17844 command:
17845
17846 @table @code
17847 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17848 @kindex info share
17849 @item info share @var{regex}
17850 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17851 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17852 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17853 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17854
17855 @kindex sharedlibrary
17856 @kindex share
17857 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17858 @itemx share @var{regex}
17859 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17860 Unix regular expression.
17861 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17862 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17863 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17864 loaded.
17865
17866 @item nosharedlibrary
17867 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17868 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17869 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17870 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17871 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17872 discarded.
17873 @end table
17874
17875 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17876 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17877 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17878 Catchpoints}).
17879
17880 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17881 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17882 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17883 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17884
17885 @table @code
17886 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17887 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17888 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17889 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17890 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17891 shared library.
17892
17893 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17894 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17895 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17896 library events happen.
17897 @end table
17898
17899 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17900 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17901 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17902 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17903 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17904 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17905 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17906 not.
17907
17908 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17909 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17910 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17911 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17912 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17913
17914 @table @code
17915 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
17916 @cindex system root, alternate
17917 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17918 @kindex set sysroot
17919 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17920 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17921 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17922 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17923 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
17924 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
17925 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
17926 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
17927 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
17928 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
17929 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
17930 @var{path}.
17931
17932 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
17933 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
17934 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
17935 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
17936 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
17937 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
17938 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
17939 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
17940 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
17941 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
17942 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
17943 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
17944 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
17945 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
17946
17947 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17948 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17949 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17950 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17951 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17952
17953 @smallexample
17954 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17955 @end smallexample
17956
17957 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17958 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17959 system:
17960
17961 @smallexample
17962 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17963 @end smallexample
17964
17965 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17966 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17967 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17968 colons:
17969
17970 @smallexample
17971 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17972 @end smallexample
17973
17974 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17975 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17976 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17977 @samp{z}):
17978
17979 @smallexample
17980 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17981 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17982 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17983 @end smallexample
17984
17985 @noindent
17986 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17987 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17988 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17989
17990 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
17991 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17992
17993 @smallexample
17994 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17995 @end smallexample
17996
17997 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17998 if you don't want or need to.
17999
18000 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18001 sysroot}.
18002
18003 @cindex default system root
18004 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18005 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18006 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18007 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18008 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18009 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18010 location.
18011
18012 @kindex show sysroot
18013 @item show sysroot
18014 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18015
18016 @kindex set solib-search-path
18017 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18018 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18019 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18020 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18021 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18022 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18023 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18024 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18025 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18026 of shared library symbols.
18027
18028 @kindex show solib-search-path
18029 @item show solib-search-path
18030 Display the current shared library search path.
18031
18032 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18033 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18034 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18035 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18036 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18037
18038 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18039 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18040 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18041 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18042 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18043 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18044 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18045 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18046 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18047 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18048 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18049 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18050 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18051 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18052 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18053 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18054 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18055 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18056 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18057 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18058 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18059 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18060
18061 @table @code
18062 @item unix
18063 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18064 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18065 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18066 the forward slash.
18067
18068 @item dos-based
18069 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18070 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18071 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18072 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18073 considered directory separators.
18074
18075 @item auto
18076 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18077 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18078 This is the default.
18079 @end table
18080 @end table
18081
18082 @cindex file name canonicalization
18083 @cindex base name differences
18084 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18085 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18086 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18087 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18088 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18089 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18090 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18091 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18092 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18093 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18094 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18095 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18096 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18097 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18098 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18099
18100 @table @code
18101 @item set basenames-may-differ
18102 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18103 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18104
18105 @item show basenames-may-differ
18106 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18107 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18108 @end table
18109
18110 @node Separate Debug Files
18111 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18112 @cindex separate debugging information files
18113 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18114 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18115 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18116 @cindex global debugging information directories
18117 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18118 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18119
18120 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18121 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18122 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18123 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18124 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18125 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18126 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18127
18128 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18129 file:
18130
18131 @itemize @bullet
18132 @item
18133 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18134 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18135 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18136 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18137 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18138 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18139 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18140 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18141
18142 @item
18143 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18144 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18145 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
18146 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18147 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18148 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18149 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18150 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18151 below.
18152 @end itemize
18153
18154 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18155 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18156
18157 @itemize @bullet
18158 @item
18159 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18160 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18161 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18162 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18163 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18164
18165 @item
18166 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18167 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18168 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18169 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18170 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18171 hex characters, not 10.)
18172 @end itemize
18173
18174 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18175 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18176 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18177 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18178 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18179 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18180
18181 @itemize @minus
18182 @item
18183 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18184 @item
18185 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18186 @item
18187 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18188 @item
18189 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18190 @end itemize
18191
18192 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18193 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18194 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18195 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18196 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18197
18198 @table @code
18199
18200 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18201 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18202 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18203 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18204 concatenating them by a path separator.
18205
18206 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18207 @item show debug-file-directory
18208 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18209 information files.
18210
18211 @end table
18212
18213 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18214 @cindex debug link sections
18215 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18216 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18217
18218 @itemize
18219 @item
18220 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18221 a zero byte,
18222 @item
18223 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18224 boundary within the section, and
18225 @item
18226 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18227 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18228 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18229 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18230 @end itemize
18231
18232 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18233 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18234 described above.
18235
18236 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18237 @cindex build ID sections
18238 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18239 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18240 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18241 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18242 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18243 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18244 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18245 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18246 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18247
18248 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18249 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18250 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18251 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18252 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18253 in an ordinary executable.
18254
18255 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18256 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18257 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18258 following commands:
18259
18260 @smallexample
18261 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18262 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18263 @end smallexample
18264
18265 @noindent
18266 These commands remove the debugging
18267 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18268 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18269 two files:
18270
18271 @itemize @bullet
18272 @item
18273 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18274 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18275
18276 @smallexample
18277 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18278 @end smallexample
18279
18280 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18281 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18282 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18283 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18284
18285 @item
18286 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18287 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18288 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18289 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18290 @end itemize
18291
18292 @noindent
18293
18294 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18295 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18296 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18297
18298 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18299 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18300 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18301 @c different ways!
18302 @ifhtml
18303 @display
18304 @html
18305 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18306 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18307 @end html
18308 @end display
18309 @end ifhtml
18310 @ifnothtml
18311 @display
18312 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18313 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18314 @end display
18315 @end ifnothtml
18316
18317 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18318 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18319 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18320 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18321 CRC.
18322
18323 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18324 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18325 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18326 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18327 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18328
18329 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18330 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18331 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18332 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18333 @code{0xffffffff}.
18334
18335 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18336 @smallexample
18337 unsigned long
18338 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18339 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18340 @{
18341 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18342 @{
18343 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18344 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18345 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18346 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18347 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18348 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18349 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18350 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18351 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18352 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18353 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18354 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18355 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18356 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18357 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18358 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18359 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18360 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18361 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18362 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18363 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18364 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18365 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18366 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18367 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18368 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18369 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18370 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18371 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18372 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18373 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18374 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18375 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18376 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18377 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18378 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18379 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18380 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18381 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18382 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18383 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18384 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18385 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18386 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18387 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18388 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18389 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18390 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18391 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18392 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18393 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18394 0x2d02ef8d
18395 @};
18396 unsigned char *end;
18397
18398 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18399 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18400 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18401 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18402 @}
18403 @end smallexample
18404
18405 @noindent
18406 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18407
18408 @node MiniDebugInfo
18409 @section Debugging information in a special section
18410 @cindex separate debug sections
18411 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18412
18413 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18414 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18415 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18416 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18417
18418 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18419 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18420 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18421 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18422 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18423 debugging information might be included in the section.
18424
18425 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18426 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18427 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18428
18429 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18430 standard utilities:
18431
18432 @smallexample
18433 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18434 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18435 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18436 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18437
18438 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18439 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18440 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18441 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18442 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18443 | sort > funcsyms
18444
18445 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18446 # table.
18447 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18448
18449 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18450 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18451
18452 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18453 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18454 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18455 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18456
18457 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18458 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18459
18460 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18461 # original binary.
18462 xz mini_debuginfo
18463 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18464 @end smallexample
18465
18466 @node Index Files
18467 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18468 @cindex index files
18469 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18470
18471 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18472 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18473 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18474 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18475 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18476 startup.
18477
18478 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18479 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18480 using @command{objcopy}.
18481
18482 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18483
18484 @table @code
18485 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18486 @kindex save gdb-index
18487 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18488 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18489 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18490 @var{directory}.
18491 @end table
18492
18493 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18494 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18495
18496 @smallexample
18497 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18498 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18499 @end smallexample
18500
18501 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18502 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18503 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18504 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18505 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18506 The default is @code{off}.
18507 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18508 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18509
18510 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18511 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18512
18513 @smallexample
18514 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18515 @end smallexample
18516
18517 Instead you must do, for example,
18518
18519 @smallexample
18520 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18521 @end smallexample
18522
18523 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18524 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18525 currently work for programs using Ada.
18526
18527 @node Symbol Errors
18528 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18529
18530 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18531 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18532 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18533 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18534 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18535 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18536 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18537 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18538 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18539 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18540 Messages}).
18541
18542 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18543
18544 @table @code
18545 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18546
18547 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18548 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18549 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18550 in its outer scope blocks.
18551
18552 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18553 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18554 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18555 function.
18556
18557 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18558
18559 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18560 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18561 do so.
18562
18563 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18564 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18565 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18566 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18567 Messages}.)
18568
18569 @item bad block start address patched
18570
18571 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18572 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18573 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18574
18575 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18576 starting on the previous source line.
18577
18578 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18579
18580 @cindex foo
18581 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18582 larger than the size of the string table.
18583
18584 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18585 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18586 with this name.
18587
18588 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18589
18590 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18591 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18592 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18593
18594 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18595 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18596 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18597 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18598 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18599 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18600
18601 @item stub type has NULL name
18602
18603 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18604
18605 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18606 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18607 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18608 it.
18609
18610 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18611
18612 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18613
18614 @end table
18615
18616 @node Data Files
18617 @section GDB Data Files
18618
18619 @cindex prefix for data files
18620 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18621 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18622
18623 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18624 is currently using.
18625
18626 @table @code
18627 @kindex set data-directory
18628 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18629 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18630 to @var{directory}.
18631
18632 @kindex show data-directory
18633 @item show data-directory
18634 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18635 @end table
18636
18637 @cindex default data directory
18638 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18639 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18640 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18641 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18642 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18643 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18644 location.
18645
18646 The data directory may also be specified with the
18647 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18648 @xref{Mode Options}.
18649
18650 @node Targets
18651 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18652
18653 @cindex debugging target
18654 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18655
18656 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18657 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18658 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18659 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18660 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18661 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18662 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18663 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18664
18665 @cindex target architecture
18666 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18667 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18668 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18669 command.
18670
18671 @table @code
18672 @kindex set architecture
18673 @kindex show architecture
18674 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18675 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18676 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18677 supported architectures.
18678
18679 @item show architecture
18680 Show the current target architecture.
18681
18682 @item set processor
18683 @itemx processor
18684 @kindex set processor
18685 @kindex show processor
18686 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18687 and @code{show architecture}.
18688 @end table
18689
18690 @menu
18691 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18692 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18693 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18694 @end menu
18695
18696 @node Active Targets
18697 @section Active Targets
18698
18699 @cindex stacking targets
18700 @cindex active targets
18701 @cindex multiple targets
18702
18703 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18704 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18705 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18706 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18707 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18708 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18709 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18710 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18711 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18712
18713 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18714 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18715 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18716 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18717
18718 @node Target Commands
18719 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18720
18721 @table @code
18722 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18723 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18724 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18725 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18726 protocol of the target machine.
18727
18728 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18729 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18730 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18731
18732 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18733 after executing the command.
18734
18735 @kindex help target
18736 @item help target
18737 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18738 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18739 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18740
18741 @item help target @var{name}
18742 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18743 select it.
18744
18745 @kindex set gnutarget
18746 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18747 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18748 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18749 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18750 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18751 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18752
18753 @quotation
18754 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18755 you must know the actual BFD name.
18756 @end quotation
18757
18758 @noindent
18759 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18760
18761 @kindex show gnutarget
18762 @item show gnutarget
18763 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18764 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18765 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18766 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18767 @end table
18768
18769 @cindex common targets
18770 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18771 configuration):
18772
18773 @table @code
18774 @kindex target
18775 @item target exec @var{program}
18776 @cindex executable file target
18777 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18778 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18779
18780 @item target core @var{filename}
18781 @cindex core dump file target
18782 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18783 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18784
18785 @item target remote @var{medium}
18786 @cindex remote target
18787 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18788 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18789 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18790
18791 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18792 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18793
18794 @smallexample
18795 target remote /dev/ttya
18796 @end smallexample
18797
18798 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18799 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18800 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18801 clobbered by the download.
18802
18803 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18804 @cindex built-in simulator target
18805 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18806 In general,
18807 @smallexample
18808 target sim
18809 load
18810 run
18811 @end smallexample
18812 @noindent
18813 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18814 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18815 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18816 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18817 Processors}.
18818
18819 @item target native
18820 @cindex native target
18821 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18822 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18823 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18824 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18825
18826 @end table
18827
18828 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18829 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18830
18831 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18832 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18833 various aspects of this process.
18834
18835 @table @code
18836
18837 @item set hash
18838 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18839 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18840 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18841 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18842 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18843 monitor.
18844
18845 @item show hash
18846 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18847 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18848
18849 @item set debug monitor
18850 @kindex set debug monitor
18851 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18852 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18853 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18854
18855 @item show debug monitor
18856 @kindex show debug monitor
18857 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18858 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18859 @end table
18860
18861 @table @code
18862
18863 @kindex load @var{filename}
18864 @item load @var{filename}
18865 @anchor{load}
18866 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18867 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18868 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18869 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18870 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18871 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18872
18873 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18874 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18875 target is @dots{}}''
18876
18877 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18878 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18879 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18880 specifies a fixed address.
18881 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18882
18883 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18884 load programs into flash memory.
18885
18886 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18887 @end table
18888
18889 @node Byte Order
18890 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18891
18892 @cindex choosing target byte order
18893 @cindex target byte order
18894
18895 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18896 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18897 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18898 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18899 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18900 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18901
18902 @table @code
18903 @kindex set endian
18904 @item set endian big
18905 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18906
18907 @item set endian little
18908 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18909
18910 @item set endian auto
18911 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18912 executable.
18913
18914 @item show endian
18915 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18916
18917 @end table
18918
18919 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18920 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18921 target system.
18922
18923
18924 @node Remote Debugging
18925 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18926 @cindex remote debugging
18927
18928 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18929 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18930 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18931 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18932 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18933
18934 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18935 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18936 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18937 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18938 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18939 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18940
18941 Other remote targets may be available in your
18942 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18943
18944 @menu
18945 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18946 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18947 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18948 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18949 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18950 @end menu
18951
18952 @node Connecting
18953 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18954
18955 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18956 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18957 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18958 program as the first argument.
18959
18960 @cindex @code{target remote}
18961 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18962 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18963 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18964 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18965 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18966 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18967
18968 @table @code
18969
18970 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18971 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18972 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18973 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18974
18975 @smallexample
18976 target remote /dev/ttyb
18977 @end smallexample
18978
18979 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18980 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18981 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18982 @code{target} command.
18983
18984 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18985 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18986 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18987 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18988 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18989 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18990 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18991 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18992 target.
18993
18994 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18995 @code{manyfarms}:
18996
18997 @smallexample
18998 target remote manyfarms:2828
18999 @end smallexample
19000
19001 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19002 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19003 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19004 port 1234 on your local machine:
19005
19006 @smallexample
19007 target remote :1234
19008 @end smallexample
19009 @noindent
19010
19011 Note that the colon is still required here.
19012
19013 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19014 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19015 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19016 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19017
19018 @smallexample
19019 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19020 @end smallexample
19021
19022 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19023 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19024 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19025 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19026
19027 @item target remote | @var{command}
19028 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19029 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19030 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19031 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19032 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19033 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19034 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19035 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19036
19037 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19038 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19039 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19040
19041 @end table
19042
19043 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
19044 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
19045 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
19046 need to use @kbd{run}.
19047
19048 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19049 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19050 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19051 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19052 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19053 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19054 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19055
19056 @smallexample
19057 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19058 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19059 @end smallexample
19060
19061 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
19062 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
19063 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
19064 goes back to waiting.
19065
19066 @table @code
19067 @kindex detach (remote)
19068 @item detach
19069 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19070 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19071 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19072 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19073 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
19074
19075 @kindex disconnect
19076 @item disconnect
19077 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
19078 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19079 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19080 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19081 another target.
19082
19083 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19084 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19085 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19086 @kindex monitor
19087 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19088 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19089 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19090 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19091 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19092 and implement.
19093 @end table
19094
19095 @node File Transfer
19096 @section Sending files to a remote system
19097 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19098 @cindex file transfer
19099 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19100
19101 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19102 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19103 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19104 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19105 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19106 the only way to upload or download files.
19107
19108 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19109
19110 @table @code
19111 @kindex remote put
19112 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19113 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19114 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19115
19116 @kindex remote get
19117 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19118 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19119 on the host system.
19120
19121 @kindex remote delete
19122 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19123 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19124
19125 @end table
19126
19127 @node Server
19128 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19129
19130 @kindex gdbserver
19131 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19132 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19133 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19134 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
19135
19136 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19137 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19138 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19139 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19140 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19141 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19142 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19143 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19144 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19145 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19146 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19147 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19148 choice for debugging.
19149
19150 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19151 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19152 protocol.
19153
19154 @quotation
19155 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19156 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19157 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19158 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19159 @code{gdbserver}.
19160 @end quotation
19161
19162 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19163 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19164 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19165
19166 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19167 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19168 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19169 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19170 system does all the symbol handling.
19171
19172 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19173 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19174 syntax is:
19175
19176 @smallexample
19177 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19178 @end smallexample
19179
19180 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19181 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19182 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19183 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19184 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19185 @file{/dev/com1}:
19186
19187 @smallexample
19188 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19189 @end smallexample
19190
19191 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19192 with it.
19193
19194 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19195
19196 @smallexample
19197 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19198 @end smallexample
19199
19200 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19201 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19202 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19203 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19204 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19205 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19206 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19207 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19208 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19209 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19210 @code{target remote} command.
19211
19212 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19213 with ssh:
19214
19215 @smallexample
19216 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19217 @end smallexample
19218
19219 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19220 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19221 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19222 You could elide it if you want to.
19223
19224 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19225 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19226 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19227 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19228
19229 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19230 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19231 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19232
19233 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19234 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19235
19236 @smallexample
19237 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19238 @end smallexample
19239
19240 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19241 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19242
19243 @pindex pidof
19244 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19245 @code{pidof} utility:
19246
19247 @smallexample
19248 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19249 @end smallexample
19250
19251 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19252 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19253 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19254
19255 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19256 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19257 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19258
19259 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19260 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19261 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19262 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19263
19264 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19265 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19266 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19267 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19268 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19269 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19270 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19271 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19272 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19273
19274 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19275 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19276 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19277 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19278 the program you want to debug.
19279
19280 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19281 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19282 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19283 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19284 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19285 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19286
19287 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19288
19289 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19290
19291 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19292 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19293 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19294 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19295 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19296 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19297 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19298 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19299
19300 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19301 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19302 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19303
19304 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19305 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19306 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19307 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19308 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19309 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19310 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19311 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19312 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19313 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19314 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19315 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19316
19317 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19318 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19319
19320 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19321 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19322 status information about the debugging process.
19323 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19324 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19325 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19326 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19327
19328 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19329 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19330 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19331 Possible options are:
19332
19333 @table @code
19334 @item none
19335 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19336 @item all
19337 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19338 @item timestamps
19339 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19340 @end table
19341
19342 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19343 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19344
19345 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19346 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19347 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19348 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19349 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19350
19351 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19352 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19353 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19354 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19355
19356 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19357 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19358 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19359 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19360
19361 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19362 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19363 environment:
19364
19365 @smallexample
19366 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19367 @end smallexample
19368
19369 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19370
19371 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19372
19373 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19374 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19375 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19376 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19377
19378 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19379 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19380 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19381 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19382 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19383 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19384 programs.
19385
19386 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19387 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19388 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19389 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19390 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19391 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19392 already on the target.
19393
19394 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19395 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19396 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19397
19398 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19399 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19400 Here are the available commands.
19401
19402 @table @code
19403 @item monitor help
19404 List the available monitor commands.
19405
19406 @item monitor set debug 0
19407 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19408 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19409
19410 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19411 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19412 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19413 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19414
19415 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19416 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19417 Possible options are:
19418
19419 @table @code
19420 @item none
19421 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19422 @item all
19423 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19424 @item timestamps
19425 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19426 @end table
19427
19428 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19429 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19430
19431 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19432 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19433 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19434 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19435 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19436 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19437
19438 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19439 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19440
19441 @item monitor exit
19442 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19443 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19444 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19445 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19446 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19447
19448 @end table
19449
19450 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19451 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19452
19453 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19454 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19455
19456 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19457 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19458 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19459 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19460 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19461 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19462 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19463 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19464 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19465 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19466 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19467 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19468
19469 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19470
19471 @table @code
19472 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19473
19474 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19475 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19476 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19477
19478 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19479
19480 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19481 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19482 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19483 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19484 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19485 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19486
19487 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19488
19489 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19490 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19491 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19492 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19493 command for that. For example:
19494
19495 @smallexample
19496 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19497 @end smallexample
19498
19499 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19500 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19501 @end table
19502
19503 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19504 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19505 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19506 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19507 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19508 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19509 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19510 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19511 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19512 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19513
19514 @smallexample
19515 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19516 @end smallexample
19517
19518 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19519
19520 @smallexample
19521 $ gdb myprogram
19522 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19523 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19524 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19525 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19526 @end smallexample
19527
19528 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19529 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19530 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19531 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19532 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19533 tracing.
19534
19535 @node Remote Configuration
19536 @section Remote Configuration
19537
19538 @kindex set remote
19539 @kindex show remote
19540 This section documents the configuration options available when
19541 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19542 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19543 system-call-allowed}.
19544
19545 @table @code
19546 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19547 @cindex address size for remote targets
19548 @cindex bits in remote address
19549 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19550 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19551 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19552 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19553
19554 @item show remoteaddresssize
19555 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19556
19557 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19558 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19559 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19560 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19561 remote targets.
19562
19563 @item show serial baud
19564 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19565
19566 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19567 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19568 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19569
19570 @item show serial parity
19571 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19572
19573 @item set remotebreak
19574 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19575 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19576 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19577 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19578 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19579 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19580 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19581 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19582
19583 @item show remotebreak
19584 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19585 interrupt the remote program.
19586
19587 @item set remoteflow on
19588 @itemx set remoteflow off
19589 @kindex set remoteflow
19590 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19591 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19592
19593 @item show remoteflow
19594 @kindex show remoteflow
19595 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19596
19597 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19598 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19599 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19600 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19601 @code{ascii}.
19602
19603 @item show remotelogbase
19604 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19605 protocol.
19606
19607 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19608 @cindex record serial communications on file
19609 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19610 default is not to record at all.
19611
19612 @item show remotelogfile.
19613 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19614 serial communications.
19615
19616 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19617 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19618 @cindex remote timeout
19619 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19620 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19621
19622 @item show remotetimeout
19623 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19624 responses.
19625
19626 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19627 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19628 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19629 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19630 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19631 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19632 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19633 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19634
19635 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19636 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19637 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19638 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19639 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19640 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19641 as unlimited.
19642
19643 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19644 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19645 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19646
19647 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19648 @itemx show remote exec-file
19649 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19650 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19651 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19652 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19653 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19654 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19655
19656 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19657 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19658 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19659 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19660 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19661 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19662 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19663 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19664 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19665 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19666
19667 @item show interrupt-sequence
19668 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19669 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19670 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19671 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19672
19673 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19674 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19675 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19676 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19677 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19678 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19679
19680 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19681 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19682 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19683
19684 @kindex set tcp
19685 @kindex show tcp
19686 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19687 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19688 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19689 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19690 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19691 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19692 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19693 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19694 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19695
19696 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19697 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19698
19699 @item show tcp auto-retry
19700 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19701
19702 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19703 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19704 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19705 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19706 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19707 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19708 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19709 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19710 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19711 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19712 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19713
19714 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19715 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19716 @end table
19717
19718 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19719 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19720 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19721 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19722 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19723 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19724 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19725 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19726 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19727
19728 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19729 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19730 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19731 @value{GDBN} developers.
19732
19733 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19734 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19735 are:
19736
19737 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19738 @item Command Name
19739 @tab Remote Packet
19740 @tab Related Features
19741
19742 @item @code{fetch-register}
19743 @tab @code{p}
19744 @tab @code{info registers}
19745
19746 @item @code{set-register}
19747 @tab @code{P}
19748 @tab @code{set}
19749
19750 @item @code{binary-download}
19751 @tab @code{X}
19752 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19753
19754 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19755 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19756 @tab @code{info auxv}
19757
19758 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19759 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19760 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19761
19762 @item @code{attach}
19763 @tab @code{vAttach}
19764 @tab @code{attach}
19765
19766 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19767 @tab @code{vCont}
19768 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19769
19770 @item @code{run}
19771 @tab @code{vRun}
19772 @tab @code{run}
19773
19774 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19775 @tab @code{Z0}
19776 @tab @code{break}
19777
19778 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19779 @tab @code{Z1}
19780 @tab @code{hbreak}
19781
19782 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19783 @tab @code{Z2}
19784 @tab @code{watch}
19785
19786 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19787 @tab @code{Z3}
19788 @tab @code{rwatch}
19789
19790 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19791 @tab @code{Z4}
19792 @tab @code{awatch}
19793
19794 @item @code{target-features}
19795 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19796 @tab @code{set architecture}
19797
19798 @item @code{library-info}
19799 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19800 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19801
19802 @item @code{memory-map}
19803 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19804 @tab @code{info mem}
19805
19806 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19807 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19808 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19809
19810 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19811 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19812 @tab @code{info spu}
19813
19814 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19815 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19816 @tab @code{info spu}
19817
19818 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19819 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19820 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19821
19822 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19823 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19824 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19825
19826 @item @code{threads}
19827 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19828 @tab @code{info threads}
19829
19830 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19831 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19832 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19833
19834 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19835 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19836 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19837
19838 @item @code{search-memory}
19839 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19840 @tab @code{find}
19841
19842 @item @code{supported-packets}
19843 @tab @code{qSupported}
19844 @tab Remote communications parameters
19845
19846 @item @code{pass-signals}
19847 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19848 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19849
19850 @item @code{program-signals}
19851 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19852 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19853
19854 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19855 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19856 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19857
19858 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19859 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19860 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19861
19862 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19863 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19864 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19865
19866 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19867 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19868 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19869
19870 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19871 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19872 @tab @code{remote delete}
19873
19874 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19875 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19876 @tab Host I/O
19877
19878 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
19879 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
19880 @tab Host I/O
19881
19882 @item @code{noack-packet}
19883 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19884 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19885
19886 @item @code{osdata}
19887 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19888 @tab @code{info os}
19889
19890 @item @code{query-attached}
19891 @tab @code{qAttached}
19892 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19893
19894 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19895 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19896 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19897
19898 @item @code{trace-status}
19899 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19900 @tab @code{tstatus}
19901
19902 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19903 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19904 @tab Traceframe info
19905
19906 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19907 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19908 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19909
19910 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19911 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19912 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19913
19914 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19915 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19916 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19917
19918 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
19919 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
19920 @tab @code{break}
19921
19922 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
19923 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
19924 @tab @code{hbreak}
19925
19926 @end multitable
19927
19928 @node Remote Stub
19929 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19930
19931 @cindex debugging stub, example
19932 @cindex remote stub, example
19933 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19934 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19935 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19936 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19937 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19938 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19939 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19940 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19941
19942 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19943 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19944 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19945 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19946 program, you need:
19947
19948 @enumerate
19949 @item
19950 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19951 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19952 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19953
19954 @item
19955 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19956 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19957
19958 @item
19959 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19960 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19961 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19962 documentation.
19963 @end enumerate
19964
19965 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19966 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19967 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19968
19969 @table @emph
19970 @item On the host,
19971 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19972 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19973 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19974
19975 @item On the target,
19976 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19977 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19978 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19979
19980 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19981 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19982 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19983 @end table
19984
19985 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19986 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19987 @sc{sparc} boards.
19988
19989 @cindex remote serial stub list
19990 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19991
19992 @table @code
19993
19994 @item i386-stub.c
19995 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19996 @cindex Intel
19997 @cindex i386
19998 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19999
20000 @item m68k-stub.c
20001 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20002 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20003 @cindex m680x0
20004 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20005
20006 @item sh-stub.c
20007 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20008 @cindex Renesas
20009 @cindex SH
20010 For Renesas SH architectures.
20011
20012 @item sparc-stub.c
20013 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20014 @cindex Sparc
20015 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20016
20017 @item sparcl-stub.c
20018 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20019 @cindex Fujitsu
20020 @cindex SparcLite
20021 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20022
20023 @end table
20024
20025 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20026 recently added stubs.
20027
20028 @menu
20029 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20030 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20031 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20032 @end menu
20033
20034 @node Stub Contents
20035 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20036
20037 @cindex remote serial stub
20038 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20039 subroutines:
20040
20041 @table @code
20042 @item set_debug_traps
20043 @findex set_debug_traps
20044 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20045 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20046 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20047 program's startup code.
20048
20049 @item handle_exception
20050 @findex handle_exception
20051 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20052 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20053 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20054 run when a trap is triggered.
20055
20056 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20057 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20058 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20059 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20060 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20061 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20062 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20063 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20064 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20065 machine.
20066
20067 @item breakpoint
20068 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20069 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20070 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20071 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20072 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20073 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20074 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20075 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20076 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20077 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20078 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20079
20080 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20081 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20082 start of your debugging session.
20083 @end table
20084
20085 @node Bootstrapping
20086 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20087
20088 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20089 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20090 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20091 debugging target machine.
20092
20093 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20094 serial port.
20095
20096 @table @code
20097 @item int getDebugChar()
20098 @findex getDebugChar
20099 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20100 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20101 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20102
20103 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20104 @findex putDebugChar
20105 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20106 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20107 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20108 @end table
20109
20110 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20111 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20112 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20113 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20114 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20115 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20116 remote system to stop.
20117
20118 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20119 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20120 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20121 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20122
20123 Other routines you need to supply are:
20124
20125 @table @code
20126 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20127 @findex exceptionHandler
20128 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20129 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20130 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20131 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20132 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20133 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20134 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20135 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20136 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20137 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20138 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20139 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20140 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20141
20142 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20143 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20144 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20145 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20146 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20147
20148 @item void flush_i_cache()
20149 @findex flush_i_cache
20150 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20151 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20152 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20153
20154 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20155 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20156 @end table
20157
20158 @noindent
20159 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20160
20161 @table @code
20162 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20163 @findex memset
20164 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20165 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20166 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20167 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20168 @end table
20169
20170 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20171 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20172 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20173 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20174
20175
20176 @node Debug Session
20177 @subsection Putting it All Together
20178
20179 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20180 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20181 steps.
20182
20183 @enumerate
20184 @item
20185 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20186 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20187 @display
20188 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20189 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20190 @end display
20191
20192 @item
20193 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20194 procedure is called:
20195
20196 @smallexample
20197 set_debug_traps();
20198 breakpoint();
20199 @end smallexample
20200
20201 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20202 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20203 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20204 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20205 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20206 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20207 progress.
20208
20209 @item
20210 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20211 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20212
20213 @smallexample
20214 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20215 @end smallexample
20216
20217 @noindent
20218 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20219 function in your program, that function is called when
20220 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20221 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20222 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20223
20224 @item
20225 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20226 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20227
20228 @item
20229 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20230 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20231
20232 @item
20233 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20234 @c document that. FIXME.
20235 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20236 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20237
20238 @item
20239 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20240 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20241
20242 @end enumerate
20243
20244 @node Configurations
20245 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20246
20247 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20248 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20249 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20250
20251 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20252 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20253 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20254 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20255 are quite different from each other.
20256
20257 @menu
20258 * Native::
20259 * Embedded OS::
20260 * Embedded Processors::
20261 * Architectures::
20262 @end menu
20263
20264 @node Native
20265 @section Native
20266
20267 This section describes details specific to particular native
20268 configurations.
20269
20270 @menu
20271 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20272 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20273 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20274 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20275 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20276 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20277 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20278 @end menu
20279
20280 @node HP-UX
20281 @subsection HP-UX
20282
20283 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20284 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20285 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20286
20287
20288 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20289 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20290
20291 @cindex libkvm
20292 @cindex kernel memory image
20293 @cindex kernel crash dump
20294
20295 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20296 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20297 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20298 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20299 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20300 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20301 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20302 @code{kvm} target:
20303
20304 @smallexample
20305 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20306 @end smallexample
20307
20308 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20309 argument:
20310
20311 @smallexample
20312 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20313 @end smallexample
20314
20315 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20316 available:
20317
20318 @table @code
20319 @kindex kvm
20320 @item kvm pcb
20321 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20322
20323 @item kvm proc
20324 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20325 modern FreeBSD systems.
20326 @end table
20327
20328 @node SVR4 Process Information
20329 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20330 @cindex /proc
20331 @cindex examine process image
20332 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20333
20334 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20335 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20336 process using file-system subroutines.
20337
20338 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20339 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20340 information about the process running your program, or about any
20341 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20342 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20343
20344 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20345 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20346
20347 @table @code
20348 @kindex info proc
20349 @cindex process ID
20350 @item info proc
20351 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20352 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20353 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20354 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20355 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20356 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20357 executable file's absolute file name.
20358
20359 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20360 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20361 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20362 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20363 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20364 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20365
20366 @item info proc cmdline
20367 @cindex info proc cmdline
20368 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20369 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20370
20371 @item info proc cwd
20372 @cindex info proc cwd
20373 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20374 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20375
20376 @item info proc exe
20377 @cindex info proc exe
20378 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20379 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20380
20381 @item info proc mappings
20382 @cindex memory address space mappings
20383 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20384 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20385 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20386 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20387 memory access rights to that range.
20388
20389 @item info proc stat
20390 @itemx info proc status
20391 @cindex process detailed status information
20392 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20393 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20394 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20395 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20396 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20397 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20398 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20399
20400 @item info proc all
20401 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20402 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20403
20404 @ignore
20405 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20406 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20407 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20408 @kindex info proc times
20409 @item info proc times
20410 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20411 its children.
20412
20413 @kindex info proc id
20414 @item info proc id
20415 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20416 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20417 @end ignore
20418
20419 @item set procfs-trace
20420 @kindex set procfs-trace
20421 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20422 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20423
20424 @item show procfs-trace
20425 @kindex show procfs-trace
20426 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20427
20428 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20429 @kindex set procfs-file
20430 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20431 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20432 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20433 standard output.
20434
20435 @item show procfs-file
20436 @kindex show procfs-file
20437 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20438
20439 @item proc-trace-entry
20440 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20441 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20442 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20443 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20444 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20445 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20446 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20447 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20448 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20449
20450 @item info pidlist
20451 @kindex info pidlist
20452 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20453 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20454 processes and all the threads within each process.
20455
20456 @item info meminfo
20457 @kindex info meminfo
20458 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20459 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20460 @end table
20461
20462 @node DJGPP Native
20463 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20464 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20465 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20466 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20467
20468 @cindex DPMI
20469 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20470 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20471 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20472 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20473
20474 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20475 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20476 subsection describes those commands.
20477
20478 @table @code
20479 @kindex info dos
20480 @item info dos
20481 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20482 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20483
20484 @kindex sysinfo
20485 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20486 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20487 @item info dos sysinfo
20488 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20489 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20490 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20491
20492 @cindex GDT
20493 @cindex LDT
20494 @cindex IDT
20495 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20496 @cindex descriptor tables display
20497 @item info dos gdt
20498 @itemx info dos ldt
20499 @itemx info dos idt
20500 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20501 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20502 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20503 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20504 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20505 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20506 rights.
20507
20508 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20509 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20510 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20511 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20512 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20513
20514 @cindex garbled pointers
20515 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20516 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20517 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20518 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20519 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20520 debugged program's data segment:
20521
20522 @smallexample
20523 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20524 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20525 @end smallexample
20526
20527 @noindent
20528 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20529 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20530
20531 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20532 @item info dos pde
20533 @itemx info dos pte
20534 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20535 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20536 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20537 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20538 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20539 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20540 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20541 that is currently in use.
20542
20543 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20544 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20545 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20546 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20547 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20548 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20549 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20550
20551 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20552 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20553 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20554 controller.
20555
20556 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20557
20558 @cindex physical address from linear address
20559 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20560 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20561 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20562 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20563 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20564 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20565 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20566
20567 @smallexample
20568 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20569 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20570 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20571 @end smallexample
20572
20573 @noindent
20574 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20575 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20576 attributes of that page.
20577
20578 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20579 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20580 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20581 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20582 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20583 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20584
20585 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20586 transfer buffer:
20587
20588 @smallexample
20589 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20590 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20591 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20592 @end smallexample
20593
20594 @noindent
20595 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20596 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20597 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20598 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20599 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20600
20601 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20602 @end table
20603
20604 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20605 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20606 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20607 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20608
20609 @table @code
20610 @kindex set com1base
20611 @kindex set com1irq
20612 @kindex set com2base
20613 @kindex set com2irq
20614 @kindex set com3base
20615 @kindex set com3irq
20616 @kindex set com4base
20617 @kindex set com4irq
20618 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20619 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20620 port.
20621
20622 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20623 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20624 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20625
20626 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20627 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20628 other 3 COM ports.
20629
20630 @kindex show com1base
20631 @kindex show com1irq
20632 @kindex show com2base
20633 @kindex show com2irq
20634 @kindex show com3base
20635 @kindex show com3irq
20636 @kindex show com4base
20637 @kindex show com4irq
20638 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20639 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20640 lines used by the COM ports.
20641
20642 @item info serial
20643 @kindex info serial
20644 @cindex DOS serial port status
20645 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20646 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20647 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20648 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20649 @end table
20650
20651
20652 @node Cygwin Native
20653 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20654 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20655 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20656 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20657
20658 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20659 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20660
20661 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20662 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20663 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20664 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20665 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20666 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20667 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20668 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20669
20670 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20671 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20672 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20673
20674 @table @code
20675 @kindex info w32
20676 @item info w32
20677 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20678 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20679
20680 @item info w32 selector
20681 This command displays information returned by
20682 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20683 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20684 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20685 Without argument, this command displays information
20686 about the six segment registers.
20687
20688 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20689 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20690 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20691 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20692
20693 @kindex info dll
20694 @item info dll
20695 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20696
20697 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20698 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20699 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20700 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20701 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20702 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20703 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20704 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20705 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20706 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20707 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20708
20709 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20710 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20711 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20712 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20713
20714 @kindex set new-console
20715 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20716 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20717 be started in a new console on next start.
20718 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20719 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20720
20721 @kindex show new-console
20722 @item show new-console
20723 Displays whether a new console is used
20724 when the debuggee is started.
20725
20726 @kindex set new-group
20727 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20728 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20729 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20730 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20731 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20732
20733 @kindex show new-group
20734 @item show new-group
20735 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20736
20737 @kindex set debugevents
20738 @item set debugevents
20739 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20740 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20741 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20742 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20743 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20744
20745 @kindex set debugexec
20746 @item set debugexec
20747 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20748 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20749
20750 @kindex set debugexceptions
20751 @item set debugexceptions
20752 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20753 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20754
20755 @kindex set debugmemory
20756 @item set debugmemory
20757 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20758 and writes by the debugger.
20759
20760 @kindex set shell
20761 @item set shell
20762 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20763 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20764
20765 @kindex show shell
20766 @item show shell
20767 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20768
20769 @end table
20770
20771 @menu
20772 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20773 @end menu
20774
20775 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20776 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20777 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20778 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20779
20780 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20781 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20782 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20783 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20784 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20785 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20786 ``minimal symbols''.
20787
20788 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20789 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20790 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20791 program run once to completion.
20792
20793 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20794
20795 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20796 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20797 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20798 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20799 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20800 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20801 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20802 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20803 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20804
20805 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20806 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20807 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20808 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20809 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20810 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20811
20812 @smallexample
20813 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20814 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20815
20816 Non-debugging symbols:
20817 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20818 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20819 @end smallexample
20820
20821 @smallexample
20822 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20823 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20824
20825 Non-debugging symbols:
20826 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20827 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20828 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20829 [etc...]
20830 @end smallexample
20831
20832 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20833
20834 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20835 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20836 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20837 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20838 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20839 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20840 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20841
20842 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20843 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20844 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20845 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20846 problem:
20847
20848 @smallexample
20849 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20850 $1 = 268572168
20851 @end smallexample
20852
20853 @smallexample
20854 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20855 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20856 @end smallexample
20857
20858 And two possible solutions:
20859
20860 @smallexample
20861 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20862 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20863 @end smallexample
20864
20865 @smallexample
20866 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20867 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20868 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20869 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20870 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20871 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20872 @end smallexample
20873
20874 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20875 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20876 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20877 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20878 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20879
20880 @smallexample
20881 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20882 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20886 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20887 safe.
20888
20889 @node Hurd Native
20890 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20891 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20892
20893 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20894 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20895
20896 @table @code
20897 @item set signals
20898 @itemx set sigs
20899 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20900 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20901 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20902 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20903 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20904 @code{signals}.
20905
20906 @item show signals
20907 @itemx show sigs
20908 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20909 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20910 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20911
20912 @item set signal-thread
20913 @itemx set sigthread
20914 @kindex set signal-thread
20915 @kindex set sigthread
20916 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20917 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20918 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20919 signal-thread}.
20920
20921 @item show signal-thread
20922 @itemx show sigthread
20923 @kindex show signal-thread
20924 @kindex show sigthread
20925 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20926 delivered a signal.
20927
20928 @item set stopped
20929 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20930 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20931 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20932 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20933
20934 @item show stopped
20935 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20936 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20937 stopped.
20938
20939 @item set exceptions
20940 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20941 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20942 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20943 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20944 trapping on.
20945
20946 @item show exceptions
20947 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20948 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20949
20950 @item set task pause
20951 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20952 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20953 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20954 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20955 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20956 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20957 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20958 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20959 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20960
20961 @item show task pause
20962 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20963 Show the current state of task suspension.
20964
20965 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20966 @cindex task suspend count
20967 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20968 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20969 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20970
20971 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20972 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20973
20974 @item set task exception-port
20975 @itemx set task excp
20976 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20977 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20978 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20979 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20980
20981 @item set noninvasive
20982 @cindex noninvasive task options
20983 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20984 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20985 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20986 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20987
20988 @item info send-rights
20989 @itemx info receive-rights
20990 @itemx info port-rights
20991 @itemx info port-sets
20992 @itemx info dead-names
20993 @itemx info ports
20994 @itemx info psets
20995 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20996 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20997 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20998 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20999 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21000 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21001 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21002 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21003 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21004
21005 @item set thread pause
21006 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21007 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21008 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21009 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21010 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21011 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21012 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21013 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21014 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21015 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21016 only the current thread.
21017
21018 @item show thread pause
21019 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21020 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21021
21022 @item set thread run
21023 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21024
21025 @item show thread run
21026 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21027
21028 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21029 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21030 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21031 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21032 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21033 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21034 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21035
21036 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21037 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21038 detaching.
21039
21040 @item set thread exception-port
21041 @itemx set thread excp
21042 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21043 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21044 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21045
21046 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21047 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21048 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21049 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21050
21051 @item set thread default
21052 @itemx show thread default
21053 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21054 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21055 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21056 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21057 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21058 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21059 the non-default commands.
21060 @end table
21061
21062 @node Darwin
21063 @subsection Darwin
21064 @cindex Darwin
21065
21066 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21067
21068 @table @code
21069 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21070 @kindex set debug darwin
21071 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21072 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21073
21074 @item show debug darwin
21075 @kindex show debug darwin
21076 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21077
21078 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21079 @kindex set debug mach-o
21080 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21081 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21082 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21083 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21084 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21085 usage.
21086
21087 @item show debug mach-o
21088 @kindex show debug mach-o
21089 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21090
21091 @item set mach-exceptions on
21092 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21093 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21094 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21095 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21096 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21097 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21098
21099 @item show mach-exceptions
21100 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21101 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21102 @end table
21103
21104
21105 @node Embedded OS
21106 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21107
21108 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21109 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21110 architectures.
21111
21112 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21113 various real-time operating systems.
21114
21115 @node Embedded Processors
21116 @section Embedded Processors
21117
21118 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21119 configurations.
21120
21121 @cindex send command to simulator
21122 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21123 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21124
21125 @table @code
21126 @item sim @var{command}
21127 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21128 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21129 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21130 acceptable commands.
21131 @end table
21132
21133
21134 @menu
21135 * ARM:: ARM RDI
21136 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
21137 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21138 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21139 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21140 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21141 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
21142 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
21143 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
21144 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
21145 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21146 * CRIS:: CRIS
21147 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21148 @end menu
21149
21150 @node ARM
21151 @subsection ARM
21152 @cindex ARM RDI
21153
21154 @table @code
21155 @kindex target rdi
21156 @item target rdi @var{dev}
21157 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
21158 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
21159 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
21160
21161 @kindex target rdp
21162 @item target rdp @var{dev}
21163 ARM Demon monitor.
21164
21165 @end table
21166
21167 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21168
21169 @table @code
21170 @item set arm disassembler
21171 @kindex set arm
21172 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21173 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21174
21175 @item show arm disassembler
21176 @kindex show arm
21177 Show the current disassembly style.
21178
21179 @item set arm apcs32
21180 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21181 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21182
21183 @item show arm apcs32
21184 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21185
21186 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21187 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21188 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21189
21190 @table @code
21191 @item auto
21192 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21193 @item softfpa
21194 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21195 processors.
21196 @item fpa
21197 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21198 @item softvfp
21199 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21200 @item vfp
21201 VFP co-processor.
21202 @end table
21203
21204 @item show arm fpu
21205 Show the current type of the FPU.
21206
21207 @item set arm abi
21208 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21209
21210 @item show arm abi
21211 Show the currently used ABI.
21212
21213 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21214 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21215 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21216 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21217 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21218 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21219 register).
21220
21221 @item show arm fallback-mode
21222 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21223
21224 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21225 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21226 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21227 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21228 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21229
21230 @item show arm force-mode
21231 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21232
21233 @item set debug arm
21234 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21235 target support subsystem.
21236
21237 @item show debug arm
21238 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21239 @end table
21240
21241 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21242 using the RDI interface:
21243
21244 @table @code
21245 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21246 @kindex rdilogfile
21247 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21248 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21249 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21250 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21251 @file{rdi.log}.
21252
21253 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21254 @kindex rdilogenable
21255 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21256 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21257 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21258 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21259 are logged to a file.
21260
21261 @item set rdiromatzero
21262 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21263 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21264 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21265 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21266 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21267 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21268
21269 @item show rdiromatzero
21270 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21271 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21272
21273 @item set rdiheartbeat
21274 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21275 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21276 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21277 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21278 well as the Angel monitor.
21279
21280 @item show rdiheartbeat
21281 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21282 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21283 @end table
21284
21285 @table @code
21286 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21287 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21288
21289 @table @code
21290 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21291 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21292 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21293 The default value is @code{all}.
21294
21295 @table @code
21296 @item none
21297 @item demon
21298 @item angel
21299 @item redboot
21300 @item all
21301 @end table
21302 @end table
21303 @end table
21304
21305 @node M32R/D
21306 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21307
21308 @table @code
21309 @kindex target m32r
21310 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21311 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21312
21313 @kindex target m32rsdi
21314 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21315 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21316 @end table
21317
21318 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21319
21320 @table @code
21321 @item set download-path @var{path}
21322 @kindex set download-path
21323 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21324 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21325
21326 @item show download-path
21327 @kindex show download-path
21328 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21329
21330 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21331 @kindex set board-address
21332 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21333 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21334
21335 @item show board-address
21336 @kindex show board-address
21337 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21338
21339 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21340 @kindex set server-address
21341 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21342 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21343 host machine.
21344
21345 @item show server-address
21346 @kindex show server-address
21347 Display the IP address of the download server.
21348
21349 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21350 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21351 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21352 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21353 executable file is uploaded.
21354
21355 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21356 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21357 Test the @code{upload} command.
21358 @end table
21359
21360 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21361
21362 @table @code
21363 @item sdireset
21364 @kindex sdireset
21365 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21366 This command resets the SDI connection.
21367
21368 @item sdistatus
21369 @kindex sdistatus
21370 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21371
21372 @item debug_chaos
21373 @kindex debug_chaos
21374 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21375 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21376
21377 @item use_debug_dma
21378 @kindex use_debug_dma
21379 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21380
21381 @item use_mon_code
21382 @kindex use_mon_code
21383 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21384
21385 @item use_ib_break
21386 @kindex use_ib_break
21387 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21388
21389 @item use_dbt_break
21390 @kindex use_dbt_break
21391 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21392 @end table
21393
21394 @node M68K
21395 @subsection M68k
21396
21397 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21398 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21399
21400 @table @code
21401
21402 @kindex target dbug
21403 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21404 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21405
21406 @end table
21407
21408 @node MicroBlaze
21409 @subsection MicroBlaze
21410 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21411 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21412
21413 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21414 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21415 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21416 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21417 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21418 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21419 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21420 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21421 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21422 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21423 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21424
21425 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21426
21427 @table @code
21428 @item target remote :1234
21429 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21430 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21431
21432 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21433 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21434 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21435
21436 @item load
21437 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21438
21439 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21440 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21441
21442 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21443 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21444 @end table
21445
21446 @node MIPS Embedded
21447 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21448
21449 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21450 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21451 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21452 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21453
21454 @need 1000
21455 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21456
21457 @table @code
21458 @item target mips @var{port}
21459 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21460 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21461 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21462 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21463 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21464 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21465 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21466
21467 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21468 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21469 debugger:
21470
21471 @smallexample
21472 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21473 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21474 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21475 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21476 (@value{GDBP}) run
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21480 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21481 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21482 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21483 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21484
21485 @item target pmon @var{port}
21486 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21487 PMON ROM monitor.
21488
21489 @item target ddb @var{port}
21490 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21491 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21492
21493 @item target lsi @var{port}
21494 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21495 LSI variant of PMON.
21496
21497 @kindex target r3900
21498 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21499 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21500
21501 @kindex target array
21502 @item target array @var{dev}
21503 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21504
21505 @end table
21506
21507
21508 @noindent
21509 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21510
21511 @table @code
21512 @item set mipsfpu double
21513 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21514 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21515 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21516 @itemx show mipsfpu
21517 @kindex set mipsfpu
21518 @kindex show mipsfpu
21519 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21520 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21521 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21522 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21523 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21524 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21525 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21526 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21527 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21528 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21529 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21530 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21531 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21532
21533 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21534 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21535 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21536
21537 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21538 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21539
21540 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21541 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21542 @itemx show timeout
21543 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21544 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21545 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21546 @kindex set timeout
21547 @kindex show timeout
21548 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21549 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21550 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21551 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21552 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21553 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21554 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21555 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21556 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21557 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21558
21559 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21560 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21561 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21562 to run before stopping.
21563
21564 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21565 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21566 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21567 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21568 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21569 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21570
21571 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21572 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21573 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21574 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21575
21576 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21577 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21578 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21579 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21580 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21581 @table @asis
21582 @item pmon target
21583 @samp{PMON}
21584 @item ddb target
21585 @samp{NEC010}
21586 @item lsi target
21587 @samp{PMON>}
21588 @end table
21589
21590 @item show monitor-prompt
21591 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21592 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21593 remote monitor.
21594
21595 @item set monitor-warnings
21596 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21597 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21598 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21599 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21600 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21601
21602 @item show monitor-warnings
21603 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21604 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21605
21606 @item pmon @var{command}
21607 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21608 @cindex send PMON command
21609 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21610 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21611 @end table
21612
21613 @node PowerPC Embedded
21614 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21615
21616 @cindex DVC register
21617 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21618 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21619
21620 @smallexample
21621 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21622 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21623 @end smallexample
21624
21625 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21626 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21627 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21628 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21629 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21630 or newer.
21631
21632 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21633 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21634 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21635 watching variables of scalar types.
21636
21637 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21638 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21639
21640 @smallexample
21641 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21642 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21643 @end smallexample
21644
21645 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21646 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21647
21648 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21649 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21650 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21651 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21652 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21653 use the @code{break-range} command.
21654
21655 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21656
21657 @table @code
21658 @kindex break-range
21659 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21660 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21661 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21662 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21663 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21664 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21665 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21666 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21667 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21668
21669 @kindex set powerpc
21670 @item set powerpc soft-float
21671 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21672 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21673 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21674 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21675
21676 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21677 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21678 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21679 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21680 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21681 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21682 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21683 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21684
21685 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21686 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21687 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21688 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21689 address of its first byte.
21690
21691 @kindex target dink32
21692 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21693 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21694
21695 @kindex target ppcbug
21696 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21697 @kindex target ppcbug1
21698 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21699 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21700
21701 @kindex target sds
21702 @item target sds @var{dev}
21703 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21704 @end table
21705
21706 @cindex SDS protocol
21707 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21708 by @value{GDBN}:
21709
21710 @table @code
21711 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21712 @kindex set sdstimeout
21713 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21714 default is 2 seconds.
21715
21716 @item show sdstimeout
21717 @kindex show sdstimeout
21718 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21719
21720 @item sds @var{command}
21721 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21722 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21723 @end table
21724
21725
21726 @node PA
21727 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21728
21729 @table @code
21730
21731 @kindex target op50n
21732 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21733 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21734
21735 @kindex target w89k
21736 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21737 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21738
21739 @end table
21740
21741 @node Sparclet
21742 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21743
21744 @cindex Sparclet
21745
21746 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21747 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21748 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21749 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21750 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21751
21752 @table @code
21753 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21754 @kindex remotetimeout
21755 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21756 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21757 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21758 @end table
21759
21760 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21761 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21762 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21763 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21764 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21765
21766 @smallexample
21767 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21768 @end smallexample
21769
21770 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21771
21772 @smallexample
21773 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21774 @end smallexample
21775
21776 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21777 Once you have set
21778 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21779 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21780 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21781
21782 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21783
21784 @smallexample
21785 (gdbslet)
21786 @end smallexample
21787
21788 @menu
21789 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21790 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21791 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21792 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21793 @end menu
21794
21795 @node Sparclet File
21796 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21797
21798 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21799
21800 @smallexample
21801 (gdbslet) file prog
21802 @end smallexample
21803
21804 @need 1000
21805 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21806 @value{GDBN} locates
21807 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21808 path.
21809 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21810 files will be searched as well.
21811 @value{GDBN} locates
21812 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21813 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21814 If it fails
21815 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21816
21817 @smallexample
21818 prog: No such file or directory.
21819 @end smallexample
21820
21821 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21822 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21823 @code{target} command again.
21824
21825 @node Sparclet Connection
21826 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21827
21828 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21829 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21830
21831 @smallexample
21832 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21833 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21834 main () at ../prog.c:3
21835 @end smallexample
21836
21837 @need 750
21838 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21839
21840 @smallexample
21841 Connected to ttya.
21842 @end smallexample
21843
21844 @node Sparclet Download
21845 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21846
21847 @cindex download to Sparclet
21848 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21849 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21850 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21851 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21852 command.
21853 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21854 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21855 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21856 of each of the file's sections.
21857 For instance, if the program
21858 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21859 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21860
21861 @smallexample
21862 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21863 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21864 @end smallexample
21865
21866 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21867 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21868 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21869
21870 @node Sparclet Execution
21871 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21872
21873 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21874 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21875 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21876 manual for the list of commands.
21877
21878 @smallexample
21879 (gdbslet) b main
21880 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21881 (gdbslet) run
21882 Starting program: prog
21883 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21884 3 char *symarg = 0;
21885 (gdbslet) step
21886 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21887 (gdbslet)
21888 @end smallexample
21889
21890 @node Sparclite
21891 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21892
21893 @table @code
21894
21895 @kindex target sparclite
21896 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21897 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21898 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21899 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21900 remote protocol.
21901
21902 @end table
21903
21904 @node Z8000
21905 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21906
21907 @cindex Z8000
21908 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21909 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21910
21911 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21912 a Z8000 simulator.
21913
21914 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21915 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21916 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21917 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21918
21919 @table @code
21920 @item target sim @var{args}
21921 @kindex sim
21922 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21923 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21924 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21925 @end table
21926
21927 @noindent
21928 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21929 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21930 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21931 to run your program, and so on.
21932
21933 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21934 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21935 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21936
21937 @table @code
21938
21939 @item cycles
21940 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21941
21942 @item insts
21943 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21944
21945 @item time
21946 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21947
21948 @end table
21949
21950 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21951 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21952 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21953 simulated clock ticks.
21954
21955 @node AVR
21956 @subsection Atmel AVR
21957 @cindex AVR
21958
21959 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21960 following AVR-specific commands:
21961
21962 @table @code
21963 @item info io_registers
21964 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21965 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21966 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21967 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21968 @end table
21969
21970 @node CRIS
21971 @subsection CRIS
21972 @cindex CRIS
21973
21974 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21975 following CRIS-specific commands:
21976
21977 @table @code
21978 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21979 @cindex CRIS version
21980 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21981 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21982 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21983
21984 @item show cris-version
21985 Show the current CRIS version.
21986
21987 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21988 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21989 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21990 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21991 @code{R59}.
21992
21993 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21994 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21995
21996 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21997 @cindex CRIS mode
21998 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21999 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22000 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22001
22002 @item show cris-mode
22003 Show the current CRIS mode.
22004 @end table
22005
22006 @node Super-H
22007 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22008 @cindex Super-H
22009
22010 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22011 commands:
22012
22013 @table @code
22014 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22015 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22016 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22017 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22018 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22019 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22020 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22021 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22022 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22023 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22024 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22025 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22026
22027 @item show sh calling-convention
22028 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22029 Show the current calling convention setting.
22030
22031 @end table
22032
22033
22034 @node Architectures
22035 @section Architectures
22036
22037 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22038 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22039
22040 @menu
22041 * AArch64::
22042 * i386::
22043 * Alpha::
22044 * MIPS::
22045 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22046 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22047 * PowerPC::
22048 * Nios II::
22049 @end menu
22050
22051 @node AArch64
22052 @subsection AArch64
22053 @cindex AArch64 support
22054
22055 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22056 following special commands:
22057
22058 @table @code
22059 @item set debug aarch64
22060 @kindex set debug aarch64
22061 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22062 messages are to be displayed.
22063
22064 @item show debug aarch64
22065 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22066
22067 @end table
22068
22069 @node i386
22070 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22071
22072 @table @code
22073 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22074 @kindex set struct-convention
22075 @cindex struct return convention
22076 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22077 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22078 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22079 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22080 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22081 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22082 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22083 be returned in a register.
22084
22085 @item show struct-convention
22086 @kindex show struct-convention
22087 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22088 from functions.
22089 @end table
22090
22091 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22092 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22093
22094 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22095 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22096 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22097 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22098 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22099 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22100 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22101
22102 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22103 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22104 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22105 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22106 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22107 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22108
22109 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22110 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22111 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22112
22113 @smallexample
22114 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22115 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22116 @end smallexample
22117
22118 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22119 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22120 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22121 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22122 the pointer.
22123
22124 @node Alpha
22125 @subsection Alpha
22126
22127 See the following section.
22128
22129 @node MIPS
22130 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22131
22132 @cindex stack on Alpha
22133 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22134 @cindex Alpha stack
22135 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22136 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22137 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22138 find the beginning of a function.
22139
22140 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22141 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22142 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22143 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22144 commands:
22145
22146 @table @code
22147 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22148 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22149 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22150 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22151 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22152 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22153 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22154 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22155
22156 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22157 Display the current limit.
22158 @end table
22159
22160 @noindent
22161 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22162 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22163
22164 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22165 programs:
22166
22167 @table @code
22168 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22169 @kindex set mips abi
22170 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22171 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22172 values of @var{arg} are:
22173
22174 @table @samp
22175 @item auto
22176 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22177 default).
22178 @item o32
22179 @item o64
22180 @item n32
22181 @item n64
22182 @item eabi32
22183 @item eabi64
22184 @end table
22185
22186 @item show mips abi
22187 @kindex show mips abi
22188 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22189
22190 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22191 @kindex set mips compression
22192 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22193 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22194 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22195 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22196 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22197 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22198 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22199 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22200 provided by the executable.
22201
22202 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22203 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22204 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22205 identified as such.
22206
22207 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22208 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22209 implicitly from an executable.
22210
22211 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22212 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22213 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22214 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22215 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22216
22217 @item show mips compression
22218 @kindex show mips compression
22219 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22220 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22221
22222 @item set mipsfpu
22223 @itemx show mipsfpu
22224 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22225
22226 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22227 @kindex set mips mask-address
22228 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22229 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22230 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22231 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22232 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22233
22234 @item show mips mask-address
22235 @kindex show mips mask-address
22236 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22237 not.
22238
22239 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22240 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22241 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22242 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22243 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22244 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22245
22246 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22247 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22248 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22249
22250 @item set debug mips
22251 @kindex set debug mips
22252 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22253 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22254
22255 @item show debug mips
22256 @kindex show debug mips
22257 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22258 @end table
22259
22260
22261 @node HPPA
22262 @subsection HPPA
22263 @cindex HPPA support
22264
22265 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22266 following special commands:
22267
22268 @table @code
22269 @item set debug hppa
22270 @kindex set debug hppa
22271 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22272 messages are to be displayed.
22273
22274 @item show debug hppa
22275 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22276
22277 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22278 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22279 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22280 given @var{address}.
22281
22282 @end table
22283
22284
22285 @node SPU
22286 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22287 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22288 @cindex SPU
22289
22290 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22291 it provides the following special commands:
22292
22293 @table @code
22294 @item info spu event
22295 @kindex info spu
22296 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22297 and pending event status.
22298
22299 @item info spu signal
22300 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22301 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22302 notification channels.
22303
22304 @item info spu mailbox
22305 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22306 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22307 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22308
22309 @item info spu dma
22310 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22311 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22312 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22313
22314 @item info spu proxydma
22315 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22316 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22317 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22318
22319 @end table
22320
22321 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22322 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22323 special commands:
22324
22325 @table @code
22326 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22327 @kindex set spu
22328 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22329 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22330 function. The default is @code{off}.
22331
22332 @item show spu stop-on-load
22333 @kindex show spu
22334 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22335
22336 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22337 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22338 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22339 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22340 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22341 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22342
22343 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22344 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22345
22346 @end table
22347
22348 @node PowerPC
22349 @subsection PowerPC
22350 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22351
22352 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22353 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22354 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22355 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22356 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22357
22358 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22359 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22360 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22361
22362 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22363 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22364
22365 @node Nios II
22366 @subsection Nios II
22367 @cindex Nios II architecture
22368
22369 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22370 it provides the following special commands:
22371
22372 @table @code
22373
22374 @item set debug nios2
22375 @kindex set debug nios2
22376 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22377 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22378
22379 @item show debug nios2
22380 @kindex show debug nios2
22381 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22382 @end table
22383
22384 @node Controlling GDB
22385 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22386
22387 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22388 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22389 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22390 described here.
22391
22392 @menu
22393 * Prompt:: Prompt
22394 * Editing:: Command editing
22395 * Command History:: Command history
22396 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22397 * Numbers:: Numbers
22398 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22399 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22400 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22401 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22402 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22403 @end menu
22404
22405 @node Prompt
22406 @section Prompt
22407
22408 @cindex prompt
22409
22410 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22411 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22412 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22413 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22414 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22415 which one you are talking to.
22416
22417 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22418 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22419 or a prompt that does not.
22420
22421 @table @code
22422 @kindex set prompt
22423 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22424 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22425
22426 @kindex show prompt
22427 @item show prompt
22428 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22429 @end table
22430
22431 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22432 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22433 are:
22434
22435 @table @code
22436 @kindex set extended-prompt
22437 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22438 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22439 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22440 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22441 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22442 is displayed.
22443
22444 For example:
22445
22446 @smallexample
22447 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22448 @end smallexample
22449
22450 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22451 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22452
22453 @kindex show extended-prompt
22454 @item show extended-prompt
22455 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22456 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22457 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22458 @end table
22459
22460 @node Editing
22461 @section Command Editing
22462 @cindex readline
22463 @cindex command line editing
22464
22465 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22466 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22467 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22468 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22469 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22470 debugging sessions.
22471
22472 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22473 command @code{set}.
22474
22475 @table @code
22476 @kindex set editing
22477 @cindex editing
22478 @item set editing
22479 @itemx set editing on
22480 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22481
22482 @item set editing off
22483 Disable command line editing.
22484
22485 @kindex show editing
22486 @item show editing
22487 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22488 @end table
22489
22490 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22491 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22492 @end ifset
22493 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22494 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22495 @end ifclear
22496 for more details about the Readline
22497 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22498 encouraged to read that chapter.
22499
22500 @node Command History
22501 @section Command History
22502 @cindex command history
22503
22504 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22505 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22506 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22507 history facility.
22508
22509 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22510 package, to provide the history facility.
22511 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22512 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22513 @end ifset
22514 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22515 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22516 @end ifclear
22517 for the detailed description of the History library.
22518
22519 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22520 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22521 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22522 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22523 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22524 pressed on a line by itself.
22525
22526 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22527 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22528 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22529 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22530
22531 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22532 history.
22533
22534 @table @code
22535 @cindex history substitution
22536 @cindex history file
22537 @kindex set history filename
22538 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22539 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22540 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22541 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22542 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22543 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22544 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22545 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22546 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22547 is not set.
22548
22549 @cindex save command history
22550 @kindex set history save
22551 @item set history save
22552 @itemx set history save on
22553 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22554 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22555
22556 @item set history save off
22557 Stop recording command history in a file.
22558
22559 @cindex history size
22560 @kindex set history size
22561 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22562 @item set history size @var{size}
22563 @itemx set history size unlimited
22564 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22565 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22566 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22567 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22568 history list is unlimited.
22569 @end table
22570
22571 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22572 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22573 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22574 @end ifset
22575 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22576 @xref{Event Designators},
22577 @end ifclear
22578 for more details.
22579
22580 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22581 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22582 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22583 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22584 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22585 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22586 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22587 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22588
22589 The commands to control history expansion are:
22590
22591 @table @code
22592 @item set history expansion on
22593 @itemx set history expansion
22594 @kindex set history expansion
22595 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22596
22597 @item set history expansion off
22598 Disable history expansion.
22599
22600 @c @group
22601 @kindex show history
22602 @item show history
22603 @itemx show history filename
22604 @itemx show history save
22605 @itemx show history size
22606 @itemx show history expansion
22607 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22608 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22609 @c @end group
22610 @end table
22611
22612 @table @code
22613 @kindex show commands
22614 @cindex show last commands
22615 @cindex display command history
22616 @item show commands
22617 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22618
22619 @item show commands @var{n}
22620 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22621
22622 @item show commands +
22623 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22624 @end table
22625
22626 @node Screen Size
22627 @section Screen Size
22628 @cindex size of screen
22629 @cindex screen size
22630 @cindex pagination
22631 @cindex page size
22632 @cindex pauses in output
22633
22634 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22635 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22636 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22637 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22638 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22639 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22640 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22641 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22642
22643 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22644 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22645 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22646 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22647 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22648 width} commands:
22649
22650 @table @code
22651 @kindex set height
22652 @kindex set width
22653 @kindex show width
22654 @kindex show height
22655 @item set height @var{lpp}
22656 @itemx set height unlimited
22657 @itemx show height
22658 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22659 @itemx set width unlimited
22660 @itemx show width
22661 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22662 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22663 commands display the current settings.
22664
22665 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22666 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22667 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22668 buffer.
22669
22670 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22671 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22672
22673 @item set pagination on
22674 @itemx set pagination off
22675 @kindex set pagination
22676 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22677 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22678 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22679 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22680
22681 @item show pagination
22682 @kindex show pagination
22683 Show the current pagination mode.
22684 @end table
22685
22686 @node Numbers
22687 @section Numbers
22688 @cindex number representation
22689 @cindex entering numbers
22690
22691 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22692 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22693 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22694 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22695 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22696 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22697 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22698 both input and output with the commands described below.
22699
22700 @table @code
22701 @kindex set input-radix
22702 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22703 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22704 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22705 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22706 example, any of
22707
22708 @smallexample
22709 set input-radix 012
22710 set input-radix 10.
22711 set input-radix 0xa
22712 @end smallexample
22713
22714 @noindent
22715 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22716 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22717 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22718 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22719 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22720 change the radix.
22721
22722 @kindex set output-radix
22723 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22724 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22725 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22726 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22727
22728 @kindex show input-radix
22729 @item show input-radix
22730 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22731
22732 @kindex show output-radix
22733 @item show output-radix
22734 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22735
22736 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22737 @itemx show radix
22738 @kindex set radix
22739 @kindex show radix
22740 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22741 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22742 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22743 default value of 10.
22744
22745 @end table
22746
22747 @node ABI
22748 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22749
22750 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22751 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22752 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22753 current ABI.
22754
22755 @cindex OS ABI
22756 @kindex set osabi
22757 @kindex show osabi
22758 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22759
22760 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22761 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22762 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22763 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22764 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22765 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22766 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22767 platform provides.
22768
22769 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22770 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22771 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22772 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22773
22774 @table @code
22775 @item show osabi
22776 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22777
22778 @item set osabi
22779 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22780
22781 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22782 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22783 @end table
22784
22785 @cindex float promotion
22786
22787 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22788 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22789 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22790 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22791 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22792 @code{double} and then passed.
22793
22794 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22795 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22796 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22797
22798 @table @code
22799 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22800 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22801 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22802 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22803 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22804
22805 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22806 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22807 functions.
22808
22809 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22810 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22811 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22812 @end table
22813
22814 @kindex set cp-abi
22815 @kindex show cp-abi
22816 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22817 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22818 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22819 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22820 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22821 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22822 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22823 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22824 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22825 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22826 ``auto''.
22827
22828 @table @code
22829 @item show cp-abi
22830 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22831
22832 @item set cp-abi
22833 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22834
22835 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22836 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22837 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22838 @end table
22839
22840 @node Auto-loading
22841 @section Automatically loading associated files
22842 @cindex auto-loading
22843
22844 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22845 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22846 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22847 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22848 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22849 sources).
22850
22851 @menu
22852 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22853 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22854
22855 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22856 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22857 @end menu
22858
22859 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22860 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22861 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22862
22863 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22864 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22865 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22866
22867 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22868 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22869
22870 @table @code
22871 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22872 @kindex set auto-load off
22873 @item set auto-load off
22874 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22875 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22876 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22877 @smallexample
22878 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22879 @end smallexample
22880
22881 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22882 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22883 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22884 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22885 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22886 @code{set auto-load no}.
22887
22888 @anchor{show auto-load}
22889 @kindex show auto-load
22890 @item show auto-load
22891 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22892 or disabled.
22893
22894 @smallexample
22895 (gdb) show auto-load
22896 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22897 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22898 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22899 is on.
22900 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22901 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22902 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22903 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22904 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22905 @end smallexample
22906
22907 @anchor{info auto-load}
22908 @kindex info auto-load
22909 @item info auto-load
22910 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22911 not.
22912
22913 @smallexample
22914 (gdb) info auto-load
22915 gdb-scripts:
22916 Loaded Script
22917 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22918 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22919 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22920 loaded.
22921 python-scripts:
22922 Loaded Script
22923 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22924 @end smallexample
22925 @end table
22926
22927 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22928
22929 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22930 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22931 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22932 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22933 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22934 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22935 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22936 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22937 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22938 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22939 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22940 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22941 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22942 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22943 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22944 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22945 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22946 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22947 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22948 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22949 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22950 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22951 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22952 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22953 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22954 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22955 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22956 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22957 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22958 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
22959 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
22960 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22961 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22962 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22963 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22964 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22965 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22966 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22967 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22968 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22969 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22970 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22971 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22972 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22973 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22974 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22975 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22976 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22977 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22978 @end multitable
22979
22980 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22981 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22982 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22983
22984 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22985 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22986 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22987
22988 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22989 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22990
22991 @table @code
22992 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22993 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22994 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22995 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22996 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22997
22998 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22999 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23000 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23001 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23002 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23003
23004 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23005 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23006 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23007 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23008 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23009 @end table
23010
23011 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23012 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23013 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23014
23015 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23016
23017 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23018 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23019
23020 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23021 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23022 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23023 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23024 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23025 library.
23026
23027 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23028 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23029
23030 @table @code
23031 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23032 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23033 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23034 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23035
23036 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23037 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23038 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23039 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23040 enabled or disabled.
23041
23042 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23043 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23044 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23045 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23046 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23047 @end table
23048
23049 @node Auto-loading safe path
23050 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23051 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23052
23053 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23054 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23055 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23056 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23057 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23058
23059 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23060 get loaded:
23061
23062 @smallexample
23063 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23064 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23065 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23066 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23067 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23068 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23069 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23070 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23071 @end smallexample
23072
23073 @noindent
23074 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23075 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23076
23077 @smallexample
23078 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23079 @end smallexample
23080
23081 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23082
23083 @table @code
23084 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23085 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23086 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23087 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23088 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23089 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23090 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23091 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23092 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23093 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23094
23095 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23096 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23097 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23098
23099 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23100 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23101 @item show auto-load safe-path
23102 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23103 scripts.
23104
23105 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23106 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23107 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23108 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23109 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23110 by the host platform path separator in use.
23111 @end table
23112
23113 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23114 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23115 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23116 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23117 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23118
23119 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23120 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23121 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23122 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23123 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23124 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23125 init file in the current directory
23126 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23127
23128 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23129 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23130
23131 @table @asis
23132 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23133 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23134 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23135 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23136
23137 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23138 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23139 @value{GDBN} session.
23140
23141 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23142 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23143 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23144 from trusted sources.
23145
23146 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23147 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23148 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23149 trusted sources.
23150 @end table
23151
23152 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23153 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23154
23155 @table @asis
23156 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23157 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23158
23159 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23160 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23161 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23162 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23163 @end table
23164
23165 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23166 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23167 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23168 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23169 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23170 recommended to be entered.
23171
23172 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23173 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23174 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23175
23176 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23177 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23178 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23179 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23180 be printed.
23181
23182 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23183 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23184 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23185
23186 @smallexample
23187 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23188 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23189 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23190 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23191 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23192 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23193 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23194 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23195 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23196 @end smallexample
23197
23198 @table @code
23199 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23200 @kindex set debug auto-load
23201 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23202 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23203
23204 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23205 @kindex show debug auto-load
23206 @item show debug auto-load
23207 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23208 on or off.
23209 @end table
23210
23211 @node Messages/Warnings
23212 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23213
23214 @cindex verbose operation
23215 @cindex optional warnings
23216 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23217 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23218 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23219 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23220
23221 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23222 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23223 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23224
23225 @table @code
23226 @kindex set verbose
23227 @item set verbose on
23228 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23229
23230 @item set verbose off
23231 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23232
23233 @kindex show verbose
23234 @item show verbose
23235 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23236 @end table
23237
23238 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23239 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23240 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23241 Symbol Files}).
23242
23243 @table @code
23244
23245 @kindex set complaints
23246 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23247 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23248 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23249 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23250 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23251
23252 @kindex show complaints
23253 @item show complaints
23254 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23255
23256 @end table
23257
23258 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23259 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23260 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23261 you try to run a program which is already running:
23262
23263 @smallexample
23264 (@value{GDBP}) run
23265 The program being debugged has been started already.
23266 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23267 @end smallexample
23268
23269 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23270 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23271
23272 @table @code
23273
23274 @kindex set confirm
23275 @cindex flinching
23276 @cindex confirmation
23277 @cindex stupid questions
23278 @item set confirm off
23279 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23280 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23281 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23282
23283 @item set confirm on
23284 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23285
23286 @kindex show confirm
23287 @item show confirm
23288 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23289
23290 @end table
23291
23292 @cindex command tracing
23293 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23294 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23295 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23296 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23297
23298 @table @code
23299 @kindex set trace-commands
23300 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23301 @item set trace-commands on
23302 Enable command tracing.
23303 @item set trace-commands off
23304 Disable command tracing.
23305 @item show trace-commands
23306 Display the current state of command tracing.
23307 @end table
23308
23309 @node Debugging Output
23310 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23311 @cindex optional debugging messages
23312
23313 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23314 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23315 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23316 section documents those commands.
23317
23318 @table @code
23319 @kindex set exec-done-display
23320 @item set exec-done-display
23321 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23322 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23323 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23324 @kindex show exec-done-display
23325 @item show exec-done-display
23326 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23327 notification.
23328 @kindex set debug
23329 @cindex ARM AArch64
23330 @item set debug aarch64
23331 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23332 The default is off.
23333 @kindex show debug
23334 @item show debug aarch64
23335 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23336 ARM AArch64.
23337 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23338 @cindex architecture debugging info
23339 @item set debug arch
23340 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23341 @item show debug arch
23342 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23343 @item set debug aix-solib
23344 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23345 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23346 support module. The default is off.
23347 @item show debug aix-thread
23348 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23349 @item set debug aix-thread
23350 @cindex AIX threads
23351 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23352 module.
23353 @item show debug aix-thread
23354 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23355 @item set debug check-physname
23356 @cindex physname
23357 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23358 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23359 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23360 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23361 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23362 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23363 @item show debug check-physname
23364 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23365 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23366 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23367 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23368 exported symbols. The default is off.
23369 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23370 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23371 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23372 @item set debug dwarf2-die
23373 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
23374 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
23375 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23376 A value of zero turns off the display.
23377 @item show debug dwarf2-die
23378 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
23379 @item set debug dwarf2-read
23380 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
23381 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23382 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23383 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23384 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23385 @item show debug dwarf2-read
23386 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
23387 @item set debug displaced
23388 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23389 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23390 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23391 @item show debug displaced
23392 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23393 related to displaced stepping.
23394 @item set debug event
23395 @cindex event debugging info
23396 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23397 default is off.
23398 @item show debug event
23399 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23400 info.
23401 @item set debug expression
23402 @cindex expression debugging info
23403 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23404 expression parsing. The default is off.
23405 @item show debug expression
23406 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23407 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23408 @item set debug frame
23409 @cindex frame debugging info
23410 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23411 default is off.
23412 @item show debug frame
23413 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23414 info.
23415 @item set debug gnu-nat
23416 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23417 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23418 @item show debug gnu-nat
23419 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23420 @item set debug infrun
23421 @cindex inferior debugging info
23422 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23423 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23424 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23425 @item show debug infrun
23426 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23427 @item set debug jit
23428 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23429 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23430 @item show debug jit
23431 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23432 @item set debug lin-lwp
23433 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23434 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23435 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23436 @item show debug lin-lwp
23437 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23438 @item set debug mach-o
23439 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23440 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23441 processing. The default is off.
23442 @item show debug mach-o
23443 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23444 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23445 @item set debug notification
23446 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23447 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23448 The default is off.
23449 @item show debug notification
23450 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23451 @item set debug observer
23452 @cindex observer debugging info
23453 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23454 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23455 @item show debug observer
23456 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23457 @item set debug overload
23458 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23459 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23460 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23461 is off.
23462 @item show debug overload
23463 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23464 debugging info.
23465 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23466 @cindex debug expression parser
23467 @item set debug parser
23468 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23469 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23470 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23471 details. The default is off.
23472 @item show debug parser
23473 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23474 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23475 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23476 @cindex debug remote protocol
23477 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23478 @cindex display remote packets
23479 @item set debug remote
23480 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23481 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23482 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23483 @item show debug remote
23484 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23485 @item set debug serial
23486 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23487 default is off.
23488 @item show debug serial
23489 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23490 info.
23491 @item set debug solib-frv
23492 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23493 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23494 @item show debug solib-frv
23495 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23496 messages.
23497 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23498 @cindex symbol lookup
23499 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23500 The default is 0 (off).
23501 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23502 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23503 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23504 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23505 @item set debug symfile
23506 @cindex symbol file functions
23507 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23508 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23509 @item show debug symfile
23510 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23511 @item set debug symtab-create
23512 @cindex symbol table creation
23513 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23514 The default is 0 (off).
23515 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23516 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23517 @item show debug symtab-create
23518 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23519 @item set debug target
23520 @cindex target debugging info
23521 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23522 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23523 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23524 value of large memory transfers.
23525 @item show debug target
23526 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23527 info.
23528 @item set debug timestamp
23529 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23530 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23531 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23532 message.
23533 @item show debug timestamp
23534 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23535 debugging info.
23536 @item set debug varobj
23537 @cindex variable object debugging info
23538 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23539 info. The default is off.
23540 @item show debug varobj
23541 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23542 debugging info.
23543 @item set debug xml
23544 @cindex XML parser debugging
23545 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23546 @item show debug xml
23547 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23548 @end table
23549
23550 @node Other Misc Settings
23551 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23552 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23553
23554 @table @code
23555 @kindex set interactive-mode
23556 @item set interactive-mode
23557 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23558 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23559 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23560 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23561 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23562 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23563 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23564 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23565
23566 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23567 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23568 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23569 inside a cygwin window.
23570
23571 @kindex show interactive-mode
23572 @item show interactive-mode
23573 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23574 @end table
23575
23576 @node Extending GDB
23577 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23578 @cindex extending GDB
23579
23580 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23581 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23582 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23583 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23584 being debugged.
23585
23586 @menu
23587 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23588 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23589 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23590 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23591 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23592 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23593 @end menu
23594
23595 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23596 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23597 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23598 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23599 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23600 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23601
23602 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23603 setting:
23604
23605 @table @code
23606 @kindex set script-extension
23607 @kindex show script-extension
23608 @item set script-extension off
23609 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23610
23611 @item set script-extension soft
23612 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23613 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23614 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23615 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23616
23617 @item set script-extension strict
23618 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23619 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23620 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23621
23622 @item show script-extension
23623 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23624
23625 @end table
23626
23627 @node Sequences
23628 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23629
23630 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23631 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23632 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23633 files.
23634
23635 @menu
23636 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23637 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23638 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23639 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23640 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23641 @end menu
23642
23643 @node Define
23644 @subsection User-defined Commands
23645
23646 @cindex user-defined command
23647 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23648 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23649 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23650 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23651 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23652 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23653
23654 @smallexample
23655 define adder
23656 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23657 end
23658 @end smallexample
23659
23660 @noindent
23661 To execute the command use:
23662
23663 @smallexample
23664 adder 1 2 3
23665 @end smallexample
23666
23667 @noindent
23668 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23669 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23670 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23671 functions calls.
23672
23673 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23674 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23675 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23676 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23677
23678 @smallexample
23679 define adder
23680 if $argc == 2
23681 print $arg0 + $arg1
23682 end
23683 if $argc == 3
23684 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23685 end
23686 end
23687 @end smallexample
23688
23689 @table @code
23690
23691 @kindex define
23692 @item define @var{commandname}
23693 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23694 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23695 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23696 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23697 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23698 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23699
23700 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23701 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23702 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23703
23704 @kindex document
23705 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23706 @item document @var{commandname}
23707 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23708 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23709 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23710 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23711 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23712 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23713
23714 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23715 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23716 does not change the documentation.
23717
23718 @kindex dont-repeat
23719 @cindex don't repeat command
23720 @item dont-repeat
23721 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23722 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23723 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23724
23725 @kindex help user-defined
23726 @item help user-defined
23727 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23728 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23729 included (if any).
23730
23731 @kindex show user
23732 @item show user
23733 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23734 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23735 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23736 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23737 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23738
23739 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23740 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23741 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23742 @item show max-user-call-depth
23743 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23744 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23745 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23746 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23747 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23748 @end table
23749
23750 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23751 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23752
23753 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23754 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23755 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23756
23757 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23758 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23759 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23760 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23761
23762 @node Hooks
23763 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23764 @cindex command hooks
23765 @cindex hooks, for commands
23766 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23767
23768 @kindex hook
23769 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23770 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23771 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23772 before that command.
23773
23774 @cindex hooks, post-command
23775 @kindex hookpost
23776 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23777 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23778 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23779 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23780 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23781
23782 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23783 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23784
23785 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23786 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23787
23788 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23789 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23790 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23791 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23792 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23793
23794 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23795 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23796 you could define:
23797
23798 @smallexample
23799 define hook-stop
23800 handle SIGALRM nopass
23801 end
23802
23803 define hook-run
23804 handle SIGALRM pass
23805 end
23806
23807 define hook-continue
23808 handle SIGALRM pass
23809 end
23810 @end smallexample
23811
23812 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23813 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23814 you could define:
23815
23816 @smallexample
23817 define hook-echo
23818 echo <<<---
23819 end
23820
23821 define hookpost-echo
23822 echo --->>>\n
23823 end
23824
23825 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23826 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23827 (@value{GDBP})
23828
23829 @end smallexample
23830
23831 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23832 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23833 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23834 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23835 @c or not?
23836 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23837 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23838 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23839
23840 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23841 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23842 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23843
23844 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23845 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23846
23847 @node Command Files
23848 @subsection Command Files
23849
23850 @cindex command files
23851 @cindex scripting commands
23852 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23853 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23854 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23855 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23856 terminal.
23857
23858 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23859 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23860 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23861 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23862 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23863
23864 @table @code
23865 @kindex source
23866 @cindex execute commands from a file
23867 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23868 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23869 @end table
23870
23871 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23872 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23873 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23874 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23875 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23876
23877 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23878 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23879 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23880 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23881 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23882 is not relevant to scripts.
23883
23884 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23885 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23886 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23887 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23888 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23889 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23890 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23891 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23892 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23893 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23894 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23895 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23896 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23897 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23898
23899 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23900 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23901 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23902
23903 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23904 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23905 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23906 when called from command files.
23907
23908 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23909 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23910 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23911 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23912 the next command.
23913
23914 @smallexample
23915 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23916 @end smallexample
23917
23918 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23919 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23920 would be directed to @file{log}.
23921
23922 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23923 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23924 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23925 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23926 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23927 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23928 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23929 conditionally, etc.
23930
23931 @table @code
23932 @kindex if
23933 @kindex else
23934 @item if
23935 @itemx else
23936 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23937 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23938 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23939 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23940 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23941 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23942 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23943
23944 @kindex while
23945 @item while
23946 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23947 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23948 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23949 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23950 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23951 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23952
23953 @kindex loop_break
23954 @item loop_break
23955 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23956 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23957 line.
23958
23959 @kindex loop_continue
23960 @item loop_continue
23961 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23962 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23963 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23964 the controlling expression.
23965
23966 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23967 @item end
23968 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23969 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23970 @end table
23971
23972
23973 @node Output
23974 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23975
23976 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23977 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23978 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23979 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23980 want.
23981
23982 @table @code
23983 @kindex echo
23984 @item echo @var{text}
23985 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23986 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23987 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23988 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23989 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23990 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23991 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23992 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23993 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23994 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23995 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23996
23997 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23998 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23999
24000 @smallexample
24001 echo This is some text\n\
24002 which is continued\n\
24003 onto several lines.\n
24004 @end smallexample
24005
24006 produces the same output as
24007
24008 @smallexample
24009 echo This is some text\n
24010 echo which is continued\n
24011 echo onto several lines.\n
24012 @end smallexample
24013
24014 @kindex output
24015 @item output @var{expression}
24016 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24017 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24018 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24019 on expressions.
24020
24021 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24022 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24023 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24024 Formats}, for more information.
24025
24026 @kindex printf
24027 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24028 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24029 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24030 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24031 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24032 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24033 executing the code below:
24034
24035 @smallexample
24036 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24037 @end smallexample
24038
24039 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24040 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24041 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24042 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24043 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24044 printed.
24045
24046 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24047
24048 @smallexample
24049 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24050 @end smallexample
24051
24052 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24053 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24054 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24055
24056 @itemize @bullet
24057 @item
24058 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24059
24060 @item
24061 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24062 width.
24063
24064 @item
24065 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24066 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24067
24068 @item
24069 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24070 supported.
24071
24072 @item
24073 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24074
24075 @item
24076 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24077 @end itemize
24078
24079 @noindent
24080 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24081 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24082 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24083 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24084
24085 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24086 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24087 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24088 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24089 supported.
24090
24091 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24092 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24093 together with a floating point specifier.
24094 letters:
24095
24096 @itemize @bullet
24097 @item
24098 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24099
24100 @item
24101 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24102
24103 @item
24104 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24105 @end itemize
24106
24107 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24108 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24109 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24110
24111 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24112 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24113
24114 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24115 @smallexample
24116 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24117 @end smallexample
24118
24119 @kindex eval
24120 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24121 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24122 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24123
24124 @end table
24125
24126 @node Auto-loading sequences
24127 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24128 @cindex native script auto-loading
24129
24130 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24131 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24132 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24133 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24134
24135 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24136 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24137
24138 @table @code
24139 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24140 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24141 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24142 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24143
24144 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24145 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24146 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24147 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24148 disabled.
24149
24150 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24151 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24152 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24153 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24154 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24155 auto-loaded.
24156 @end table
24157
24158 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24159 matching names are printed.
24160
24161 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24162 @include python.texi
24163
24164 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24165 @include guile.texi
24166
24167 @node Auto-loading extensions
24168 @section Auto-loading extensions
24169 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24170
24171 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24172 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24173 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24174 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24175 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24176
24177 @menu
24178 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24179 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24180 * Which flavor to choose?::
24181 @end menu
24182
24183 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24184 debugging commands and features.
24185
24186 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24187 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24188 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24189 for more information.
24190 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24191 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24192
24193 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24194 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24195
24196 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24197 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24198 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24199 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24200 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24201
24202 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24203 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24204 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24205 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24206
24207 @table @code
24208 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24209 GDB's own command language
24210 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24211 Python
24212 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24213 Guile
24214 @end table
24215
24216 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24217 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24218 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24219 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24220 script in the specified extension language.
24221
24222 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24223 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24224
24225 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24226 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24227
24228 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24229 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24230 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24231 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24232 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24233 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24234
24235 @table @code
24236 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24237 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24238 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24239 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24240 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24241 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24242
24243 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24244 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24245
24246 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24247 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24248 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24249 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24250
24251 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24252 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24253 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24254 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24255 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24256 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24257 platform.
24258
24259 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24260 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24261 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24262
24263 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24264 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24265 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24266 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24267
24268 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24269 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24270 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24271 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24272 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24273 @end table
24274
24275 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24276 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24277 @var{objfile} is opened.
24278 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24279 is evaluated more than once.
24280
24281 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24282 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24283 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24284
24285 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24286 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24287 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24288 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24289 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24290 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24291 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24292
24293 The following entries are supported:
24294
24295 @table @code
24296 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24297 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24298 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24299 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24300 @end table
24301
24302 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24303
24304 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24305 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24306 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24307 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24308 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24309
24310 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24311 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24312
24313 @example
24314 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24315 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24316 asm("\
24317 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24318 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24319 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24320 .popsection \n\
24321 ");
24322 @end example
24323
24324 @noindent
24325 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24326 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24327
24328 @example
24329 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24330 @end example
24331
24332 The script name may include directories if desired.
24333
24334 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24335 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24336
24337 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24338 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24339 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24340 will remove duplicates.
24341
24342 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24343
24344 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24345 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24346 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24347 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24348 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24349 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24350 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24351 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24352 on its name.
24353
24354 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24355 testsuite.
24356
24357 @example
24358 #include "symcat.h"
24359 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24360 asm(
24361 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24362 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24363 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24364 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24365 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24366 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24367 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24368 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24369 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24370 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24371 ".byte 0\n"
24372 ".popsection\n"
24373 );
24374 @end example
24375
24376 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24377 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24378 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24379 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24380
24381 @node Which flavor to choose?
24382 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24383
24384 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24385 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24386
24387 @noindent
24388 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24389
24390 @itemize @bullet
24391 @item
24392 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24393
24394 @item
24395 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24396
24397 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24398 in the source search path.
24399 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24400 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24401
24402 @item
24403 Doesn't require source code additions.
24404 @end itemize
24405
24406 @noindent
24407 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24408
24409 @itemize @bullet
24410 @item
24411 Works with static linking.
24412
24413 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24414 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24415 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24416 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24417 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24418
24419 @item
24420 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24421
24422 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24423 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24424
24425 @item
24426 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24427
24428 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24429 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24430 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24431 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24432 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24433 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24434 @end itemize
24435
24436 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24437 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24438
24439 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24440 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24441 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24442
24443 @subsection Python comes first
24444
24445 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24446 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24447 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24448 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24449 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24450 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24451 pretty-printed form of a value).
24452 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24453 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24454 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24455
24456 @node Aliases
24457 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24458 @cindex aliases for commands
24459
24460 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24461 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24462 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24463 that involves less typing.
24464
24465 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24466 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24467 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24468
24469 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24470 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24471 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24472
24473 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24474
24475 @table @code
24476
24477 @kindex alias
24478 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24479
24480 @end table
24481
24482 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24483 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24484 underscores.
24485
24486 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24487 that is being aliased.
24488
24489 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24490 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24491 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24492
24493 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24494 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24495
24496 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24497 of a command so that there is less to type.
24498 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24499 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24500 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24501 The following will accomplish this.
24502
24503 @smallexample
24504 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24505 @end smallexample
24506
24507 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24508 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24509 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24510 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24511
24512 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24513 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24514 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24515 of a command.
24516
24517 @smallexample
24518 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24519 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24520 (gdb) set p elms 20
24521 (gdb) show p elms
24522 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24523 @end smallexample
24524
24525 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24526 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24527 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24528
24529 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24530 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24531
24532 @smallexample
24533 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24534 @end smallexample
24535
24536 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24537 alias for a more complex command.
24538 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24539
24540 @smallexample
24541 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24542 (gdb) spe 20
24543 @end smallexample
24544
24545 @node Interpreters
24546 @chapter Command Interpreters
24547 @cindex command interpreters
24548
24549 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24550 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24551 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24552
24553 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24554 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24555 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24556 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24557
24558 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24559 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24560 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24561 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24562
24563 @table @code
24564 @item console
24565 @cindex console interpreter
24566 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24567 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24568 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24569
24570 @item mi
24571 @cindex mi interpreter
24572 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24573 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24574 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24575 Interface}.
24576
24577 @item mi2
24578 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24579 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24580
24581 @item mi1
24582 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24583 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24584
24585 @end table
24586
24587 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24588 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24589 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24590 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24591 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24592 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24593 the IDE inoperable!
24594
24595 @kindex interpreter-exec
24596 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24597 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24598 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24599 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24600
24601 @smallexample
24602 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24603 @end smallexample
24604
24605 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24606 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24607
24608 @node TUI
24609 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24610 @cindex TUI
24611 @cindex Text User Interface
24612
24613 @menu
24614 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24615 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24616 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24617 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24618 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24619 @end menu
24620
24621 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24622 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24623 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24624 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24625 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24626 is available.
24627
24628 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24629 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24630 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24631 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24632 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24633
24634 @node TUI Overview
24635 @section TUI Overview
24636
24637 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24638
24639 @table @emph
24640 @item command
24641 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24642 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24643 managed using readline.
24644
24645 @item source
24646 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24647 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24648
24649 @item assembly
24650 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24651
24652 @item register
24653 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24654 when their values change.
24655 @end table
24656
24657 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24658 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24659 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24660 indicates the breakpoint type:
24661
24662 @table @code
24663 @item B
24664 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24665
24666 @item b
24667 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24668
24669 @item H
24670 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24671
24672 @item h
24673 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24674 @end table
24675
24676 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24677
24678 @table @code
24679 @item +
24680 Breakpoint is enabled.
24681
24682 @item -
24683 Breakpoint is disabled.
24684 @end table
24685
24686 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24687 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24688 changes.
24689
24690 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24691 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24692 layouts:
24693
24694 @itemize @bullet
24695 @item
24696 source only,
24697
24698 @item
24699 assembly only,
24700
24701 @item
24702 source and assembly,
24703
24704 @item
24705 source and registers, or
24706
24707 @item
24708 assembly and registers.
24709 @end itemize
24710
24711 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24712
24713 @table @emph
24714 @item target
24715 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24716 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24717
24718 @item process
24719 Gives the current process or thread number.
24720 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24721
24722 @item function
24723 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24724 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24725 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24726 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24727
24728 @item line
24729 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24730 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24731
24732 @item pc
24733 Indicates the current program counter address.
24734 @end table
24735
24736 @node TUI Keys
24737 @section TUI Key Bindings
24738 @cindex TUI key bindings
24739
24740 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24741 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24742 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24743 @end ifset
24744 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24745 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24746 @end ifclear
24747 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24748 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24749
24750 @table @kbd
24751 @kindex C-x C-a
24752 @item C-x C-a
24753 @kindex C-x a
24754 @itemx C-x a
24755 @kindex C-x A
24756 @itemx C-x A
24757 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24758 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24759 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24760 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24761 The screen is then refreshed.
24762
24763 @kindex C-x 1
24764 @item C-x 1
24765 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24766 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24767 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24768
24769 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24770
24771 @kindex C-x 2
24772 @item C-x 2
24773 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24774 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24775 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24776 previous layout and the new one.
24777
24778 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24779
24780 @kindex C-x o
24781 @item C-x o
24782 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24783 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24784 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24785
24786 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24787
24788 @kindex C-x s
24789 @item C-x s
24790 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24791 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24792 @end table
24793
24794 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24795
24796 @table @asis
24797 @kindex PgUp
24798 @item @key{PgUp}
24799 Scroll the active window one page up.
24800
24801 @kindex PgDn
24802 @item @key{PgDn}
24803 Scroll the active window one page down.
24804
24805 @kindex Up
24806 @item @key{Up}
24807 Scroll the active window one line up.
24808
24809 @kindex Down
24810 @item @key{Down}
24811 Scroll the active window one line down.
24812
24813 @kindex Left
24814 @item @key{Left}
24815 Scroll the active window one column left.
24816
24817 @kindex Right
24818 @item @key{Right}
24819 Scroll the active window one column right.
24820
24821 @kindex C-L
24822 @item @kbd{C-L}
24823 Refresh the screen.
24824 @end table
24825
24826 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24827 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24828 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24829 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24830 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24831
24832 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24833 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24834 @cindex TUI single key mode
24835
24836 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24837 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24838 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24839
24840 @table @kbd
24841 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24842 @item c
24843 continue
24844
24845 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24846 @item d
24847 down
24848
24849 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24850 @item f
24851 finish
24852
24853 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24854 @item n
24855 next
24856
24857 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24858 @item q
24859 exit the SingleKey mode.
24860
24861 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24862 @item r
24863 run
24864
24865 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24866 @item s
24867 step
24868
24869 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24870 @item u
24871 up
24872
24873 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24874 @item v
24875 info locals
24876
24877 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24878 @item w
24879 where
24880 @end table
24881
24882 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24883 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24884 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24885 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24886 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24887 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24888
24889
24890 @node TUI Commands
24891 @section TUI-specific Commands
24892 @cindex TUI commands
24893
24894 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24895 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24896 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24897 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24898
24899 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24900 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24901 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24902 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24903 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24904
24905 @table @code
24906 @item info win
24907 @kindex info win
24908 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24909
24910 @item layout next
24911 @kindex layout
24912 Display the next layout.
24913
24914 @item layout prev
24915 Display the previous layout.
24916
24917 @item layout src
24918 Display the source window only.
24919
24920 @item layout asm
24921 Display the assembly window only.
24922
24923 @item layout split
24924 Display the source and assembly window.
24925
24926 @item layout regs
24927 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24928
24929 @item focus next
24930 @kindex focus
24931 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24932
24933 @item focus prev
24934 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24935
24936 @item focus src
24937 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24938
24939 @item focus asm
24940 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24941
24942 @item focus regs
24943 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24944
24945 @item focus cmd
24946 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24947
24948 @item refresh
24949 @kindex refresh
24950 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24951
24952 @item tui reg float
24953 @kindex tui reg
24954 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24955
24956 @item tui reg general
24957 Show the general registers in the register window.
24958
24959 @item tui reg next
24960 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24961 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24962 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24963 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24964
24965 @item tui reg system
24966 Show the system registers in the register window.
24967
24968 @item update
24969 @kindex update
24970 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24971
24972 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24973 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24974 @kindex winheight
24975 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24976 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24977 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
24978 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
24979 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
24980
24981 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24982 @kindex tabset
24983 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
24984 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
24985 assembly windows.
24986 @end table
24987
24988 @node TUI Configuration
24989 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24990 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24991
24992 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24993
24994 @table @code
24995 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24996 @kindex set tui border-kind
24997 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24998 The possible values are the following:
24999 @table @code
25000 @item space
25001 Use a space character to draw the border.
25002
25003 @item ascii
25004 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25005
25006 @item acs
25007 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25008 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25009 @end table
25010
25011 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25012 @kindex set tui border-mode
25013 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25014 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25015 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25016 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25017 @table @code
25018 @item normal
25019 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25020
25021 @item standout
25022 Use standout mode.
25023
25024 @item reverse
25025 Use reverse video mode.
25026
25027 @item half
25028 Use half bright mode.
25029
25030 @item half-standout
25031 Use half bright and standout mode.
25032
25033 @item bold
25034 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25035
25036 @item bold-standout
25037 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25038 @end table
25039 @end table
25040
25041 @node Emacs
25042 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25043
25044 @cindex Emacs
25045 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25046 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25047 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25048 @value{GDBN}.
25049
25050 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25051 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25052 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25053 created Emacs buffer.
25054 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25055
25056 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25057 things:
25058
25059 @itemize @bullet
25060 @item
25061 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25062 the GUD buffer.
25063
25064 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25065 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25066
25067 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25068 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25069 in this way.
25070
25071 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25072 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25073 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25074 stop.
25075
25076 @item
25077 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25078
25079 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25080 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25081 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25082 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25083 and the source.
25084
25085 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25086 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25087 @end itemize
25088
25089 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25090 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25091 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25092 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25093
25094 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25095 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25096 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25097 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25098 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25099 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25100 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25101 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25102 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25103
25104 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25105 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25106 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25107 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25108
25109 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25110 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25111 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25112 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25113 one you want.
25114
25115 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25116 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25117
25118 @table @kbd
25119 @item C-h m
25120 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25121
25122 @item C-c C-s
25123 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25124 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25125
25126 @item C-c C-n
25127 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25128 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25129 to show the current file and location.
25130
25131 @item C-c C-i
25132 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25133 display window accordingly.
25134
25135 @item C-c C-f
25136 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25137 @code{finish} command.
25138
25139 @item C-c C-r
25140 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25141 command.
25142
25143 @item C-c <
25144 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25145 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25146 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25147
25148 @item C-c >
25149 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25150 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25151 @end table
25152
25153 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25154 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25155
25156 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25157 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25158 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25159 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25160 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25161 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25162 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25163
25164 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25165 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25166 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25167 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25168 frame.
25169
25170 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25171 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25172 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25173 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25174 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25175 to correspond properly with the code.
25176
25177 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25178 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25179 Emacs Manual}).
25180
25181 @node GDB/MI
25182 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25183
25184 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25185
25186 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25187 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25188 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25189 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25190 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25191 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25192
25193 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25194 in the form of a reference manual.
25195
25196 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25197 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25198 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25199
25200 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25201
25202 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25203 This chapter uses the following notation:
25204
25205 @itemize @bullet
25206 @item
25207 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25208
25209 @item
25210 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25211 it may or may not be given.
25212
25213 @item
25214 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25215 may repeat zero or more times.
25216
25217 @item
25218 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25219 may repeat one or more times.
25220
25221 @item
25222 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25223 @end itemize
25224
25225 @ignore
25226 @heading Dependencies
25227 @end ignore
25228
25229 @menu
25230 * GDB/MI General Design::
25231 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25232 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25233 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25234 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25235 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25236 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25237 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25238 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25239 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25240 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25241 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25242 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25243 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25244 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25245 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25246 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25247 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25248 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25249 @ignore
25250 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25251 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25252 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25253 @end ignore
25254 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25255 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25256 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25257 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25258 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25259 @end menu
25260
25261 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25262 @node GDB/MI General Design
25263 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25264 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25265
25266 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25267 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25268 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25269 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25270 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25271 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25272 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25273 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25274 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25275 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25276
25277 The important examples of notifications are:
25278 @itemize @bullet
25279
25280 @item
25281 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25282 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25283 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25284 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25285 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25286 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25287 command itself was successfully executed.
25288
25289 @item
25290 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25291 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25292 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25293 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25294 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25295 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25296
25297 @item
25298 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25299 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25300 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25301 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25302 orthogonal frontend design.
25303
25304 @end itemize
25305
25306 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25307 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25308 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25309 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25310 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25311 the user interface.
25312
25313
25314 @menu
25315 * Context management::
25316 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25317 * Thread groups::
25318 @end menu
25319
25320 @node Context management
25321 @subsection Context management
25322
25323 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25324
25325 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25326 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25327 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25328 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25329 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25330 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25331 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25332 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25333 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25334
25335 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25336 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25337 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25338 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25339 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25340 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25341 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25342 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25343 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25344 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25345 for thread and frame to operate on.
25346
25347 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25348 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25349 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25350 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25351 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25352 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25353 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25354 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25355 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25356 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25357
25358 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25359 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25360 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25361 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25362 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25363 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25364 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25365 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25366 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25367 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25368 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25369 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25370 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25371 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25372 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25373 @samp{--frame} options.
25374
25375 @subsubsection Language
25376
25377 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25378 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25379 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25380 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25381 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25382 For instance:
25383
25384 @smallexample
25385 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25386 ^done,value="4"
25387 (gdb)
25388 @end smallexample
25389
25390 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25391 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25392 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25393
25394 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25395 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25396
25397 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25398 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25399 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25400 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25401 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25402 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25403 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25404 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25405 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25406
25407 @table @code
25408 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25409 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25410 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25411
25412 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25413 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25414 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25415
25416 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25417 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25418 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25419 MI commands even while the target is running.
25420
25421 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25422 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25423 @end table
25424
25425 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25426 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25427 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25428 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25429 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25430 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25431
25432 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25433 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25434 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25435 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25436 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25437 are running.
25438
25439 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25440 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25441 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25442 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25443 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25444 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25445 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25446 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25447 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25448 @samp{--thread} option).
25449
25450 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25451 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25452 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25453 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25454
25455 @node Thread groups
25456 @subsection Thread groups
25457 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25458 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25459 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25460 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25461 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25462
25463 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25464 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25465 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25466 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25467 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25468 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25469 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25470 into processes.
25471
25472 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25473 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25474 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25475 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25476 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25477 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25478 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25479 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25480 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25481 the members of specific thread group.
25482
25483 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25484 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25485 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25486 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25487 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25488 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25489 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25490 after attaching to that thread group.
25491
25492 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25493 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25494 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25495 such thread groups.
25496
25497 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25498 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25499 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25500
25501 @menu
25502 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25503 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25504 @end menu
25505
25506 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25507 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25508
25509 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25510 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25511 @table @code
25512 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25513 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25514
25515 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25516 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25517 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25518
25519 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25520 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25521 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25522
25523 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25524 "any sequence of digits"
25525
25526 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25527 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25528
25529 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25530 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25531
25532 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25533 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25534
25535 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25536 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25537 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25538
25539 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25540 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25541
25542 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25543 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25544 @end table
25545
25546 @noindent
25547 Notes:
25548
25549 @itemize @bullet
25550 @item
25551 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25552 output is described below.
25553
25554 @item
25555 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25556 finishes.
25557
25558 @item
25559 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25560 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25561 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25562 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25563 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25564 @end itemize
25565
25566 Pragmatics:
25567
25568 @itemize @bullet
25569 @item
25570 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25571
25572 @item
25573 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25574 @end itemize
25575
25576 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25577 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25578
25579 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25580 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25581 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25582 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25583 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25584 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25585
25586 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25587 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25588 @var{token}.
25589
25590 @table @code
25591 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25592 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25593
25594 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25595 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25596
25597 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25598 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25599
25600 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25601 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25602
25603 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25604 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25605
25606 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25607 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25608
25609 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25610 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25611
25612 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25613 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25614
25615 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25616 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25617
25618 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25619 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25620 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25621
25622 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25623 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25624
25625 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25626 @code{ @var{string} }
25627
25628 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25629 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25630
25631 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25632 @code{@var{c-string}}
25633
25634 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25635 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25636
25637 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25638 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25639 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25640
25641 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25642 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25643
25644 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25645 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25646
25647 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25648 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25649
25650 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25651 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25652
25653 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25654 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25655
25656 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25657 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25658 @end table
25659
25660 @noindent
25661 Notes:
25662
25663 @itemize @bullet
25664 @item
25665 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25666
25667 @item
25668 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25669 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25670 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25671 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25672 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25673 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25674 prior command.
25675
25676 @item
25677 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25678 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25679 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25680 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25681
25682 @item
25683 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25684 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25685 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25686 @samp{*}.
25687
25688 @item
25689 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25690 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25691 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25692 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25693
25694 @item
25695 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25696 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25697 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25698 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25699
25700 @item
25701 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25702 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25703 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25704
25705 @item
25706 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25707 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25708 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25709 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25710
25711 @item
25712 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25713 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25714 @var{values}.
25715
25716
25717 @end itemize
25718
25719 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25720 details about the various output records.
25721
25722 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25723 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25724 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25725
25726 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25727 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25728
25729 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25730 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25731 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25732 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25733 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25734 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25735
25736 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25737 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25738 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25739
25740 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25741 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25742 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25743 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25744
25745 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25746 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25747
25748 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25749 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25750 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25751 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25752 might change.
25753
25754 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25755 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25756 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25757 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25758
25759 @itemize @bullet
25760 @item
25761 New MI commands may be added.
25762
25763 @item
25764 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25765
25766 @item
25767 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25768 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25769
25770 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25771 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25772
25773 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25774 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25775 @end itemize
25776
25777 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25778 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25779 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25780 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25781 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25782
25783 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25784 @c version?
25785
25786 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25787 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25788 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25789 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25790 @cindex mailing lists
25791
25792 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25793 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25794 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25795
25796 @menu
25797 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25798 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25799 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25800 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25801 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25802 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25803 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25804 @end menu
25805
25806 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25807 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25808
25809 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25810 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25811 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25812 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25813
25814 @table @code
25815 @findex ^done
25816 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25817 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25818 values.
25819
25820 @item "^running"
25821 @findex ^running
25822 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25823 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25824 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25825 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25826 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25827 which threads are resumed.
25828
25829 @item "^connected"
25830 @findex ^connected
25831 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25832
25833 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25834 @findex ^error
25835 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25836 the corresponding error message.
25837
25838 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25839 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25840 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25841
25842 @table @samp
25843 @item "undefined-command"
25844 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25845 @end table
25846
25847 @item "^exit"
25848 @findex ^exit
25849 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25850
25851 @end table
25852
25853 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25854 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25855
25856 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25857 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25858 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25859 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25860 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25861
25862 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25863 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25864 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25865 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25866 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25867
25868 @table @code
25869 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25870 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25871 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25872
25873 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25874 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25875 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25876 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25877
25878 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25879 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25880 internals.
25881 @end table
25882
25883 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25884 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25885
25886 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25887 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25888 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25889 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25890 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25891 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25892
25893 The following is the list of possible async records:
25894
25895 @table @code
25896
25897 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25898 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25899 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25900 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25901 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25902 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25903 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25904 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25905 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25906 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25907
25908 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25909 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25910 following values:
25911
25912 @table @code
25913 @item breakpoint-hit
25914 A breakpoint was reached.
25915 @item watchpoint-trigger
25916 A watchpoint was triggered.
25917 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25918 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25919 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25920 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25921 @item function-finished
25922 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25923 @item location-reached
25924 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25925 @item watchpoint-scope
25926 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25927 @item end-stepping-range
25928 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25929 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25930 @item exited-signalled
25931 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25932 @item exited
25933 The inferior exited.
25934 @item exited-normally
25935 The inferior exited normally.
25936 @item signal-received
25937 A signal was received by the inferior.
25938 @item solib-event
25939 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25940 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25941 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25942 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25943 @item fork
25944 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25945 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25946 @item vfork
25947 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25948 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25949 @item syscall-entry
25950 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25951 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25952 @item syscall-return
25953 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25954 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25955 @item exec
25956 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25957 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25958 @end table
25959
25960 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25961 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25962 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25963 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25964 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25965 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25966 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25967 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25968 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25969 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25970 if such information is not available.
25971
25972 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25973 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25974 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25975 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25976 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25977 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25978 cannot be used in any way.
25979
25980 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25981 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25982 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25983 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25984 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25985 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25986
25987 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25988 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25989 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25990 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25991 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25992 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25993
25994 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25995 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25996 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25997 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25998 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25999
26000 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26001 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26002 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26003 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26004 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26005 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26006 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26007
26008 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26009 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26010 that thread.
26011
26012 @item =library-loaded,...
26013 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26014 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26015 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26016 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26017 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26018 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26019 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26020 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26021 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26022 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26023 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26024 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26025 thread groups.
26026
26027 @item =library-unloaded,...
26028 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26029 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26030 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26031 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26032 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26033 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26034 thread groups.
26035
26036 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26037 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26038 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26039 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26040 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26041
26042 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26043 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26044 initial value @var{initial}.
26045
26046 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26047 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26048 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26049 trace state variables are deleted.
26050
26051 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26052 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26053 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26054 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26055 value of trace state variable is known.
26056
26057 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26058 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26059 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26060 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26061 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26062 user.
26063
26064 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26065 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26066 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26067
26068 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26069 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26070
26071 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26072 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26073 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26074 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26075 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26076
26077 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26078 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26079 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26080 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26081 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26082 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26083
26084 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26085 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26086 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26087 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26088 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26089 executable code.
26090 @end table
26091
26092 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26093 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26094
26095 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26096 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26097 following fields:
26098
26099 @table @code
26100 @item number
26101 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26102 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26103 @samp{1.2}.
26104
26105 @item type
26106 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26107 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26108
26109 @item catch-type
26110 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26111 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26112
26113 @item disp
26114 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26115 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26116 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26117
26118 @item enabled
26119 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26120 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26121 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26122
26123 @item addr
26124 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26125 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26126 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26127 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26128 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26129
26130 @item func
26131 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26132 If not known, this field is not present.
26133
26134 @item filename
26135 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26136 If not known, this field is not present.
26137
26138 @item fullname
26139 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26140 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26141
26142 @item line
26143 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26144 If not known, this field is not present.
26145
26146 @item at
26147 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26148 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26149 by a symbol name.
26150
26151 @item pending
26152 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26153 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26154
26155 @item evaluated-by
26156 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26157 @samp{target}.
26158
26159 @item thread
26160 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26161 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26162
26163 @item task
26164 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26165 field will hold the task identifier.
26166
26167 @item cond
26168 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26169
26170 @item ignore
26171 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26172
26173 @item enable
26174 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26175
26176 @item traceframe-usage
26177 FIXME.
26178
26179 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26180 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26181
26182 @item mask
26183 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26184
26185 @item pass
26186 A tracepoint's pass count.
26187
26188 @item original-location
26189 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26190 This field is optional.
26191
26192 @item times
26193 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26194
26195 @item installed
26196 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26197 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26198 is not.
26199
26200 @item what
26201 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26202
26203 @end table
26204
26205 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26206 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26207
26208 @smallexample
26209 -> -break-insert main
26210 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26211 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26212 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26213 times="0"@}
26214 <- (gdb)
26215 @end smallexample
26216
26217 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26218 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26219
26220 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26221 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26222 fields:
26223
26224 @table @code
26225 @item level
26226 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26227 zero. This field is always present.
26228
26229 @item func
26230 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26231 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26232
26233 @item addr
26234 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26235
26236 @item file
26237 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26238 address. This field may be absent.
26239
26240 @item line
26241 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26242 may be absent.
26243
26244 @item from
26245 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26246 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26247
26248 @end table
26249
26250 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26251 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26252
26253 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26254 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26255
26256 @table @code
26257 @item id
26258 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26259 always present.
26260
26261 @item target-id
26262 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26263
26264 @item details
26265 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26266 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26267 frontend. This field is optional.
26268
26269 @item state
26270 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26271 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26272
26273 @item core
26274 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26275 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26276 @end table
26277
26278 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26279 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26280
26281 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26282 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26283 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26284 the @code{exception-name} field.
26285
26286 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26287 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26288 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26289 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26290
26291 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26292 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26293 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26294 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26295
26296 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26297 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26298
26299 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26300
26301 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26302 information of the breakpoint.
26303
26304 @smallexample
26305 -> -break-insert main
26306 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26307 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26308 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26309 times="0"@}
26310 <- (gdb)
26311 @end smallexample
26312
26313 @subheading Program Execution
26314
26315 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26316 reason that execution stopped.
26317
26318 @smallexample
26319 -> -exec-run
26320 <- ^running
26321 <- (gdb)
26322 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26323 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26324 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26325 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26326 <- (gdb)
26327 -> -exec-continue
26328 <- ^running
26329 <- (gdb)
26330 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26331 <- (gdb)
26332 @end smallexample
26333
26334 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26335
26336 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26337
26338 @smallexample
26339 -> (gdb)
26340 <- -gdb-exit
26341 <- ^exit
26342 @end smallexample
26343
26344 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26345 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26346 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26347 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26348 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26349 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26350
26351 @subheading A Bad Command
26352
26353 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26354
26355 @smallexample
26356 -> -rubbish
26357 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26358 <- (gdb)
26359 @end smallexample
26360
26361
26362 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26363 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26364 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26365
26366 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26367 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26368
26369 @subheading Motivation
26370
26371 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26372
26373 @subheading Introduction
26374
26375 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26376
26377 @subheading Commands
26378
26379 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26380
26381 @subsubheading Synopsis
26382
26383 @smallexample
26384 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26385 @end smallexample
26386
26387 @subsubheading Result
26388
26389 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26390
26391 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26392
26393 @subsubheading Example
26394
26395 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26396 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26397
26398
26399 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26400 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26401 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26402
26403 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26404 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26405 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26406 breakpoints.
26407
26408 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26409 @findex -break-after
26410
26411 @subsubheading Synopsis
26412
26413 @smallexample
26414 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26415 @end smallexample
26416
26417 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26418 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26419 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26420 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26421
26422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26423
26424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26425
26426 @subsubheading Example
26427
26428 @smallexample
26429 (gdb)
26430 -break-insert main
26431 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26432 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26433 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26434 times="0"@}
26435 (gdb)
26436 -break-after 1 3
26437 ~
26438 ^done
26439 (gdb)
26440 -break-list
26441 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26442 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26443 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26444 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26445 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26446 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26447 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26448 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26449 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26450 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26451 (gdb)
26452 @end smallexample
26453
26454 @ignore
26455 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26456 @findex -break-catch
26457 @end ignore
26458
26459 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26460 @findex -break-commands
26461
26462 @subsubheading Synopsis
26463
26464 @smallexample
26465 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26466 @end smallexample
26467
26468 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26469 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26470 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26471 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26472 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26473 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26474
26475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26476
26477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26478
26479 @subsubheading Example
26480
26481 @smallexample
26482 (gdb)
26483 -break-insert main
26484 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26485 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26486 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26487 times="0"@}
26488 (gdb)
26489 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26490 ^done
26491 (gdb)
26492 @end smallexample
26493
26494 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26495 @findex -break-condition
26496
26497 @subsubheading Synopsis
26498
26499 @smallexample
26500 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26501 @end smallexample
26502
26503 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26504 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26505 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26506 command below).
26507
26508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26509
26510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26511
26512 @subsubheading Example
26513
26514 @smallexample
26515 (gdb)
26516 -break-condition 1 1
26517 ^done
26518 (gdb)
26519 -break-list
26520 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26521 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26522 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26523 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26524 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26525 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26526 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26527 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26528 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26529 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26530 (gdb)
26531 @end smallexample
26532
26533 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26534 @findex -break-delete
26535
26536 @subsubheading Synopsis
26537
26538 @smallexample
26539 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26540 @end smallexample
26541
26542 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26543 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26544
26545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26546
26547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26548
26549 @subsubheading Example
26550
26551 @smallexample
26552 (gdb)
26553 -break-delete 1
26554 ^done
26555 (gdb)
26556 -break-list
26557 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26558 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26559 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26560 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26561 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26562 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26563 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26564 body=[]@}
26565 (gdb)
26566 @end smallexample
26567
26568 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26569 @findex -break-disable
26570
26571 @subsubheading Synopsis
26572
26573 @smallexample
26574 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26575 @end smallexample
26576
26577 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26578 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26579
26580 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26581
26582 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26583
26584 @subsubheading Example
26585
26586 @smallexample
26587 (gdb)
26588 -break-disable 2
26589 ^done
26590 (gdb)
26591 -break-list
26592 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26593 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26594 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26595 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26596 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26597 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26598 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26599 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26600 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26601 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26602 (gdb)
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26606 @findex -break-enable
26607
26608 @subsubheading Synopsis
26609
26610 @smallexample
26611 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26612 @end smallexample
26613
26614 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26615
26616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26617
26618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26619
26620 @subsubheading Example
26621
26622 @smallexample
26623 (gdb)
26624 -break-enable 2
26625 ^done
26626 (gdb)
26627 -break-list
26628 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26629 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26630 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26631 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26632 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26633 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26634 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26635 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26636 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26637 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26638 (gdb)
26639 @end smallexample
26640
26641 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26642 @findex -break-info
26643
26644 @subsubheading Synopsis
26645
26646 @smallexample
26647 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26648 @end smallexample
26649
26650 @c REDUNDANT???
26651 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26652
26653 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26654 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26655 table.
26656
26657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26658
26659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26660
26661 @subsubheading Example
26662 N.A.
26663
26664 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26665 @findex -break-insert
26666
26667 @subsubheading Synopsis
26668
26669 @smallexample
26670 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26671 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26672 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26673 @end smallexample
26674
26675 @noindent
26676 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26677
26678 @itemize @bullet
26679 @item function
26680 @c @item +offset
26681 @c @item -offset
26682 @c @item linenum
26683 @item filename:linenum
26684 @item filename:function
26685 @item *address
26686 @end itemize
26687
26688 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26689
26690 @table @samp
26691 @item -t
26692 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26693 @item -h
26694 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26695 @item -f
26696 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26697 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26698 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26699 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26700 cannot be parsed.
26701 @item -d
26702 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26703 @item -a
26704 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26705 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26706 @item -c @var{condition}
26707 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26708 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26709 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26710 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26711 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26712 @end table
26713
26714 @subsubheading Result
26715
26716 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26717 resulting breakpoint.
26718
26719 Note: this format is open to change.
26720 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26721
26722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26723
26724 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26725 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26726
26727 @subsubheading Example
26728
26729 @smallexample
26730 (gdb)
26731 -break-insert main
26732 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26733 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26734 times="0"@}
26735 (gdb)
26736 -break-insert -t foo
26737 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26738 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26739 times="0"@}
26740 (gdb)
26741 -break-list
26742 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26743 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26744 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26745 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26746 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26747 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26748 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26749 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26750 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26751 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26752 times="0"@},
26753 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26754 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26755 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26756 times="0"@}]@}
26757 (gdb)
26758 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26759 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26760 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26761 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26762 @c times="0"@}
26763 @c (gdb)
26764 @end smallexample
26765
26766 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26767 @findex -dprintf-insert
26768
26769 @subsubheading Synopsis
26770
26771 @smallexample
26772 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26773 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26774 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26775 [ @var{argument} ]
26776 @end smallexample
26777
26778 @noindent
26779 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26780
26781 @itemize @bullet
26782 @item @var{function}
26783 @c @item +offset
26784 @c @item -offset
26785 @c @item @var{linenum}
26786 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26787 @item @var{filename}:function
26788 @item *@var{address}
26789 @end itemize
26790
26791 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26792
26793 @table @samp
26794 @item -t
26795 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26796 @item -f
26797 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26798 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26799 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26800 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26801 cannot be parsed.
26802 @item -d
26803 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26804 @item -c @var{condition}
26805 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26806 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26807 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26808 to @var{ignore-count}.
26809 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26810 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26811 @end table
26812
26813 @subsubheading Result
26814
26815 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26816 resulting breakpoint.
26817
26818 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26819
26820 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26821
26822 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26823
26824 @subsubheading Example
26825
26826 @smallexample
26827 (gdb)
26828 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26829 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26830 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26831 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26832 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26833 original-location="foo"@}
26834 (gdb)
26835 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26836 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26837 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26838 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26839 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26840 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26841 (gdb)
26842 @end smallexample
26843
26844 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26845 @findex -break-list
26846
26847 @subsubheading Synopsis
26848
26849 @smallexample
26850 -break-list
26851 @end smallexample
26852
26853 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26854
26855 @table @samp
26856 @item Number
26857 number of the breakpoint
26858 @item Type
26859 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26860 @item Disposition
26861 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26862 or @samp{nokeep}
26863 @item Enabled
26864 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26865 @item Address
26866 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26867 @item What
26868 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26869 name, line number
26870 @item Thread-groups
26871 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26872 @item Times
26873 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26874 @end table
26875
26876 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26877 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26878
26879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26880
26881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26882
26883 @subsubheading Example
26884
26885 @smallexample
26886 (gdb)
26887 -break-list
26888 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26889 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26890 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26891 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26892 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26893 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26894 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26895 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26896 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26897 times="0"@},
26898 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26899 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26900 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26901 (gdb)
26902 @end smallexample
26903
26904 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26905
26906 @smallexample
26907 (gdb)
26908 -break-list
26909 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26910 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26911 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26912 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26913 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26914 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26915 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26916 body=[]@}
26917 (gdb)
26918 @end smallexample
26919
26920 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26921 @findex -break-passcount
26922
26923 @subsubheading Synopsis
26924
26925 @smallexample
26926 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26927 @end smallexample
26928
26929 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26930 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26931 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26932 command @samp{passcount}.
26933
26934 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26935 @findex -break-watch
26936
26937 @subsubheading Synopsis
26938
26939 @smallexample
26940 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26941 @end smallexample
26942
26943 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26944 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26945 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26946 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26947 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26948 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26949 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26950 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26951
26952 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26953 breakpoints inserted.
26954
26955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26956
26957 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26958 @samp{rwatch}.
26959
26960 @subsubheading Example
26961
26962 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26963
26964 @smallexample
26965 (gdb)
26966 -break-watch x
26967 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26968 (gdb)
26969 -exec-continue
26970 ^running
26971 (gdb)
26972 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26973 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26974 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26975 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26976 (gdb)
26977 @end smallexample
26978
26979 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26980 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26981 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26982
26983 @smallexample
26984 (gdb)
26985 -break-watch C
26986 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26987 (gdb)
26988 -exec-continue
26989 ^running
26990 (gdb)
26991 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26992 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26993 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26994 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26996 (gdb)
26997 -exec-continue
26998 ^running
26999 (gdb)
27000 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27001 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27002 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27003 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27004 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27005 (gdb)
27006 @end smallexample
27007
27008 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27009 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27010 deleted.
27011
27012 @smallexample
27013 (gdb)
27014 -break-watch C
27015 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27016 (gdb)
27017 -break-list
27018 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27019 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27020 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27021 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27022 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27023 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27024 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27025 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27026 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27027 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27028 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27029 times="1"@},
27030 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27031 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27032 (gdb)
27033 -exec-continue
27034 ^running
27035 (gdb)
27036 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27037 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27038 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27039 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27040 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27041 (gdb)
27042 -break-list
27043 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27044 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27045 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27046 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27047 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27048 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27049 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27050 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27051 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27052 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27053 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27054 times="1"@},
27055 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27056 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27057 (gdb)
27058 -exec-continue
27059 ^running
27060 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27061 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27062 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27063 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27064 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27065 (gdb)
27066 -break-list
27067 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27068 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27069 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27070 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27071 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27072 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27073 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27074 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27075 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27076 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27077 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27078 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27079 (gdb)
27080 @end smallexample
27081
27082
27083 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27084 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27085 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27086
27087 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27088 catchpoints.
27089
27090 @menu
27091 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27092 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27093 @end menu
27094
27095 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27096 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27097
27098 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27099 @findex -catch-load
27100
27101 @subsubheading Synopsis
27102
27103 @smallexample
27104 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27105 @end smallexample
27106
27107 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27108 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27109 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27110 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27111 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27112
27113
27114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27115
27116 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27117
27118 @subsubheading Example
27119
27120 @smallexample
27121 -catch-load -t foo.so
27122 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27123 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27124 (gdb)
27125 @end smallexample
27126
27127
27128 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27129 @findex -catch-unload
27130
27131 @subsubheading Synopsis
27132
27133 @smallexample
27134 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27135 @end smallexample
27136
27137 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27138 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27139 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27140 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27141 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27142
27143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27144
27145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27146
27147 @subsubheading Example
27148
27149 @smallexample
27150 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27151 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27152 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27153 (gdb)
27154 @end smallexample
27155
27156 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27157 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27158
27159 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27160 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27161
27162 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27163 @findex -catch-assert
27164
27165 @subsubheading Synopsis
27166
27167 @smallexample
27168 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27169 @end smallexample
27170
27171 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27172
27173 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27174
27175 @table @samp
27176 @item -c @var{condition}
27177 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27178 @item -d
27179 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27180 @item -t
27181 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27182 @end table
27183
27184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27185
27186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27187
27188 @subsubheading Example
27189
27190 @smallexample
27191 -catch-assert
27192 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27193 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27194 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27195 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27196 (gdb)
27197 @end smallexample
27198
27199 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27200 @findex -catch-exception
27201
27202 @subsubheading Synopsis
27203
27204 @smallexample
27205 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27206 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27207 @end smallexample
27208
27209 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27210 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27211 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27212 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27213 catchpoints.
27214
27215 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27216
27217 @table @samp
27218 @item -c @var{condition}
27219 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27220 @item -d
27221 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27222 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27223 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27224 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27225 @item -t
27226 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27227 @item -u
27228 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27229 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27230 @end table
27231
27232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27233
27234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27235 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27236
27237 @subsubheading Example
27238
27239 @smallexample
27240 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27241 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27242 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27243 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27244 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27245 (gdb)
27246 @end smallexample
27247
27248 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27249 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27250 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27251
27252 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27253 @findex -exec-arguments
27254
27255
27256 @subsubheading Synopsis
27257
27258 @smallexample
27259 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27260 @end smallexample
27261
27262 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27263 @samp{-exec-run}.
27264
27265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27266
27267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27268
27269 @subsubheading Example
27270
27271 @smallexample
27272 (gdb)
27273 -exec-arguments -v word
27274 ^done
27275 (gdb)
27276 @end smallexample
27277
27278
27279 @ignore
27280 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27281 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27282
27283 @subsubheading Synopsis
27284
27285 @smallexample
27286 -exec-show-arguments
27287 @end smallexample
27288
27289 Print the arguments of the program.
27290
27291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27292
27293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27294
27295 @subsubheading Example
27296 N.A.
27297 @end ignore
27298
27299
27300 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27301 @findex -environment-cd
27302
27303 @subsubheading Synopsis
27304
27305 @smallexample
27306 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27307 @end smallexample
27308
27309 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27310
27311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27312
27313 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27314
27315 @subsubheading Example
27316
27317 @smallexample
27318 (gdb)
27319 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27320 ^done
27321 (gdb)
27322 @end smallexample
27323
27324
27325 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27326 @findex -environment-directory
27327
27328 @subsubheading Synopsis
27329
27330 @smallexample
27331 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27332 @end smallexample
27333
27334 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27335 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27336 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27337 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27338 occurs as normal.
27339 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27340 multiple directories in a single command
27341 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27342 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27343 If blanks are needed as
27344 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27345 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27346 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27347 character must not be used
27348 in any directory name.
27349 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27350
27351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27352
27353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27354
27355 @subsubheading Example
27356
27357 @smallexample
27358 (gdb)
27359 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27360 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27361 (gdb)
27362 -environment-directory ""
27363 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27364 (gdb)
27365 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27366 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27367 (gdb)
27368 -environment-directory -r
27369 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27370 (gdb)
27371 @end smallexample
27372
27373
27374 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27375 @findex -environment-path
27376
27377 @subsubheading Synopsis
27378
27379 @smallexample
27380 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27381 @end smallexample
27382
27383 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27384 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27385 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27386 supplied in addition to the
27387 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27388 occurs as normal.
27389 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27390 multiple directories in a single command
27391 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27392 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27393 If blanks are needed as
27394 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27395 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27396 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27397 character must not be used
27398 in any directory name.
27399 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27400
27401
27402 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27403
27404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27405
27406 @subsubheading Example
27407
27408 @smallexample
27409 (gdb)
27410 -environment-path
27411 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27412 (gdb)
27413 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27414 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27415 (gdb)
27416 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27417 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27418 (gdb)
27419 @end smallexample
27420
27421
27422 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27423 @findex -environment-pwd
27424
27425 @subsubheading Synopsis
27426
27427 @smallexample
27428 -environment-pwd
27429 @end smallexample
27430
27431 Show the current working directory.
27432
27433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27434
27435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27436
27437 @subsubheading Example
27438
27439 @smallexample
27440 (gdb)
27441 -environment-pwd
27442 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27443 (gdb)
27444 @end smallexample
27445
27446 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27447 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27448 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27449
27450
27451 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27452 @findex -thread-info
27453
27454 @subsubheading Synopsis
27455
27456 @smallexample
27457 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27458 @end smallexample
27459
27460 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27461 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27462 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27463 also reports the current thread.
27464
27465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27466
27467 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27468 about all threads.
27469
27470 @subsubheading Result
27471
27472 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27473 defined for a given thread:
27474
27475 @table @samp
27476 @item current
27477 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27478
27479 @item id
27480 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27481
27482 @item target-id
27483 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27484
27485 @item details
27486 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27487 field is optional.
27488
27489 @item name
27490 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27491 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27492 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27493 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27494 field is omitted.
27495
27496 @item frame
27497 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27498
27499 @item state
27500 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27501 values:
27502
27503 @table @code
27504 @item stopped
27505 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27506 threads.
27507
27508 @item running
27509 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27510 threads.
27511
27512 @end table
27513
27514 @item core
27515 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27516 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27517
27518 @end table
27519
27520 @subsubheading Example
27521
27522 @smallexample
27523 -thread-info
27524 ^done,threads=[
27525 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27526 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27527 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27528 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27529 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27530 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27531 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27532 state="running"@}],
27533 current-thread-id="1"
27534 (gdb)
27535 @end smallexample
27536
27537 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27538 @findex -thread-list-ids
27539
27540 @subsubheading Synopsis
27541
27542 @smallexample
27543 -thread-list-ids
27544 @end smallexample
27545
27546 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27547 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27548
27549 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27550 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27551
27552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27553
27554 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27555
27556 @subsubheading Example
27557
27558 @smallexample
27559 (gdb)
27560 -thread-list-ids
27561 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27562 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27563 (gdb)
27564 @end smallexample
27565
27566
27567 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27568 @findex -thread-select
27569
27570 @subsubheading Synopsis
27571
27572 @smallexample
27573 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27574 @end smallexample
27575
27576 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27577 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27578
27579 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27580 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27581
27582 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27583
27584 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27585
27586 @subsubheading Example
27587
27588 @smallexample
27589 (gdb)
27590 -exec-next
27591 ^running
27592 (gdb)
27593 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27594 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27595 (gdb)
27596 -thread-list-ids
27597 ^done,
27598 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27599 number-of-threads="3"
27600 (gdb)
27601 -thread-select 3
27602 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27603 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27604 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27605 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27606 (gdb)
27607 @end smallexample
27608
27609 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27610 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27611 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27612
27613 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27614 @findex -ada-task-info
27615
27616 @subsubheading Synopsis
27617
27618 @smallexample
27619 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27620 @end smallexample
27621
27622 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27623 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27624
27625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27626
27627 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27628 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27629
27630 @subsubheading Result
27631
27632 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27633 defined for each Ada task:
27634
27635 @table @samp
27636 @item current
27637 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27638
27639 @item id
27640 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27641
27642 @item task-id
27643 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27644
27645 @item thread-id
27646 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27647
27648 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27649 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27650 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27651
27652 @item parent-id
27653 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27654 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27655
27656 @item priority
27657 The base priority of the task.
27658
27659 @item state
27660 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27661 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27662
27663 @item name
27664 The name of the task.
27665
27666 @end table
27667
27668 @subsubheading Example
27669
27670 @smallexample
27671 -ada-task-info
27672 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27673 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27674 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27675 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27676 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27677 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27678 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27679 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27680 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27681 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27682 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27683 (gdb)
27684 @end smallexample
27685
27686 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27687 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27688 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27689
27690 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27691 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27692 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27693 other cases.
27694
27695 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27696 @findex -exec-continue
27697
27698 @subsubheading Synopsis
27699
27700 @smallexample
27701 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27702 @end smallexample
27703
27704 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27705 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27706 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27707 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27708 @itemize @bullet
27709 @item
27710 breakpoints or watchpoints
27711 @item
27712 signals or exceptions
27713 @item
27714 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27715 @item
27716 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27717 @end itemize
27718 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27719 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27720 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27721 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27722 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27723 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27724
27725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27726
27727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27728
27729 @subsubheading Example
27730
27731 @smallexample
27732 -exec-continue
27733 ^running
27734 (gdb)
27735 @@Hello world
27736 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27737 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27738 line="13"@}
27739 (gdb)
27740 @end smallexample
27741
27742
27743 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27744 @findex -exec-finish
27745
27746 @subsubheading Synopsis
27747
27748 @smallexample
27749 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27750 @end smallexample
27751
27752 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27753 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27754 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27755 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27756 function was called.
27757
27758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27759
27760 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27761
27762 @subsubheading Example
27763
27764 Function returning @code{void}.
27765
27766 @smallexample
27767 -exec-finish
27768 ^running
27769 (gdb)
27770 @@hello from foo
27771 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27772 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27773 (gdb)
27774 @end smallexample
27775
27776 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27777 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27778 value itself.
27779
27780 @smallexample
27781 -exec-finish
27782 ^running
27783 (gdb)
27784 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27785 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27786 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27787 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27788 (gdb)
27789 @end smallexample
27790
27791
27792 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27793 @findex -exec-interrupt
27794
27795 @subsubheading Synopsis
27796
27797 @smallexample
27798 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27799 @end smallexample
27800
27801 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27802 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27803 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27804 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27805 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27806
27807 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27808 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27809 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27810 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27811
27812 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27813 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27814 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27815 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27816
27817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27818
27819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27820
27821 @subsubheading Example
27822
27823 @smallexample
27824 (gdb)
27825 111-exec-continue
27826 111^running
27827
27828 (gdb)
27829 222-exec-interrupt
27830 222^done
27831 (gdb)
27832 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27833 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27834 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27835 (gdb)
27836
27837 (gdb)
27838 -exec-interrupt
27839 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27840 (gdb)
27841 @end smallexample
27842
27843 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27844 @findex -exec-jump
27845
27846 @subsubheading Synopsis
27847
27848 @smallexample
27849 -exec-jump @var{location}
27850 @end smallexample
27851
27852 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27853 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27854 different forms of @var{location}.
27855
27856 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27857
27858 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27859
27860 @subsubheading Example
27861
27862 @smallexample
27863 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27864 *running,thread-id="all"
27865 ^running
27866 @end smallexample
27867
27868
27869 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27870 @findex -exec-next
27871
27872 @subsubheading Synopsis
27873
27874 @smallexample
27875 -exec-next [--reverse]
27876 @end smallexample
27877
27878 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27879 of the next source line is reached.
27880
27881 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27882 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27883 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27884 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27885 source line where the function was called.
27886
27887
27888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27889
27890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27891
27892 @subsubheading Example
27893
27894 @smallexample
27895 -exec-next
27896 ^running
27897 (gdb)
27898 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27899 (gdb)
27900 @end smallexample
27901
27902
27903 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27904 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27905
27906 @subsubheading Synopsis
27907
27908 @smallexample
27909 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27910 @end smallexample
27911
27912 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27913 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27914 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27915 printed as well.
27916
27917 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27918 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27919 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27920 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27921 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27922
27923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27924
27925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27926
27927 @subsubheading Example
27928
27929 @smallexample
27930 (gdb)
27931 -exec-next-instruction
27932 ^running
27933
27934 (gdb)
27935 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27936 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27937 (gdb)
27938 @end smallexample
27939
27940
27941 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27942 @findex -exec-return
27943
27944 @subsubheading Synopsis
27945
27946 @smallexample
27947 -exec-return
27948 @end smallexample
27949
27950 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27951 Displays the new current frame.
27952
27953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27954
27955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27956
27957 @subsubheading Example
27958
27959 @smallexample
27960 (gdb)
27961 200-break-insert callee4
27962 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27963 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27964 (gdb)
27965 000-exec-run
27966 000^running
27967 (gdb)
27968 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27969 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27970 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27971 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27972 (gdb)
27973 205-break-delete
27974 205^done
27975 (gdb)
27976 111-exec-return
27977 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27978 args=[@{name="strarg",
27979 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27980 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27981 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27982 (gdb)
27983 @end smallexample
27984
27985
27986 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27987 @findex -exec-run
27988
27989 @subsubheading Synopsis
27990
27991 @smallexample
27992 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27993 @end smallexample
27994
27995 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27996 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27997 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27998 the program has exited exceptionally.
27999
28000 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28001 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28002 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28003 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28004 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28005
28006 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28007 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28008 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28009 (@pxref{Starting}).
28010
28011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28012
28013 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28014
28015 @subsubheading Examples
28016
28017 @smallexample
28018 (gdb)
28019 -break-insert main
28020 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28021 (gdb)
28022 -exec-run
28023 ^running
28024 (gdb)
28025 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28026 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28027 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28028 (gdb)
28029 @end smallexample
28030
28031 @noindent
28032 Program exited normally:
28033
28034 @smallexample
28035 (gdb)
28036 -exec-run
28037 ^running
28038 (gdb)
28039 x = 55
28040 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28041 (gdb)
28042 @end smallexample
28043
28044 @noindent
28045 Program exited exceptionally:
28046
28047 @smallexample
28048 (gdb)
28049 -exec-run
28050 ^running
28051 (gdb)
28052 x = 55
28053 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28054 (gdb)
28055 @end smallexample
28056
28057 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28058 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28059
28060 @smallexample
28061 (gdb)
28062 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28063 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28064 @end smallexample
28065
28066
28067 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28068
28069
28070 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28071 @findex -exec-step
28072
28073 @subsubheading Synopsis
28074
28075 @smallexample
28076 -exec-step [--reverse]
28077 @end smallexample
28078
28079 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28080 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28081 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28082 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28083 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28084 previously executed source line.
28085
28086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28087
28088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28089
28090 @subsubheading Example
28091
28092 Stepping into a function:
28093
28094 @smallexample
28095 -exec-step
28096 ^running
28097 (gdb)
28098 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28099 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28100 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28101 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28102 (gdb)
28103 @end smallexample
28104
28105 Regular stepping:
28106
28107 @smallexample
28108 -exec-step
28109 ^running
28110 (gdb)
28111 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28112 (gdb)
28113 @end smallexample
28114
28115
28116 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28117 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28118
28119 @subsubheading Synopsis
28120
28121 @smallexample
28122 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28123 @end smallexample
28124
28125 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28126 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28127 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28128 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28129 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28130 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28131 as well.
28132
28133 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28134
28135 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28136
28137 @subsubheading Example
28138
28139 @smallexample
28140 (gdb)
28141 -exec-step-instruction
28142 ^running
28143
28144 (gdb)
28145 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28146 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28147 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28148 (gdb)
28149 -exec-step-instruction
28150 ^running
28151
28152 (gdb)
28153 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28154 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28155 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28156 (gdb)
28157 @end smallexample
28158
28159
28160 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28161 @findex -exec-until
28162
28163 @subsubheading Synopsis
28164
28165 @smallexample
28166 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28167 @end smallexample
28168
28169 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28170 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28171 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28172 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28173
28174 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28175
28176 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28177
28178 @subsubheading Example
28179
28180 @smallexample
28181 (gdb)
28182 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28183 ^running
28184 (gdb)
28185 x = 55
28186 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28187 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28188 (gdb)
28189 @end smallexample
28190
28191 @ignore
28192 @subheading -file-clear
28193 Is this going away????
28194 @end ignore
28195
28196 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28197 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28198 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28199
28200 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28201 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28202
28203 @smallexample
28204 -enable-frame-filters
28205 @end smallexample
28206
28207 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28208 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28209 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28210 request that this functionality be enabled.
28211
28212 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28213
28214 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28215 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28216
28217 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28218 @findex -stack-info-frame
28219
28220 @subsubheading Synopsis
28221
28222 @smallexample
28223 -stack-info-frame
28224 @end smallexample
28225
28226 Get info on the selected frame.
28227
28228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28229
28230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28231 (without arguments).
28232
28233 @subsubheading Example
28234
28235 @smallexample
28236 (gdb)
28237 -stack-info-frame
28238 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28239 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28240 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28241 (gdb)
28242 @end smallexample
28243
28244 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28245 @findex -stack-info-depth
28246
28247 @subsubheading Synopsis
28248
28249 @smallexample
28250 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28251 @end smallexample
28252
28253 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28254 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28255
28256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28257
28258 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28259
28260 @subsubheading Example
28261
28262 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28263
28264 @smallexample
28265 (gdb)
28266 -stack-info-depth
28267 ^done,depth="12"
28268 (gdb)
28269 -stack-info-depth 4
28270 ^done,depth="4"
28271 (gdb)
28272 -stack-info-depth 12
28273 ^done,depth="12"
28274 (gdb)
28275 -stack-info-depth 11
28276 ^done,depth="11"
28277 (gdb)
28278 -stack-info-depth 13
28279 ^done,depth="12"
28280 (gdb)
28281 @end smallexample
28282
28283 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28284 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28285 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28286
28287 @subsubheading Synopsis
28288
28289 @smallexample
28290 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28291 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28292 @end smallexample
28293
28294 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28295 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28296 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28297 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28298 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28299 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28300 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28301 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28302
28303 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28304 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28305 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28306 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28307 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28308 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28309
28310 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28311 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28312 are still displayed, however.
28313
28314 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28315 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28316
28317 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28318
28319 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28320 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28321 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28322
28323 @subsubheading Example
28324
28325 @smallexample
28326 (gdb)
28327 -stack-list-frames
28328 ^done,
28329 stack=[
28330 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28331 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28332 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28333 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28334 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28335 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28336 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28337 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28338 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28339 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28340 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28341 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28342 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28343 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28344 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28345 (gdb)
28346 -stack-list-arguments 0
28347 ^done,
28348 stack-args=[
28349 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28350 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28351 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28352 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28353 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28354 (gdb)
28355 -stack-list-arguments 1
28356 ^done,
28357 stack-args=[
28358 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28359 frame=@{level="1",
28360 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28361 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28362 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28363 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28364 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28365 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28366 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28367 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28368 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28369 (gdb)
28370 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28371 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28372 (gdb)
28373 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28374 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28375 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28376 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28377 (gdb)
28378 @end smallexample
28379
28380 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28381
28382
28383 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28384 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28385 @findex -stack-list-frames
28386
28387 @subsubheading Synopsis
28388
28389 @smallexample
28390 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28391 @end smallexample
28392
28393 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28394 following info:
28395
28396 @table @samp
28397 @item @var{level}
28398 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28399 @item @var{addr}
28400 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28401 @item @var{func}
28402 Function name.
28403 @item @var{file}
28404 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28405 @item @var{fullname}
28406 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28407 @item @var{line}
28408 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28409 @item @var{from}
28410 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28411 if the frame's function is not known.
28412 @end table
28413
28414 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28415 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28416 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28417 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28418 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28419 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28420 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28421 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28422 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28423
28424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28425
28426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28427
28428 @subsubheading Example
28429
28430 Full stack backtrace:
28431
28432 @smallexample
28433 (gdb)
28434 -stack-list-frames
28435 ^done,stack=
28436 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28437 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28438 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28439 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28440 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28441 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28442 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28443 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28444 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28445 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28446 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28447 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28448 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28449 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28450 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28451 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28452 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28453 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28454 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28455 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28456 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28457 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28458 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28460 (gdb)
28461 @end smallexample
28462
28463 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28464
28465 @smallexample
28466 (gdb)
28467 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28468 ^done,stack=
28469 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28470 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28471 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28472 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28473 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28474 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28475 (gdb)
28476 @end smallexample
28477
28478 Show a single frame:
28479
28480 @smallexample
28481 (gdb)
28482 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28483 ^done,stack=
28484 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28485 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28486 (gdb)
28487 @end smallexample
28488
28489
28490 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28491 @findex -stack-list-locals
28492 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28493
28494 @subsubheading Synopsis
28495
28496 @smallexample
28497 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28498 @end smallexample
28499
28500 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28501 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28502 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28503 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28504 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28505 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28506 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28507 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28508 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28509 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28510
28511 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28512 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28513 variables are still displayed, however.
28514
28515 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28516 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28517
28518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28519
28520 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28521
28522 @subsubheading Example
28523
28524 @smallexample
28525 (gdb)
28526 -stack-list-locals 0
28527 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28528 (gdb)
28529 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28530 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28531 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28532 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28533 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28534 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28535 (gdb)
28536 @end smallexample
28537
28538 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28539 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28540 @findex -stack-list-variables
28541
28542 @subsubheading Synopsis
28543
28544 @smallexample
28545 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28546 @end smallexample
28547
28548 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28549 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28550 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28551 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28552 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28553 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28554 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28555
28556 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28557 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28558 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28559
28560 @subsubheading Example
28561
28562 @smallexample
28563 (gdb)
28564 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28565 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28566 (gdb)
28567 @end smallexample
28568
28569
28570 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28571 @findex -stack-select-frame
28572
28573 @subsubheading Synopsis
28574
28575 @smallexample
28576 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28577 @end smallexample
28578
28579 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28580 the stack.
28581
28582 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28583 option to every command.
28584
28585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28586
28587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28588 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28589
28590 @subsubheading Example
28591
28592 @smallexample
28593 (gdb)
28594 -stack-select-frame 2
28595 ^done
28596 (gdb)
28597 @end smallexample
28598
28599 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28600 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28601 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28602
28603 @ignore
28604
28605 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28606
28607 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28608 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28609 used by @code{Insight}.
28610
28611 The two main reasons for that are:
28612
28613 @enumerate 1
28614 @item
28615 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28616
28617 @item
28618 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28619 now).
28620 @end enumerate
28621
28622 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28623 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28624 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28625 hints about their use.
28626
28627 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28628 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28629 least, the following operations:
28630
28631 @itemize @bullet
28632 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28633 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28634 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28635 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28636 @end itemize
28637
28638 @end ignore
28639
28640 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28641
28642 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28643
28644 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28645 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28646 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28647 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28648 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28649 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28650 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28651 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28652 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28653 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28654 object, or to change display format.
28655
28656 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28657 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28658 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28659 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28660 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28661 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28662 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28663 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28664 child will be created.
28665
28666 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28667 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28668 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28669 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28670 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28671
28672 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28673 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28674 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28675 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28676 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28677 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28678 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28679 variables that frontend has created.
28680
28681 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28682 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28683 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28684 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28685 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28686 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28687 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28688 implicitly updated.
28689
28690 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28691 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28692 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28693 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28694 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28695 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28696 frame. Consider this example:
28697
28698 @smallexample
28699 void do_work(...)
28700 @{
28701 struct work_state state;
28702
28703 if (...)
28704 do_work(...);
28705 @}
28706 @end smallexample
28707
28708 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28709 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28710 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28711 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28712 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28713
28714 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28715 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28716 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28717 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28718 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28719 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28720
28721 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28722 access this functionality:
28723
28724 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28725 @item @strong{Operation}
28726 @tab @strong{Description}
28727
28728 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28729 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28730 @item @code{-var-create}
28731 @tab create a variable object
28732 @item @code{-var-delete}
28733 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28734 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28735 @tab set the display format of this variable
28736 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28737 @tab show the display format of this variable
28738 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28739 @tab tells how many children this object has
28740 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28741 @tab return a list of the object's children
28742 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28743 @tab show the type of this variable object
28744 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28745 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28746 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28747 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28748 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28749 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28750 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28751 @tab get the value of this variable
28752 @item @code{-var-assign}
28753 @tab set the value of this variable
28754 @item @code{-var-update}
28755 @tab update the variable and its children
28756 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28757 @tab set frozeness attribute
28758 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28759 @tab set range of children to display on update
28760 @end multitable
28761
28762 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28763 how it can be used.
28764
28765 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28766
28767 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28768 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28769
28770 @smallexample
28771 -enable-pretty-printing
28772 @end smallexample
28773
28774 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28775 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28776 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28777 request that this functionality be enabled.
28778
28779 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28780
28781 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28782 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28783
28784 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28785 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28786
28787 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28788 @findex -var-create
28789
28790 @subsubheading Synopsis
28791
28792 @smallexample
28793 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28794 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28795 @end smallexample
28796
28797 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28798 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28799 register.
28800
28801 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28802 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28803 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28804 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28805 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28806
28807 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28808 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28809 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28810 object must be created.
28811
28812 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28813 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28814
28815 @itemize @bullet
28816 @item
28817 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28818
28819 @item
28820 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28821
28822 @item
28823 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28824 @end itemize
28825
28826 @cindex dynamic varobj
28827 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28828 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28829 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28830 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28831 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28832 compatibility for existing clients.
28833
28834 @subsubheading Result
28835
28836 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28837 are:
28838
28839 @table @samp
28840 @item name
28841 The name of the varobj.
28842
28843 @item numchild
28844 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28845 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28846 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28847
28848 @item value
28849 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28850 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28851 will not be interesting.
28852
28853 @item type
28854 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28855 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28856 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28857 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28858 @emph{declared} one.
28859
28860 @item thread-id
28861 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28862 thread's identifier.
28863
28864 @item has_more
28865 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28866 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28867
28868 @item dynamic
28869 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28870 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28871 then this attribute will not be present.
28872
28873 @item displayhint
28874 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28875 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28876 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28877 @end table
28878
28879 Typical output will look like this:
28880
28881 @smallexample
28882 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28883 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28884 @end smallexample
28885
28886
28887 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28888 @findex -var-delete
28889
28890 @subsubheading Synopsis
28891
28892 @smallexample
28893 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28894 @end smallexample
28895
28896 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28897 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28898
28899 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28900
28901
28902 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28903 @findex -var-set-format
28904
28905 @subsubheading Synopsis
28906
28907 @smallexample
28908 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28909 @end smallexample
28910
28911 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28912 @var{format-spec}.
28913
28914 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28915 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28916
28917 @smallexample
28918 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28919 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28920 @end smallexample
28921
28922 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28923 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28924 for pointers, etc.).
28925
28926 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28927 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28928
28929 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28930 @findex -var-show-format
28931
28932 @subsubheading Synopsis
28933
28934 @smallexample
28935 -var-show-format @var{name}
28936 @end smallexample
28937
28938 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28939
28940 @smallexample
28941 @var{format} @expansion{}
28942 @var{format-spec}
28943 @end smallexample
28944
28945
28946 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28947 @findex -var-info-num-children
28948
28949 @subsubheading Synopsis
28950
28951 @smallexample
28952 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28953 @end smallexample
28954
28955 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28956
28957 @smallexample
28958 numchild=@var{n}
28959 @end smallexample
28960
28961 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28962 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28963 be available.
28964
28965
28966 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28967 @findex -var-list-children
28968
28969 @subsubheading Synopsis
28970
28971 @smallexample
28972 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28973 @end smallexample
28974 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28975
28976 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28977 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28978 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28979 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28980 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28981 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28982 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28983 and unions.
28984
28985 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28986 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28987 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28988 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28989 reported.
28990
28991 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28992 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28993 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28994 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28995 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28996 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28997 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28998 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28999 the visible items.
29000
29001 For each child the following results are returned:
29002
29003 @table @var
29004
29005 @item name
29006 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29007
29008 @item exp
29009 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29010 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29011
29012 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29013 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29014
29015 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29016 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29017 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29018 type and value are not present.
29019
29020 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29021 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29022 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29023
29024 @item numchild
29025 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29026 0.
29027
29028 @item type
29029 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29030 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29031 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29032 @emph{declared} one.
29033
29034 @item value
29035 If values were requested, this is the value.
29036
29037 @item thread-id
29038 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29039 Otherwise this result is not present.
29040
29041 @item frozen
29042 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29043
29044 @item displayhint
29045 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29046 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29047 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29048
29049 @item dynamic
29050 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29051 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29052 then this attribute will not be present.
29053
29054 @end table
29055
29056 The result may have its own attributes:
29057
29058 @table @samp
29059 @item displayhint
29060 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29061 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29062 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29063
29064 @item has_more
29065 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29066 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29067 @end table
29068
29069 @subsubheading Example
29070
29071 @smallexample
29072 (gdb)
29073 -var-list-children n
29074 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29075 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29076 (gdb)
29077 -var-list-children --all-values n
29078 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29079 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29080 @end smallexample
29081
29082
29083 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29084 @findex -var-info-type
29085
29086 @subsubheading Synopsis
29087
29088 @smallexample
29089 -var-info-type @var{name}
29090 @end smallexample
29091
29092 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29093 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29094 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29095
29096 @smallexample
29097 type=@var{typename}
29098 @end smallexample
29099
29100
29101 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29102 @findex -var-info-expression
29103
29104 @subsubheading Synopsis
29105
29106 @smallexample
29107 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29108 @end smallexample
29109
29110 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29111 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29112 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29113
29114 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29115 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29116
29117 @smallexample
29118 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29119 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29120 @end smallexample
29121
29122 @noindent
29123 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29124 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29125
29126 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29127 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29128 is of limited use.
29129
29130 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29131 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29132
29133 @subsubheading Synopsis
29134
29135 @smallexample
29136 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29137 @end smallexample
29138
29139 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29140 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29141 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29142 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29143 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29144 watchpoint from a variable object.
29145
29146 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29147 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29148
29149 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29150 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29151 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29152 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29153 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29154 @smallexample
29155 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29156 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29157 @end smallexample
29158
29159 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29160 @findex -var-show-attributes
29161
29162 @subsubheading Synopsis
29163
29164 @smallexample
29165 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29166 @end smallexample
29167
29168 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29169
29170 @smallexample
29171 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29172 @end smallexample
29173
29174 @noindent
29175 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29176
29177 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29178 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29179
29180 @subsubheading Synopsis
29181
29182 @smallexample
29183 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29184 @end smallexample
29185
29186 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29187 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29188 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29189 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29190 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29191 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29192 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29193
29194 @smallexample
29195 value=@var{value}
29196 @end smallexample
29197
29198 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29199 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29200
29201 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29202 @findex -var-assign
29203
29204 @subsubheading Synopsis
29205
29206 @smallexample
29207 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29208 @end smallexample
29209
29210 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29211 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29212 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29213 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29214
29215 @subsubheading Example
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 (gdb)
29219 -var-assign var1 3
29220 ^done,value="3"
29221 (gdb)
29222 -var-update *
29223 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29224 (gdb)
29225 @end smallexample
29226
29227 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29228 @findex -var-update
29229
29230 @subsubheading Synopsis
29231
29232 @smallexample
29233 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29237 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29238 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29239 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29240 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29241 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29242 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29243 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29244 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29245 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29246 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29247 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29248 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29249
29250 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29251 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29252 diagnostic.
29253
29254 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29255 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29256
29257 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29258 @samp{changelist}.
29259
29260 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29261
29262 @table @samp
29263 @item name
29264 The name of the varobj.
29265
29266 @item value
29267 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29268 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29269
29270 @item in_scope
29271 @anchor{-var-update}
29272 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29273
29274 @table @code
29275 @item "true"
29276 The variable object's current value is valid.
29277
29278 @item "false"
29279 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29280 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29281 scope.
29282
29283 @item "invalid"
29284 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29285 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29286 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29287 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29288 objects.
29289 @end table
29290
29291 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29292 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29293
29294 @item type_changed
29295 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29296 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29297 be @samp{false}.
29298
29299 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29300 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29301 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29302 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29303 unset.
29304
29305 @item new_type
29306 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29307 hold the new type.
29308
29309 @item new_num_children
29310 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29311 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29312
29313 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29314 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29315 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29316 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29317 children which may be available.
29318
29319 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29320 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29321 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29322 only happen at the end of the update range).
29323
29324 @item displayhint
29325 The display hint, if any.
29326
29327 @item has_more
29328 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29329 available outside the varobj's update range.
29330
29331 @item dynamic
29332 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29333 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29334 then this attribute will not be present.
29335
29336 @item new_children
29337 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29338 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29339 be listed in this attribute.
29340 @end table
29341
29342 @subsubheading Example
29343
29344 @smallexample
29345 (gdb)
29346 -var-assign var1 3
29347 ^done,value="3"
29348 (gdb)
29349 -var-update --all-values var1
29350 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29351 type_changed="false"@}]
29352 (gdb)
29353 @end smallexample
29354
29355 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29356 @findex -var-set-frozen
29357 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29358
29359 @subsubheading Synopsis
29360
29361 @smallexample
29362 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29363 @end smallexample
29364
29365 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29366 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29367 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29368 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29369 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29370 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29371 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29372 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29373 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29374 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29375 @code{-var-update} does.
29376
29377 @subsubheading Example
29378
29379 @smallexample
29380 (gdb)
29381 -var-set-frozen V 1
29382 ^done
29383 (gdb)
29384 @end smallexample
29385
29386 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29387 @findex -var-set-update-range
29388 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29389
29390 @subsubheading Synopsis
29391
29392 @smallexample
29393 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29394 @end smallexample
29395
29396 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29397 @code{-var-update}.
29398
29399 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29400 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29401 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29402 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29403
29404 @subsubheading Example
29405
29406 @smallexample
29407 (gdb)
29408 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29409 ^done
29410 @end smallexample
29411
29412 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29413 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29414 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29415
29416 @subsubheading Synopsis
29417
29418 @smallexample
29419 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29420 @end smallexample
29421
29422 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29423
29424 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29425 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29426
29427 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29428 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29429 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29430 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29431 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29432 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29433 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29434
29435 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29436 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29437 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29438 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29439
29440 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29441 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29442 can be used to check this.
29443
29444 @subsubheading Example
29445
29446 Resetting the visualizer:
29447
29448 @smallexample
29449 (gdb)
29450 -var-set-visualizer V None
29451 ^done
29452 @end smallexample
29453
29454 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29455
29456 @smallexample
29457 (gdb)
29458 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29459 ^done
29460 @end smallexample
29461
29462 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29463 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29464
29465 @smallexample
29466 (gdb)
29467 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29468 ^done
29469 @end smallexample
29470
29471 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29472 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29473 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29474
29475 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29476 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29477 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29478 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29479
29480 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29481 @c @subheading -data-assign
29482 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29483 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29484 @c set variable
29485 @c @subsubheading Example
29486 @c N.A.
29487
29488 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29489 @findex -data-disassemble
29490
29491 @subsubheading Synopsis
29492
29493 @smallexample
29494 -data-disassemble
29495 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29496 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29497 -- @var{mode}
29498 @end smallexample
29499
29500 @noindent
29501 Where:
29502
29503 @table @samp
29504 @item @var{start-addr}
29505 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29506 @item @var{end-addr}
29507 is the end address
29508 @item @var{filename}
29509 is the name of the file to disassemble
29510 @item @var{linenum}
29511 is the line number to disassemble around
29512 @item @var{lines}
29513 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29514 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29515 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29516 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29517 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29518 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29519 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29520 are displayed.
29521 @item @var{mode}
29522 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29523 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29524 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29525 @end table
29526
29527 @subsubheading Result
29528
29529 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29530 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29531 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29532
29533 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29534 following fields:
29535
29536 @table @code
29537 @item address
29538 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29539
29540 @item func-name
29541 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29542
29543 @item offset
29544 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29545
29546 @item inst
29547 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29548
29549 @item opcodes
29550 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29551 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29552
29553 @end table
29554
29555 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29556 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29557
29558 @table @code
29559 @item line
29560 The line number within @samp{file}.
29561
29562 @item file
29563 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29564 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29565 used.
29566
29567 @item fullname
29568 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29569 using the source file search path
29570 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29571 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29572
29573 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29574 present in the debug information.
29575
29576 @item line_asm_insn
29577 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29578 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29579 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29580 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29581 @samp{opcodes}.
29582
29583 @end table
29584
29585 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29586 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29587 adjust its format.
29588
29589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29590
29591 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29592
29593 @subsubheading Example
29594
29595 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29596
29597 @smallexample
29598 (gdb)
29599 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29600 ^done,
29601 asm_insns=[
29602 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29603 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29604 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29605 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29606 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29607 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29608 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29609 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29610 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29611 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29612 (gdb)
29613 @end smallexample
29614
29615 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29616 @code{main}.
29617
29618 @smallexample
29619 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29620 ^done,asm_insns=[
29621 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29622 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29623 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29624 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29625 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29626 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29627 [@dots{}]
29628 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29629 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29630 (gdb)
29631 @end smallexample
29632
29633 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29634
29635 @smallexample
29636 (gdb)
29637 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29638 ^done,asm_insns=[
29639 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29640 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29641 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29642 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29643 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29644 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29645 (gdb)
29646 @end smallexample
29647
29648 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29649
29650 @smallexample
29651 (gdb)
29652 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29653 ^done,asm_insns=[
29654 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29655 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29656 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29657 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29658 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29659 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29660 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29661 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29662 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29663 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29664 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29665 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29666 (gdb)
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669
29670 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29671 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29672
29673 @subsubheading Synopsis
29674
29675 @smallexample
29676 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29677 @end smallexample
29678
29679 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29680 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29681 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29682
29683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29684
29685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29686 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29687 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29688
29689 @subsubheading Example
29690
29691 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29692 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29693 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29694 output.
29695
29696 @smallexample
29697 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29698 211^done,value="1"
29699 (gdb)
29700 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29701 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29702 (gdb)
29703 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29704 411^done,value="4"
29705 (gdb)
29706 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29707 511^done,value="4"
29708 (gdb)
29709 @end smallexample
29710
29711
29712 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29713 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29714
29715 @subsubheading Synopsis
29716
29717 @smallexample
29718 -data-list-changed-registers
29719 @end smallexample
29720
29721 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29722
29723 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29724
29725 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29726 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29727
29728 @subsubheading Example
29729
29730 On a PPC MBX board:
29731
29732 @smallexample
29733 (gdb)
29734 -exec-continue
29735 ^running
29736
29737 (gdb)
29738 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29739 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29740 line="5"@}
29741 (gdb)
29742 -data-list-changed-registers
29743 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29744 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29745 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29746 (gdb)
29747 @end smallexample
29748
29749
29750 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29751 @findex -data-list-register-names
29752
29753 @subsubheading Synopsis
29754
29755 @smallexample
29756 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29757 @end smallexample
29758
29759 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29760 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29761 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29762 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29763 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29764 include empty register names.
29765
29766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29767
29768 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29769 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29770 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29771
29772 @subsubheading Example
29773
29774 For the PPC MBX board:
29775 @smallexample
29776 (gdb)
29777 -data-list-register-names
29778 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29779 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29780 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29781 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29782 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29783 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29784 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29785 (gdb)
29786 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29787 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29788 (gdb)
29789 @end smallexample
29790
29791 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29792 @findex -data-list-register-values
29793
29794 @subsubheading Synopsis
29795
29796 @smallexample
29797 -data-list-register-values
29798 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29799 @end smallexample
29800
29801 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29802 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29803 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29804 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29805 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29806 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29807
29808 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29809
29810 @table @code
29811 @item x
29812 Hexadecimal
29813 @item o
29814 Octal
29815 @item t
29816 Binary
29817 @item d
29818 Decimal
29819 @item r
29820 Raw
29821 @item N
29822 Natural
29823 @end table
29824
29825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29826
29827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29828 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29829
29830 @subsubheading Example
29831
29832 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29833 don't appear in the actual output):
29834
29835 @smallexample
29836 (gdb)
29837 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29838 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29839 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29840 (gdb)
29841 -data-list-register-values x
29842 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29843 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29844 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29845 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29846 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29847 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29848 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29849 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29850 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29851 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29852 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29853 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29854 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29855 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29856 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29857 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29858 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29859 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29860 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29861 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29862 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29863 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29864 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29865 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29866 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29867 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29868 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29869 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29870 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29871 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29872 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29873 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29874 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29875 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29876 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29877 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29878 (gdb)
29879 @end smallexample
29880
29881
29882 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29883 @findex -data-read-memory
29884
29885 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29886
29887 @subsubheading Synopsis
29888
29889 @smallexample
29890 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29891 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29892 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29893 @end smallexample
29894
29895 @noindent
29896 where:
29897
29898 @table @samp
29899 @item @var{address}
29900 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29901 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29902 quoted using the C convention.
29903
29904 @item @var{word-format}
29905 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29906 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29907 ,Output Formats}).
29908
29909 @item @var{word-size}
29910 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29911
29912 @item @var{nr-rows}
29913 The number of rows in the output table.
29914
29915 @item @var{nr-cols}
29916 The number of columns in the output table.
29917
29918 @item @var{aschar}
29919 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29920 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29921 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29922 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29923
29924 @item @var{byte-offset}
29925 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29926 @end table
29927
29928 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29929 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29930 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29931 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29932 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29933 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29934 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29935 @samp{addr}.
29936
29937 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29938 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29939 @samp{prev-page}.
29940
29941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29942
29943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29944 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29945
29946 @subsubheading Example
29947
29948 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29949 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29950 word. Display each word in hex.
29951
29952 @smallexample
29953 (gdb)
29954 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29955 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29956 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29957 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29958 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29959 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29960 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29961 (gdb)
29962 @end smallexample
29963
29964 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29965 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29966
29967 @smallexample
29968 (gdb)
29969 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29970 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29971 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29972 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29973 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29974 (gdb)
29975 @end smallexample
29976
29977 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29978 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29979 used as the non-printable character.
29980
29981 @smallexample
29982 (gdb)
29983 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29984 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29985 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29986 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29987 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29988 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29989 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29990 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29991 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29992 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29993 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29994 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29995 (gdb)
29996 @end smallexample
29997
29998 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29999 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30000
30001 @subsubheading Synopsis
30002
30003 @smallexample
30004 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30005 @var{address} @var{count}
30006 @end smallexample
30007
30008 @noindent
30009 where:
30010
30011 @table @samp
30012 @item @var{address}
30013 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30014 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30015 quoted using the C convention.
30016
30017 @item @var{count}
30018 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
30019
30020 @item @var{byte-offset}
30021 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
30022 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
30023 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
30024 perform address arithmetics itself.
30025
30026 @end table
30027
30028 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30029 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30030 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30031 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30032 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30033 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30034
30035 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
30036 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
30037 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30038 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
30039 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30040 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30041 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30042 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30043
30044 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30045 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30046 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30047 and has the following fields:
30048
30049 @table @code
30050 @item begin
30051 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30052
30053 @item end
30054 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30055
30056 @item offset
30057 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30058 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30059
30060 @item contents
30061 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30062
30063 @end table
30064
30065
30066
30067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30068
30069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30070
30071 @subsubheading Example
30072
30073 @smallexample
30074 (gdb)
30075 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30076 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30077 end="0xbffff15e",
30078 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30079 (gdb)
30080 @end smallexample
30081
30082
30083 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30084 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30085
30086 @subsubheading Synopsis
30087
30088 @smallexample
30089 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30090 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30091 @end smallexample
30092
30093 @noindent
30094 where:
30095
30096 @table @samp
30097 @item @var{address}
30098 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30099 written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30100 quoted using the C convention.
30101
30102 @item @var{contents}
30103 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
30104
30105 @item @var{count}
30106 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
30107 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
30108 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
30109
30110 @end table
30111
30112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30113
30114 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30115
30116 @subsubheading Example
30117
30118 @smallexample
30119 (gdb)
30120 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30121 ^done
30122 (gdb)
30123 @end smallexample
30124
30125 @smallexample
30126 (gdb)
30127 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30128 ^done
30129 (gdb)
30130 @end smallexample
30131
30132 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30133 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30134 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30135
30136 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30137 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30138
30139 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30140 @findex -trace-find
30141
30142 @subsubheading Synopsis
30143
30144 @smallexample
30145 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30146 @end smallexample
30147
30148 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30149 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30150 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30151
30152 @table @samp
30153
30154 @item none
30155 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30156
30157 @item frame-number
30158 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30159 that index.
30160
30161 @item tracepoint-number
30162 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30163 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30164
30165 @item pc
30166 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30167 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30168 address.
30169
30170 @item pc-inside-range
30171 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30172 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30173 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30174
30175 @item pc-outside-range
30176 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30177 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30178 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30179
30180 @item line
30181 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30182 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30183 the specified location.
30184
30185 @end table
30186
30187 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30188 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30189
30190 @table @samp
30191 @item found
30192 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30193 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30194
30195 @item traceframe
30196 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30197 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30198
30199 @item tracepoint
30200 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30201 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30202
30203 @item frame
30204 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30205 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30206 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30207
30208 @end table
30209
30210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30211
30212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30213
30214 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30215 @findex -trace-define-variable
30216
30217 @subsubheading Synopsis
30218
30219 @smallexample
30220 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30221 @end smallexample
30222
30223 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30224 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30225 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30226 with the @samp{$} character.
30227
30228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30229
30230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30231
30232 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30233 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30234
30235 @subsubheading Synopsis
30236
30237 @smallexample
30238 -trace-frame-collected
30239 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30240 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30241 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30242 [--memory-contents]
30243 @end smallexample
30244
30245 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30246 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30247 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30248 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30249 See the output description table below for more details.
30250
30251 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30252 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30253 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30254 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30255 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30256
30257 For instance, if the actions were
30258 @smallexample
30259 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30260 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30261 @end smallexample
30262
30263 @noindent
30264 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30265 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30266 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30267 objects would be computed expressions.
30268
30269 An example output would be:
30270
30271 @smallexample
30272 (gdb)
30273 -trace-frame-collected
30274 ^done,
30275 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30276 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30277 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30278 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30279 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30280 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30281 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30282 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30283 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30284 ...
30285 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30286 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30287 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30288 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30289 (gdb)
30290 @end smallexample
30291
30292 Where:
30293
30294 @table @code
30295 @item explicit-variables
30296 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30297 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30298 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30299 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30300 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30301 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30302 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30303 arrays, structures and unions.
30304
30305 @item computed-expressions
30306 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30307 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30308 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30309 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30310
30311 @item registers
30312 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30313 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30314 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30315 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30316 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30317
30318 @item tvars
30319 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30320 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30321 current value are returned.
30322
30323 @item memory
30324 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30325 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30326 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30327
30328 @table @code
30329 @item address
30330 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30331
30332 @item length
30333 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30334
30335 @item contents
30336 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30337 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30338
30339 @end table
30340
30341 @end table
30342
30343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30344
30345 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30346
30347 @subsubheading Example
30348
30349 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30350 @findex -trace-list-variables
30351
30352 @subsubheading Synopsis
30353
30354 @smallexample
30355 -trace-list-variables
30356 @end smallexample
30357
30358 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30359 table has the following fields:
30360
30361 @table @samp
30362 @item name
30363 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30364
30365 @item initial
30366 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30367 field is always present.
30368
30369 @item current
30370 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30371 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30372 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30373 presently running.
30374
30375 @end table
30376
30377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30378
30379 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30380
30381 @subsubheading Example
30382
30383 @smallexample
30384 (gdb)
30385 -trace-list-variables
30386 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30387 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30388 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30389 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30390 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30391 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30392 (gdb)
30393 @end smallexample
30394
30395 @subheading -trace-save
30396 @findex -trace-save
30397
30398 @subsubheading Synopsis
30399
30400 @smallexample
30401 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30402 @end smallexample
30403
30404 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30405 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30406 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30407 to perform the save.
30408
30409 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30410
30411 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30412
30413
30414 @subheading -trace-start
30415 @findex -trace-start
30416
30417 @subsubheading Synopsis
30418
30419 @smallexample
30420 -trace-start
30421 @end smallexample
30422
30423 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30424 have any fields.
30425
30426 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30427
30428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30429
30430 @subheading -trace-status
30431 @findex -trace-status
30432
30433 @subsubheading Synopsis
30434
30435 @smallexample
30436 -trace-status
30437 @end smallexample
30438
30439 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30440 the following fields:
30441
30442 @table @samp
30443
30444 @item supported
30445 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30446 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30447 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30448 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30449 started. This field is always present.
30450
30451 @item running
30452 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30453 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30454 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30455
30456 @item stop-reason
30457 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30458 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30459 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30460 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30461 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30462 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30463 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30464 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30465 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30466
30467 @item stopping-tracepoint
30468 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30469 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30470 @samp{passcount}.
30471
30472 @item frames
30473 @itemx frames-created
30474 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30475 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30476 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30477 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30478
30479 @item buffer-size
30480 @itemx buffer-free
30481 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30482 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30483
30484 @item circular
30485 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30486 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30487 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30488 and may fill up.
30489
30490 @item disconnected
30491 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30492 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30493 that the trace run will stop.
30494
30495 @item trace-file
30496 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30497 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30498
30499 @end table
30500
30501 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30502
30503 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30504
30505 @subheading -trace-stop
30506 @findex -trace-stop
30507
30508 @subsubheading Synopsis
30509
30510 @smallexample
30511 -trace-stop
30512 @end smallexample
30513
30514 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30515 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30516 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30517
30518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30519
30520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30521
30522
30523 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30524 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30525 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30526
30527
30528 @ignore
30529 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30530 @findex -symbol-info-address
30531
30532 @subsubheading Synopsis
30533
30534 @smallexample
30535 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30536 @end smallexample
30537
30538 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30539
30540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30541
30542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30543
30544 @subsubheading Example
30545 N.A.
30546
30547
30548 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30549 @findex -symbol-info-file
30550
30551 @subsubheading Synopsis
30552
30553 @smallexample
30554 -symbol-info-file
30555 @end smallexample
30556
30557 Show the file for the symbol.
30558
30559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30560
30561 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30562 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30563
30564 @subsubheading Example
30565 N.A.
30566
30567
30568 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30569 @findex -symbol-info-function
30570
30571 @subsubheading Synopsis
30572
30573 @smallexample
30574 -symbol-info-function
30575 @end smallexample
30576
30577 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30578
30579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30580
30581 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30582
30583 @subsubheading Example
30584 N.A.
30585
30586
30587 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30588 @findex -symbol-info-line
30589
30590 @subsubheading Synopsis
30591
30592 @smallexample
30593 -symbol-info-line
30594 @end smallexample
30595
30596 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30597
30598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30599
30600 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30601 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30602
30603 @subsubheading Example
30604 N.A.
30605
30606
30607 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30608 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30609
30610 @subsubheading Synopsis
30611
30612 @smallexample
30613 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30614 @end smallexample
30615
30616 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30617
30618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30619
30620 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30621
30622 @subsubheading Example
30623 N.A.
30624
30625
30626 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30627 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30628
30629 @subsubheading Synopsis
30630
30631 @smallexample
30632 -symbol-list-functions
30633 @end smallexample
30634
30635 List the functions in the executable.
30636
30637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30638
30639 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30640 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30641
30642 @subsubheading Example
30643 N.A.
30644 @end ignore
30645
30646
30647 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30648 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30649
30650 @subsubheading Synopsis
30651
30652 @smallexample
30653 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30654 @end smallexample
30655
30656 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30657 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30658 ascending PC order.
30659
30660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30661
30662 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30663
30664 @subsubheading Example
30665 @smallexample
30666 (gdb)
30667 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30668 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30669 (gdb)
30670 @end smallexample
30671
30672
30673 @ignore
30674 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30675 @findex -symbol-list-types
30676
30677 @subsubheading Synopsis
30678
30679 @smallexample
30680 -symbol-list-types
30681 @end smallexample
30682
30683 List all the type names.
30684
30685 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30686
30687 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30688 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30689
30690 @subsubheading Example
30691 N.A.
30692
30693
30694 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30695 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30696
30697 @subsubheading Synopsis
30698
30699 @smallexample
30700 -symbol-list-variables
30701 @end smallexample
30702
30703 List all the global and static variable names.
30704
30705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30706
30707 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30708
30709 @subsubheading Example
30710 N.A.
30711
30712
30713 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30714 @findex -symbol-locate
30715
30716 @subsubheading Synopsis
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 -symbol-locate
30720 @end smallexample
30721
30722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30723
30724 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30725
30726 @subsubheading Example
30727 N.A.
30728
30729
30730 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30731 @findex -symbol-type
30732
30733 @subsubheading Synopsis
30734
30735 @smallexample
30736 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30737 @end smallexample
30738
30739 Show type of @var{variable}.
30740
30741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30742
30743 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30744 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30745
30746 @subsubheading Example
30747 N.A.
30748 @end ignore
30749
30750
30751 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30752 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30753 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30754
30755 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30756 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30757
30758 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30759 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30760
30761 @subsubheading Synopsis
30762
30763 @smallexample
30764 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30765 @end smallexample
30766
30767 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30768 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30769 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30770 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30771 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30772 notification.
30773
30774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30775
30776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30777
30778 @subsubheading Example
30779
30780 @smallexample
30781 (gdb)
30782 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30783 ^done
30784 (gdb)
30785 @end smallexample
30786
30787
30788 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30789 @findex -file-exec-file
30790
30791 @subsubheading Synopsis
30792
30793 @smallexample
30794 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30795 @end smallexample
30796
30797 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30798 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30799 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30800 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30801 notification.
30802
30803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30804
30805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30806
30807 @subsubheading Example
30808
30809 @smallexample
30810 (gdb)
30811 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30812 ^done
30813 (gdb)
30814 @end smallexample
30815
30816
30817 @ignore
30818 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30819 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30820
30821 @subsubheading Synopsis
30822
30823 @smallexample
30824 -file-list-exec-sections
30825 @end smallexample
30826
30827 List the sections of the current executable file.
30828
30829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30830
30831 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30832 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30833 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30834
30835 @subsubheading Example
30836 N.A.
30837 @end ignore
30838
30839
30840 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30841 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30842
30843 @subsubheading Synopsis
30844
30845 @smallexample
30846 -file-list-exec-source-file
30847 @end smallexample
30848
30849 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30850 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30851 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30852 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30853
30854 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30855
30856 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30857
30858 @subsubheading Example
30859
30860 @smallexample
30861 (gdb)
30862 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30863 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30864 (gdb)
30865 @end smallexample
30866
30867
30868 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30869 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30870
30871 @subsubheading Synopsis
30872
30873 @smallexample
30874 -file-list-exec-source-files
30875 @end smallexample
30876
30877 List the source files for the current executable.
30878
30879 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30880 name) of a source file.
30881
30882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30883
30884 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30885 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30886
30887 @subsubheading Example
30888 @smallexample
30889 (gdb)
30890 -file-list-exec-source-files
30891 ^done,files=[
30892 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30893 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30894 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30895 (gdb)
30896 @end smallexample
30897
30898 @ignore
30899 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30900 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30901
30902 @subsubheading Synopsis
30903
30904 @smallexample
30905 -file-list-shared-libraries
30906 @end smallexample
30907
30908 List the shared libraries in the program.
30909
30910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30911
30912 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30913
30914 @subsubheading Example
30915 N.A.
30916
30917
30918 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30919 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30920
30921 @subsubheading Synopsis
30922
30923 @smallexample
30924 -file-list-symbol-files
30925 @end smallexample
30926
30927 List symbol files.
30928
30929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30930
30931 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30932
30933 @subsubheading Example
30934 N.A.
30935 @end ignore
30936
30937
30938 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30939 @findex -file-symbol-file
30940
30941 @subsubheading Synopsis
30942
30943 @smallexample
30944 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30945 @end smallexample
30946
30947 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30948 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30949 produced, except for a completion notification.
30950
30951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30952
30953 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30954
30955 @subsubheading Example
30956
30957 @smallexample
30958 (gdb)
30959 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30960 ^done
30961 (gdb)
30962 @end smallexample
30963
30964 @ignore
30965 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30966 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30967 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30968
30969 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30970
30971 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30972
30973 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30974
30975 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30976
30977 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30978
30979 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30980
30981 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30982
30983 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30984
30985 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30986 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30987 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30988
30989 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30990
30991 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30992
30993 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30994
30995 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30996 @end ignore
30997
30998
30999 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31000 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31001 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31002
31003
31004 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31005 @findex -target-attach
31006
31007 @subsubheading Synopsis
31008
31009 @smallexample
31010 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31011 @end smallexample
31012
31013 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31014 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31015 group, the id previously returned by
31016 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31017
31018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31019
31020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31021
31022 @subsubheading Example
31023 @smallexample
31024 (gdb)
31025 -target-attach 34
31026 =thread-created,id="1"
31027 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31028 ^done
31029 (gdb)
31030 @end smallexample
31031
31032 @ignore
31033 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31034 @findex -target-compare-sections
31035
31036 @subsubheading Synopsis
31037
31038 @smallexample
31039 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31040 @end smallexample
31041
31042 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31043 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31044
31045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31046
31047 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31048
31049 @subsubheading Example
31050 N.A.
31051 @end ignore
31052
31053
31054 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31055 @findex -target-detach
31056
31057 @subsubheading Synopsis
31058
31059 @smallexample
31060 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31061 @end smallexample
31062
31063 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31064 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31065 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31066
31067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31068
31069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31070
31071 @subsubheading Example
31072
31073 @smallexample
31074 (gdb)
31075 -target-detach
31076 ^done
31077 (gdb)
31078 @end smallexample
31079
31080
31081 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31082 @findex -target-disconnect
31083
31084 @subsubheading Synopsis
31085
31086 @smallexample
31087 -target-disconnect
31088 @end smallexample
31089
31090 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31091 generally not resumed.
31092
31093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31094
31095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31096
31097 @subsubheading Example
31098
31099 @smallexample
31100 (gdb)
31101 -target-disconnect
31102 ^done
31103 (gdb)
31104 @end smallexample
31105
31106
31107 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31108 @findex -target-download
31109
31110 @subsubheading Synopsis
31111
31112 @smallexample
31113 -target-download
31114 @end smallexample
31115
31116 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31117 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31118
31119 @table @samp
31120 @item section
31121 The name of the section.
31122 @item section-sent
31123 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31124 @item section-size
31125 The size of the section.
31126 @item total-sent
31127 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31128 @item total-size
31129 The size of the overall executable to download.
31130 @end table
31131
31132 @noindent
31133 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31134 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31135
31136 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31137 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31138
31139 @table @samp
31140 @item section
31141 The name of the section.
31142 @item section-size
31143 The size of the section.
31144 @item total-size
31145 The size of the overall executable to download.
31146 @end table
31147
31148 @noindent
31149 At the end, a summary is printed.
31150
31151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31152
31153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31154
31155 @subsubheading Example
31156
31157 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31158 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31159
31160 @smallexample
31161 (gdb)
31162 -target-download
31163 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31164 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31165 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31166 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31167 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31168 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31169 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31170 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31171 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31172 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31173 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31174 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31175 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31176 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31177 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31178 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31179 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31180 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31181 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31182 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31183 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31184 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31185 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31186 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31187 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31188 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31189 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31190 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31191 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31192 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31193 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31194 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31195 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31196 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31197 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31198 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31199 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31200 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31201 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31202 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31203 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31204 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31205 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31206 write-rate="429"
31207 (gdb)
31208 @end smallexample
31209
31210
31211 @ignore
31212 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31213 @findex -target-exec-status
31214
31215 @subsubheading Synopsis
31216
31217 @smallexample
31218 -target-exec-status
31219 @end smallexample
31220
31221 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31222 not, for instance).
31223
31224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31225
31226 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31227
31228 @subsubheading Example
31229 N.A.
31230
31231
31232 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31233 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31234
31235 @subsubheading Synopsis
31236
31237 @smallexample
31238 -target-list-available-targets
31239 @end smallexample
31240
31241 List the possible targets to connect to.
31242
31243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31244
31245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31246
31247 @subsubheading Example
31248 N.A.
31249
31250
31251 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31252 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31253
31254 @subsubheading Synopsis
31255
31256 @smallexample
31257 -target-list-current-targets
31258 @end smallexample
31259
31260 Describe the current target.
31261
31262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31263
31264 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31265 other things).
31266
31267 @subsubheading Example
31268 N.A.
31269
31270
31271 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31272 @findex -target-list-parameters
31273
31274 @subsubheading Synopsis
31275
31276 @smallexample
31277 -target-list-parameters
31278 @end smallexample
31279
31280 @c ????
31281 @end ignore
31282
31283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31284
31285 No equivalent.
31286
31287 @subsubheading Example
31288 N.A.
31289
31290
31291 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31292 @findex -target-select
31293
31294 @subsubheading Synopsis
31295
31296 @smallexample
31297 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31298 @end smallexample
31299
31300 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31301
31302 @table @samp
31303 @item @var{type}
31304 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31305 @item @var{parameters}
31306 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31307 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31308 @end table
31309
31310 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31311 which the target program is, in the following form:
31312
31313 @smallexample
31314 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31315 args=[@var{arg list}]
31316 @end smallexample
31317
31318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31319
31320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31321
31322 @subsubheading Example
31323
31324 @smallexample
31325 (gdb)
31326 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31327 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31328 (gdb)
31329 @end smallexample
31330
31331 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31332 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31333 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31334
31335
31336 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31337 @findex -target-file-put
31338
31339 @subsubheading Synopsis
31340
31341 @smallexample
31342 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31343 @end smallexample
31344
31345 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31346 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31347
31348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31349
31350 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31351
31352 @subsubheading Example
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 (gdb)
31356 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31357 ^done
31358 (gdb)
31359 @end smallexample
31360
31361
31362 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31363 @findex -target-file-get
31364
31365 @subsubheading Synopsis
31366
31367 @smallexample
31368 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31369 @end smallexample
31370
31371 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31372 on the host system.
31373
31374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31375
31376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31377
31378 @subsubheading Example
31379
31380 @smallexample
31381 (gdb)
31382 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31383 ^done
31384 (gdb)
31385 @end smallexample
31386
31387
31388 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31389 @findex -target-file-delete
31390
31391 @subsubheading Synopsis
31392
31393 @smallexample
31394 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31395 @end smallexample
31396
31397 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31398
31399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31400
31401 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31402
31403 @subsubheading Example
31404
31405 @smallexample
31406 (gdb)
31407 -target-file-delete remotefile
31408 ^done
31409 (gdb)
31410 @end smallexample
31411
31412
31413 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31414 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31415 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31416
31417 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31418 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31419
31420 @subsubheading Synopsis
31421
31422 @smallexample
31423 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31424 @end smallexample
31425
31426 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31427 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31428 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31429
31430 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31431
31432 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31433
31434 @subsubheading Result
31435
31436 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31437 defined for each exception:
31438
31439 @table @samp
31440 @item name
31441 The name of the exception.
31442
31443 @item address
31444 The address of the exception.
31445
31446 @end table
31447
31448 @subsubheading Example
31449
31450 @smallexample
31451 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31452 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31453 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31454 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31455 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31456 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31457 @end smallexample
31458
31459 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31460
31461 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31462 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31463 Catchpoint Commands}.
31464
31465
31466 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31467 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31468 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31469
31470 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31471 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31472 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31473 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31474
31475 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31476 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31477 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31478
31479 @subsubheading Synopsis
31480
31481 @smallexample
31482 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31483 @end smallexample
31484
31485 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31486
31487 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31488 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31489 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31490 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31491 dash.
31492
31493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31494
31495 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31496
31497 @subsubheading Result
31498
31499 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31500
31501 @table @samp
31502 @item exists
31503 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31504 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31505
31506 @end table
31507
31508 @subsubheading Example
31509
31510 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31511
31512 @smallexample
31513 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31514 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31515 @end smallexample
31516
31517 @noindent
31518 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31519 to the debugger:
31520
31521 @smallexample
31522 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31523 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31524 @end smallexample
31525
31526 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31527 @findex -list-features
31528 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31529
31530 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31531 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31532 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31533 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31534 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31535 startup.
31536
31537 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31538 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31539 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31540 is given below.
31541
31542 Example output:
31543
31544 @smallexample
31545 (gdb) -list-features
31546 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31547 @end smallexample
31548
31549 The current list of features is:
31550
31551 @ftable @samp
31552 @item frozen-varobjs
31553 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31554 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31555 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31556 @item pending-breakpoints
31557 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31558 command.
31559 @item python
31560 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31561 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31562 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31563 @item thread-info
31564 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31565 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31566 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31567 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31568 @item breakpoint-notifications
31569 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31570 CLI will be announced via async records.
31571 @item ada-task-info
31572 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31573 @item language-option
31574 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31575 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31576 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31577 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31578 @item undefined-command-error-code
31579 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31580 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31581 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31582 @item exec-run-start-option
31583 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31584 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31585 @end ftable
31586
31587 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31588 @findex -list-target-features
31589
31590 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31591 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31592 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31593 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31594 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31595 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31596 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31597 Example output:
31598
31599 @smallexample
31600 (gdb) -list-target-features
31601 ^done,result=["async"]
31602 @end smallexample
31603
31604 The current list of features is:
31605
31606 @table @samp
31607 @item async
31608 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31609 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31610 while the target is running.
31611
31612 @item reverse
31613 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31614 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31615
31616 @end table
31617
31618 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31619 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31620 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31621
31622 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31623
31624 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31625 @findex -gdb-exit
31626
31627 @subsubheading Synopsis
31628
31629 @smallexample
31630 -gdb-exit
31631 @end smallexample
31632
31633 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31634
31635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31636
31637 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31638
31639 @subsubheading Example
31640
31641 @smallexample
31642 (gdb)
31643 -gdb-exit
31644 ^exit
31645 @end smallexample
31646
31647
31648 @ignore
31649 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31650 @findex -exec-abort
31651
31652 @subsubheading Synopsis
31653
31654 @smallexample
31655 -exec-abort
31656 @end smallexample
31657
31658 Kill the inferior running program.
31659
31660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31661
31662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31663
31664 @subsubheading Example
31665 N.A.
31666 @end ignore
31667
31668
31669 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31670 @findex -gdb-set
31671
31672 @subsubheading Synopsis
31673
31674 @smallexample
31675 -gdb-set
31676 @end smallexample
31677
31678 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31679 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31680
31681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31682
31683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31684
31685 @subsubheading Example
31686
31687 @smallexample
31688 (gdb)
31689 -gdb-set $foo=3
31690 ^done
31691 (gdb)
31692 @end smallexample
31693
31694
31695 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31696 @findex -gdb-show
31697
31698 @subsubheading Synopsis
31699
31700 @smallexample
31701 -gdb-show
31702 @end smallexample
31703
31704 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31705
31706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31707
31708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31709
31710 @subsubheading Example
31711
31712 @smallexample
31713 (gdb)
31714 -gdb-show annotate
31715 ^done,value="0"
31716 (gdb)
31717 @end smallexample
31718
31719 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31720
31721
31722 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31723 @findex -gdb-version
31724
31725 @subsubheading Synopsis
31726
31727 @smallexample
31728 -gdb-version
31729 @end smallexample
31730
31731 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31732
31733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31734
31735 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31736 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31737
31738 @subsubheading Example
31739
31740 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31741 @c box in TeX.
31742 @smallexample
31743 (gdb)
31744 -gdb-version
31745 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31746 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31747 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31748 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31749 ~ certain conditions.
31750 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31751 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31752 ~ details.
31753 ~This GDB was configured as
31754 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31755 ^done
31756 (gdb)
31757 @end smallexample
31758
31759 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31760 @findex -list-thread-groups
31761
31762 @subheading Synopsis
31763
31764 @smallexample
31765 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31766 @end smallexample
31767
31768 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31769 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31770 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31771 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31772 top-level thread groups.
31773
31774 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31775 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31776 available on the target.
31777
31778 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31779 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31780 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31781 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31782 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31783 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31784 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31785 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31786
31787 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31788 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31789 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31790 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31791 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31792 @samp{threads} field.
31793
31794 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31795 the following caveats:
31796
31797 @itemize @bullet
31798 @item
31799 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31800 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31801 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31802
31803 @item
31804 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31805 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31806 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31807 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31808 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31809 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31810
31811 @end itemize
31812
31813 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31814 have the following fields:
31815
31816 @table @code
31817 @item id
31818 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31819 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31820 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31821
31822 @item type
31823 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31824 valid type.
31825
31826 @item pid
31827 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31828 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31829
31830 @item exit-code
31831 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31832 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31833 only if the process is not running.
31834
31835 @item num_children
31836 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31837 absent for an available thread group.
31838
31839 @item threads
31840 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31841 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31842 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31843
31844 @item cores
31845 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31846 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31847 such information is not available.
31848
31849 @item executable
31850 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31851 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31852 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31853
31854 @end table
31855
31856 @subheading Example
31857
31858 @smallexample
31859 @value{GDBP}
31860 -list-thread-groups
31861 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31862 -list-thread-groups 17
31863 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31864 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31865 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31866 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31867 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31868 -list-thread-groups --available
31869 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31870 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31871 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31872 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31873 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31874 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31875 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31876 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31877 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31878 @end smallexample
31879
31880 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31881 @findex -info-os
31882
31883 @subsubheading Synopsis
31884
31885 @smallexample
31886 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31887 @end smallexample
31888
31889 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31890 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31891 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31892 of data of that type.
31893
31894 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31895 system.
31896
31897 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31898
31899 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31900
31901 @subsubheading Example
31902
31903 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31904 like this:
31905
31906 @smallexample
31907 @value{GDBP}
31908 -info-os
31909 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
31910 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31911 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31912 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31913 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
31914 col2="CPUs"@},
31915 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31916 col2="File descriptors"@},
31917 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31918 col2="Kernel modules"@},
31919 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31920 col2="Message queues"@},
31921 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31922 col2="Processes"@},
31923 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31924 col2="Process groups"@},
31925 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31926 col2="Semaphores"@},
31927 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31928 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31929 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31930 col2="Sockets"@},
31931 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31932 col2="Threads"@}]
31933 @value{GDBP}
31934 -info-os processes
31935 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31936 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31937 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31938 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31939 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31940 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31941 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31942 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31943 ...
31944 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31945 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31946 (gdb)
31947 @end smallexample
31948
31949 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31950 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31951 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31952 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31953 @code{info os} omits it.)
31954
31955 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31956 @findex -add-inferior
31957
31958 @subheading Synopsis
31959
31960 @smallexample
31961 -add-inferior
31962 @end smallexample
31963
31964 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31965 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31966 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31967 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31968 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31969 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31970
31971 @subheading Example
31972
31973 @smallexample
31974 @value{GDBP}
31975 -add-inferior
31976 ^done,inferior="i3"
31977 @end smallexample
31978
31979 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31980 @findex -interpreter-exec
31981
31982 @subheading Synopsis
31983
31984 @smallexample
31985 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31986 @end smallexample
31987 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31988
31989 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31990
31991 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31992
31993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31994
31995 @subheading Example
31996
31997 @smallexample
31998 (gdb)
31999 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32000 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32001 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32002 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32003 ^done
32004 (gdb)
32005 @end smallexample
32006
32007 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32008 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32009
32010 @subheading Synopsis
32011
32012 @smallexample
32013 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32014 @end smallexample
32015
32016 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32017
32018 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32019
32020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32021
32022 @subheading Example
32023
32024 @smallexample
32025 (gdb)
32026 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32027 ^done
32028 (gdb)
32029 @end smallexample
32030
32031 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32032 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32033
32034 @subheading Synopsis
32035
32036 @smallexample
32037 -inferior-tty-show
32038 @end smallexample
32039
32040 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32041
32042 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32043
32044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32045
32046 @subheading Example
32047
32048 @smallexample
32049 (gdb)
32050 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32051 ^done
32052 (gdb)
32053 -inferior-tty-show
32054 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32055 (gdb)
32056 @end smallexample
32057
32058 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32059 @findex -enable-timings
32060
32061 @subheading Synopsis
32062
32063 @smallexample
32064 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32065 @end smallexample
32066
32067 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32068 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32069 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32070 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32071
32072 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32073
32074 No equivalent.
32075
32076 @subheading Example
32077
32078 @smallexample
32079 (gdb)
32080 -enable-timings
32081 ^done
32082 (gdb)
32083 -break-insert main
32084 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32085 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32086 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32087 times="0"@},
32088 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32089 (gdb)
32090 -enable-timings no
32091 ^done
32092 (gdb)
32093 -exec-run
32094 ^running
32095 (gdb)
32096 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32097 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32098 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32099 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32100 (gdb)
32101 @end smallexample
32102
32103 @node Annotations
32104 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32105
32106 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32107 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32108 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32109 relatively high level.
32110
32111 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32112 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32113
32114 @ignore
32115 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32116 @end ignore
32117
32118 @menu
32119 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32120 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32121 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32122 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32123 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32124 * Annotations for Running::
32125 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32126 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32127 @end menu
32128
32129 @node Annotations Overview
32130 @section What is an Annotation?
32131 @cindex annotations
32132
32133 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32134 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32135 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32136 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32137 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32138 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32139 cannot contain newline characters.
32140
32141 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32142 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32143 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32144 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32145 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32146 means those three characters as output.
32147
32148 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32149 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32150 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32151 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32152 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32153 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32154 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32155 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32156 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32157
32158 @table @code
32159 @kindex set annotate
32160 @item set annotate @var{level}
32161 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32162 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32163
32164 @item show annotate
32165 @kindex show annotate
32166 Show the current annotation level.
32167 @end table
32168
32169 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32170
32171 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32172
32173 @smallexample
32174 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32175 GNU gdb 6.0
32176 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32177 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32178 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32179 under certain conditions.
32180 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32181 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32182 for details.
32183 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32184
32185 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32186 (@value{GDBP})
32187 ^Z^Zprompt
32188 @kbd{quit}
32189
32190 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32191 $
32192 @end smallexample
32193
32194 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32195 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32196 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32197 output from @value{GDBN}.
32198
32199 @node Server Prefix
32200 @section The Server Prefix
32201 @cindex server prefix
32202
32203 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32204 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32205 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32206 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32207 a transparent manner.
32208
32209 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32210 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32211 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32212 @code{print} command.
32213
32214 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32215 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32216
32217 @node Prompting
32218 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32219
32220 @cindex annotations for prompts
32221 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32222 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32223 over, etc.
32224
32225 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32226 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32227 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32228 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32229 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32230 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32231 features the following annotations:
32232
32233 @smallexample
32234 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32235 ^Z^Zprompt
32236 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32237 @end smallexample
32238
32239 The input types are
32240
32241 @table @code
32242 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32243 @findex prompt annotation
32244 @findex post-prompt annotation
32245 @item prompt
32246 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32247
32248 @findex pre-commands annotation
32249 @findex commands annotation
32250 @findex post-commands annotation
32251 @item commands
32252 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32253 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32254
32255 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32256 @findex overload-choice annotation
32257 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32258 @item overload-choice
32259 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32260
32261 @findex pre-query annotation
32262 @findex query annotation
32263 @findex post-query annotation
32264 @item query
32265 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32266
32267 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32268 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32269 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32270 @item prompt-for-continue
32271 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32272 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32273 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32274 presence of annotations.
32275 @end table
32276
32277 @node Errors
32278 @section Errors
32279 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32280
32281 @findex quit annotation
32282 @smallexample
32283 ^Z^Zquit
32284 @end smallexample
32285
32286 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32287
32288 @findex error annotation
32289 @smallexample
32290 ^Z^Zerror
32291 @end smallexample
32292
32293 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32294
32295 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32296 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32297 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32298 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32299 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32300 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32301 to the top level.
32302
32303 @findex error-begin annotation
32304 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32305
32306 @smallexample
32307 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32308 @end smallexample
32309
32310 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32311 message.
32312
32313 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32314 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32315 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32316
32317 @node Invalidation
32318 @section Invalidation Notices
32319
32320 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32321 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32322 changed.
32323
32324 @table @code
32325 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32326 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32327
32328 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32329 have changed.
32330
32331 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32332 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32333
32334 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32335 deleted a breakpoint.
32336 @end table
32337
32338 @node Annotations for Running
32339 @section Running the Program
32340 @cindex annotations for running programs
32341
32342 @findex starting annotation
32343 @findex stopping annotation
32344 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32345 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32346
32347 @smallexample
32348 ^Z^Zstarting
32349 @end smallexample
32350
32351 is output. When the program stops,
32352
32353 @smallexample
32354 ^Z^Zstopped
32355 @end smallexample
32356
32357 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32358 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32359
32360 @table @code
32361 @findex exited annotation
32362 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32363 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32364 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32365
32366 @findex signalled annotation
32367 @findex signal-name annotation
32368 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32369 @findex signal-string annotation
32370 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32371 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32372 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32373 annotation continues:
32374
32375 @smallexample
32376 @var{intro-text}
32377 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32378 @var{name}
32379 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32380 @var{middle-text}
32381 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32382 @var{string}
32383 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32384 @var{end-text}
32385 @end smallexample
32386
32387 @noindent
32388 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32389 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32390 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32391 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32392 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32393
32394 @findex signal annotation
32395 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32396 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32397 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32398 terminated with it.
32399
32400 @findex breakpoint annotation
32401 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32402 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32403
32404 @findex watchpoint annotation
32405 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32406 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32407 @end table
32408
32409 @node Source Annotations
32410 @section Displaying Source
32411 @cindex annotations for source display
32412
32413 @findex source annotation
32414 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32415
32416 @smallexample
32417 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32418 @end smallexample
32419
32420 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32421 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32422 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32423 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32424 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32425 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32426 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32427 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32428 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32429 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32430 depend on the language).
32431
32432 @node JIT Interface
32433 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32434 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32435 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32436
32437 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32438 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32439 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32440 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32441
32442 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32443 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32444 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32445 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32446 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32447 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32448
32449 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32450 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32451 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32452 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32453 LLVM JIT.
32454
32455 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32456 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32457 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32458 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32459 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32460 out about additional code.
32461
32462 @menu
32463 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32464 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32465 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32466 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32467 @end menu
32468
32469 @node Declarations
32470 @section JIT Declarations
32471
32472 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32473 implement the interface:
32474
32475 @smallexample
32476 typedef enum
32477 @{
32478 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32479 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32480 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32481 @} jit_actions_t;
32482
32483 struct jit_code_entry
32484 @{
32485 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32486 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32487 const char *symfile_addr;
32488 uint64_t symfile_size;
32489 @};
32490
32491 struct jit_descriptor
32492 @{
32493 uint32_t version;
32494 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32495 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32496 uint32_t action_flag;
32497 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32498 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32499 @};
32500
32501 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32502 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32503
32504 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32505 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32506 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32507 @end smallexample
32508
32509 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32510 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32511 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32512
32513 @node Registering Code
32514 @section Registering Code
32515
32516 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32517
32518 @itemize @bullet
32519 @item
32520 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32521 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32522
32523 @item
32524 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32525 file.
32526
32527 @item
32528 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32529
32530 @item
32531 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32532
32533 @item
32534 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32535 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32536 @end itemize
32537
32538 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32539 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32540 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32541 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32542
32543 @node Unregistering Code
32544 @section Unregistering Code
32545
32546 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32547
32548 @itemize @bullet
32549 @item
32550 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32551
32552 @item
32553 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32554
32555 @item
32556 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32557 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32558 @end itemize
32559
32560 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32561 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32562
32563 @node Custom Debug Info
32564 @section Custom Debug Info
32565 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32566 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32567
32568 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32569 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32570 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32571 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32572 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32573 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32574 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32575 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32576 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32577
32578 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32579 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32580 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32581 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32582 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32583 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32584 compiler.
32585
32586 @menu
32587 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32588 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32589 @end menu
32590
32591 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32592 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32593 @kindex jit-reader-load
32594 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32595
32596 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32597 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32598
32599 @table @code
32600 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32601 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32602 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32603 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32604 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32605 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32606 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32607
32608 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32609 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32610 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32611 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32612 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32613
32614 @item jit-reader-unload
32615 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32616
32617 @end table
32618
32619 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32620 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32621 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32622
32623 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32624 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32625
32626 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32627 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32628 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32629 the system include directory.
32630
32631 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32632 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32633 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32634
32635 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32636 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32637
32638 @findex gdb_init_reader
32639 @smallexample
32640 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32641 @end smallexample
32642
32643 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32644
32645 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32646 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32647 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32648 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32649 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32650 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32651
32652 @smallexample
32653 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32654 @{
32655 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32656 int reader_version;
32657
32658 /* For use by the reader. */
32659 void *priv_data;
32660
32661 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32662 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32663 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32664 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32665 @};
32666 @end smallexample
32667
32668 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32669 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32670
32671 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32672 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32673 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32674 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32675 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32676 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32677 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32678 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32679 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32680 target's address space.
32681
32682 @node In-Process Agent
32683 @chapter In-Process Agent
32684 @cindex debugging agent
32685 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32686 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32687 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32688 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32689 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32690 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32691 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32692 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32693 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32694 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32695 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32696 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32697 behavior without interrupting it.
32698
32699 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32700 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32701 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32702 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32703 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32704 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32705 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32706 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32707 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32708
32709 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32710 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32711 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32712 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32713
32714 @anchor{Control Agent}
32715 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32716 debugging with the following commands:
32717
32718 @table @code
32719 @kindex set agent on
32720 @item set agent on
32721 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32722 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32723 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32724 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32725 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32726 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32727
32728 @kindex set agent off
32729 @item set agent off
32730 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32731 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32732
32733 @kindex show agent
32734 @item show agent
32735 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32736 the in-process agent.
32737 @end table
32738
32739 @menu
32740 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32741 @end menu
32742
32743 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32744 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32745 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32746
32747 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32748 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32749 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32750 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32751 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32752 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32753 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32754 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32755 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32756
32757 @menu
32758 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32759 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32760 @end menu
32761
32762 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32763 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32764 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32765
32766 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32767 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32768
32769 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32770 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32771 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32772 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32773
32774 @enumerate
32775 @item
32776 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32777 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32778 @item
32779 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32780 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32781 the other one.
32782 @end enumerate
32783
32784 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32785
32786 @enumerate
32787 @item
32788 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32789 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32790 @anchor{agent expression object}
32791 @item
32792 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32793 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32794 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32795 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32796 @item
32797 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32798 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32799
32800 @end enumerate
32801
32802 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32803 object:
32804
32805 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32806 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32807 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32808 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32809 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32810 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32811 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32812 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32813 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32814 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32815 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32816 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32817 memory address for collecting.
32818 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32819 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32820 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32821 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32822 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32823 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32824 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32825 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32826 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32827 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32828 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32829 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32830 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32831 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32832 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32833 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32834 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32835 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32836 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32837 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32838 @ref{agent expression object}
32839 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32840 @ref{agent expression object}
32841 @item actions @tab variable
32842 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32843 @end multitable
32844
32845 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32846 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32847 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32848
32849 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32850 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32851
32852 @table @samp
32853
32854 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32855 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32856 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32857 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32858 in IPA finally.
32859
32860 Replies:
32861 @table @samp
32862 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32863 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32864 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32865 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32866 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32867 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32868 @item E @var{NN}
32869 for an error
32870
32871 @end table
32872
32873 @item close
32874 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32875 is about to kill inferiors.
32876
32877 @item qTfSTM
32878 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32879 @item qTsSTM
32880 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32881 @item qTSTMat
32882 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32883 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32884 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32885
32886 Replies:
32887 @table @samp
32888 @item E @var{NN}
32889 for an error
32890 @end table
32891 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32892 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32893 @end table
32894
32895 @node GDB Bugs
32896 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32897 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32898 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32899
32900 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32901
32902 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32903 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32904 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32905 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32906
32907 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32908 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32909
32910 @menu
32911 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32912 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32913 @end menu
32914
32915 @node Bug Criteria
32916 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32917 @cindex bug criteria
32918
32919 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32920
32921 @itemize @bullet
32922 @cindex fatal signal
32923 @cindex debugger crash
32924 @cindex crash of debugger
32925 @item
32926 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32927 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32928
32929 @cindex error on valid input
32930 @item
32931 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32932 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32933 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32934
32935 @cindex invalid input
32936 @item
32937 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32938 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32939 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32940 for traditional practice''.
32941
32942 @item
32943 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32944 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32945 @end itemize
32946
32947 @node Bug Reporting
32948 @section How to Report Bugs
32949 @cindex bug reports
32950 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32951
32952 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32953 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32954 contact that organization first.
32955
32956 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32957 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32958 distribution.
32959 @c should add a web page ref...
32960
32961 @ifset BUGURL
32962 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32963 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32964 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32965 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32966 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32967 be used.
32968
32969 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32970 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32971 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32972 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32973
32974 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32975 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32976 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32977 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32978 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32979 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32980 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32981 bug reports to the mailing list.
32982 @end ifset
32983 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32984 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32985 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32986 @end ifclear
32987 @end ifset
32988
32989 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32990 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32991 fact or leave it out, state it!
32992
32993 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32994 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32995 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32996 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32997 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32998 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32999 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33000 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33001 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33002
33003 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33004 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33005 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33006 self-contained.
33007
33008 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33009 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33010 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33011 bugs properly.
33012
33013 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33014
33015 @itemize @bullet
33016 @item
33017 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33018 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33019 version}.
33020
33021 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33022 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33023
33024 @item
33025 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33026 version number.
33027
33028 @item
33029 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33030 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33031 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33032 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33033
33034 @item
33035 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33036 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33037
33038 @item
33039 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33040 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33041 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33042 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33043 those compilers.
33044
33045 @item
33046 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33047 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33048 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33049 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33050
33051 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33052 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33053
33054 @item
33055 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33056 reproduce the bug.
33057
33058 @item
33059 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33060 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33061
33062 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33063 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33064 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33065 a chance to make a mistake.
33066
33067 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33068 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33069 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33070 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33071 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33072 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33073 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33074 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33075
33076 @pindex script
33077 @cindex recording a session script
33078 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33079 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33080 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33081 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33082
33083 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33084 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33085
33086 @item
33087 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33088 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33089 it by context, not by line number.
33090
33091 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33092 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33093
33094 @end itemize
33095
33096 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33097
33098 @itemize @bullet
33099 @item
33100 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33101
33102 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33103 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33104 changes will not affect it.
33105
33106 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33107 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33108 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33109 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33110
33111 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33112 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33113 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33114 less time, and so on.
33115
33116 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33117 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33118
33119 @item
33120 A patch for the bug.
33121
33122 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33123 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33124 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33125 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33126
33127 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33128 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33129 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33130 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33131
33132 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33133 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33134 help us to understand.
33135
33136 @item
33137 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33138
33139 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33140 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33141 @end itemize
33142
33143 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33144 @c and consists of the two following files:
33145 @c rluser.texi
33146 @c hsuser.texi
33147 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33148 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33149 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33150 @include rluser.texi
33151 @include hsuser.texi
33152 @end ifclear
33153
33154 @node In Memoriam
33155 @appendix In Memoriam
33156
33157 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33158 contributors:
33159
33160 @table @code
33161 @item Fred Fish
33162 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33163 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33164 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33165
33166 @item Michael Snyder
33167 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33168 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33169 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33170 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33171 @end table
33172
33173 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33174 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33175
33176 @node Formatting Documentation
33177 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33178
33179 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33180 @cindex reference card
33181 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33182 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33183 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33184 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33185 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33186 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33187
33188 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33189 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33190
33191 @smallexample
33192 make refcard.dvi
33193 @end smallexample
33194
33195 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33196 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33197 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33198 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33199 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33200
33201 @cindex documentation
33202
33203 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33204 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33205 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33206 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33207 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33208 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33209
33210 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33211 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33212 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33213 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33214 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33215 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33216 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33217 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33218
33219 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33220 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33221 @code{makeinfo}.
33222
33223 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33224 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33225 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33226
33227 @smallexample
33228 cd gdb
33229 make gdb.info
33230 @end smallexample
33231
33232 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33233 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33234 Texinfo definitions file.
33235
33236 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33237 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33238 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33239 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33240 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33241 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33242 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33243
33244 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33245 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33246 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33247 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33248 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33249 directory.
33250
33251 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33252 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33253 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33254 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33255
33256 @smallexample
33257 make gdb.dvi
33258 @end smallexample
33259
33260 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33261
33262 @node Installing GDB
33263 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33264 @cindex installation
33265
33266 @menu
33267 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33268 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33269 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33270 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33271 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33272 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33273 @end menu
33274
33275 @node Requirements
33276 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33277 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33278
33279 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33280 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33281
33282 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33283 @table @asis
33284 @item ISO C90 compiler
33285 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33286 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33287
33288 @end table
33289
33290 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33291 @table @asis
33292 @item Expat
33293 @anchor{Expat}
33294 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33295 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33296 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33297 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33298 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33299 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33300
33301 Expat is used for:
33302
33303 @itemize @bullet
33304 @item
33305 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33306 @item
33307 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33308 @item
33309 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33310 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33311 @item
33312 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33313 @item
33314 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33315 @item
33316 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33317 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33318 @end itemize
33319
33320 @item zlib
33321 @cindex compressed debug sections
33322 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33323 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33324 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33325 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33326 information in such binaries.
33327
33328 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33329 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33330 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33331
33332 @item iconv
33333 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33334 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33335 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33336 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33337
33338 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33339 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33340 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33341 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33342
33343 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33344 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33345 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33346
33347 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33348 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33349 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33350 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33351 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33352 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33353 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33354 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33355 @end table
33356
33357 @node Running Configure
33358 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33359 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33360 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33361 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33362 build the @code{gdb} program.
33363 @iftex
33364 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33365 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33366 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33367 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33368 @end iftex
33369
33370 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33371 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33372 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33373
33374 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33375 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33376
33377 @table @code
33378 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33379 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33380
33381 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33382 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33383
33384 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33385 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33386
33387 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33388 @sc{gnu} include files
33389
33390 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33391 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33392
33393 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33394 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33395
33396 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33397 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33398
33399 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33400 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33401
33402 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33403 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33404 @end table
33405
33406 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33407 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33408 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33409
33410 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33411 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33412 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33413 argument.
33414
33415 For example:
33416
33417 @smallexample
33418 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33419 ./configure @var{host}
33420 make
33421 @end smallexample
33422
33423 @noindent
33424 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33425 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33426 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33427 correct value by examining your system.)
33428
33429 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33430 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33431 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33432 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33433
33434 @need 750
33435 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33436 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33437 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33438
33439 @smallexample
33440 sh configure @var{host}
33441 @end smallexample
33442
33443 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33444 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33445 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33446 @file{configure}
33447 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33448 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33449
33450 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33451 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33452 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33453 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33454 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33455 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33456 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33457 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33458 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33459
33460 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33461 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33462 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33463 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33464 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33465
33466 @node Separate Objdir
33467 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33468
33469 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33470 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33471 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33472 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33473 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33474 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33475 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33476 program specified there.
33477
33478 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33479 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33480 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33481 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33482 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33483 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33484
33485 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33486 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33487
33488 @smallexample
33489 @group
33490 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33491 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33492 cd ../gdb-sun4
33493 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33494 make
33495 @end group
33496 @end smallexample
33497
33498 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33499 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33500 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33501 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33502 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33503 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33504
33505 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33506 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33507 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33508 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33509 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33510
33511 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33512 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33513 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33514 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33515 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33516 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33517
33518 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33519 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33520 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33521
33522 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33523 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33524 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33525 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33526 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33527
33528 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33529 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33530 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33531 with each other.
33532
33533 @node Config Names
33534 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33535
33536 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33537 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33538 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33539 of information in the following pattern:
33540
33541 @smallexample
33542 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33543 @end smallexample
33544
33545 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33546 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33547 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33548
33549 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33550 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33551 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33552 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33553 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33554 abbreviations---for example:
33555
33556 @smallexample
33557 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33558 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33559 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33560 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33561 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33562 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33563 % sh config.sub sun4
33564 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33565 % sh config.sub sun3
33566 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33567 % sh config.sub i986v
33568 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33569 @end smallexample
33570
33571 @noindent
33572 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33573 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33574
33575 @node Configure Options
33576 @section @file{configure} Options
33577
33578 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33579 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33580 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33581 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33582
33583 @smallexample
33584 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33585 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33586 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33587 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33588 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33589 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33590 @var{host}
33591 @end smallexample
33592
33593 @noindent
33594 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33595 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33596 @samp{--}.
33597
33598 @table @code
33599 @item --help
33600 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33601
33602 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33603 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33604 @file{@var{dir}}.
33605
33606 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33607 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33608 @file{@var{dir}}.
33609
33610 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33611 @need 2000
33612 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33613 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33614 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33615 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33616 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33617 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33618 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33619 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33620 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33621 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33622 @var{dirname}.
33623
33624 @item --norecursion
33625 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33626 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33627
33628 @item --target=@var{target}
33629 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33630 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33631 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33632
33633 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33634
33635 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33636 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33637
33638 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33639 @end table
33640
33641 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33642 needed for special purposes only.
33643
33644 @node System-wide configuration
33645 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33646 @cindex system-wide init file
33647
33648 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33649 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33650 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33651
33652 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33653
33654 @table @code
33655 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33656 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33657 @var{file}.
33658 @end table
33659
33660 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33661 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33662
33663 @itemize @bullet
33664 @item
33665 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33666 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33667 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33668 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33669 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33670 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33671
33672 @item
33673 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33674 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33675 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33676 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33677 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33678 @end itemize
33679
33680 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33681 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33682 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33683 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33684 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33685 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33686 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33687 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33688 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33689 reread.
33690
33691 @menu
33692 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33693 @end menu
33694
33695 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33696 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33697 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33698
33699 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33700 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33701 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33702 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33703 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33704 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33705
33706 The following scripts are currently available:
33707 @itemize @bullet
33708
33709 @item @file{elinos.py}
33710 @pindex elinos.py
33711 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33712 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33713 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33714 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33715 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33716 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33717
33718 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33719 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33720 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33721 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33722 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33723 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33724
33725 @end itemize
33726
33727 @node Maintenance Commands
33728 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33729 @cindex maintenance commands
33730 @cindex internal commands
33731
33732 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33733 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33734 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33735 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33736 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33737
33738 @table @code
33739 @kindex maint agent
33740 @kindex maint agent-eval
33741 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33742 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33743 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33744 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33745 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33746 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33747 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33748 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33749 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33750 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33751 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33752 addition and return the sum.
33753 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33754 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33755
33756 @kindex maint agent-printf
33757 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33758 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33759 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33760 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33761 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33762
33763 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33764 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33765 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33766 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33767 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33768 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33769 is shown:
33770
33771 @table @code
33772 @item breakpoint
33773 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33774
33775 @item watchpoint
33776 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33777
33778 @item longjmp
33779 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33780 @code{longjmp} calls.
33781
33782 @item longjmp resume
33783 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33784
33785 @item until
33786 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33787
33788 @item finish
33789 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33790
33791 @item shlib events
33792 Shared library events.
33793
33794 @end table
33795
33796 @kindex maint info bfds
33797 @item maint info bfds
33798 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33799 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33800
33801 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33802 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33803 @cindex displaced stepping support
33804 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33805 @item set displaced-stepping
33806 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33807 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33808 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33809 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33810 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33811 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33812
33813 @table @code
33814 @item set displaced-stepping on
33815 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33816 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33817
33818 @item set displaced-stepping off
33819 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33820 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33821
33822 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33823 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33824 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33825 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33826 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33827 @end table
33828
33829 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33830 @item maint check-psymtabs
33831 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33832 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33833
33834 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33835 @item maint check-symtabs
33836 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33837
33838 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33839 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33840 Expand symbol tables.
33841 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33842 names matching @var{regexp}.
33843
33844 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33845 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33846 @cindex demangler crashes
33847 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33848 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33849 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33850 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33851 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33852 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33853 option to terminate the current session.
33854
33855 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33856 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33857 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33858
33859 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33860 @item maint cplus namespace
33861 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33862
33863 @kindex maint deprecate
33864 @kindex maint undeprecate
33865 @cindex deprecated commands
33866 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33867 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33868 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33869 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33870 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33871 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33872 the replacement as part of the warning.
33873
33874 @kindex maint dump-me
33875 @item maint dump-me
33876 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33877 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33878 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33879 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33880
33881 @kindex maint internal-error
33882 @kindex maint internal-warning
33883 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33884 @cindex demangler crashes
33885 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33886 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33887 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33888
33889 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33890 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33891 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
33892 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33893 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33894 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33895 @value{GDBN} session.
33896
33897 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33898 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33899
33900 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33901
33902 @smallexample
33903 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33904 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33905 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33906 debugging may prove unreliable.
33907 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33908 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33909 (@value{GDBP})
33910 @end smallexample
33911
33912 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33913 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33914 @cindex demangler crashes
33915
33916 @kindex maint set internal-error
33917 @kindex maint show internal-error
33918 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33919 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33920 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33921 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33922 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33923 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33924 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33925 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33926 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33927 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33928 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33929 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33930 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33931 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33932 described in the table below.
33933
33934 @table @samp
33935 @item quit
33936 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33937 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33938
33939 @item corefile
33940 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33941 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33942 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33943 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33944 disabled.
33945 @end table
33946
33947 @kindex maint packet
33948 @item maint packet @var{text}
33949 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33950 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33951 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33952 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33953 checksum.
33954
33955 @kindex maint print architecture
33956 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33957 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33958 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33959
33960 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33961 @item maint print c-tdesc
33962 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33963 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33964 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33965
33966 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33967 @item maint print dummy-frames
33968 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33969
33970 @smallexample
33971 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33972 @dots{}
33973 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33974 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33975 58 return (a + b);
33976 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33977 @dots{}
33978 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33979 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33980 (@value{GDBP})
33981 @end smallexample
33982
33983 Takes an optional file parameter.
33984
33985 @kindex maint print registers
33986 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33987 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33988 @kindex maint print register-groups
33989 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33990 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33991 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33992 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33993 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33994 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33995 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33996
33997 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33998 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33999 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34000 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34001 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34002 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34003 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34004 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34005
34006 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34007 write the information.
34008
34009 @kindex maint print reggroups
34010 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34011 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34012 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34013 information.
34014
34015 The register groups info looks like this:
34016
34017 @smallexample
34018 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34019 Group Type
34020 general user
34021 float user
34022 all user
34023 vector user
34024 system user
34025 save internal
34026 restore internal
34027 @end smallexample
34028
34029 @kindex flushregs
34030 @item flushregs
34031 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34032
34033 @kindex maint print objfiles
34034 @cindex info for known object files
34035 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34036 Print a dump of all known object files.
34037 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34038 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34039 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34040
34041 @kindex maint print user-registers
34042 @cindex user registers
34043 @item maint print user-registers
34044 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34045 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34046 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34047 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34048 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34049 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34050 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34051
34052 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34053 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34054 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34055 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34056 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34057 matching @var{regexp}.
34058 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34059 and the full path if known.
34060 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34061
34062 @kindex maint print statistics
34063 @cindex bcache statistics
34064 @item maint print statistics
34065 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34066 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34067 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34068 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34069 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34070 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34071 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34072 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34073 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34074 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34075 lengths.
34076
34077 @kindex maint print target-stack
34078 @cindex target stack description
34079 @item maint print target-stack
34080 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34081 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34082 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34083 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34084 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34085 address.
34086
34087 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34088 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34089
34090 @kindex maint print type
34091 @cindex type chain of a data type
34092 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34093 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34094 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34095 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34096 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34097 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34098
34099 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34100 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34101 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34102 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34103 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34104 information.
34105
34106 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34107 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34108 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34109 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34110 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34111 always see the disassembly form.
34112
34113 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34114
34115 @smallexample
34116 (gdb) info addr argc
34117 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34118 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34119 @end smallexample
34120
34121 For more information on these expressions, see
34122 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34123
34124 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34125 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34126 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34127 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34128 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
34129
34130 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
34131 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34132 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
34133 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34134 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34135 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34136 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34137 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34138 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34139
34140 @kindex maint set profile
34141 @kindex maint show profile
34142 @cindex profiling GDB
34143 @item maint set profile
34144 @itemx maint show profile
34145 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34146
34147 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34148 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34149 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34150 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34151 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34152 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34153 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34154
34155 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34156 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34157
34158 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34159 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34160 @cindex hardware debug registers
34161 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34162 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34163 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34164 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34165 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34166 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34167 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34168
34169 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34170 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34171 @item maint set show-all-tib
34172 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34173 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34174 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34175 command.
34176
34177 @kindex maint set target-async
34178 @kindex maint show target-async
34179 @item maint set target-async
34180 @itemx maint show target-async
34181 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34182 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34183 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34184 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34185
34186 @kindex maint set per-command
34187 @kindex maint show per-command
34188 @item maint set per-command
34189 @itemx maint show per-command
34190 @cindex resources used by commands
34191
34192 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34193 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34194
34195 @table @code
34196 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34197 @itemx maint show per-command space
34198 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34199 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34200 took, following the command's own output.
34201 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34202 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34203
34204 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34205 @itemx maint show per-command time
34206 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34207 for each command.
34208 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34209 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34210 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34211 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34212 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34213 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34214 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34215 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34216 spent by the program been debugged.
34217 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34218 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34219
34220 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34221 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34222 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34223 for each command.
34224 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34225
34226 @enumerate a
34227 @item
34228 number of symbol tables
34229 @item
34230 number of primary symbol tables
34231 @item
34232 number of blocks in the blockvector
34233 @end enumerate
34234 @end table
34235
34236 @kindex maint space
34237 @cindex memory used by commands
34238 @item maint space @var{value}
34239 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34240 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34241
34242 @kindex maint time
34243 @cindex time of command execution
34244 @item maint time @var{value}
34245 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34246 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34247
34248 @kindex maint translate-address
34249 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34250 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34251 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34252 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34253 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34254 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34255 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34256
34257 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34258 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34259 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34260
34261 @end table
34262
34263 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34264 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34265
34266 @table @code
34267 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34268 @kindex set watchdog
34269 @cindex watchdog timer
34270 @cindex timeout for commands
34271 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34272 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34273 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34274
34275 @item show watchdog
34276 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34277 @end table
34278
34279 @node Remote Protocol
34280 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34281
34282 @menu
34283 * Overview::
34284 * Packets::
34285 * Stop Reply Packets::
34286 * General Query Packets::
34287 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34288 * Tracepoint Packets::
34289 * Host I/O Packets::
34290 * Interrupts::
34291 * Notification Packets::
34292 * Remote Non-Stop::
34293 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34294 * Examples::
34295 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34296 * Library List Format::
34297 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34298 * Memory Map Format::
34299 * Thread List Format::
34300 * Traceframe Info Format::
34301 * Branch Trace Format::
34302 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34303 @end menu
34304
34305 @node Overview
34306 @section Overview
34307
34308 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34309 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34310 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34311 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34312
34313 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34314 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34315
34316 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34317 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34318 @cindex remote serial protocol
34319 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34320 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34321 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34322 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34323 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34324
34325 @smallexample
34326 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34327 @end smallexample
34328 @noindent
34329
34330 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34331 @noindent
34332 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34333 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34334 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34335
34336 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34337 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34338
34339 @smallexample
34340 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34341 @end smallexample
34342
34343 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34344 @noindent
34345 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34346 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34347 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34348
34349 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34350 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34351 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34352 retransmission):
34353
34354 @smallexample
34355 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34356 <- @code{+}
34357 @end smallexample
34358 @noindent
34359
34360 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34361 once a connection is established.
34362 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34363
34364 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34365 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34366 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34367 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34368 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34369 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34370 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34371
34372 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34373 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34374 exceptions).
34375
34376 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34377 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34378 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34379 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34380
34381 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34382 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34383 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34384
34385 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34386 @anchor{Binary Data}
34387 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34388 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34389 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34390 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34391 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34392 binary data.
34393
34394 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34395 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34396 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34397 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34398 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34399 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34400 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34401 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34402 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34403 (described next).
34404
34405 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34406 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34407 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34408 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34409 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34410 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34411 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34412 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34413 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34414 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34415 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34416 3}} more times.
34417
34418 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34419 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34420 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34421 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34422 @samp{0*"00}.
34423
34424 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34425 error number. That number is not well defined.
34426
34427 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34428 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34429 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34430 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34431 on that response.
34432
34433 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34434 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34435 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34436 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34437 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34438 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34439
34440 @node Packets
34441 @section Packets
34442
34443 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34444 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34445 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34446 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34447
34448 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34449 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34450 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34451 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34452 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34453 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34454 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34455 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34456 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34457 @var{baz}.
34458
34459 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34460 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34461 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34462 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34463 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34464 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34465 pick any thread.
34466
34467 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34468 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34469 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34470 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34471 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34472 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34473 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34474 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34475 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34476 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34477 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34478 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34479 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34480
34481 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34482 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34483 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34484 more information.
34485
34486 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34487 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34488
34489 Here are the packet descriptions.
34490
34491 @table @samp
34492
34493 @item !
34494 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34495 @anchor{extended mode}
34496 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34497 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34498 debugged.
34499
34500 Reply:
34501 @table @samp
34502 @item OK
34503 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34504 @end table
34505
34506 @item ?
34507 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34508 @anchor{? packet}
34509 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34510 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34511 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34512
34513 Reply:
34514 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34515
34516 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34517 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34518 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34519 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34520 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34521
34522 Reply:
34523 @table @samp
34524 @item OK
34525 The arguments were set.
34526 @item E @var{NN}
34527 An error occurred.
34528 @end table
34529
34530 @item b @var{baud}
34531 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34532 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34533 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34534
34535 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34536 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34537 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34538
34539 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34540 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34541 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34542 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34543 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34544
34545 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34546 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34547 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34548 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34549
34550 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34551 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34552
34553 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34554 @anchor{bc}
34555 @item bc
34556 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34557 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34558
34559 Reply:
34560 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34561
34562 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34563 @anchor{bs}
34564 @item bs
34565 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34566 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34567
34568 Reply:
34569 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34570
34571 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34572 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34573 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34574 is omitted, resume at current address.
34575
34576 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34577 packet}.
34578
34579 Reply:
34580 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34581
34582 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34583 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34584 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34585 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34586
34587 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34588 packet}.
34589
34590 Reply:
34591 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34592
34593 @item d
34594 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34595 Toggle debug flag.
34596
34597 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34598 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34599
34600 @item D
34601 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34602 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34603 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34604 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34605 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34606
34607 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34608 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34609 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34610 big-endian hex string.
34611
34612 Reply:
34613 @table @samp
34614 @item OK
34615 for success
34616 @item E @var{NN}
34617 for an error
34618 @end table
34619
34620 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34621 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34622 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34623 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34624 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34625
34626 @item g
34627 @anchor{read registers packet}
34628 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34629 Read general registers.
34630
34631 Reply:
34632 @table @samp
34633 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34634 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34635 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34636 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34637 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34638 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34639 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34640
34641 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34642 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34643 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34644 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34645 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34646 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34647 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34648 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34649
34650 @smallexample
34651 -> @code{g}
34652 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34653 @end smallexample
34654
34655 @item E @var{NN}
34656 for an error.
34657 @end table
34658
34659 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34660 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34661 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34662 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34663
34664 Reply:
34665 @table @samp
34666 @item OK
34667 for success
34668 @item E @var{NN}
34669 for an error
34670 @end table
34671
34672 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34673 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34674 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34675 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34676 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34677 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34678 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34679 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34680 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34681
34682 Reply:
34683 @table @samp
34684 @item OK
34685 for success
34686 @item E @var{NN}
34687 for an error
34688 @end table
34689
34690 @c FIXME: JTC:
34691 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34692 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34693 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34694 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34695 @c described. For example:
34696 @c
34697 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34698 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34699 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34700 @c
34701 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34702 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34703 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34704
34705 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34706 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34707 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34708 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34709 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34710 step starting at that address.
34711
34712 @item I
34713 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34714 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34715 step packet}.
34716
34717 @item k
34718 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34719 Kill request.
34720
34721 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34722
34723 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34724 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34725
34726 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34727
34728 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34729 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34730 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34731
34732 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34733 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34734 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34735
34736 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34737 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34738 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34739 (@pxref{? packet}).
34740
34741 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34742 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34743 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34744 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34745
34746 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34747 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34748 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34749 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34750 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34751 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34752 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34753 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34754
34755 Reply:
34756 @table @samp
34757 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34758 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34759 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34760 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34761 @item E @var{NN}
34762 @var{NN} is errno
34763 @end table
34764
34765 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34766 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34767 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34768 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34769 hexadecimal number.
34770
34771 Reply:
34772 @table @samp
34773 @item OK
34774 for success
34775 @item E @var{NN}
34776 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34777 written).
34778 @end table
34779
34780 @item p @var{n}
34781 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34782 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34783 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34784 register value is encoded.
34785
34786 Reply:
34787 @table @samp
34788 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34789 the register's value
34790 @item E @var{NN}
34791 for an error
34792 @item @w{}
34793 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34794 @end table
34795
34796 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34797 @anchor{write register packet}
34798 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34799 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34800 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34801 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34802
34803 Reply:
34804 @table @samp
34805 @item OK
34806 for success
34807 @item E @var{NN}
34808 for an error
34809 @end table
34810
34811 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34812 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34813 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34814 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34815 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34816 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34817
34818 @item r
34819 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34820 Reset the entire system.
34821
34822 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34823
34824 @item R @var{XX}
34825 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34826 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34827 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34828
34829 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34830
34831 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34832 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34833 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34834 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34835
34836 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34837 packet}.
34838
34839 Reply:
34840 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34841
34842 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34843 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34844 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34845 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34846 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34847
34848 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34849 packet}.
34850
34851 Reply:
34852 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34853
34854 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34855 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34856 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34857 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34858 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34859
34860 @item T @var{thread-id}
34861 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34862 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34863
34864 Reply:
34865 @table @samp
34866 @item OK
34867 thread is still alive
34868 @item E @var{NN}
34869 thread is dead
34870 @end table
34871
34872 @item v
34873 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34874 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34875
34876 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34877 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34878 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34879 The process ID is a
34880 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34881 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34882 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34883
34884 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34885 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34886 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34887 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34888 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34889 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34890 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34891 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34892
34893 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34894
34895 Reply:
34896 @table @samp
34897 @item E @var{nn}
34898 for an error
34899 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34900 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34901 @item OK
34902 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34903 @end table
34904
34905 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34906 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34907 @anchor{vCont packet}
34908 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34909 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34910 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34911 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34912 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34913 Specifying multiple
34914 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34915 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34916
34917 Currently supported actions are:
34918
34919 @table @samp
34920 @item c
34921 Continue.
34922 @item C @var{sig}
34923 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34924 @item s
34925 Step.
34926 @item S @var{sig}
34927 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34928 @item t
34929 Stop.
34930 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34931 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34932 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34933 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34934 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34935 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34936
34937 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34938 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34939 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34940 jumps to @var{start}).
34941
34942 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34943 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34944 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34945
34946 @end table
34947
34948 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34949 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34950 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34951
34952 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34953 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34954 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34955 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34956 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34957 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34958 as an implementation detail.
34959
34960 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34961 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34962 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34963 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34964 @var{thread-id}.
34965
34966 Reply:
34967 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34968
34969 @item vCont?
34970 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34971 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34972
34973 Reply:
34974 @table @samp
34975 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34976 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34977 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34978 @item @w{}
34979 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34980 @end table
34981
34982 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34983 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34984 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34985 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34986
34987 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34988 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34989 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34990 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34991 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34992 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34993 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34994 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34995 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34996 packet is received.
34997
34998 Reply:
34999 @table @samp
35000 @item OK
35001 for success
35002 @item E @var{NN}
35003 for an error
35004 @end table
35005
35006 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35007 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35008 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35009 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35010 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35011 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35012 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35013 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35014 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35015 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35016 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35017 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35018
35019
35020 Reply:
35021 @table @samp
35022 @item OK
35023 for success
35024 @item E.memtype
35025 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35026 @item E @var{NN}
35027 for an error
35028 @end table
35029
35030 @item vFlashDone
35031 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35032 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35033 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35034 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35035 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35036 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35037 request is completed.
35038
35039 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35040 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35041 @anchor{vKill packet}
35042 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35043 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35044 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35045 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35046
35047 Reply:
35048 @table @samp
35049 @item E @var{nn}
35050 for an error
35051 @item OK
35052 for success
35053 @end table
35054
35055 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35056 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35057 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35058 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35059 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35060 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35061 state.
35062
35063 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35064
35065 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35066
35067 Reply:
35068 @table @samp
35069 @item E @var{nn}
35070 for an error
35071 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35072 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35073 @end table
35074
35075 @item vStopped
35076 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35077 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35078
35079 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35080 @anchor{X packet}
35081 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35082 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35083 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
35084 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35085
35086 Reply:
35087 @table @samp
35088 @item OK
35089 for success
35090 @item E @var{NN}
35091 for an error
35092 @end table
35093
35094 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35095 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35096 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35097 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35098 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35099 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35100 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35101
35102 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35103 separately.
35104
35105 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35106 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35107 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35108 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35109 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35110 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35111
35112 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35113 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35114 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35115 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35116 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35117 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35118
35119 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35120 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35121 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35122 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35123 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35124 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35125 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35126 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35127 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35128 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35129
35130 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35131 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35132
35133 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35134 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35135
35136 @table @samp
35137
35138 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35139 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35140 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35141
35142 @end table
35143
35144 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35145 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35146 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35147 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35148 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35149 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35150 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35151
35152 @table @samp
35153
35154 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35155 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35156 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35157
35158 @end table
35159
35160 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35161
35162 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35163 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35164 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35165 target, is not defined.}
35166
35167 Reply:
35168 @table @samp
35169 @item OK
35170 success
35171 @item @w{}
35172 not supported
35173 @item E @var{NN}
35174 for an error
35175 @end table
35176
35177 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35178 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35179 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35180 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35181 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35182 address @var{addr}.
35183
35184 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35185 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35186 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35187
35188 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35189 movement.}
35190
35191 Reply:
35192 @table @samp
35193 @item OK
35194 success
35195 @item @w{}
35196 not supported
35197 @item E @var{NN}
35198 for an error
35199 @end table
35200
35201 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35202 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35203 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35204 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35205 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35206 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35207
35208 Reply:
35209 @table @samp
35210 @item OK
35211 success
35212 @item @w{}
35213 not supported
35214 @item E @var{NN}
35215 for an error
35216 @end table
35217
35218 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35219 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35220 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35221 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35222 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35223 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35224
35225 Reply:
35226 @table @samp
35227 @item OK
35228 success
35229 @item @w{}
35230 not supported
35231 @item E @var{NN}
35232 for an error
35233 @end table
35234
35235 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35236 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35237 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35238 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35239 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35240 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35241
35242 Reply:
35243 @table @samp
35244 @item OK
35245 success
35246 @item @w{}
35247 not supported
35248 @item E @var{NN}
35249 for an error
35250 @end table
35251
35252 @end table
35253
35254 @node Stop Reply Packets
35255 @section Stop Reply Packets
35256 @cindex stop reply packets
35257
35258 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35259 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35260 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35261 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35262 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35263 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35264 @value{GDBN} source code.
35265
35266 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35267 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35268 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35269 components.
35270
35271 @table @samp
35272
35273 @item S @var{AA}
35274 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35275 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35276 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35277
35278 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35279 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35280 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35281 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35282 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35283 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35284 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35285 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35286
35287 @itemize @bullet
35288 @item
35289 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35290 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35291 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35292 two-digit hex number.
35293
35294 @item
35295 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35296 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35297
35298 @item
35299 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35300 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35301
35302 @item
35303 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35304 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35305 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35306 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35307
35308 @item
35309 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35310 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35311 future.
35312 @end itemize
35313
35314 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35315
35316 @table @samp
35317 @item watch
35318 @itemx rwatch
35319 @itemx awatch
35320 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35321 hex.
35322
35323 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35324 @item library
35325 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35326 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35327 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35328
35329 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35330 @item replaylog
35331 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35332 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35333 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35334 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35335 for more information.
35336
35337 @item swbreak
35338 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35339 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35340 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35341 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35342 part must be left empty.
35343
35344 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35345 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35346 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35347 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35348 address.
35349
35350 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35351 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35352 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35353 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35354 indicating support.
35355
35356 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35357
35358 @item hwbreak
35359 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35360 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35361
35362 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35363 apply.
35364 @end table
35365
35366 @item W @var{AA}
35367 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35368 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35369 applicable to certain targets.
35370
35371 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35372 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35373 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35374 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35375
35376 @item X @var{AA}
35377 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35378 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35379
35380 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35381 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35382 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35383 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35384
35385 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35386 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35387 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35388 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35389 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35390
35391 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35392 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35393 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35394 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35395 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35396 system calls.
35397
35398 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35399 this very system call.
35400
35401 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35402 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35403 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35404 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35405 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35406 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35407
35408 @end table
35409
35410 @node General Query Packets
35411 @section General Query Packets
35412 @cindex remote query requests
35413
35414 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35415 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35416 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35417 sending information to and from the stub.
35418
35419 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35420 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35421 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35422 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35423 conventions:
35424
35425 @itemize @bullet
35426 @item
35427 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35428 @item
35429 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35430 letter.
35431 @item
35432 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35433 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35434 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35435 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35436 @end itemize
35437
35438 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35439 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35440 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35441 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35442 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35443 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35444 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35445 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35446 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35447 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35448 packet.}.
35449
35450 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35451 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35452 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35453 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35454 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35455
35456 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35457
35458 @table @samp
35459
35460 @item QAgent:1
35461 @itemx QAgent:0
35462 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35463 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35464
35465 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35466 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35467 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35468 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35469 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35470 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35471 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35472 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35473 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35474 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35475 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35476
35477 @item qC
35478 @cindex current thread, remote request
35479 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35480 Return the current thread ID.
35481
35482 Reply:
35483 @table @samp
35484 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35485 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35486 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35487 @item @r{(anything else)}
35488 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35489 @end table
35490
35491 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35492 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35493 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35494 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35495 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35496 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35497 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35498 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35499
35500 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35501 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35502 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35503 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35504 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35505 detect trailing zeros.
35506
35507 Reply:
35508 @table @samp
35509 @item E @var{NN}
35510 An error (such as memory fault)
35511 @item C @var{crc32}
35512 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35513 @end table
35514
35515 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35516 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35517 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35518 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35519 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35520 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35521 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35522 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35523 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35524 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35525 randomization.
35526
35527 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35528
35529 Reply:
35530 @table @samp
35531 @item OK
35532 The request succeeded.
35533
35534 @item E @var{nn}
35535 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35536
35537 @item @w{}
35538 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35539 by the stub.
35540 @end table
35541
35542 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35543 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35544 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35545 address space randomization.
35546
35547 @item qfThreadInfo
35548 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35549 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35550 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35551 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35552 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35553 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35554 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35555 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35556 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35557 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35558
35559 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35560
35561 Reply:
35562 @table @samp
35563 @item m @var{thread-id}
35564 A single thread ID
35565 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35566 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35567 @item l
35568 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35569 @end table
35570
35571 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35572 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35573 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35574 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35575 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35576 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35577 fields.
35578
35579 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35580 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35581 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35582 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35583 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35584
35585 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35586 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35587 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35588 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35589 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35590
35591 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35592 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35593
35594 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35595 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35596 information associated with the variable.)
35597
35598 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35599 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35600 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35601 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35602 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35603 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35604
35605 Reply:
35606 @table @samp
35607 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35608 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35609 local storage requested.
35610
35611 @item E @var{nn}
35612 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35613
35614 @item @w{}
35615 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35616 @end table
35617
35618 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35619 @cindex get thread information block address
35620 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35621 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35622
35623 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35624
35625 Reply:
35626 @table @samp
35627 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35628 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35629 thread information block.
35630
35631 @item E @var{nn}
35632 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35633 address could not be retrieved.
35634
35635 @item @w{}
35636 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35637 @end table
35638
35639 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35640 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35641 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35642 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35643 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35644 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35645 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35646
35647 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35648
35649 Reply:
35650 @table @samp
35651 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35652 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35653 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35654 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35655 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35656 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35657 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35658 @end table
35659
35660 @item qOffsets
35661 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35662 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35663 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35664 image.
35665
35666 Reply:
35667 @table @samp
35668 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35669 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35670 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35671 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35672 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35673 segments by the supplied offsets.
35674
35675 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35676 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35677 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35678
35679 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35680 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35681 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35682 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35683 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35684 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35685 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35686 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35687 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35688 @end table
35689
35690 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35691 @cindex thread information, remote request
35692 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35693 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35694 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35695 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35696
35697 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35698 (see below).
35699
35700 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35701
35702 @item QNonStop:1
35703 @itemx QNonStop:0
35704 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35705 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35706 @anchor{QNonStop}
35707 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35708 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35709
35710 Reply:
35711 @table @samp
35712 @item OK
35713 The request succeeded.
35714
35715 @item E @var{nn}
35716 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35717
35718 @item @w{}
35719 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35720 the stub.
35721 @end table
35722
35723 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35724 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35725 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35726 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35727
35728 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35729 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35730 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35731 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35732 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35733 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35734 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35735 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35736 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35737 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35738 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35739 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35740 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35741
35742 Reply:
35743 @table @samp
35744 @item OK
35745 The request succeeded.
35746
35747 @item E @var{nn}
35748 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35749
35750 @item @w{}
35751 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35752 the stub.
35753 @end table
35754
35755 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35756 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35757 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35758 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35759
35760 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35761 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35762 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35763 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35764 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35765 Others should be silently discarded.
35766
35767 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35768 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35769 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35770 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35771 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35772 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35773 signals.
35774
35775 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35776 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35777
35778 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35779 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35780 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35781 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35782 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35783
35784 Reply:
35785 @table @samp
35786 @item OK
35787 The request succeeded.
35788
35789 @item E @var{nn}
35790 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35791
35792 @item @w{}
35793 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35794 by the stub.
35795 @end table
35796
35797 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35798 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35799 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35800 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35801
35802 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35803 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35804 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35805 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35806 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35807 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35808 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35809 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35810 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35811
35812 Reply:
35813 @table @samp
35814 @item OK
35815 A command response with no output.
35816 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35817 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35818 @item E @var{NN}
35819 Indicate a badly formed request.
35820 @item @w{}
35821 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35822 @end table
35823
35824 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35825 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35826 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35827 packets.)
35828
35829 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35830 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35831 @ifnotinfo
35832 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35833 @end ifnotinfo
35834 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35835 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35836 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35837 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35838 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35839
35840 Reply:
35841 @table @samp
35842 @item 0
35843 The pattern was not found.
35844 @item 1,address
35845 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35846 @item E @var{NN}
35847 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35848 @item @w{}
35849 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35850 @end table
35851
35852 @item QStartNoAckMode
35853 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35854 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35855 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35856 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35857
35858 Reply:
35859 @table @samp
35860 @item OK
35861 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35862 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35863 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35864 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35865 @item @w{}
35866 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35867 @end table
35868
35869 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35870 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35871 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35872 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35873 @anchor{qSupported}
35874 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35875 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35876 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35877 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35878 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35879 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35880 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35881 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35882 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35883 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35884 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35885 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35886 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35887 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35888
35889 Reply:
35890 @table @samp
35891 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35892 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35893 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35894 possible forms).
35895 @item @w{}
35896 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35897 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35898 @end table
35899
35900 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35901 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35902 are:
35903
35904 @table @samp
35905 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35906 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35907 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35908 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35909 @item @var{name}+
35910 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35911 need an associated value.
35912 @item @var{name}-
35913 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35914 @item @var{name}?
35915 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35916 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35917 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35918 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35919 @end table
35920
35921 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35922 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35923 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35924 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35925 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35926
35927 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35928 are defined:
35929
35930 @table @samp
35931 @item multiprocess
35932 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35933 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35934 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35935 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35936 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35937
35938 @item xmlRegisters
35939 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35940 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35941 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35942 description.
35943
35944 @item qRelocInsn
35945 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35946 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35947 instruction reply packet}).
35948
35949 @item swbreak
35950 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
35951 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
35952
35953 @item hwbreak
35954 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
35955 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
35956 @end table
35957
35958 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35959 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35960 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35961 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35962 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35963 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35964 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35965 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35966 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35967 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35968 all the features it supports.
35969
35970 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35971 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35972
35973 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35974 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35975 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35976 form response.
35977
35978 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35979 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35980 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35981 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35982
35983 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35984 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35985 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35986 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35987 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35988
35989 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35990
35991 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35992 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35993 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35994 @item Feature Name
35995 @tab Value Required
35996 @tab Default
35997 @tab Probe Allowed
35998
35999 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36000 @tab Yes
36001 @tab @samp{-}
36002 @tab No
36003
36004 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36005 @tab No
36006 @tab @samp{-}
36007 @tab Yes
36008
36009 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36010 @tab No
36011 @tab @samp{-}
36012 @tab Yes
36013
36014 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36015 @tab No
36016 @tab @samp{-}
36017 @tab Yes
36018
36019 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36020 @tab No
36021 @tab @samp{-}
36022 @tab Yes
36023
36024 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36025 @tab No
36026 @tab @samp{-}
36027 @tab Yes
36028
36029 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36030 @tab No
36031 @tab @samp{-}
36032 @tab Yes
36033
36034 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36035 @tab No
36036 @tab @samp{-}
36037 @tab No
36038
36039 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36040 @tab No
36041 @tab @samp{-}
36042 @tab Yes
36043
36044 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36045 @tab No
36046 @tab @samp{-}
36047 @tab Yes
36048
36049 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36050 @tab No
36051 @tab @samp{-}
36052 @tab Yes
36053
36054 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36055 @tab No
36056 @tab @samp{-}
36057 @tab Yes
36058
36059 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36060 @tab No
36061 @tab @samp{-}
36062 @tab Yes
36063
36064 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36065 @tab No
36066 @tab @samp{-}
36067 @tab Yes
36068
36069 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36070 @tab No
36071 @tab @samp{-}
36072 @tab Yes
36073
36074 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36075 @tab No
36076 @tab @samp{-}
36077 @tab Yes
36078
36079 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36080 @tab No
36081 @tab @samp{-}
36082 @tab Yes
36083
36084 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36085 @tab No
36086 @tab @samp{-}
36087 @tab Yes
36088
36089 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36090 @tab Yes
36091 @tab @samp{-}
36092 @tab Yes
36093
36094 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36095 @tab Yes
36096 @tab @samp{-}
36097 @tab Yes
36098
36099 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36100 @tab Yes
36101 @tab @samp{-}
36102 @tab Yes
36103
36104 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36105 @tab No
36106 @tab @samp{-}
36107 @tab Yes
36108
36109 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36110 @tab No
36111 @tab @samp{-}
36112 @tab Yes
36113
36114 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36115 @tab No
36116 @tab @samp{-}
36117 @tab Yes
36118
36119 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36120 @tab No
36121 @tab @samp{-}
36122 @tab No
36123
36124 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36125 @tab No
36126 @tab @samp{-}
36127 @tab No
36128
36129 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36130 @tab No
36131 @tab @samp{-}
36132 @tab No
36133
36134 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36135 @tab No
36136 @tab @samp{-}
36137 @tab No
36138
36139 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36140 @tab No
36141 @tab @samp{-}
36142 @tab No
36143
36144 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36145 @tab No
36146 @tab @samp{-}
36147 @tab No
36148
36149 @item @samp{QAgent}
36150 @tab No
36151 @tab @samp{-}
36152 @tab No
36153
36154 @item @samp{QAllow}
36155 @tab No
36156 @tab @samp{-}
36157 @tab No
36158
36159 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36160 @tab No
36161 @tab @samp{-}
36162 @tab No
36163
36164 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36165 @tab No
36166 @tab @samp{-}
36167 @tab No
36168
36169 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36170 @tab No
36171 @tab @samp{-}
36172 @tab No
36173
36174 @item @samp{tracenz}
36175 @tab No
36176 @tab @samp{-}
36177 @tab No
36178
36179 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36180 @tab No
36181 @tab @samp{-}
36182 @tab No
36183
36184 @item @samp{swbreak}
36185 @tab No
36186 @tab @samp{-}
36187 @tab No
36188
36189 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36190 @tab No
36191 @tab @samp{-}
36192 @tab No
36193
36194 @end multitable
36195
36196 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36197
36198 @table @samp
36199 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36200 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36201 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36202 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36203 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36204 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36205 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36206 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36207 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36208 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36209
36210 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36211 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36212 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36213
36214 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36215 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36216 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36217
36218 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36219 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36220 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36221
36222 @item qXfer:features:read
36223 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36224 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36225
36226 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36227 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36228 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36229
36230 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36231 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36232 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36233
36234 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36235 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36236 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36237 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36238
36239 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36240 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36241 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36242
36243 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36244 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36245 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36246
36247 @item qXfer:spu:read
36248 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36249 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36250
36251 @item qXfer:spu:write
36252 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36253 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36254
36255 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36256 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36257 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36258
36259 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36260 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36261 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36262
36263 @item qXfer:threads:read
36264 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36265 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36266
36267 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36268 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36269 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36270
36271 @item qXfer:uib:read
36272 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36273 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36274
36275 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36276 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36277 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36278
36279 @item QNonStop
36280 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36281 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36282
36283 @item QPassSignals
36284 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36285 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36286
36287 @item QStartNoAckMode
36288 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36289 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36290
36291 @item multiprocess
36292 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36293 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36294 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36295 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36296 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36297 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36298 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36299 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36300 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36301 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36302 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36303
36304 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36305 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36306 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36307
36308 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36309 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36310 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36311 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36312
36313 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36314 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36315 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36316
36317 @item ReverseContinue
36318 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36319 (@pxref{bc}).
36320
36321 @item ReverseStep
36322 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36323 (@pxref{bs}).
36324
36325 @item TracepointSource
36326 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36327 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36328
36329 @item QAgent
36330 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36331
36332 @item QAllow
36333 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36334
36335 @item QDisableRandomization
36336 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36337
36338 @item StaticTracepoint
36339 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36340 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36341
36342 @item InstallInTrace
36343 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36344 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36345
36346 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36347 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36348 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36349 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36350
36351 @item QTBuffer:size
36352 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36353 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36354
36355 @item tracenz
36356 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36357 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36358 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36359
36360 @item BreakpointCommands
36361 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36362 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36363 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36364
36365 @item Qbtrace:off
36366 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36367
36368 @item Qbtrace:bts
36369 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36370
36371 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36372 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36373
36374 @item swbreak
36375 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36376 breakpoints.
36377
36378 @item hwbreak
36379 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36380 breakpoints.
36381
36382 @end table
36383
36384 @item qSymbol::
36385 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36386 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36387 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36388 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36389
36390 Reply:
36391 @table @samp
36392 @item OK
36393 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36394 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36395 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36396 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36397 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36398 below.
36399 @end table
36400
36401 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36402 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36403
36404 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36405 target has previously requested.
36406
36407 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36408 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36409 will be empty.
36410
36411 Reply:
36412 @table @samp
36413 @item OK
36414 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36415 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36416 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36417 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36418 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36419 @end table
36420
36421 @item qTBuffer
36422 @itemx QTBuffer
36423 @itemx QTDisconnected
36424 @itemx QTDP
36425 @itemx QTDPsrc
36426 @itemx QTDV
36427 @itemx qTfP
36428 @itemx qTfV
36429 @itemx QTFrame
36430 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36431
36432 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36433
36434 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36435 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36436 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36437 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36438 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36439 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36440 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36441 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36442 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36443 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36444 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36445
36446 Reply:
36447 @table @samp
36448 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36449 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36450 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36451 the thread's attributes.
36452 @end table
36453
36454 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36455 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36456 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36457 packets.)
36458
36459 @item QTNotes
36460 @itemx qTP
36461 @itemx QTSave
36462 @itemx qTsP
36463 @itemx qTsV
36464 @itemx QTStart
36465 @itemx QTStop
36466 @itemx QTEnable
36467 @itemx QTDisable
36468 @itemx QTinit
36469 @itemx QTro
36470 @itemx qTStatus
36471 @itemx qTV
36472 @itemx qTfSTM
36473 @itemx qTsSTM
36474 @itemx qTSTMat
36475 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36476
36477 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36478 @cindex read special object, remote request
36479 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36480 @anchor{qXfer read}
36481 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36482 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36483 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36484 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36485 additional details about what data to access.
36486
36487 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36488 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36489 formats, listed below.
36490
36491 @table @samp
36492 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36493 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36494 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36495 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36496
36497 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36498 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36499
36500 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36501 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36502
36503 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36504 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36505 packet may have one of the following values:
36506
36507 @table @code
36508 @item all
36509 Returns all available branch trace.
36510
36511 @item new
36512 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36513 the last read request.
36514
36515 @item delta
36516 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36517 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36518 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36519 used to stitch traces together.
36520
36521 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36522 @end table
36523
36524 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36525 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36526
36527 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36528 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36529
36530 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36531 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36532
36533 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36534 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36535
36536 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36537 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36538 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36539 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36540 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36541
36542 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36543 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36544
36545 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36546 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36547 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36548 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36549 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36550
36551 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36552 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36553 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36554
36555 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36556 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36557
36558 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36559 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36560 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36561 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36562 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36563 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36564 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36565 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36566
36567 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36568 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36569
36570 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36571 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36572
36573 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36574 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36575 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36576 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36577
36578 @table @code
36579 @item start=@var{address}
36580 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36581 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36582 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36583 chosen as the starting point.
36584
36585 @item prev=@var{address}
36586 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36587 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36588 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36589 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36590 exists prior to the starting point.
36591
36592 @end table
36593
36594 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36595 ignored.
36596
36597 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36598 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36599 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36600 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36601 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36602
36603 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36604 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36605
36606 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36607 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36608
36609 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36610 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36611 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
36612 Action Lists}.
36613
36614 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36615 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36616 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36617
36618 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36619 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
36620 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36621 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36622 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36623
36624 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36625 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36626 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36627
36628 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36629 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36630 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36631 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36632 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36633 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36634 in that context to be accessed.
36635
36636 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36637 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36638 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36639
36640 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36641 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
36642 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
36643 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36644 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36645
36646 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36647 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36648
36649 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36650 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
36651
36652 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
36653 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
36654 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36655
36656 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36657 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36658
36659 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36660 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
36661
36662 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
36663 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
36664
36665 This packet is not probed by default.
36666
36667 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36668 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
36669 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
36670 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
36671 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
36672
36673 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36674 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36675
36676 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36677 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
36678 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
36679 @xref{Operating System Information}.
36680
36681 @end table
36682
36683 Reply:
36684 @table @samp
36685 @item m @var{data}
36686 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
36687 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
36688 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
36689 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
36690 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
36691 request.
36692
36693 @item l @var{data}
36694 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36695 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36696 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36697
36698 @item l
36699 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36700 There is no more data to be read.
36701
36702 @item E00
36703 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36704
36705 @item E @var{nn}
36706 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36707 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36708
36709 @item @w{}
36710 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36711 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36712 @end table
36713
36714 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36715 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36716 @anchor{qXfer write}
36717 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36718 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36719 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36720 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36721 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36722 to access.
36723
36724 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36725 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36726 formats, listed below.
36727
36728 @table @samp
36729 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36730 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36731 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36732 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36733 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36734
36735 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36736 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36737 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36738
36739 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36740 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36741 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36742 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36743 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36744 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36745 in that context to be accessed.
36746
36747 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36748 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36749 @end table
36750
36751 Reply:
36752 @table @samp
36753 @item @var{nn}
36754 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36755 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36756
36757 @item E00
36758 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36759
36760 @item E @var{nn}
36761 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36762 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36763
36764 @item @w{}
36765 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36766 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36767 @end table
36768
36769 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36770 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36771 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36772 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36773 must respond with an empty packet.
36774
36775 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36776 @cindex query attached, remote request
36777 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36778 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36779 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36780 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36781 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36782 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36783 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36784
36785 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36786 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36787 the @code{quit} command.
36788
36789 Reply:
36790 @table @samp
36791 @item 1
36792 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36793 @item 0
36794 The remote server created a new process.
36795 @item E @var{NN}
36796 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36797 @end table
36798
36799 @item Qbtrace:bts
36800 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36801
36802 Reply:
36803 @table @samp
36804 @item OK
36805 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36806 @item E.errtext
36807 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36808 @end table
36809
36810 @item Qbtrace:off
36811 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36812
36813 Reply:
36814 @table @samp
36815 @item OK
36816 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36817 @item E.errtext
36818 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36819 @end table
36820
36821 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
36822 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
36823 btrace recording method in bts format.
36824
36825 Reply:
36826 @table @samp
36827 @item OK
36828 The ring buffer size has been set.
36829 @item E.errtext
36830 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36831 @end table
36832
36833 @end table
36834
36835 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36836 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36837
36838 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36839 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36840 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36841
36842 @menu
36843 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36844 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36845 @end menu
36846
36847 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36848 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36849
36850 @menu
36851 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36852 @end menu
36853
36854 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36855 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36856 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36857
36858 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36859
36860 @table @r
36861
36862 @item 2
36863 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36864
36865 @item 3
36866 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36867
36868 @item 4
36869 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36870
36871 @end table
36872
36873 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36874 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36875
36876 @menu
36877 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36878 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36879 @end menu
36880
36881 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36882 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36883 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36884
36885 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36886 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36887 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36888 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36889 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36890 most-significant -- least-significant.
36891
36892 @table @r
36893
36894 @item MIPS32
36895 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36896 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36897 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36898
36899 @item MIPS64
36900 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36901 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36902 as @code{MIPS32}.
36903
36904 @end table
36905
36906 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36907 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36908 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36909
36910 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36911
36912 @table @r
36913
36914 @item 2
36915 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36916
36917 @item 3
36918 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36919
36920 @item 4
36921 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36922
36923 @item 5
36924 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36925
36926 @end table
36927
36928 @node Tracepoint Packets
36929 @section Tracepoint Packets
36930 @cindex tracepoint packets
36931 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36932
36933 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36934 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36935
36936 @table @samp
36937
36938 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36939 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36940 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36941 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36942 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36943 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36944 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36945 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36946 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36947 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36948 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36949 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36950 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36951 actions.
36952
36953 Replies:
36954 @table @samp
36955 @item OK
36956 The packet was understood and carried out.
36957 @item qRelocInsn
36958 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36959 @item @w{}
36960 The packet was not recognized.
36961 @end table
36962
36963 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36964 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36965 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36966 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36967 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36968 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36969 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36970
36971 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36972 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36973 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36974 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36975 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36976 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36977 tracepoint actions.
36978
36979 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36980 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36981 following forms:
36982
36983 @table @samp
36984
36985 @item R @var{mask}
36986 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36987 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36988 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36989 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36990 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36991
36992 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36993 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36994 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36995 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36996 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36997 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36998 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36999
37000 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37001 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37002 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37003 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37004 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37005 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37006 packet).
37007
37008 @end table
37009
37010 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37011 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37012 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37013 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37014 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37015 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37016 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37017 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37018
37019 Replies:
37020 @table @samp
37021 @item OK
37022 The packet was understood and carried out.
37023 @item qRelocInsn
37024 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37025 @item @w{}
37026 The packet was not recognized.
37027 @end table
37028
37029 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37030 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37031 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37032 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37033 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37034 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37035 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37036 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37037
37038 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37039 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37040 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37041 fit in a single packet.
37042 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37043 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37044
37045 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37046 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37047 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37048 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37049
37050 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37051 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37052 query packets.
37053
37054 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37055 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37056 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37057 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37058 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37059 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37060 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37061 be found.
37062
37063 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37064 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37065 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37066 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37067 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37068 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37069 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37070 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37071 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37072 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37073 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37074 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37075 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37076 variable.
37077
37078 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37079 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37080 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37081 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37082 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37083
37084 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37085 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37086 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37087 one of the following forms:
37088
37089 @table @samp
37090 @item F @var{f}
37091 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37092 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37093 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37094
37095 @item T @var{t}
37096 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37097 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37098
37099 @end table
37100
37101 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37102 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37103 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37104 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37105
37106 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37107 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37108 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37109 is a hexadecimal number.
37110
37111 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37112 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37113 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37114 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37115 numbers.
37116
37117 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37118 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37119 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37120
37121 @item qTMinFTPILen
37122 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37123 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37124 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37125 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37126 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37127 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37128 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37129 arrange for that.
37130
37131 Replies:
37132
37133 @table @samp
37134 @item 0
37135 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37136 @item @var{length}
37137 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37138 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37139 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37140 regardless of size.
37141 @item E
37142 An error has occurred.
37143 @item @w{}
37144 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37145 @end table
37146
37147 @item QTStart
37148 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37149 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37150 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37151 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37152 instruction reply packet}).
37153
37154 @item QTStop
37155 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37156 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37157
37158 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37159 @anchor{QTEnable}
37160 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37161 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37162 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37163 of data from it will resume.
37164
37165 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37166 @anchor{QTDisable}
37167 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37168 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37169 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37170 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37171
37172 @item QTinit
37173 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37174 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37175
37176 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37177 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37178 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37179 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37180 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37181
37182 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37183 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37184 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37185 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37186
37187 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37188 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37189 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37190 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37191 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37192 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37193
37194 @item qTStatus
37195 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37196 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37197
37198 The reply has the form:
37199
37200 @table @samp
37201
37202 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37203 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37204 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37205 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37206
37207 @end table
37208
37209 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37210 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37211
37212 @table @samp
37213
37214 @item tnotrun:0
37215 No trace has been run yet.
37216
37217 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37218 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37219 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37220 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37221 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37222
37223 @item tfull:0
37224 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37225
37226 @item tdisconnected:0
37227 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37228
37229 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37230 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37231
37232 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37233 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37234 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37235 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37236 is hex encoded.
37237
37238 @item tunknown:0
37239 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37240
37241 @end table
37242
37243 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37244 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37245 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37246 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37247 trace.
37248
37249 @table @samp
37250
37251 @item tframes:@var{n}
37252 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37253
37254 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37255 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37256 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37257
37258 @item tsize:@var{n}
37259 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37260
37261 @item tfree:@var{n}
37262 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37263
37264 @item circular:@var{n}
37265 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37266 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37267 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37268 and may fill up.
37269
37270 @item disconn:@var{n}
37271 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37272 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37273 that the trace run will stop.
37274
37275 @end table
37276
37277 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37278 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37279 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37280 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37281 address @var{addr}.
37282
37283 Replies:
37284 @table @samp
37285 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37286 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37287 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37288 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37289 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37290
37291 @end table
37292
37293 @item qTV:@var{var}
37294 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37295 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37296 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37297
37298 Replies:
37299 @table @samp
37300 @item V@var{value}
37301 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37302 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37303 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37304 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37305 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37306 program is running.
37307
37308 @item U
37309 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37310 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37311 was not collected.
37312 @end table
37313
37314 @item qTfP
37315 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37316 @itemx qTsP
37317 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37318 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37319 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37320 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37321 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37322 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37323
37324 @item qTfV
37325 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37326 @itemx qTsV
37327 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37328 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37329 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37330 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37331 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37332 trace state variables.
37333
37334 @item qTfSTM
37335 @itemx qTsSTM
37336 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37337 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37338 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37339 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37340 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37341 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37342 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37343 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37344
37345 Reply:
37346 @table @samp
37347 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37348 A single marker
37349 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37350 a comma-separated list of markers
37351 @item l
37352 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37353 @item E @var{nn}
37354 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37355 @item @w{}
37356 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37357 stub.
37358 @end table
37359
37360 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37361 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37362
37363 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37364 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37365 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37366 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37367 @dfn{last}).
37368
37369 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37370 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37371 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37372 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37373 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37374 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37375 tracepoint markers.
37376
37377 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37378 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37379 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37380 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37381 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37382 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37383
37384 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37385 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37386 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37387 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37388 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37389 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37390 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37391 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37392 available.
37393
37394 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37395 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37396 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37397
37398 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37399 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37400 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37401 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37402 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37403 use whatever size it prefers.
37404
37405 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37406 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37407 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37408 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37409 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37410
37411 @end table
37412
37413 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37414 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37415 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37416 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37417 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37418 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37419 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37420 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37421 it had executed in the original location.
37422
37423 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37424 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37425 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37426 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37427 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37428 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37429 format of the request is:
37430
37431 @table @samp
37432 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37433
37434 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37435 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37436 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37437 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37438 memory starting at @var{to}.
37439 @end table
37440
37441 Replies:
37442 @table @samp
37443 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37444 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37445 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37446 @item E @var{NN}
37447 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37448 relocating the instruction.
37449 @end table
37450
37451 @node Host I/O Packets
37452 @section Host I/O Packets
37453 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37454 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37455
37456 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37457 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37458 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37459 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37460 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37461 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37462 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37463 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37464 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37465 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37466
37467 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37468 its arguments. They have this format:
37469
37470 @table @samp
37471
37472 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37473 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37474 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37475 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37476 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37477 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37478 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37479 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37480 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37481
37482 @end table
37483
37484 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37485
37486 @table @samp
37487
37488 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37489 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37490 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37491 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37492 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37493 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37494 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37495 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37496 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37497 @var{attachment}.
37498
37499 @item @w{}
37500 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37501
37502 @end table
37503
37504 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37505
37506 @table @samp
37507 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37508 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37509 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37510 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37511 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37512 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37513 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37514
37515 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37516 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37517 -1 if an error occurs.
37518
37519 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37520 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37521 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37522 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37523 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37524 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37525 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37526 @var{count} was zero.
37527
37528 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37529 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37530 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37531 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37532 some characters were escaped.
37533
37534 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37535 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37536 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37537 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37538 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37539 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37540 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37541 error occurred.
37542
37543 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
37544 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
37545 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
37546 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
37547 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
37548 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
37549
37550 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37551 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37552 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37553
37554 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37555 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37556 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37557
37558 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37559 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37560 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37561 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37562 some characters were escaped.
37563
37564 @end table
37565
37566 @node Interrupts
37567 @section Interrupts
37568 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37569
37570 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
37571 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
37572 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
37573 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37574
37575 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
37576 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
37577 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
37578 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
37579 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
37580
37581 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
37582 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
37583 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
37584 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
37585 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
37586 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
37587 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
37588 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
37589
37590 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
37591 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
37592 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
37593
37594 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
37595 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
37596 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
37597 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
37598 currently-executing threads and processes.
37599 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
37600 running program, it should send one of the stop
37601 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
37602 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
37603 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
37604 Interrupts received while the
37605 program is stopped are discarded.
37606
37607 @node Notification Packets
37608 @section Notification Packets
37609 @cindex notification packets
37610 @cindex packets, notification
37611
37612 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
37613 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
37614 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
37615 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
37616 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
37617 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
37618 is not a problem.
37619
37620 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
37621 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
37622 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
37623 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
37624 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
37625 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
37626 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
37627
37628 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
37629 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
37630
37631 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
37632 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
37633 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
37634 not they understand it.
37635
37636 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
37637 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
37638 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
37639 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
37640 recipients.
37641
37642 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
37643 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
37644 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
37645 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
37646 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
37647
37648 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
37649 @table @samp
37650 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
37651 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
37652 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
37653 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
37654 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
37655 @item @var{ack}
37656 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
37657 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
37658 @end table
37659
37660 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
37661 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
37662
37663 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
37664 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
37665 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
37666 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
37667 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
37668 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
37669 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
37670 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
37671 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
37672 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
37673
37674 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
37675 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
37676 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
37677 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
37678 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
37679 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
37680
37681 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
37682 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
37683 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
37684 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
37685 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
37686
37687 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
37688 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
37689 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
37690 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
37691 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
37692 normally.
37693
37694 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
37695 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
37696 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
37697 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
37698 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
37699 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
37700 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
37701 the process shall be repeated.
37702
37703 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
37704 following example:
37705 @smallexample
37706 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
37707 @code{...}
37708 -> @code{vStopped}
37709 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
37710 -> @code{vStopped}
37711 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
37712 -> @code{vStopped}
37713 <- @code{OK}
37714 @end smallexample
37715
37716 The following notifications are defined:
37717 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37718
37719 @item Notification
37720 @tab Ack
37721 @tab Event
37722 @tab Description
37723
37724 @item Stop
37725 @tab vStopped
37726 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37727 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37728 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37729 @value{GDBN}.
37730 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37731
37732 @end multitable
37733
37734 @node Remote Non-Stop
37735 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37736
37737 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37738 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37739 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37740 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37741
37742 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37743 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37744 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37745 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37746 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37747 probe the target state after a mode change.
37748
37749 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37750 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37751 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37752 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37753 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37754 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37755 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37756 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37757 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37758 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37759 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37760
37761 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37762 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37763 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37764 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37765 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37766 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37767 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37768 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37769 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37770 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37771 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37772 @samp{OK}.
37773
37774 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
37775 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
37776 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
37777 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
37778 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
37779 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
37780 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
37781 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
37782 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
37783 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
37784 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
37785 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
37786 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
37787
37788 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37789 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37790
37791 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37792 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37793 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37794 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37795 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37796 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37797 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37798
37799 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37800 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37801 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37802 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37803 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37804
37805 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37806 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37807 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37808 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37809
37810 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37811 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37812 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37813 @pxref{qSupported}.
37814 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37815 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37816 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37817 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37818 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37819 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37820 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37821
37822 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37823 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37824 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37825 connection.
37826 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37827 new connection is established,
37828 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37829 for the current connection, once disabled.
37830
37831 @node Examples
37832 @section Examples
37833
37834 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37835 does not get any direct output:
37836
37837 @smallexample
37838 -> @code{R00}
37839 <- @code{+}
37840 @emph{target restarts}
37841 -> @code{?}
37842 <- @code{+}
37843 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37844 -> @code{+}
37845 @end smallexample
37846
37847 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37848
37849 @smallexample
37850 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37851 <- @code{+}
37852 -> @code{s}
37853 <- @code{+}
37854 @emph{time passes}
37855 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37856 -> @code{+}
37857 -> @code{g}
37858 <- @code{+}
37859 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37860 -> @code{+}
37861 @end smallexample
37862
37863 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37864 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37865 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37866
37867 @menu
37868 * File-I/O Overview::
37869 * Protocol Basics::
37870 * The F Request Packet::
37871 * The F Reply Packet::
37872 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37873 * Console I/O::
37874 * List of Supported Calls::
37875 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37876 * Constants::
37877 * File-I/O Examples::
37878 @end menu
37879
37880 @node File-I/O Overview
37881 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37882 @cindex file-i/o overview
37883
37884 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37885 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37886 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37887 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37888 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37889 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37890
37891 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37892 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37893 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37894 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37895 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37896
37897 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37898 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37899 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37900 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37901 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37902 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37903 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37904
37905 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37906 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37907 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37908 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37909 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37910
37911 @smallexample
37912 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37913 <- target requests 'system call X'
37914 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37915 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37916 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37917 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37918 @end smallexample
37919
37920 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37921 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37922 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37923 system are not supported by this protocol.
37924
37925 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37926
37927 @node Protocol Basics
37928 @subsection Protocol Basics
37929 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37930
37931 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37932 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37933 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37934 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37935 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37936 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37937 to call the appropriate host system call:
37938
37939 @itemize @bullet
37940 @item
37941 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37942
37943 @item
37944 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37945 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37946 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37947 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37948
37949 @end itemize
37950
37951 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37952
37953 @itemize @bullet
37954 @item
37955 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37956 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37957 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37958 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37959 packet.
37960
37961 @item
37962 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37963 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37964
37965 @item
37966 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37967
37968 @item
37969 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37970
37971 @item
37972 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37973 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37974 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37975 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37976 packet.
37977
37978 @end itemize
37979
37980 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37981 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37982
37983 @itemize @bullet
37984 @item
37985 Return value.
37986
37987 @item
37988 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37989
37990 @item
37991 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37992
37993 @end itemize
37994
37995 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37996 the latest continue or step action.
37997
37998 @node The F Request Packet
37999 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38000 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38001 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38002
38003 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38004
38005 @table @samp
38006 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38007
38008 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38009 This is just the name of the function.
38010
38011 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38012 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38013 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38014 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38015 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38016 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38017 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38018
38019 @end table
38020
38021
38022
38023 @node The F Reply Packet
38024 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38025 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38026 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38027
38028 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38029
38030 @table @samp
38031
38032 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38033
38034 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38035
38036 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38037 representation.
38038 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38039
38040 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38041 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38042 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38043
38044 @smallexample
38045 F0,0,C
38046 @end smallexample
38047
38048 @noindent
38049 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38050
38051 @smallexample
38052 F-1,4,C
38053 @end smallexample
38054
38055 @noindent
38056 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38057
38058 @end table
38059
38060
38061 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38062 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38063 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38064
38065 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38066 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38067 the target should behave as if it had
38068 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38069 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38070 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38071 packet.
38072
38073 It's important for the target to know in which
38074 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38075
38076 @itemize @bullet
38077 @item
38078 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38079
38080 @item
38081 The system call on the host has been finished.
38082
38083 @end itemize
38084
38085 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38086 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38087 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38088 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38089 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38090 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38091
38092 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38093 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38094 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38095 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38096 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38097 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38098 or the full action has been completed.
38099
38100 @node Console I/O
38101 @subsection Console I/O
38102 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38103
38104 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38105 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38106 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38107 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38108 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38109 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38110 conditions is met:
38111
38112 @itemize @bullet
38113 @item
38114 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38115 @code{read}
38116 system call is treated as finished.
38117
38118 @item
38119 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38120 newline.
38121
38122 @item
38123 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38124 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38125
38126 @end itemize
38127
38128 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38129 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38130 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38131 is stopped at the user's request.
38132
38133
38134 @node List of Supported Calls
38135 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38136 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38137
38138 @menu
38139 * open::
38140 * close::
38141 * read::
38142 * write::
38143 * lseek::
38144 * rename::
38145 * unlink::
38146 * stat/fstat::
38147 * gettimeofday::
38148 * isatty::
38149 * system::
38150 @end menu
38151
38152 @node open
38153 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38154 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38155
38156 @table @asis
38157 @item Synopsis:
38158 @smallexample
38159 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38160 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38161 @end smallexample
38162
38163 @item Request:
38164 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38165
38166 @noindent
38167 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38168
38169 @table @code
38170 @item O_CREAT
38171 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38172 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38173 are concerned.
38174
38175 @item O_EXCL
38176 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38177 an error and open() fails.
38178
38179 @item O_TRUNC
38180 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38181 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38182 truncated to zero length.
38183
38184 @item O_APPEND
38185 The file is opened in append mode.
38186
38187 @item O_RDONLY
38188 The file is opened for reading only.
38189
38190 @item O_WRONLY
38191 The file is opened for writing only.
38192
38193 @item O_RDWR
38194 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38195 @end table
38196
38197 @noindent
38198 Other bits are silently ignored.
38199
38200
38201 @noindent
38202 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38203
38204 @table @code
38205 @item S_IRUSR
38206 User has read permission.
38207
38208 @item S_IWUSR
38209 User has write permission.
38210
38211 @item S_IRGRP
38212 Group has read permission.
38213
38214 @item S_IWGRP
38215 Group has write permission.
38216
38217 @item S_IROTH
38218 Others have read permission.
38219
38220 @item S_IWOTH
38221 Others have write permission.
38222 @end table
38223
38224 @noindent
38225 Other bits are silently ignored.
38226
38227
38228 @item Return value:
38229 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38230 occurred.
38231
38232 @item Errors:
38233
38234 @table @code
38235 @item EEXIST
38236 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38237
38238 @item EISDIR
38239 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38240
38241 @item EACCES
38242 The requested access is not allowed.
38243
38244 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38245 @var{pathname} was too long.
38246
38247 @item ENOENT
38248 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38249
38250 @item ENODEV
38251 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38252
38253 @item EROFS
38254 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38255 write access was requested.
38256
38257 @item EFAULT
38258 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38259
38260 @item ENOSPC
38261 No space on device to create the file.
38262
38263 @item EMFILE
38264 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38265
38266 @item ENFILE
38267 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38268 has been reached.
38269
38270 @item EINTR
38271 The call was interrupted by the user.
38272 @end table
38273
38274 @end table
38275
38276 @node close
38277 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38278 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38279
38280 @table @asis
38281 @item Synopsis:
38282 @smallexample
38283 int close(int fd);
38284 @end smallexample
38285
38286 @item Request:
38287 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38288
38289 @item Return value:
38290 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38291
38292 @item Errors:
38293
38294 @table @code
38295 @item EBADF
38296 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38297
38298 @item EINTR
38299 The call was interrupted by the user.
38300 @end table
38301
38302 @end table
38303
38304 @node read
38305 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38306 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38307
38308 @table @asis
38309 @item Synopsis:
38310 @smallexample
38311 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38312 @end smallexample
38313
38314 @item Request:
38315 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38316
38317 @item Return value:
38318 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38319 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38320 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38321
38322 @item Errors:
38323
38324 @table @code
38325 @item EBADF
38326 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38327 reading.
38328
38329 @item EFAULT
38330 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38331
38332 @item EINTR
38333 The call was interrupted by the user.
38334 @end table
38335
38336 @end table
38337
38338 @node write
38339 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38340 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38341
38342 @table @asis
38343 @item Synopsis:
38344 @smallexample
38345 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38346 @end smallexample
38347
38348 @item Request:
38349 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38350
38351 @item Return value:
38352 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38353 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38354 is returned.
38355
38356 @item Errors:
38357
38358 @table @code
38359 @item EBADF
38360 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38361 writing.
38362
38363 @item EFAULT
38364 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38365
38366 @item EFBIG
38367 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38368 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38369
38370 @item ENOSPC
38371 No space on device to write the data.
38372
38373 @item EINTR
38374 The call was interrupted by the user.
38375 @end table
38376
38377 @end table
38378
38379 @node lseek
38380 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38381 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38382
38383 @table @asis
38384 @item Synopsis:
38385 @smallexample
38386 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38387 @end smallexample
38388
38389 @item Request:
38390 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38391
38392 @var{flag} is one of:
38393
38394 @table @code
38395 @item SEEK_SET
38396 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38397
38398 @item SEEK_CUR
38399 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38400 bytes.
38401
38402 @item SEEK_END
38403 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38404 bytes.
38405 @end table
38406
38407 @item Return value:
38408 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38409 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38410 value of -1 is returned.
38411
38412 @item Errors:
38413
38414 @table @code
38415 @item EBADF
38416 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38417
38418 @item ESPIPE
38419 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38420
38421 @item EINVAL
38422 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38423
38424 @item EINTR
38425 The call was interrupted by the user.
38426 @end table
38427
38428 @end table
38429
38430 @node rename
38431 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38432 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38433
38434 @table @asis
38435 @item Synopsis:
38436 @smallexample
38437 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38438 @end smallexample
38439
38440 @item Request:
38441 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38442
38443 @item Return value:
38444 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38445
38446 @item Errors:
38447
38448 @table @code
38449 @item EISDIR
38450 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38451 directory.
38452
38453 @item EEXIST
38454 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38455
38456 @item EBUSY
38457 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38458 process.
38459
38460 @item EINVAL
38461 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38462 of itself.
38463
38464 @item ENOTDIR
38465 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38466 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38467 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38468
38469 @item EFAULT
38470 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38471
38472 @item EACCES
38473 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38474
38475 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38476
38477 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38478
38479 @item ENOENT
38480 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38481
38482 @item EROFS
38483 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38484
38485 @item ENOSPC
38486 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38487 directory entry.
38488
38489 @item EINTR
38490 The call was interrupted by the user.
38491 @end table
38492
38493 @end table
38494
38495 @node unlink
38496 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38497 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38498
38499 @table @asis
38500 @item Synopsis:
38501 @smallexample
38502 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38503 @end smallexample
38504
38505 @item Request:
38506 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38507
38508 @item Return value:
38509 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38510
38511 @item Errors:
38512
38513 @table @code
38514 @item EACCES
38515 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38516
38517 @item EPERM
38518 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38519
38520 @item EBUSY
38521 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38522 being used by another process.
38523
38524 @item EFAULT
38525 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38526
38527 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38528 @var{pathname} was too long.
38529
38530 @item ENOENT
38531 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38532
38533 @item ENOTDIR
38534 A component of the path is not a directory.
38535
38536 @item EROFS
38537 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38538
38539 @item EINTR
38540 The call was interrupted by the user.
38541 @end table
38542
38543 @end table
38544
38545 @node stat/fstat
38546 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38547 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38548 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38549
38550 @table @asis
38551 @item Synopsis:
38552 @smallexample
38553 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38554 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38555 @end smallexample
38556
38557 @item Request:
38558 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38559 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38560
38561 @item Return value:
38562 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38563
38564 @item Errors:
38565
38566 @table @code
38567 @item EBADF
38568 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38569
38570 @item ENOENT
38571 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38572 path is an empty string.
38573
38574 @item ENOTDIR
38575 A component of the path is not a directory.
38576
38577 @item EFAULT
38578 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38579
38580 @item EACCES
38581 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38582
38583 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38584 @var{pathname} was too long.
38585
38586 @item EINTR
38587 The call was interrupted by the user.
38588 @end table
38589
38590 @end table
38591
38592 @node gettimeofday
38593 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
38594 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
38595
38596 @table @asis
38597 @item Synopsis:
38598 @smallexample
38599 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
38600 @end smallexample
38601
38602 @item Request:
38603 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
38604
38605 @item Return value:
38606 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
38607
38608 @item Errors:
38609
38610 @table @code
38611 @item EINVAL
38612 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
38613
38614 @item EFAULT
38615 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38616 @end table
38617
38618 @end table
38619
38620 @node isatty
38621 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
38622 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
38623
38624 @table @asis
38625 @item Synopsis:
38626 @smallexample
38627 int isatty(int fd);
38628 @end smallexample
38629
38630 @item Request:
38631 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
38632
38633 @item Return value:
38634 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
38635
38636 @item Errors:
38637
38638 @table @code
38639 @item EINTR
38640 The call was interrupted by the user.
38641 @end table
38642
38643 @end table
38644
38645 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
38646 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
38647 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
38648 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
38649 needed.
38650
38651
38652 @node system
38653 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
38654 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
38655
38656 @table @asis
38657 @item Synopsis:
38658 @smallexample
38659 int system(const char *command);
38660 @end smallexample
38661
38662 @item Request:
38663 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
38664
38665 @item Return value:
38666 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
38667 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
38668 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
38669 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
38670 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
38671 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
38672 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
38673
38674 @item Errors:
38675
38676 @table @code
38677 @item EINTR
38678 The call was interrupted by the user.
38679 @end table
38680
38681 @end table
38682
38683 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
38684 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
38685 the host is simplified before it's returned
38686 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
38687 is discarded, and the return value consists
38688 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
38689
38690 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
38691 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
38692 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
38693
38694 @table @code
38695 @item set remote system-call-allowed
38696 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
38697 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
38698 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
38699
38700 @item show remote system-call-allowed
38701 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
38702 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
38703 protocol.
38704 @end table
38705
38706 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38707 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38708 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38709
38710 @menu
38711 * Integral Datatypes::
38712 * Pointer Values::
38713 * Memory Transfer::
38714 * struct stat::
38715 * struct timeval::
38716 @end menu
38717
38718 @node Integral Datatypes
38719 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
38720 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38721
38722 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
38723 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
38724 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
38725
38726 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
38727 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
38728
38729 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
38730
38731 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38732 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38733
38734 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38735
38736 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38737 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38738 byte order.
38739
38740 @node Pointer Values
38741 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38742 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38743
38744 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38745 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38746 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38747 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38748
38749 @smallexample
38750 @code{1aaf/12}
38751 @end smallexample
38752
38753 @noindent
38754 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38755 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38756 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38757 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38758
38759 @smallexample
38760 @code{123456/d}
38761 @end smallexample
38762
38763 @node Memory Transfer
38764 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38765 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38766
38767 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38768 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38769 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38770 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38771 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38772 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38773 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38774
38775
38776 @node struct stat
38777 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38778 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38779
38780 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38781 is defined as follows:
38782
38783 @smallexample
38784 struct stat @{
38785 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38786 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38787 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38788 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38789 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38790 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38791 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38792 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38793 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38794 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38795 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38796 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38797 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38798 @};
38799 @end smallexample
38800
38801 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38802 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38803 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38804
38805 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38806 range of values.
38807
38808 @table @code
38809
38810 @item st_dev
38811 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38812
38813 @item st_ino
38814 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38815
38816 @item st_mode
38817 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38818 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38819
38820 @item st_uid
38821 @itemx st_gid
38822 @itemx st_rdev
38823 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38824
38825 @item st_atime
38826 @itemx st_mtime
38827 @itemx st_ctime
38828 These values have a host and file system dependent
38829 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38830 support exact timing values.
38831 @end table
38832
38833 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38834 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38835 continuing.
38836
38837 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38838 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38839 get truncated on the target.
38840
38841 @node struct timeval
38842 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38843 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38844
38845 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38846 is defined as follows:
38847
38848 @smallexample
38849 struct timeval @{
38850 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38851 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38852 @};
38853 @end smallexample
38854
38855 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38856 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38857 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38858
38859 @node Constants
38860 @subsection Constants
38861 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38862
38863 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38864 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38865 values before and after the call as needed.
38866
38867 @menu
38868 * Open Flags::
38869 * mode_t Values::
38870 * Errno Values::
38871 * Lseek Flags::
38872 * Limits::
38873 @end menu
38874
38875 @node Open Flags
38876 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38877 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38878
38879 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38880
38881 @smallexample
38882 O_RDONLY 0x0
38883 O_WRONLY 0x1
38884 O_RDWR 0x2
38885 O_APPEND 0x8
38886 O_CREAT 0x200
38887 O_TRUNC 0x400
38888 O_EXCL 0x800
38889 @end smallexample
38890
38891 @node mode_t Values
38892 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38893 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38894
38895 All values are given in octal representation.
38896
38897 @smallexample
38898 S_IFREG 0100000
38899 S_IFDIR 040000
38900 S_IRUSR 0400
38901 S_IWUSR 0200
38902 S_IXUSR 0100
38903 S_IRGRP 040
38904 S_IWGRP 020
38905 S_IXGRP 010
38906 S_IROTH 04
38907 S_IWOTH 02
38908 S_IXOTH 01
38909 @end smallexample
38910
38911 @node Errno Values
38912 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38913 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38914
38915 All values are given in decimal representation.
38916
38917 @smallexample
38918 EPERM 1
38919 ENOENT 2
38920 EINTR 4
38921 EBADF 9
38922 EACCES 13
38923 EFAULT 14
38924 EBUSY 16
38925 EEXIST 17
38926 ENODEV 19
38927 ENOTDIR 20
38928 EISDIR 21
38929 EINVAL 22
38930 ENFILE 23
38931 EMFILE 24
38932 EFBIG 27
38933 ENOSPC 28
38934 ESPIPE 29
38935 EROFS 30
38936 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38937 EUNKNOWN 9999
38938 @end smallexample
38939
38940 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38941 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38942
38943 @node Lseek Flags
38944 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38945 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38946
38947 @smallexample
38948 SEEK_SET 0
38949 SEEK_CUR 1
38950 SEEK_END 2
38951 @end smallexample
38952
38953 @node Limits
38954 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38955 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38956
38957 All values are given in decimal representation.
38958
38959 @smallexample
38960 INT_MIN -2147483648
38961 INT_MAX 2147483647
38962 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38963 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38964 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38965 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38966 @end smallexample
38967
38968 @node File-I/O Examples
38969 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38970 @cindex file-i/o examples
38971
38972 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38973 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38974
38975 @smallexample
38976 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38977 @emph{request memory read from target}
38978 -> @code{m1234,6}
38979 <- XXXXXX
38980 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38981 -> @code{F6}
38982 @end smallexample
38983
38984 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38985 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38986
38987 @smallexample
38988 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38989 @emph{request memory write to target}
38990 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38991 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38992 -> @code{F6}
38993 @end smallexample
38994
38995 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38996 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38997
38998 @smallexample
38999 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39000 -> @code{F-1,9}
39001 @end smallexample
39002
39003 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39004 host is called:
39005
39006 @smallexample
39007 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39008 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39009 <- @code{T02}
39010 @end smallexample
39011
39012 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39013 host is called:
39014
39015 @smallexample
39016 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39017 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39018 <- @code{T02}
39019 @end smallexample
39020
39021 @node Library List Format
39022 @section Library List Format
39023 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39024
39025 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39026 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39027 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39028 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39029 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39030 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39031 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39032 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39033 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39034 are loaded.
39035
39036 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39037 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39038 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39039 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39040
39041 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39042 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39043 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39044 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39045 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39046 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39047
39048 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39049 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39050
39051 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39052 offset, looks like this:
39053
39054 @smallexample
39055 <library-list>
39056 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39057 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39058 </library>
39059 </library-list>
39060 @end smallexample
39061
39062 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39063 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39064
39065 @smallexample
39066 <library-list>
39067 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39068 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39069 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39070 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39071 </library>
39072 </library-list>
39073 @end smallexample
39074
39075 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39076
39077 @smallexample
39078 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39079 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39080 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39081 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39082 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39083 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39084 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39085 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39086 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39087 @end smallexample
39088
39089 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39090 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39091 section for each library.
39092
39093 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39094 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39095 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39096
39097 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39098 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39099 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39100 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39101
39102 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39103 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39104 target, the following parameters are reported:
39105
39106 @itemize @minus
39107 @item
39108 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39109 @code{struct link_map}.
39110 @item
39111 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39112 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39113 @item
39114 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39115 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39116 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39117 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39118 @item
39119 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39120 @end itemize
39121
39122 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39123 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39124 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39125
39126 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39127 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39128
39129 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39130 looks like this:
39131
39132 @smallexample
39133 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39134 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39135 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39136 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39137 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39138 </library-list-svr>
39139 @end smallexample
39140
39141 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39142
39143 @smallexample
39144 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39145 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39146 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39147 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39148 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39149 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39150 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39151 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39152 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39153 @end smallexample
39154
39155 @node Memory Map Format
39156 @section Memory Map Format
39157 @cindex memory map format
39158
39159 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39160 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39161 memory map.
39162
39163 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39164 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39165 lists memory regions.
39166
39167 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39168 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39169
39170 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39171
39172 @smallexample
39173 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39174 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39175 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39176 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39177 <memory-map>
39178 region...
39179 </memory-map>
39180 @end smallexample
39181
39182 Each region can be either:
39183
39184 @itemize
39185
39186 @item
39187 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39188 bytes from there:
39189
39190 @smallexample
39191 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39192 @end smallexample
39193
39194
39195 @item
39196 A region of read-only memory:
39197
39198 @smallexample
39199 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39200 @end smallexample
39201
39202
39203 @item
39204 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39205 bytes in length:
39206
39207 @smallexample
39208 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39209 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39210 </memory>
39211 @end smallexample
39212
39213 @end itemize
39214
39215 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39216 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39217 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39218
39219 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39220
39221 @smallexample
39222 <!-- ................................................... -->
39223 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39224 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39225 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39226 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39227 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39228 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39229 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39230 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39231 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39232 and its type, or device. -->
39233 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39234 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39235 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39236 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39237 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39238 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39239 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39240 @end smallexample
39241
39242 @node Thread List Format
39243 @section Thread List Format
39244 @cindex thread list format
39245
39246 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39247 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39248 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39249 the following structure:
39250
39251 @smallexample
39252 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39253 <threads>
39254 <thread id="id" core="0">
39255 ... description ...
39256 </thread>
39257 </threads>
39258 @end smallexample
39259
39260 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39261 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39262 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39263 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39264 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39265
39266 @node Traceframe Info Format
39267 @section Traceframe Info Format
39268 @cindex traceframe info format
39269
39270 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39271 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39272 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39273 collected in a traceframe.
39274
39275 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39276 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39277
39278 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39279 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39280
39281 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39282
39283 @smallexample
39284 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39285 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39286 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39287 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39288 <traceframe-info>
39289 block...
39290 </traceframe-info>
39291 @end smallexample
39292
39293 Each traceframe block can be either:
39294
39295 @itemize
39296
39297 @item
39298 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39299 @var{length} bytes from there:
39300
39301 @smallexample
39302 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39303 @end smallexample
39304
39305 @item
39306 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39307 collected:
39308
39309 @smallexample
39310 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39311 @end smallexample
39312
39313 @end itemize
39314
39315 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39316
39317 @smallexample
39318 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39319 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39320
39321 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39322 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39323 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39324 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39325 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39326 @end smallexample
39327
39328 @node Branch Trace Format
39329 @section Branch Trace Format
39330 @cindex branch trace format
39331
39332 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39333 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39334 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39335 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39336
39337 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39338 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39339
39340 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39341 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39342
39343 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39344
39345 @smallexample
39346 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39347 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39348 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39349 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39350 <btrace>
39351 block...
39352 </btrace>
39353 @end smallexample
39354
39355 @itemize
39356
39357 @item
39358 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39359 and ending at @var{end}:
39360
39361 @smallexample
39362 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39363 @end smallexample
39364
39365 @end itemize
39366
39367 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39368
39369 @smallexample
39370 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
39371 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39372
39373 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39374 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39375 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39376 @end smallexample
39377
39378 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39379 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39380 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39381
39382 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39383 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39384 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39385
39386 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39387 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39388
39389 @table @code
39390 @item bts
39391 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39392 @table @code
39393 @item size
39394 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39395 @end table
39396 @end table
39397
39398 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39399 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39400
39401 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39402
39403 @smallexample
39404 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?)>
39405 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39406
39407 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39408 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39409 @end smallexample
39410
39411 @include agentexpr.texi
39412
39413 @node Target Descriptions
39414 @appendix Target Descriptions
39415 @cindex target descriptions
39416
39417 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39418 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39419 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39420 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39421 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39422 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39423 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39424
39425 @itemize @bullet
39426 @item
39427 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39428 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39429 @item
39430 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39431 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39432 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39433 @item
39434 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39435 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39436 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39437 @end itemize
39438
39439 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39440 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39441 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39442 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39443 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39444
39445 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39446 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39447
39448 @menu
39449 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39450 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39451 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39452 descriptions.
39453 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39454 @end menu
39455
39456 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39457 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39458
39459 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39460 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39461 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39462 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39463 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39464 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39465 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39466 Format}.
39467
39468 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39469 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39470 specify a file are:
39471
39472 @table @code
39473 @cindex set tdesc filename
39474 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39475 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39476
39477 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39478 @item unset tdesc filename
39479 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39480 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39481
39482 @cindex show tdesc filename
39483 @item show tdesc filename
39484 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39485 @end table
39486
39487
39488 @node Target Description Format
39489 @section Target Description Format
39490 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39491
39492 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39493 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39494 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39495 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39496 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39497 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39498 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39499
39500 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39501 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39502 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39503 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39504 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39505
39506 Here is a simple target description:
39507
39508 @smallexample
39509 <target version="1.0">
39510 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39511 </target>
39512 @end smallexample
39513
39514 @noindent
39515 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39516 the x86-64 architecture.
39517
39518 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39519 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39520 are explained further below.
39521
39522 @smallexample
39523 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39524 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39525 <target version="1.0">
39526 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39527 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39528 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39529 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39530 </target>
39531 @end smallexample
39532
39533 @noindent
39534 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39535 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39536 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39537 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39538 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39539 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39540 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39541 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39542 the version mismatch.
39543
39544 @subsection Inclusion
39545 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39546 @cindex XInclude
39547 @ifnotinfo
39548 @cindex <xi:include>
39549 @end ifnotinfo
39550
39551 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39552 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39553 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39554 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39555 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39556
39557 @smallexample
39558 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39559 @end smallexample
39560
39561 @noindent
39562 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39563 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39564 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39565 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39566 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39567 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39568 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39569 original description.
39570
39571 @subsection Architecture
39572 @cindex <architecture>
39573
39574 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
39575
39576 @smallexample
39577 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
39578 @end smallexample
39579
39580 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39581 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39582
39583 @subsection OS ABI
39584 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
39585
39586 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39587 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39588
39589 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
39590
39591 @smallexample
39592 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
39593 @end smallexample
39594
39595 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
39596 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
39597
39598 @subsection Compatible Architecture
39599 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
39600
39601 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39602 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39603
39604 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
39605
39606 @smallexample
39607 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
39608 @end smallexample
39609
39610 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39611 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39612
39613 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
39614 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
39615 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
39616 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
39617 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
39618 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
39619 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
39620
39621 @smallexample
39622 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
39623 <compatible>spu</compatible>
39624 @end smallexample
39625
39626 @subsection Features
39627 @cindex <feature>
39628
39629 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
39630 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
39631 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
39632 has this form:
39633
39634 @smallexample
39635 <feature name="@var{name}">
39636 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
39637 @var{reg}@dots{}
39638 </feature>
39639 @end smallexample
39640
39641 @noindent
39642 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
39643 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
39644 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
39645 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
39646
39647 @subsection Types
39648
39649 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
39650 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
39651 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
39652 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
39653 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
39654
39655 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
39656 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
39657 Types must be defined before they are used.
39658
39659 @cindex <vector>
39660 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
39661 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
39662 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
39663 @var{count}:
39664
39665 @smallexample
39666 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
39667 @end smallexample
39668
39669 @cindex <union>
39670 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
39671 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
39672 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
39673 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
39674
39675 @smallexample
39676 <union id="@var{id}">
39677 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39678 @dots{}
39679 </union>
39680 @end smallexample
39681
39682 @cindex <struct>
39683 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
39684 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
39685 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
39686 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
39687 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
39688 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
39689 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
39690 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
39691
39692 @smallexample
39693 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39694 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39695 @dots{}
39696 </struct>
39697 @end smallexample
39698
39699 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
39700 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
39701
39702 @smallexample
39703 <struct id="@var{id}">
39704 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39705 @dots{}
39706 </struct>
39707 @end smallexample
39708
39709 @cindex <flags>
39710 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
39711 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
39712 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
39713 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
39714 are supported.
39715
39716 @smallexample
39717 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39718 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39719 @dots{}
39720 </flags>
39721 @end smallexample
39722
39723 @subsection Registers
39724 @cindex <reg>
39725
39726 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
39727
39728 @smallexample
39729 <reg name="@var{name}"
39730 bitsize="@var{size}"
39731 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
39732 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
39733 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
39734 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
39735 @end smallexample
39736
39737 @noindent
39738 The components are as follows:
39739
39740 @table @var
39741
39742 @item name
39743 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
39744
39745 @item bitsize
39746 The register's size, in bits.
39747
39748 @item regnum
39749 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
39750 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
39751 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
39752 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
39753 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
39754 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
39755 in order of increasing register number.
39756
39757 @item save-restore
39758 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
39759 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
39760 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
39761 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
39762 ABI.
39763
39764 @item type
39765 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39766 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39767 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39768 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39769 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39770 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39771
39772 @item group
39773 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39774 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39775 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39776 in @code{info registers}.
39777
39778 @end table
39779
39780 @node Predefined Target Types
39781 @section Predefined Target Types
39782 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39783
39784 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39785 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39786 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39787 types. The currently supported types are:
39788
39789 @table @code
39790
39791 @item int8
39792 @itemx int16
39793 @itemx int32
39794 @itemx int64
39795 @itemx int128
39796 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39797
39798 @item uint8
39799 @itemx uint16
39800 @itemx uint32
39801 @itemx uint64
39802 @itemx uint128
39803 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39804
39805 @item code_ptr
39806 @itemx data_ptr
39807 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39808 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39809 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39810 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39811 may be marked as data pointers.
39812
39813 @item ieee_single
39814 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39815
39816 @item ieee_double
39817 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39818
39819 @item arm_fpa_ext
39820 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39821
39822 @item i387_ext
39823 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39824
39825 @item i386_eflags
39826 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39827
39828 @item i386_mxcsr
39829 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39830
39831 @end table
39832
39833 @node Standard Target Features
39834 @section Standard Target Features
39835 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39836
39837 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39838 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39839 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39840 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39841 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39842 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39843 can recognize them.
39844
39845 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39846 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39847 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39848 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39849 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39850 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39851 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39852 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39853
39854 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39855 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39856 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39857
39858 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39859 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39860 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39861 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39862
39863 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39864 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39865 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39866
39867 @menu
39868 * AArch64 Features::
39869 * ARM Features::
39870 * i386 Features::
39871 * MicroBlaze Features::
39872 * MIPS Features::
39873 * M68K Features::
39874 * Nios II Features::
39875 * PowerPC Features::
39876 * S/390 and System z Features::
39877 * TIC6x Features::
39878 @end menu
39879
39880
39881 @node AArch64 Features
39882 @subsection AArch64 Features
39883 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39884
39885 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39886 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39887 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39888
39889 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39890 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39891 and @samp{fpcr}.
39892
39893 @node ARM Features
39894 @subsection ARM Features
39895 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39896
39897 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39898 ARM targets.
39899 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39900 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39901
39902 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39903 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39904 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39905 and @samp{xpsr}.
39906
39907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39908 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39909
39910 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39911 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39912 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39913 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39914
39915 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39916 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39917 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39918 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39919 halves of the double-precision registers.
39920
39921 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39922 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39923 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39924 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39925 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39926 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39927
39928 @node i386 Features
39929 @subsection i386 Features
39930 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39931
39932 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39933 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39934
39935 @itemize @minus
39936 @item
39937 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39938 @item
39939 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39940 @item
39941 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39942 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39943 @item
39944 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39945 @item
39946 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39947 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39948 @end itemize
39949
39950 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39951
39952 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39953 describe registers:
39954
39955 @itemize @minus
39956 @item
39957 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39958 @item
39959 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39960 @item
39961 @samp{mxcsr}
39962 @end itemize
39963
39964 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39965 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39966 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39967
39968 @itemize @minus
39969 @item
39970 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39971 @item
39972 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39973 @end itemize
39974
39975 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39976 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39977
39978 @itemize @minus
39979 @item
39980 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39981 @item
39982 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39983 @end itemize
39984
39985 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39986 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39987
39988 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39989 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39990 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39991
39992 @itemize @minus
39993 @item
39994 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39995 @end itemize
39996
39997 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39998
39999 @itemize @minus
40000 @item
40001 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40002 @end itemize
40003
40004 It should
40005 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40006
40007 @itemize @minus
40008 @item
40009 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40010 @item
40011 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40012 @end itemize
40013
40014 It should
40015 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40016
40017 @itemize @minus
40018 @item
40019 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40020 @end itemize
40021
40022 @node MicroBlaze Features
40023 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40024 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40025
40026 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40027 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40028 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40029 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40030 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40031
40032 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40033 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40034
40035 @node MIPS Features
40036 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40037 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40038
40039 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40040 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40041 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40042 on the target.
40043
40044 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40045 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40046 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40047
40048 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40049 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40050 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40051 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40052
40053 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40054 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40055 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40056 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40057
40058 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40059 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40060 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40061
40062 @node M68K Features
40063 @subsection M68K Features
40064 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40065
40066 @table @code
40067 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40068 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40069 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40070 One of those features must be always present.
40071 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40072 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40073 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40074 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40075
40076 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40077 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40078 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40079 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40080 @end table
40081
40082 @node Nios II Features
40083 @subsection Nios II Features
40084 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40085
40086 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40087 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40088 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40089 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40090 @samp{mpuacc}).
40091
40092 @node PowerPC Features
40093 @subsection PowerPC Features
40094 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40095
40096 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40097 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40098 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40099 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40100
40101 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40102 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40103
40104 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40105 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40106 and @samp{vrsave}.
40107
40108 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40109 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40110 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40111 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40112 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40113 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40114
40115 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40116 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40117 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40118 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40119 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40120 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40121 user.
40122
40123 @node S/390 and System z Features
40124 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40125 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40126 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40127
40128 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40129 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40130 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40131 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40132 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40133 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40134 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40135 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40136 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40137
40138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40139 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40140 @samp{fpc}.
40141
40142 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40143 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40144
40145 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40146 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40147 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40148 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40149 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40150 32-bit wide.
40151
40152 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40153 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40154 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40155
40156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40157 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40158 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40159 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40160 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40161 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40162 @samp{v31}.
40163
40164 @node TIC6x Features
40165 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40166 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40167 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40169 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40170 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40171
40172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40173 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40174 through @samp{B31}.
40175
40176 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40177 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40178
40179 @node Operating System Information
40180 @appendix Operating System Information
40181 @cindex operating system information
40182
40183 @menu
40184 * Process list::
40185 @end menu
40186
40187 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40188 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40189 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40190 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40191 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40192 on a different aspect of target.
40193
40194 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40195 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40196 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40197 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40198
40199 @node Process list
40200 @appendixsection Process list
40201 @cindex operating system information, process list
40202
40203 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40204 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40205 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40206 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40207
40208 An example document is:
40209
40210 @smallexample
40211 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40212 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40213 <osdata type="processes">
40214 <item>
40215 <column name="pid">1</column>
40216 <column name="user">root</column>
40217 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40218 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40219 </item>
40220 </osdata>
40221 @end smallexample
40222
40223 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40224 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40225 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40226 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40227 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40228 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40229 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40230
40231 @node Trace File Format
40232 @appendix Trace File Format
40233 @cindex trace file format
40234
40235 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40236 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40237
40238 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40239 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40240 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40241 in the future.
40242
40243 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40244 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40245 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40246 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40247 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40248 of this section.
40249
40250 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40251
40252 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40253 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40254 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40255 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40256 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40257 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40258 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40259 endianness.
40260
40261 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40262
40263 @table @code
40264 @item R @var{bytes}
40265 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40266 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40267 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40268 hexadecimal encoding.
40269
40270 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40271 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40272 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40273 @var{length} bytes.
40274
40275 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40276 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40277 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40278
40279 @end table
40280
40281 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40282 of blocks.
40283
40284 @node Index Section Format
40285 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40286 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40287 @cindex index section format
40288
40289 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40290 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40291 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40292 description.
40293
40294 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40295 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40296 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40297 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40298 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40299 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40300
40301 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40302
40303 @enumerate
40304 @item
40305 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40306 unless otherwise noted:
40307
40308 @enumerate
40309 @item
40310 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40311 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40312 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40313 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40314 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40315 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40316 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40317
40318 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40319 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40320 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40321 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40322
40323 @item
40324 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40325
40326 @item
40327 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40328 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40329 to the next offset.
40330
40331 @item
40332 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40333
40334 @item
40335 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40336
40337 @item
40338 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40339 @end enumerate
40340
40341 @item
40342 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40343 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40344 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40345 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40346 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40347 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40348 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40349 CU indices.
40350
40351 @item
40352 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40353 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40354 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40355 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40356
40357 @item
40358 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40359 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40360
40361 @enumerate
40362 @item
40363 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40364
40365 @item
40366 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40367 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40368
40369 @item
40370 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40371 @end enumerate
40372
40373 @item
40374 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40375 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40376
40377 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40378 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40379 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40380 constant pool.
40381
40382 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40383 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40384 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40385
40386 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40387 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40388 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40389 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40390 index version:
40391
40392 @table @asis
40393 @item Version 4
40394 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40395
40396 @item Versions 5 to 7
40397 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40398 @end table
40399
40400 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40401
40402 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40403 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40404 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40405 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40406 collision.
40407
40408 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40409 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40410 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40411 the code.
40412
40413 @item
40414 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40415 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40416 strings.
40417
40418 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40419 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40420 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40421 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40422 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40423 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40424
40425 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40426 @end enumerate
40427
40428 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40429 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40430 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40431
40432 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40433 (bit 0 = LSB):
40434
40435 @table @asis
40436
40437 @item Bits 0-23
40438 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40439 @item Bits 24-27
40440 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40441 @item Bits 28-30
40442 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40443
40444 @table @asis
40445 @item 0
40446 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40447 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40448 with previous versions of the index.
40449 @item 1
40450 The symbol is a type.
40451 @item 2
40452 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40453 @item 3
40454 The symbol is a function.
40455 @item 4
40456 Any other kind of symbol.
40457 @item 5,6,7
40458 These values are reserved.
40459 @end table
40460
40461 @item Bit 31
40462 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40463
40464 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40465 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40466 @value{GDBN} sources.
40467
40468 @end table
40469
40470 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40471 global/static attributes in the index.
40472
40473 @smallexample
40474 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40475 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40476 switch (die->tag)
40477 @{
40478 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40479 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40480 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40481 kind = TYPE;
40482 is_static = 1;
40483 break;
40484 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40485 kind = VARIABLE;
40486 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40487 break;
40488 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40489 kind = FUNCTION;
40490 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40491 break;
40492 case DW_TAG_constant:
40493 kind = VARIABLE;
40494 is_static = ! is_external;
40495 break;
40496 case DW_TAG_variable:
40497 kind = VARIABLE;
40498 is_static = ! is_external;
40499 break;
40500 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40501 kind = TYPE;
40502 is_static = 0;
40503 break;
40504 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40505 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40506 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40507 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40508 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40509 kind = TYPE;
40510 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40511 break;
40512 default:
40513 assert (0);
40514 @}
40515 @end smallexample
40516
40517 @node Man Pages
40518 @appendix Manual pages
40519 @cindex Man pages
40520
40521 @menu
40522 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40523 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40524 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40525 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40526 @end menu
40527
40528 @node gdb man
40529 @heading gdb man
40530
40531 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40532
40533 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40534 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40535 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40536 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40537 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40538 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40539 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40540 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40541 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40542 @c man end
40543
40544 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40545 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40546 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40547 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40548
40549 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40550 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40551
40552 @itemize @bullet
40553 @item
40554 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
40555
40556 @item
40557 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
40558
40559 @item
40560 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
40561
40562 @item
40563 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
40564 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
40565 @end itemize
40566
40567 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
40568 Modula-2.
40569
40570 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
40571 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
40572 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
40573 by using the command @code{help}.
40574
40575 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
40576 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
40577 executable program as the argument:
40578
40579 @smallexample
40580 gdb program
40581 @end smallexample
40582
40583 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
40584
40585 @smallexample
40586 gdb program core
40587 @end smallexample
40588
40589 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
40590 to debug a running process:
40591
40592 @smallexample
40593 gdb program 1234
40594 gdb -p 1234
40595 @end smallexample
40596
40597 @noindent
40598 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
40599 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
40600 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
40601
40602 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
40603
40604 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
40605 @table @env
40606 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
40607 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
40608
40609 @item run [@var{arglist}]
40610 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
40611
40612 @item bt
40613 Backtrace: display the program stack.
40614
40615 @item print @var{expr}
40616 Display the value of an expression.
40617
40618 @item c
40619 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
40620
40621 @item next
40622 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
40623 function calls in the line.
40624
40625 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40626 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
40627
40628 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40629 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
40630
40631 @item step
40632 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
40633 function calls in the line.
40634
40635 @item help [@var{name}]
40636 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
40637 about using @value{GDBN}.
40638
40639 @item quit
40640 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
40641 @end table
40642
40643 @ifset man
40644 For full details on @value{GDBN},
40645 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40646 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
40647 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
40648 @end ifset
40649 @c man end
40650
40651 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
40652 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
40653 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
40654 encountered with no
40655 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
40656 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
40657 Many options have
40658 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
40659 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
40660 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
40661 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
40662 more usual convention.)
40663
40664 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
40665 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
40666 option is used.
40667
40668 @table @env
40669 @item -help
40670 @itemx -h
40671 List all options, with brief explanations.
40672
40673 @item -symbols=@var{file}
40674 @itemx -s @var{file}
40675 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
40676
40677 @item -write
40678 Enable writing into executable and core files.
40679
40680 @item -exec=@var{file}
40681 @itemx -e @var{file}
40682 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
40683 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
40684 dump.
40685
40686 @item -se=@var{file}
40687 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
40688 file.
40689
40690 @item -core=@var{file}
40691 @itemx -c @var{file}
40692 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
40693
40694 @item -command=@var{file}
40695 @itemx -x @var{file}
40696 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
40697
40698 @item -ex @var{command}
40699 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
40700
40701 @item -directory=@var{directory}
40702 @itemx -d @var{directory}
40703 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
40704
40705 @item -nh
40706 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
40707
40708 @item -nx
40709 @itemx -n
40710 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
40711
40712 @item -quiet
40713 @itemx -q
40714 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
40715 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
40716
40717 @item -batch
40718 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
40719 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
40720 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
40721 commands in the command files.
40722
40723 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
40724 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
40725 more useful, the message
40726
40727 @smallexample
40728 Program exited normally.
40729 @end smallexample
40730
40731 @noindent
40732 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
40733 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
40734
40735 @item -cd=@var{directory}
40736 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
40737 instead of the current directory.
40738
40739 @item -fullname
40740 @itemx -f
40741 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
40742 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
40743 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
40744 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
40745 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
40746 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
40747 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
40748 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
40749
40750 @item -b @var{bps}
40751 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
40752 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
40753
40754 @item -tty=@var{device}
40755 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
40756 @end table
40757 @c man end
40758
40759 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
40760 @ifset man
40761 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40762 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40763 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40764
40765 @smallexample
40766 info gdb
40767 @end smallexample
40768
40769 @noindent
40770 should give you access to the complete manual.
40771
40772 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40773 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40774 @end ifset
40775 @c man end
40776
40777 @node gdbserver man
40778 @heading gdbserver man
40779
40780 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
40781 @format
40782 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
40783 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40784
40785 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40786
40787 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40788 @c man end
40789 @end format
40790
40791 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40792 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40793 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40794
40795 @ifclear man
40796 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40797 @end ifclear
40798 @ifset man
40799 Usage (server (target) side):
40800 @end ifset
40801
40802 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40803 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40804 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40805 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40806
40807 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40808 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40809 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40810
40811 @smallexample
40812 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40813 @end smallexample
40814
40815 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40816
40817 @smallexample
40818 @ifset man
40819 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40820 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40821 @end ifset
40822 @ifclear man
40823 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40824 @end ifclear
40825 @end smallexample
40826
40827 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40828 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40829 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40830
40831 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40832
40833 @smallexample
40834 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40835 @end smallexample
40836
40837 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40838 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40839 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40840 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40841 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40842 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40843 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40844 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40845 print an error message and exit.
40846
40847 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40848 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40849
40850 @smallexample
40851 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40852 @end smallexample
40853
40854 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40855 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40856
40857 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40858 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40859 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40860 the program you want to debug.
40861
40862 @smallexample
40863 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40864 @end smallexample
40865
40866 @ifclear man
40867 @subheading Usage (host side)
40868 @end ifclear
40869 @ifset man
40870 Usage (host side):
40871 @end ifset
40872
40873 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40874 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40875 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40876 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40877 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40878 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40879 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40880 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40881 descriptor. For example:
40882
40883 @smallexample
40884 @ifset man
40885 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40886 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40887 @end ifset
40888 @ifclear man
40889 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40890 @end ifclear
40891 @end smallexample
40892
40893 @noindent
40894 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40895
40896 @smallexample
40897 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40898 @end smallexample
40899
40900 @noindent
40901 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40902 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40903 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40904 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40905 `Connection refused'.
40906
40907 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40908 described in
40909 @ifset man
40910 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40911 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40912 @end ifset
40913 @ifclear man
40914 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40915 @end ifclear
40916 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40917
40918 @smallexample
40919 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40920 @end smallexample
40921
40922 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40923 case.
40924 @c man end
40925
40926 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40927 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40928
40929 @itemize @bullet
40930
40931 @item
40932 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40933
40934 @smallexample
40935 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40936 @end smallexample
40937
40938 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40939 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40940 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40941 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40942 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40943 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40944 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40945
40946 @item
40947 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40948 program:
40949
40950 @smallexample
40951 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40952 @end smallexample
40953
40954 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40955 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40956 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40957 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40958
40959 @item
40960 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40961
40962 @smallexample
40963 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40964 @end smallexample
40965
40966 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40967 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40968 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40969 debug several processes in the same session.
40970 @end itemize
40971
40972 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40973
40974 @table @env
40975
40976 @item --help
40977 List all options, with brief explanations.
40978
40979 @item --version
40980 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40981
40982 @item --attach
40983 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40984
40985 @smallexample
40986 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40987 @end smallexample
40988
40989 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40990 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40991
40992 @item --multi
40993 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40994 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40995 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40996 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40997
40998 @smallexample
40999 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41000 @end smallexample
41001
41002 @item --debug
41003 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41004 process.
41005 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41006 the developers.
41007
41008 @item --remote-debug
41009 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41010 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41011 the developers.
41012
41013 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41014 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41015 of debugging output.
41016 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41017
41018 @item --wrapper
41019 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41020 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41021 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41022 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41023
41024 @item --once
41025 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41026 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41027 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41028 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41029
41030 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41031
41032 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41033 @c QDisableRandomization.
41034
41035 @end table
41036 @c man end
41037
41038 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41039 @ifset man
41040 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41041 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41042 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41043
41044 @smallexample
41045 info gdb
41046 @end smallexample
41047
41048 should give you access to the complete manual.
41049
41050 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41051 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41052 @end ifset
41053 @c man end
41054
41055 @node gcore man
41056 @heading gcore
41057
41058 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41059
41060 @format
41061 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41062 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41063 @c man end
41064 @end format
41065
41066 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41067 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41068 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41069 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41070 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41071 running without any change.
41072 @c man end
41073
41074 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41075 @table @env
41076 @item -o @var{filename}
41077 The optional argument
41078 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41079 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41080 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41081 @end table
41082 @c man end
41083
41084 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41085 @ifset man
41086 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41087 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41088 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41089
41090 @smallexample
41091 info gdb
41092 @end smallexample
41093
41094 @noindent
41095 should give you access to the complete manual.
41096
41097 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41098 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41099 @end ifset
41100 @c man end
41101
41102 @node gdbinit man
41103 @heading gdbinit
41104
41105 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41106
41107 @format
41108 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41109 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41110 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41111 @end ifset
41112
41113 ~/.gdbinit
41114
41115 ./.gdbinit
41116 @c man end
41117 @end format
41118
41119 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41120 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41121 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41122 described in
41123 @ifset man
41124 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41125 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41126 @end ifset
41127 @ifclear man
41128 @ref{Sequences}.
41129 @end ifclear
41130
41131 Please read more in
41132 @ifset man
41133 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41134 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41135 @end ifset
41136 @ifclear man
41137 @ref{Startup}.
41138 @end ifclear
41139
41140 @table @env
41141 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41142 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41143 @end ifset
41144 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41145 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41146 @end ifclear
41147 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41148 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41149 See more in
41150 @ifset man
41151 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41152 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41153 @end ifset
41154 @ifclear man
41155 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41156 @end ifclear
41157
41158 @item ~/.gdbinit
41159 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41160 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41161
41162 @item ./.gdbinit
41163 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41164 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41165 See more in
41166 @ifset man
41167 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41168 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41169 @end ifset
41170 @ifclear man
41171 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41172 @end ifclear
41173 @end table
41174 @c man end
41175
41176 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41177 @ifset man
41178 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41179
41180 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41181 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41182 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41183
41184 @smallexample
41185 info gdb
41186 @end smallexample
41187
41188 should give you access to the complete manual.
41189
41190 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41191 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41192 @end ifset
41193 @c man end
41194
41195 @include gpl.texi
41196
41197 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41198 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41199 @include fdl.texi
41200
41201 @node Concept Index
41202 @unnumbered Concept Index
41203
41204 @printindex cp
41205
41206 @node Command and Variable Index
41207 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41208
41209 @printindex fn
41210
41211 @tex
41212 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41213 % meantime:
41214 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41215 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41216 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41217 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41218 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41219 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41220 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41221 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41222 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41223 \page\colophon
41224 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41225 @end tex
41226
41227 @bye